| 1 |
709 |
jeremybenn |
/* Subroutines for insn-output.c for HPPA.
|
| 2 |
|
|
Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
|
| 3 |
|
|
2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
|
| 4 |
|
|
Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
| 5 |
|
|
Contributed by Tim Moore (moore@cs.utah.edu), based on sparc.c
|
| 6 |
|
|
|
| 7 |
|
|
This file is part of GCC.
|
| 8 |
|
|
|
| 9 |
|
|
GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
| 10 |
|
|
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
| 11 |
|
|
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
| 12 |
|
|
any later version.
|
| 13 |
|
|
|
| 14 |
|
|
GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
| 15 |
|
|
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
| 16 |
|
|
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
| 17 |
|
|
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
| 18 |
|
|
|
| 19 |
|
|
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
| 20 |
|
|
along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
|
| 21 |
|
|
<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
|
| 22 |
|
|
|
| 23 |
|
|
#include "config.h"
|
| 24 |
|
|
#include "system.h"
|
| 25 |
|
|
#include "coretypes.h"
|
| 26 |
|
|
#include "tm.h"
|
| 27 |
|
|
#include "rtl.h"
|
| 28 |
|
|
#include "regs.h"
|
| 29 |
|
|
#include "hard-reg-set.h"
|
| 30 |
|
|
#include "insn-config.h"
|
| 31 |
|
|
#include "conditions.h"
|
| 32 |
|
|
#include "insn-attr.h"
|
| 33 |
|
|
#include "flags.h"
|
| 34 |
|
|
#include "tree.h"
|
| 35 |
|
|
#include "output.h"
|
| 36 |
|
|
#include "except.h"
|
| 37 |
|
|
#include "expr.h"
|
| 38 |
|
|
#include "optabs.h"
|
| 39 |
|
|
#include "reload.h"
|
| 40 |
|
|
#include "integrate.h"
|
| 41 |
|
|
#include "function.h"
|
| 42 |
|
|
#include "diagnostic-core.h"
|
| 43 |
|
|
#include "ggc.h"
|
| 44 |
|
|
#include "recog.h"
|
| 45 |
|
|
#include "predict.h"
|
| 46 |
|
|
#include "tm_p.h"
|
| 47 |
|
|
#include "target.h"
|
| 48 |
|
|
#include "common/common-target.h"
|
| 49 |
|
|
#include "target-def.h"
|
| 50 |
|
|
#include "langhooks.h"
|
| 51 |
|
|
#include "df.h"
|
| 52 |
|
|
#include "opts.h"
|
| 53 |
|
|
|
| 54 |
|
|
/* Return nonzero if there is a bypass for the output of
|
| 55 |
|
|
OUT_INSN and the fp store IN_INSN. */
|
| 56 |
|
|
int
|
| 57 |
|
|
pa_fpstore_bypass_p (rtx out_insn, rtx in_insn)
|
| 58 |
|
|
{
|
| 59 |
|
|
enum machine_mode store_mode;
|
| 60 |
|
|
enum machine_mode other_mode;
|
| 61 |
|
|
rtx set;
|
| 62 |
|
|
|
| 63 |
|
|
if (recog_memoized (in_insn) < 0
|
| 64 |
|
|
|| (get_attr_type (in_insn) != TYPE_FPSTORE
|
| 65 |
|
|
&& get_attr_type (in_insn) != TYPE_FPSTORE_LOAD)
|
| 66 |
|
|
|| recog_memoized (out_insn) < 0)
|
| 67 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 68 |
|
|
|
| 69 |
|
|
store_mode = GET_MODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (in_insn)));
|
| 70 |
|
|
|
| 71 |
|
|
set = single_set (out_insn);
|
| 72 |
|
|
if (!set)
|
| 73 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 74 |
|
|
|
| 75 |
|
|
other_mode = GET_MODE (SET_SRC (set));
|
| 76 |
|
|
|
| 77 |
|
|
return (GET_MODE_SIZE (store_mode) == GET_MODE_SIZE (other_mode));
|
| 78 |
|
|
}
|
| 79 |
|
|
|
| 80 |
|
|
|
| 81 |
|
|
#ifndef DO_FRAME_NOTES
|
| 82 |
|
|
#ifdef INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
|
| 83 |
|
|
#define DO_FRAME_NOTES 1
|
| 84 |
|
|
#else
|
| 85 |
|
|
#define DO_FRAME_NOTES 0
|
| 86 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 87 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 88 |
|
|
|
| 89 |
|
|
static void pa_option_override (void);
|
| 90 |
|
|
static void copy_reg_pointer (rtx, rtx);
|
| 91 |
|
|
static void fix_range (const char *);
|
| 92 |
|
|
static int hppa_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode, reg_class_t,
|
| 93 |
|
|
reg_class_t);
|
| 94 |
|
|
static int hppa_address_cost (rtx, bool);
|
| 95 |
|
|
static bool hppa_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int, int *, bool);
|
| 96 |
|
|
static inline rtx force_mode (enum machine_mode, rtx);
|
| 97 |
|
|
static void pa_reorg (void);
|
| 98 |
|
|
static void pa_combine_instructions (void);
|
| 99 |
|
|
static int pa_can_combine_p (rtx, rtx, rtx, int, rtx, rtx, rtx);
|
| 100 |
|
|
static bool forward_branch_p (rtx);
|
| 101 |
|
|
static void compute_zdepwi_operands (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned *);
|
| 102 |
|
|
static void compute_zdepdi_operands (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned *);
|
| 103 |
|
|
static int compute_movmem_length (rtx);
|
| 104 |
|
|
static int compute_clrmem_length (rtx);
|
| 105 |
|
|
static bool pa_assemble_integer (rtx, unsigned int, int);
|
| 106 |
|
|
static void remove_useless_addtr_insns (int);
|
| 107 |
|
|
static void store_reg (int, HOST_WIDE_INT, int);
|
| 108 |
|
|
static void store_reg_modify (int, int, HOST_WIDE_INT);
|
| 109 |
|
|
static void load_reg (int, HOST_WIDE_INT, int);
|
| 110 |
|
|
static void set_reg_plus_d (int, int, HOST_WIDE_INT, int);
|
| 111 |
|
|
static rtx pa_function_value (const_tree, const_tree, bool);
|
| 112 |
|
|
static rtx pa_libcall_value (enum machine_mode, const_rtx);
|
| 113 |
|
|
static bool pa_function_value_regno_p (const unsigned int);
|
| 114 |
|
|
static void pa_output_function_prologue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
|
| 115 |
|
|
static void update_total_code_bytes (unsigned int);
|
| 116 |
|
|
static void pa_output_function_epilogue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
|
| 117 |
|
|
static int pa_adjust_cost (rtx, rtx, rtx, int);
|
| 118 |
|
|
static int pa_adjust_priority (rtx, int);
|
| 119 |
|
|
static int pa_issue_rate (void);
|
| 120 |
|
|
static void pa_som_asm_init_sections (void) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 121 |
|
|
static section *pa_som_tm_clone_table_section (void) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 122 |
|
|
static section *pa_select_section (tree, int, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
|
| 123 |
|
|
ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 124 |
|
|
static void pa_encode_section_info (tree, rtx, int);
|
| 125 |
|
|
static const char *pa_strip_name_encoding (const char *);
|
| 126 |
|
|
static bool pa_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree, tree);
|
| 127 |
|
|
static void pa_globalize_label (FILE *, const char *)
|
| 128 |
|
|
ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 129 |
|
|
static void pa_asm_output_mi_thunk (FILE *, tree, HOST_WIDE_INT,
|
| 130 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT, tree);
|
| 131 |
|
|
#if !defined(USE_COLLECT2)
|
| 132 |
|
|
static void pa_asm_out_constructor (rtx, int);
|
| 133 |
|
|
static void pa_asm_out_destructor (rtx, int);
|
| 134 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 135 |
|
|
static void pa_init_builtins (void);
|
| 136 |
|
|
static rtx pa_expand_builtin (tree, rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode mode, int);
|
| 137 |
|
|
static rtx hppa_builtin_saveregs (void);
|
| 138 |
|
|
static void hppa_va_start (tree, rtx);
|
| 139 |
|
|
static tree hppa_gimplify_va_arg_expr (tree, tree, gimple_seq *, gimple_seq *);
|
| 140 |
|
|
static bool pa_scalar_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode);
|
| 141 |
|
|
static bool pa_commutative_p (const_rtx x, int outer_code);
|
| 142 |
|
|
static void copy_fp_args (rtx) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 143 |
|
|
static int length_fp_args (rtx) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 144 |
|
|
static rtx hppa_legitimize_address (rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode);
|
| 145 |
|
|
static inline void pa_file_start_level (void) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 146 |
|
|
static inline void pa_file_start_space (int) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 147 |
|
|
static inline void pa_file_start_file (int) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 148 |
|
|
static inline void pa_file_start_mcount (const char*) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 149 |
|
|
static void pa_elf_file_start (void) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 150 |
|
|
static void pa_som_file_start (void) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 151 |
|
|
static void pa_linux_file_start (void) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 152 |
|
|
static void pa_hpux64_gas_file_start (void) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 153 |
|
|
static void pa_hpux64_hpas_file_start (void) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 154 |
|
|
static void output_deferred_plabels (void);
|
| 155 |
|
|
static void output_deferred_profile_counters (void) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
| 156 |
|
|
#ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_REAL
|
| 157 |
|
|
static void pa_hpux_file_end (void);
|
| 158 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 159 |
|
|
static void pa_init_libfuncs (void);
|
| 160 |
|
|
static rtx pa_struct_value_rtx (tree, int);
|
| 161 |
|
|
static bool pa_pass_by_reference (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
|
| 162 |
|
|
const_tree, bool);
|
| 163 |
|
|
static int pa_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
|
| 164 |
|
|
tree, bool);
|
| 165 |
|
|
static void pa_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
|
| 166 |
|
|
const_tree, bool);
|
| 167 |
|
|
static rtx pa_function_arg (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
|
| 168 |
|
|
const_tree, bool);
|
| 169 |
|
|
static unsigned int pa_function_arg_boundary (enum machine_mode, const_tree);
|
| 170 |
|
|
static struct machine_function * pa_init_machine_status (void);
|
| 171 |
|
|
static reg_class_t pa_secondary_reload (bool, rtx, reg_class_t,
|
| 172 |
|
|
enum machine_mode,
|
| 173 |
|
|
secondary_reload_info *);
|
| 174 |
|
|
static void pa_extra_live_on_entry (bitmap);
|
| 175 |
|
|
static enum machine_mode pa_promote_function_mode (const_tree,
|
| 176 |
|
|
enum machine_mode, int *,
|
| 177 |
|
|
const_tree, int);
|
| 178 |
|
|
|
| 179 |
|
|
static void pa_asm_trampoline_template (FILE *);
|
| 180 |
|
|
static void pa_trampoline_init (rtx, tree, rtx);
|
| 181 |
|
|
static rtx pa_trampoline_adjust_address (rtx);
|
| 182 |
|
|
static rtx pa_delegitimize_address (rtx);
|
| 183 |
|
|
static bool pa_print_operand_punct_valid_p (unsigned char);
|
| 184 |
|
|
static rtx pa_internal_arg_pointer (void);
|
| 185 |
|
|
static bool pa_can_eliminate (const int, const int);
|
| 186 |
|
|
static void pa_conditional_register_usage (void);
|
| 187 |
|
|
static enum machine_mode pa_c_mode_for_suffix (char);
|
| 188 |
|
|
static section *pa_function_section (tree, enum node_frequency, bool, bool);
|
| 189 |
|
|
static bool pa_cannot_force_const_mem (enum machine_mode, rtx);
|
| 190 |
|
|
static bool pa_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode, rtx);
|
| 191 |
|
|
|
| 192 |
|
|
/* The following extra sections are only used for SOM. */
|
| 193 |
|
|
static GTY(()) section *som_readonly_data_section;
|
| 194 |
|
|
static GTY(()) section *som_one_only_readonly_data_section;
|
| 195 |
|
|
static GTY(()) section *som_one_only_data_section;
|
| 196 |
|
|
static GTY(()) section *som_tm_clone_table_section;
|
| 197 |
|
|
|
| 198 |
|
|
/* Counts for the number of callee-saved general and floating point
|
| 199 |
|
|
registers which were saved by the current function's prologue. */
|
| 200 |
|
|
static int gr_saved, fr_saved;
|
| 201 |
|
|
|
| 202 |
|
|
/* Boolean indicating whether the return pointer was saved by the
|
| 203 |
|
|
current function's prologue. */
|
| 204 |
|
|
static bool rp_saved;
|
| 205 |
|
|
|
| 206 |
|
|
static rtx find_addr_reg (rtx);
|
| 207 |
|
|
|
| 208 |
|
|
/* Keep track of the number of bytes we have output in the CODE subspace
|
| 209 |
|
|
during this compilation so we'll know when to emit inline long-calls. */
|
| 210 |
|
|
unsigned long total_code_bytes;
|
| 211 |
|
|
|
| 212 |
|
|
/* The last address of the previous function plus the number of bytes in
|
| 213 |
|
|
associated thunks that have been output. This is used to determine if
|
| 214 |
|
|
a thunk can use an IA-relative branch to reach its target function. */
|
| 215 |
|
|
static unsigned int last_address;
|
| 216 |
|
|
|
| 217 |
|
|
/* Variables to handle plabels that we discover are necessary at assembly
|
| 218 |
|
|
output time. They are output after the current function. */
|
| 219 |
|
|
struct GTY(()) deferred_plabel
|
| 220 |
|
|
{
|
| 221 |
|
|
rtx internal_label;
|
| 222 |
|
|
rtx symbol;
|
| 223 |
|
|
};
|
| 224 |
|
|
static GTY((length ("n_deferred_plabels"))) struct deferred_plabel *
|
| 225 |
|
|
deferred_plabels;
|
| 226 |
|
|
static size_t n_deferred_plabels = 0;
|
| 227 |
|
|
|
| 228 |
|
|
/* Initialize the GCC target structure. */
|
| 229 |
|
|
|
| 230 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
|
| 231 |
|
|
#define TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE pa_option_override
|
| 232 |
|
|
|
| 233 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
|
| 234 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP "\t.half\t"
|
| 235 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
|
| 236 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP "\t.word\t"
|
| 237 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
|
| 238 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP "\t.dword\t"
|
| 239 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
|
| 240 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
|
| 241 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
|
| 242 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
|
| 243 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
|
| 244 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
|
| 245 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
|
| 246 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_INTEGER pa_assemble_integer
|
| 247 |
|
|
|
| 248 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
|
| 249 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE pa_output_function_prologue
|
| 250 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
|
| 251 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE pa_output_function_epilogue
|
| 252 |
|
|
|
| 253 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
|
| 254 |
|
|
#define TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE pa_function_value
|
| 255 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
|
| 256 |
|
|
#define TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE pa_libcall_value
|
| 257 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
|
| 258 |
|
|
#define TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P pa_function_value_regno_p
|
| 259 |
|
|
|
| 260 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
|
| 261 |
|
|
#define TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS hppa_legitimize_address
|
| 262 |
|
|
|
| 263 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
|
| 264 |
|
|
#define TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST pa_adjust_cost
|
| 265 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
|
| 266 |
|
|
#define TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY pa_adjust_priority
|
| 267 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
|
| 268 |
|
|
#define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE pa_issue_rate
|
| 269 |
|
|
|
| 270 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
|
| 271 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO pa_encode_section_info
|
| 272 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
|
| 273 |
|
|
#define TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING pa_strip_name_encoding
|
| 274 |
|
|
|
| 275 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
|
| 276 |
|
|
#define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL pa_function_ok_for_sibcall
|
| 277 |
|
|
|
| 278 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
|
| 279 |
|
|
#define TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P pa_commutative_p
|
| 280 |
|
|
|
| 281 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
|
| 282 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK pa_asm_output_mi_thunk
|
| 283 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
|
| 284 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK default_can_output_mi_thunk_no_vcall
|
| 285 |
|
|
|
| 286 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
|
| 287 |
|
|
#ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_REAL
|
| 288 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_FILE_END pa_hpux_file_end
|
| 289 |
|
|
#else
|
| 290 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_FILE_END output_deferred_plabels
|
| 291 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 292 |
|
|
|
| 293 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
|
| 294 |
|
|
#define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P pa_print_operand_punct_valid_p
|
| 295 |
|
|
|
| 296 |
|
|
#if !defined(USE_COLLECT2)
|
| 297 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
|
| 298 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR pa_asm_out_constructor
|
| 299 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
|
| 300 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR pa_asm_out_destructor
|
| 301 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 302 |
|
|
|
| 303 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
|
| 304 |
|
|
#define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS pa_init_builtins
|
| 305 |
|
|
|
| 306 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
|
| 307 |
|
|
#define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN pa_expand_builtin
|
| 308 |
|
|
|
| 309 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
|
| 310 |
|
|
#define TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST hppa_register_move_cost
|
| 311 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS
|
| 312 |
|
|
#define TARGET_RTX_COSTS hppa_rtx_costs
|
| 313 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
|
| 314 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ADDRESS_COST hppa_address_cost
|
| 315 |
|
|
|
| 316 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
|
| 317 |
|
|
#define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG pa_reorg
|
| 318 |
|
|
|
| 319 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
|
| 320 |
|
|
#define TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS pa_init_libfuncs
|
| 321 |
|
|
|
| 322 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
|
| 323 |
|
|
#define TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE pa_promote_function_mode
|
| 324 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
|
| 325 |
|
|
#define TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES hook_bool_const_tree_true
|
| 326 |
|
|
|
| 327 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
|
| 328 |
|
|
#define TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX pa_struct_value_rtx
|
| 329 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
|
| 330 |
|
|
#define TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY pa_return_in_memory
|
| 331 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
|
| 332 |
|
|
#define TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK must_pass_in_stack_var_size
|
| 333 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
|
| 334 |
|
|
#define TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE pa_pass_by_reference
|
| 335 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
|
| 336 |
|
|
#define TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES hook_bool_CUMULATIVE_ARGS_mode_tree_bool_true
|
| 337 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
|
| 338 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES pa_arg_partial_bytes
|
| 339 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
|
| 340 |
|
|
#define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG pa_function_arg
|
| 341 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
|
| 342 |
|
|
#define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE pa_function_arg_advance
|
| 343 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
|
| 344 |
|
|
#define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY pa_function_arg_boundary
|
| 345 |
|
|
|
| 346 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
|
| 347 |
|
|
#define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS hppa_builtin_saveregs
|
| 348 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START
|
| 349 |
|
|
#define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START hppa_va_start
|
| 350 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
|
| 351 |
|
|
#define TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR hppa_gimplify_va_arg_expr
|
| 352 |
|
|
|
| 353 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
|
| 354 |
|
|
#define TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P pa_scalar_mode_supported_p
|
| 355 |
|
|
|
| 356 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
|
| 357 |
|
|
#define TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM pa_cannot_force_const_mem
|
| 358 |
|
|
|
| 359 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
|
| 360 |
|
|
#define TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD pa_secondary_reload
|
| 361 |
|
|
|
| 362 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
|
| 363 |
|
|
#define TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY pa_extra_live_on_entry
|
| 364 |
|
|
|
| 365 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
|
| 366 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE pa_asm_trampoline_template
|
| 367 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
|
| 368 |
|
|
#define TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT pa_trampoline_init
|
| 369 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
|
| 370 |
|
|
#define TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS pa_trampoline_adjust_address
|
| 371 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
|
| 372 |
|
|
#define TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS pa_delegitimize_address
|
| 373 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_INTERNAL_ARG_POINTER
|
| 374 |
|
|
#define TARGET_INTERNAL_ARG_POINTER pa_internal_arg_pointer
|
| 375 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
|
| 376 |
|
|
#define TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE pa_can_eliminate
|
| 377 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
|
| 378 |
|
|
#define TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE pa_conditional_register_usage
|
| 379 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_C_MODE_FOR_SUFFIX
|
| 380 |
|
|
#define TARGET_C_MODE_FOR_SUFFIX pa_c_mode_for_suffix
|
| 381 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
|
| 382 |
|
|
#define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION pa_function_section
|
| 383 |
|
|
|
| 384 |
|
|
#undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
|
| 385 |
|
|
#define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P pa_legitimate_constant_p
|
| 386 |
|
|
|
| 387 |
|
|
struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
|
| 388 |
|
|
|
| 389 |
|
|
/* Parse the -mfixed-range= option string. */
|
| 390 |
|
|
|
| 391 |
|
|
static void
|
| 392 |
|
|
fix_range (const char *const_str)
|
| 393 |
|
|
{
|
| 394 |
|
|
int i, first, last;
|
| 395 |
|
|
char *str, *dash, *comma;
|
| 396 |
|
|
|
| 397 |
|
|
/* str must be of the form REG1'-'REG2{,REG1'-'REG} where REG1 and
|
| 398 |
|
|
REG2 are either register names or register numbers. The effect
|
| 399 |
|
|
of this option is to mark the registers in the range from REG1 to
|
| 400 |
|
|
REG2 as ``fixed'' so they won't be used by the compiler. This is
|
| 401 |
|
|
used, e.g., to ensure that kernel mode code doesn't use fr4-fr31. */
|
| 402 |
|
|
|
| 403 |
|
|
i = strlen (const_str);
|
| 404 |
|
|
str = (char *) alloca (i + 1);
|
| 405 |
|
|
memcpy (str, const_str, i + 1);
|
| 406 |
|
|
|
| 407 |
|
|
while (1)
|
| 408 |
|
|
{
|
| 409 |
|
|
dash = strchr (str, '-');
|
| 410 |
|
|
if (!dash)
|
| 411 |
|
|
{
|
| 412 |
|
|
warning (0, "value of -mfixed-range must have form REG1-REG2");
|
| 413 |
|
|
return;
|
| 414 |
|
|
}
|
| 415 |
|
|
*dash = '\0';
|
| 416 |
|
|
|
| 417 |
|
|
comma = strchr (dash + 1, ',');
|
| 418 |
|
|
if (comma)
|
| 419 |
|
|
*comma = '\0';
|
| 420 |
|
|
|
| 421 |
|
|
first = decode_reg_name (str);
|
| 422 |
|
|
if (first < 0)
|
| 423 |
|
|
{
|
| 424 |
|
|
warning (0, "unknown register name: %s", str);
|
| 425 |
|
|
return;
|
| 426 |
|
|
}
|
| 427 |
|
|
|
| 428 |
|
|
last = decode_reg_name (dash + 1);
|
| 429 |
|
|
if (last < 0)
|
| 430 |
|
|
{
|
| 431 |
|
|
warning (0, "unknown register name: %s", dash + 1);
|
| 432 |
|
|
return;
|
| 433 |
|
|
}
|
| 434 |
|
|
|
| 435 |
|
|
*dash = '-';
|
| 436 |
|
|
|
| 437 |
|
|
if (first > last)
|
| 438 |
|
|
{
|
| 439 |
|
|
warning (0, "%s-%s is an empty range", str, dash + 1);
|
| 440 |
|
|
return;
|
| 441 |
|
|
}
|
| 442 |
|
|
|
| 443 |
|
|
for (i = first; i <= last; ++i)
|
| 444 |
|
|
fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
|
| 445 |
|
|
|
| 446 |
|
|
if (!comma)
|
| 447 |
|
|
break;
|
| 448 |
|
|
|
| 449 |
|
|
*comma = ',';
|
| 450 |
|
|
str = comma + 1;
|
| 451 |
|
|
}
|
| 452 |
|
|
|
| 453 |
|
|
/* Check if all floating point registers have been fixed. */
|
| 454 |
|
|
for (i = FP_REG_FIRST; i <= FP_REG_LAST; i++)
|
| 455 |
|
|
if (!fixed_regs[i])
|
| 456 |
|
|
break;
|
| 457 |
|
|
|
| 458 |
|
|
if (i > FP_REG_LAST)
|
| 459 |
|
|
target_flags |= MASK_DISABLE_FPREGS;
|
| 460 |
|
|
}
|
| 461 |
|
|
|
| 462 |
|
|
/* Implement the TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE hook. */
|
| 463 |
|
|
|
| 464 |
|
|
static void
|
| 465 |
|
|
pa_option_override (void)
|
| 466 |
|
|
{
|
| 467 |
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
| 468 |
|
|
cl_deferred_option *opt;
|
| 469 |
|
|
VEC(cl_deferred_option,heap) *vec
|
| 470 |
|
|
= (VEC(cl_deferred_option,heap) *) pa_deferred_options;
|
| 471 |
|
|
|
| 472 |
|
|
FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (cl_deferred_option, vec, i, opt)
|
| 473 |
|
|
{
|
| 474 |
|
|
switch (opt->opt_index)
|
| 475 |
|
|
{
|
| 476 |
|
|
case OPT_mfixed_range_:
|
| 477 |
|
|
fix_range (opt->arg);
|
| 478 |
|
|
break;
|
| 479 |
|
|
|
| 480 |
|
|
default:
|
| 481 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 482 |
|
|
}
|
| 483 |
|
|
}
|
| 484 |
|
|
|
| 485 |
|
|
/* Unconditional branches in the delay slot are not compatible with dwarf2
|
| 486 |
|
|
call frame information. There is no benefit in using this optimization
|
| 487 |
|
|
on PA8000 and later processors. */
|
| 488 |
|
|
if (pa_cpu >= PROCESSOR_8000
|
| 489 |
|
|
|| (targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_DWARF2
|
| 490 |
|
|
&& flag_exceptions)
|
| 491 |
|
|
|| flag_unwind_tables)
|
| 492 |
|
|
target_flags &= ~MASK_JUMP_IN_DELAY;
|
| 493 |
|
|
|
| 494 |
|
|
if (flag_pic && TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME)
|
| 495 |
|
|
{
|
| 496 |
|
|
warning (0, "PIC code generation is not supported in the portable runtime model");
|
| 497 |
|
|
}
|
| 498 |
|
|
|
| 499 |
|
|
if (flag_pic && TARGET_FAST_INDIRECT_CALLS)
|
| 500 |
|
|
{
|
| 501 |
|
|
warning (0, "PIC code generation is not compatible with fast indirect calls");
|
| 502 |
|
|
}
|
| 503 |
|
|
|
| 504 |
|
|
if (! TARGET_GAS && write_symbols != NO_DEBUG)
|
| 505 |
|
|
{
|
| 506 |
|
|
warning (0, "-g is only supported when using GAS on this processor,");
|
| 507 |
|
|
warning (0, "-g option disabled");
|
| 508 |
|
|
write_symbols = NO_DEBUG;
|
| 509 |
|
|
}
|
| 510 |
|
|
|
| 511 |
|
|
/* We only support the "big PIC" model now. And we always generate PIC
|
| 512 |
|
|
code when in 64bit mode. */
|
| 513 |
|
|
if (flag_pic == 1 || TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 514 |
|
|
flag_pic = 2;
|
| 515 |
|
|
|
| 516 |
|
|
/* Disable -freorder-blocks-and-partition as we don't support hot and
|
| 517 |
|
|
cold partitioning. */
|
| 518 |
|
|
if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
|
| 519 |
|
|
{
|
| 520 |
|
|
inform (input_location,
|
| 521 |
|
|
"-freorder-blocks-and-partition does not work "
|
| 522 |
|
|
"on this architecture");
|
| 523 |
|
|
flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition = 0;
|
| 524 |
|
|
flag_reorder_blocks = 1;
|
| 525 |
|
|
}
|
| 526 |
|
|
|
| 527 |
|
|
/* We can't guarantee that .dword is available for 32-bit targets. */
|
| 528 |
|
|
if (UNITS_PER_WORD == 4)
|
| 529 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.aligned_op.di = NULL;
|
| 530 |
|
|
|
| 531 |
|
|
/* The unaligned ops are only available when using GAS. */
|
| 532 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_GAS)
|
| 533 |
|
|
{
|
| 534 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.hi = NULL;
|
| 535 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.si = NULL;
|
| 536 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.di = NULL;
|
| 537 |
|
|
}
|
| 538 |
|
|
|
| 539 |
|
|
init_machine_status = pa_init_machine_status;
|
| 540 |
|
|
}
|
| 541 |
|
|
|
| 542 |
|
|
enum pa_builtins
|
| 543 |
|
|
{
|
| 544 |
|
|
PA_BUILTIN_COPYSIGNQ,
|
| 545 |
|
|
PA_BUILTIN_FABSQ,
|
| 546 |
|
|
PA_BUILTIN_INFQ,
|
| 547 |
|
|
PA_BUILTIN_HUGE_VALQ,
|
| 548 |
|
|
PA_BUILTIN_max
|
| 549 |
|
|
};
|
| 550 |
|
|
|
| 551 |
|
|
static GTY(()) tree pa_builtins[(int) PA_BUILTIN_max];
|
| 552 |
|
|
|
| 553 |
|
|
static void
|
| 554 |
|
|
pa_init_builtins (void)
|
| 555 |
|
|
{
|
| 556 |
|
|
#ifdef DONT_HAVE_FPUTC_UNLOCKED
|
| 557 |
|
|
{
|
| 558 |
|
|
tree decl = builtin_decl_explicit (BUILT_IN_PUTC_UNLOCKED);
|
| 559 |
|
|
set_builtin_decl (BUILT_IN_FPUTC_UNLOCKED, decl,
|
| 560 |
|
|
builtin_decl_implicit_p (BUILT_IN_PUTC_UNLOCKED));
|
| 561 |
|
|
}
|
| 562 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 563 |
|
|
#if TARGET_HPUX_11
|
| 564 |
|
|
{
|
| 565 |
|
|
tree decl;
|
| 566 |
|
|
|
| 567 |
|
|
if ((decl = builtin_decl_explicit (BUILT_IN_FINITE)) != NULL_TREE)
|
| 568 |
|
|
set_user_assembler_name (decl, "_Isfinite");
|
| 569 |
|
|
if ((decl = builtin_decl_explicit (BUILT_IN_FINITEF)) != NULL_TREE)
|
| 570 |
|
|
set_user_assembler_name (decl, "_Isfinitef");
|
| 571 |
|
|
}
|
| 572 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 573 |
|
|
|
| 574 |
|
|
if (HPUX_LONG_DOUBLE_LIBRARY)
|
| 575 |
|
|
{
|
| 576 |
|
|
tree decl, ftype;
|
| 577 |
|
|
|
| 578 |
|
|
/* Under HPUX, the __float128 type is a synonym for "long double". */
|
| 579 |
|
|
(*lang_hooks.types.register_builtin_type) (long_double_type_node,
|
| 580 |
|
|
"__float128");
|
| 581 |
|
|
|
| 582 |
|
|
/* TFmode support builtins. */
|
| 583 |
|
|
ftype = build_function_type_list (long_double_type_node,
|
| 584 |
|
|
long_double_type_node,
|
| 585 |
|
|
NULL_TREE);
|
| 586 |
|
|
decl = add_builtin_function ("__builtin_fabsq", ftype,
|
| 587 |
|
|
PA_BUILTIN_FABSQ, BUILT_IN_MD,
|
| 588 |
|
|
"_U_Qfabs", NULL_TREE);
|
| 589 |
|
|
TREE_READONLY (decl) = 1;
|
| 590 |
|
|
pa_builtins[PA_BUILTIN_FABSQ] = decl;
|
| 591 |
|
|
|
| 592 |
|
|
ftype = build_function_type_list (long_double_type_node,
|
| 593 |
|
|
long_double_type_node,
|
| 594 |
|
|
long_double_type_node,
|
| 595 |
|
|
NULL_TREE);
|
| 596 |
|
|
decl = add_builtin_function ("__builtin_copysignq", ftype,
|
| 597 |
|
|
PA_BUILTIN_COPYSIGNQ, BUILT_IN_MD,
|
| 598 |
|
|
"_U_Qfcopysign", NULL_TREE);
|
| 599 |
|
|
TREE_READONLY (decl) = 1;
|
| 600 |
|
|
pa_builtins[PA_BUILTIN_COPYSIGNQ] = decl;
|
| 601 |
|
|
|
| 602 |
|
|
ftype = build_function_type_list (long_double_type_node, NULL_TREE);
|
| 603 |
|
|
decl = add_builtin_function ("__builtin_infq", ftype,
|
| 604 |
|
|
PA_BUILTIN_INFQ, BUILT_IN_MD,
|
| 605 |
|
|
NULL, NULL_TREE);
|
| 606 |
|
|
pa_builtins[PA_BUILTIN_INFQ] = decl;
|
| 607 |
|
|
|
| 608 |
|
|
decl = add_builtin_function ("__builtin_huge_valq", ftype,
|
| 609 |
|
|
PA_BUILTIN_HUGE_VALQ, BUILT_IN_MD,
|
| 610 |
|
|
NULL, NULL_TREE);
|
| 611 |
|
|
pa_builtins[PA_BUILTIN_HUGE_VALQ] = decl;
|
| 612 |
|
|
}
|
| 613 |
|
|
}
|
| 614 |
|
|
|
| 615 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 616 |
|
|
pa_expand_builtin (tree exp, rtx target, rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 617 |
|
|
enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 618 |
|
|
int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 619 |
|
|
{
|
| 620 |
|
|
tree fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (CALL_EXPR_FN (exp), 0);
|
| 621 |
|
|
unsigned int fcode = DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl);
|
| 622 |
|
|
|
| 623 |
|
|
switch (fcode)
|
| 624 |
|
|
{
|
| 625 |
|
|
case PA_BUILTIN_FABSQ:
|
| 626 |
|
|
case PA_BUILTIN_COPYSIGNQ:
|
| 627 |
|
|
return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
|
| 628 |
|
|
|
| 629 |
|
|
case PA_BUILTIN_INFQ:
|
| 630 |
|
|
case PA_BUILTIN_HUGE_VALQ:
|
| 631 |
|
|
{
|
| 632 |
|
|
enum machine_mode target_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
|
| 633 |
|
|
REAL_VALUE_TYPE inf;
|
| 634 |
|
|
rtx tmp;
|
| 635 |
|
|
|
| 636 |
|
|
real_inf (&inf);
|
| 637 |
|
|
tmp = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (inf, target_mode);
|
| 638 |
|
|
|
| 639 |
|
|
tmp = validize_mem (force_const_mem (target_mode, tmp));
|
| 640 |
|
|
|
| 641 |
|
|
if (target == 0)
|
| 642 |
|
|
target = gen_reg_rtx (target_mode);
|
| 643 |
|
|
|
| 644 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (target, tmp);
|
| 645 |
|
|
return target;
|
| 646 |
|
|
}
|
| 647 |
|
|
|
| 648 |
|
|
default:
|
| 649 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 650 |
|
|
}
|
| 651 |
|
|
|
| 652 |
|
|
return NULL_RTX;
|
| 653 |
|
|
}
|
| 654 |
|
|
|
| 655 |
|
|
/* Function to init struct machine_function.
|
| 656 |
|
|
This will be called, via a pointer variable,
|
| 657 |
|
|
from push_function_context. */
|
| 658 |
|
|
|
| 659 |
|
|
static struct machine_function *
|
| 660 |
|
|
pa_init_machine_status (void)
|
| 661 |
|
|
{
|
| 662 |
|
|
return ggc_alloc_cleared_machine_function ();
|
| 663 |
|
|
}
|
| 664 |
|
|
|
| 665 |
|
|
/* If FROM is a probable pointer register, mark TO as a probable
|
| 666 |
|
|
pointer register with the same pointer alignment as FROM. */
|
| 667 |
|
|
|
| 668 |
|
|
static void
|
| 669 |
|
|
copy_reg_pointer (rtx to, rtx from)
|
| 670 |
|
|
{
|
| 671 |
|
|
if (REG_POINTER (from))
|
| 672 |
|
|
mark_reg_pointer (to, REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (from)));
|
| 673 |
|
|
}
|
| 674 |
|
|
|
| 675 |
|
|
/* Return 1 if X contains a symbolic expression. We know these
|
| 676 |
|
|
expressions will have one of a few well defined forms, so
|
| 677 |
|
|
we need only check those forms. */
|
| 678 |
|
|
int
|
| 679 |
|
|
pa_symbolic_expression_p (rtx x)
|
| 680 |
|
|
{
|
| 681 |
|
|
|
| 682 |
|
|
/* Strip off any HIGH. */
|
| 683 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == HIGH)
|
| 684 |
|
|
x = XEXP (x, 0);
|
| 685 |
|
|
|
| 686 |
|
|
return (symbolic_operand (x, VOIDmode));
|
| 687 |
|
|
}
|
| 688 |
|
|
|
| 689 |
|
|
/* Accept any constant that can be moved in one instruction into a
|
| 690 |
|
|
general register. */
|
| 691 |
|
|
int
|
| 692 |
|
|
pa_cint_ok_for_move (HOST_WIDE_INT ival)
|
| 693 |
|
|
{
|
| 694 |
|
|
/* OK if ldo, ldil, or zdepi, can be used. */
|
| 695 |
|
|
return (VAL_14_BITS_P (ival)
|
| 696 |
|
|
|| pa_ldil_cint_p (ival)
|
| 697 |
|
|
|| pa_zdepi_cint_p (ival));
|
| 698 |
|
|
}
|
| 699 |
|
|
|
| 700 |
|
|
/* True iff ldil can be used to load this CONST_INT. The least
|
| 701 |
|
|
significant 11 bits of the value must be zero and the value must
|
| 702 |
|
|
not change sign when extended from 32 to 64 bits. */
|
| 703 |
|
|
int
|
| 704 |
|
|
pa_ldil_cint_p (HOST_WIDE_INT ival)
|
| 705 |
|
|
{
|
| 706 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT x = ival & (((HOST_WIDE_INT) -1 << 31) | 0x7ff);
|
| 707 |
|
|
|
| 708 |
|
|
return x == 0 || x == ((HOST_WIDE_INT) -1 << 31);
|
| 709 |
|
|
}
|
| 710 |
|
|
|
| 711 |
|
|
/* True iff zdepi can be used to generate this CONST_INT.
|
| 712 |
|
|
zdepi first sign extends a 5-bit signed number to a given field
|
| 713 |
|
|
length, then places this field anywhere in a zero. */
|
| 714 |
|
|
int
|
| 715 |
|
|
pa_zdepi_cint_p (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT x)
|
| 716 |
|
|
{
|
| 717 |
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lsb_mask, t;
|
| 718 |
|
|
|
| 719 |
|
|
/* This might not be obvious, but it's at least fast.
|
| 720 |
|
|
This function is critical; we don't have the time loops would take. */
|
| 721 |
|
|
lsb_mask = x & -x;
|
| 722 |
|
|
t = ((x >> 4) + lsb_mask) & ~(lsb_mask - 1);
|
| 723 |
|
|
/* Return true iff t is a power of two. */
|
| 724 |
|
|
return ((t & (t - 1)) == 0);
|
| 725 |
|
|
}
|
| 726 |
|
|
|
| 727 |
|
|
/* True iff depi or extru can be used to compute (reg & mask).
|
| 728 |
|
|
Accept bit pattern like these:
|
| 729 |
|
|
0....01....1
|
| 730 |
|
|
1....10....0
|
| 731 |
|
|
1..10..01..1 */
|
| 732 |
|
|
int
|
| 733 |
|
|
pa_and_mask_p (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask)
|
| 734 |
|
|
{
|
| 735 |
|
|
mask = ~mask;
|
| 736 |
|
|
mask += mask & -mask;
|
| 737 |
|
|
return (mask & (mask - 1)) == 0;
|
| 738 |
|
|
}
|
| 739 |
|
|
|
| 740 |
|
|
/* True iff depi can be used to compute (reg | MASK). */
|
| 741 |
|
|
int
|
| 742 |
|
|
pa_ior_mask_p (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask)
|
| 743 |
|
|
{
|
| 744 |
|
|
mask += mask & -mask;
|
| 745 |
|
|
return (mask & (mask - 1)) == 0;
|
| 746 |
|
|
}
|
| 747 |
|
|
|
| 748 |
|
|
/* Legitimize PIC addresses. If the address is already
|
| 749 |
|
|
position-independent, we return ORIG. Newly generated
|
| 750 |
|
|
position-independent addresses go to REG. If we need more
|
| 751 |
|
|
than one register, we lose. */
|
| 752 |
|
|
|
| 753 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 754 |
|
|
legitimize_pic_address (rtx orig, enum machine_mode mode, rtx reg)
|
| 755 |
|
|
{
|
| 756 |
|
|
rtx pic_ref = orig;
|
| 757 |
|
|
|
| 758 |
|
|
gcc_assert (!PA_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P (orig));
|
| 759 |
|
|
|
| 760 |
|
|
/* Labels need special handling. */
|
| 761 |
|
|
if (pic_label_operand (orig, mode))
|
| 762 |
|
|
{
|
| 763 |
|
|
rtx insn;
|
| 764 |
|
|
|
| 765 |
|
|
/* We do not want to go through the movXX expanders here since that
|
| 766 |
|
|
would create recursion.
|
| 767 |
|
|
|
| 768 |
|
|
Nor do we really want to call a generator for a named pattern
|
| 769 |
|
|
since that requires multiple patterns if we want to support
|
| 770 |
|
|
multiple word sizes.
|
| 771 |
|
|
|
| 772 |
|
|
So instead we just emit the raw set, which avoids the movXX
|
| 773 |
|
|
expanders completely. */
|
| 774 |
|
|
mark_reg_pointer (reg, BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
| 775 |
|
|
insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, orig));
|
| 776 |
|
|
|
| 777 |
|
|
/* Put a REG_EQUAL note on this insn, so that it can be optimized. */
|
| 778 |
|
|
add_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, orig);
|
| 779 |
|
|
|
| 780 |
|
|
/* During and after reload, we need to generate a REG_LABEL_OPERAND note
|
| 781 |
|
|
and update LABEL_NUSES because this is not done automatically. */
|
| 782 |
|
|
if (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
|
| 783 |
|
|
{
|
| 784 |
|
|
/* Extract LABEL_REF. */
|
| 785 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (orig) == CONST)
|
| 786 |
|
|
orig = XEXP (XEXP (orig, 0), 0);
|
| 787 |
|
|
/* Extract CODE_LABEL. */
|
| 788 |
|
|
orig = XEXP (orig, 0);
|
| 789 |
|
|
add_reg_note (insn, REG_LABEL_OPERAND, orig);
|
| 790 |
|
|
LABEL_NUSES (orig)++;
|
| 791 |
|
|
}
|
| 792 |
|
|
crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = 1;
|
| 793 |
|
|
return reg;
|
| 794 |
|
|
}
|
| 795 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (orig) == SYMBOL_REF)
|
| 796 |
|
|
{
|
| 797 |
|
|
rtx insn, tmp_reg;
|
| 798 |
|
|
|
| 799 |
|
|
gcc_assert (reg);
|
| 800 |
|
|
|
| 801 |
|
|
/* Before reload, allocate a temporary register for the intermediate
|
| 802 |
|
|
result. This allows the sequence to be deleted when the final
|
| 803 |
|
|
result is unused and the insns are trivially dead. */
|
| 804 |
|
|
tmp_reg = ((reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
|
| 805 |
|
|
? reg : gen_reg_rtx (Pmode));
|
| 806 |
|
|
|
| 807 |
|
|
if (function_label_operand (orig, VOIDmode))
|
| 808 |
|
|
{
|
| 809 |
|
|
/* Force function label into memory in word mode. */
|
| 810 |
|
|
orig = XEXP (force_const_mem (word_mode, orig), 0);
|
| 811 |
|
|
/* Load plabel address from DLT. */
|
| 812 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmp_reg,
|
| 813 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, pic_offset_table_rtx,
|
| 814 |
|
|
gen_rtx_HIGH (word_mode, orig)));
|
| 815 |
|
|
pic_ref
|
| 816 |
|
|
= gen_const_mem (Pmode,
|
| 817 |
|
|
gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, tmp_reg,
|
| 818 |
|
|
gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode,
|
| 819 |
|
|
gen_rtvec (1, orig),
|
| 820 |
|
|
UNSPEC_DLTIND14R)));
|
| 821 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (reg, pic_ref);
|
| 822 |
|
|
/* Now load address of function descriptor. */
|
| 823 |
|
|
pic_ref = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, reg);
|
| 824 |
|
|
}
|
| 825 |
|
|
else
|
| 826 |
|
|
{
|
| 827 |
|
|
/* Load symbol reference from DLT. */
|
| 828 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmp_reg,
|
| 829 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, pic_offset_table_rtx,
|
| 830 |
|
|
gen_rtx_HIGH (word_mode, orig)));
|
| 831 |
|
|
pic_ref
|
| 832 |
|
|
= gen_const_mem (Pmode,
|
| 833 |
|
|
gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, tmp_reg,
|
| 834 |
|
|
gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode,
|
| 835 |
|
|
gen_rtvec (1, orig),
|
| 836 |
|
|
UNSPEC_DLTIND14R)));
|
| 837 |
|
|
}
|
| 838 |
|
|
|
| 839 |
|
|
crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = 1;
|
| 840 |
|
|
mark_reg_pointer (reg, BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
| 841 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (reg, pic_ref);
|
| 842 |
|
|
|
| 843 |
|
|
/* Put a REG_EQUAL note on this insn, so that it can be optimized. */
|
| 844 |
|
|
set_unique_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, orig);
|
| 845 |
|
|
|
| 846 |
|
|
return reg;
|
| 847 |
|
|
}
|
| 848 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (orig) == CONST)
|
| 849 |
|
|
{
|
| 850 |
|
|
rtx base;
|
| 851 |
|
|
|
| 852 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (orig, 0)) == PLUS
|
| 853 |
|
|
&& XEXP (XEXP (orig, 0), 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx)
|
| 854 |
|
|
return orig;
|
| 855 |
|
|
|
| 856 |
|
|
gcc_assert (reg);
|
| 857 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (orig, 0)) == PLUS);
|
| 858 |
|
|
|
| 859 |
|
|
base = legitimize_pic_address (XEXP (XEXP (orig, 0), 0), Pmode, reg);
|
| 860 |
|
|
orig = legitimize_pic_address (XEXP (XEXP (orig, 0), 1), Pmode,
|
| 861 |
|
|
base == reg ? 0 : reg);
|
| 862 |
|
|
|
| 863 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (orig) == CONST_INT)
|
| 864 |
|
|
{
|
| 865 |
|
|
if (INT_14_BITS (orig))
|
| 866 |
|
|
return plus_constant (base, INTVAL (orig));
|
| 867 |
|
|
orig = force_reg (Pmode, orig);
|
| 868 |
|
|
}
|
| 869 |
|
|
pic_ref = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, base, orig);
|
| 870 |
|
|
/* Likewise, should we set special REG_NOTEs here? */
|
| 871 |
|
|
}
|
| 872 |
|
|
|
| 873 |
|
|
return pic_ref;
|
| 874 |
|
|
}
|
| 875 |
|
|
|
| 876 |
|
|
static GTY(()) rtx gen_tls_tga;
|
| 877 |
|
|
|
| 878 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 879 |
|
|
gen_tls_get_addr (void)
|
| 880 |
|
|
{
|
| 881 |
|
|
if (!gen_tls_tga)
|
| 882 |
|
|
gen_tls_tga = init_one_libfunc ("__tls_get_addr");
|
| 883 |
|
|
return gen_tls_tga;
|
| 884 |
|
|
}
|
| 885 |
|
|
|
| 886 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 887 |
|
|
hppa_tls_call (rtx arg)
|
| 888 |
|
|
{
|
| 889 |
|
|
rtx ret;
|
| 890 |
|
|
|
| 891 |
|
|
ret = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 892 |
|
|
emit_library_call_value (gen_tls_get_addr (), ret,
|
| 893 |
|
|
LCT_CONST, Pmode, 1, arg, Pmode);
|
| 894 |
|
|
|
| 895 |
|
|
return ret;
|
| 896 |
|
|
}
|
| 897 |
|
|
|
| 898 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 899 |
|
|
legitimize_tls_address (rtx addr)
|
| 900 |
|
|
{
|
| 901 |
|
|
rtx ret, insn, tmp, t1, t2, tp;
|
| 902 |
|
|
enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (addr);
|
| 903 |
|
|
|
| 904 |
|
|
switch (model)
|
| 905 |
|
|
{
|
| 906 |
|
|
case TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC:
|
| 907 |
|
|
tmp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 908 |
|
|
if (flag_pic)
|
| 909 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_tgd_load_pic (tmp, addr));
|
| 910 |
|
|
else
|
| 911 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_tgd_load (tmp, addr));
|
| 912 |
|
|
ret = hppa_tls_call (tmp);
|
| 913 |
|
|
break;
|
| 914 |
|
|
|
| 915 |
|
|
case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC:
|
| 916 |
|
|
ret = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 917 |
|
|
tmp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 918 |
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
| 919 |
|
|
if (flag_pic)
|
| 920 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_tld_load_pic (tmp, addr));
|
| 921 |
|
|
else
|
| 922 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_tld_load (tmp, addr));
|
| 923 |
|
|
t1 = hppa_tls_call (tmp);
|
| 924 |
|
|
insn = get_insns ();
|
| 925 |
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
| 926 |
|
|
t2 = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 927 |
|
|
emit_libcall_block (insn, t2, t1,
|
| 928 |
|
|
gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, const0_rtx),
|
| 929 |
|
|
UNSPEC_TLSLDBASE));
|
| 930 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_tld_offset_load (ret, addr, t2));
|
| 931 |
|
|
break;
|
| 932 |
|
|
|
| 933 |
|
|
case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC:
|
| 934 |
|
|
tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 935 |
|
|
tmp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 936 |
|
|
ret = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 937 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_tp_load (tp));
|
| 938 |
|
|
if (flag_pic)
|
| 939 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_tie_load_pic (tmp, addr));
|
| 940 |
|
|
else
|
| 941 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_tie_load (tmp, addr));
|
| 942 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (ret, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, tmp));
|
| 943 |
|
|
break;
|
| 944 |
|
|
|
| 945 |
|
|
case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC:
|
| 946 |
|
|
tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 947 |
|
|
ret = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 948 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_tp_load (tp));
|
| 949 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_tle_load (ret, addr, tp));
|
| 950 |
|
|
break;
|
| 951 |
|
|
|
| 952 |
|
|
default:
|
| 953 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 954 |
|
|
}
|
| 955 |
|
|
|
| 956 |
|
|
return ret;
|
| 957 |
|
|
}
|
| 958 |
|
|
|
| 959 |
|
|
/* Try machine-dependent ways of modifying an illegitimate address
|
| 960 |
|
|
to be legitimate. If we find one, return the new, valid address.
|
| 961 |
|
|
This macro is used in only one place: `memory_address' in explow.c.
|
| 962 |
|
|
|
| 963 |
|
|
OLDX is the address as it was before break_out_memory_refs was called.
|
| 964 |
|
|
In some cases it is useful to look at this to decide what needs to be done.
|
| 965 |
|
|
|
| 966 |
|
|
It is always safe for this macro to do nothing. It exists to recognize
|
| 967 |
|
|
opportunities to optimize the output.
|
| 968 |
|
|
|
| 969 |
|
|
For the PA, transform:
|
| 970 |
|
|
|
| 971 |
|
|
memory(X + <large int>)
|
| 972 |
|
|
|
| 973 |
|
|
into:
|
| 974 |
|
|
|
| 975 |
|
|
if (<large int> & mask) >= 16
|
| 976 |
|
|
Y = (<large int> & ~mask) + mask + 1 Round up.
|
| 977 |
|
|
else
|
| 978 |
|
|
Y = (<large int> & ~mask) Round down.
|
| 979 |
|
|
Z = X + Y
|
| 980 |
|
|
memory (Z + (<large int> - Y));
|
| 981 |
|
|
|
| 982 |
|
|
This is for CSE to find several similar references, and only use one Z.
|
| 983 |
|
|
|
| 984 |
|
|
X can either be a SYMBOL_REF or REG, but because combine cannot
|
| 985 |
|
|
perform a 4->2 combination we do nothing for SYMBOL_REF + D where
|
| 986 |
|
|
D will not fit in 14 bits.
|
| 987 |
|
|
|
| 988 |
|
|
MODE_FLOAT references allow displacements which fit in 5 bits, so use
|
| 989 |
|
|
0x1f as the mask.
|
| 990 |
|
|
|
| 991 |
|
|
MODE_INT references allow displacements which fit in 14 bits, so use
|
| 992 |
|
|
0x3fff as the mask.
|
| 993 |
|
|
|
| 994 |
|
|
This relies on the fact that most mode MODE_FLOAT references will use FP
|
| 995 |
|
|
registers and most mode MODE_INT references will use integer registers.
|
| 996 |
|
|
(In the rare case of an FP register used in an integer MODE, we depend
|
| 997 |
|
|
on secondary reloads to clean things up.)
|
| 998 |
|
|
|
| 999 |
|
|
|
| 1000 |
|
|
It is also beneficial to handle (plus (mult (X) (Y)) (Z)) in a special
|
| 1001 |
|
|
manner if Y is 2, 4, or 8. (allows more shadd insns and shifted indexed
|
| 1002 |
|
|
addressing modes to be used).
|
| 1003 |
|
|
|
| 1004 |
|
|
Put X and Z into registers. Then put the entire expression into
|
| 1005 |
|
|
a register. */
|
| 1006 |
|
|
|
| 1007 |
|
|
rtx
|
| 1008 |
|
|
hppa_legitimize_address (rtx x, rtx oldx ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 1009 |
|
|
enum machine_mode mode)
|
| 1010 |
|
|
{
|
| 1011 |
|
|
rtx orig = x;
|
| 1012 |
|
|
|
| 1013 |
|
|
/* We need to canonicalize the order of operands in unscaled indexed
|
| 1014 |
|
|
addresses since the code that checks if an address is valid doesn't
|
| 1015 |
|
|
always try both orders. */
|
| 1016 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS
|
| 1017 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
|
| 1018 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE (x) == Pmode
|
| 1019 |
|
|
&& REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
|
| 1020 |
|
|
&& REG_P (XEXP (x, 1))
|
| 1021 |
|
|
&& REG_POINTER (XEXP (x, 0))
|
| 1022 |
|
|
&& !REG_POINTER (XEXP (x, 1)))
|
| 1023 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, XEXP (x, 1), XEXP (x, 0));
|
| 1024 |
|
|
|
| 1025 |
|
|
if (PA_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P (x))
|
| 1026 |
|
|
return legitimize_tls_address (x);
|
| 1027 |
|
|
else if (flag_pic)
|
| 1028 |
|
|
return legitimize_pic_address (x, mode, gen_reg_rtx (Pmode));
|
| 1029 |
|
|
|
| 1030 |
|
|
/* Strip off CONST. */
|
| 1031 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
|
| 1032 |
|
|
x = XEXP (x, 0);
|
| 1033 |
|
|
|
| 1034 |
|
|
/* Special case. Get the SYMBOL_REF into a register and use indexing.
|
| 1035 |
|
|
That should always be safe. */
|
| 1036 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
|
| 1037 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
|
| 1038 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF)
|
| 1039 |
|
|
{
|
| 1040 |
|
|
rtx reg = force_reg (Pmode, XEXP (x, 1));
|
| 1041 |
|
|
return force_reg (Pmode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, reg, XEXP (x, 0)));
|
| 1042 |
|
|
}
|
| 1043 |
|
|
|
| 1044 |
|
|
/* Note we must reject symbols which represent function addresses
|
| 1045 |
|
|
since the assembler/linker can't handle arithmetic on plabels. */
|
| 1046 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
|
| 1047 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1048 |
|
|
&& ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
|
| 1049 |
|
|
&& !FUNCTION_NAME_P (XSTR (XEXP (x, 0), 0)))
|
| 1050 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG))
|
| 1051 |
|
|
{
|
| 1052 |
|
|
rtx int_part, ptr_reg;
|
| 1053 |
|
|
int newoffset;
|
| 1054 |
|
|
int offset = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
|
| 1055 |
|
|
int mask;
|
| 1056 |
|
|
|
| 1057 |
|
|
mask = (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
|
| 1058 |
|
|
? (INT14_OK_STRICT ? 0x3fff : 0x1f) : 0x3fff);
|
| 1059 |
|
|
|
| 1060 |
|
|
/* Choose which way to round the offset. Round up if we
|
| 1061 |
|
|
are >= halfway to the next boundary. */
|
| 1062 |
|
|
if ((offset & mask) >= ((mask + 1) / 2))
|
| 1063 |
|
|
newoffset = (offset & ~ mask) + mask + 1;
|
| 1064 |
|
|
else
|
| 1065 |
|
|
newoffset = (offset & ~ mask);
|
| 1066 |
|
|
|
| 1067 |
|
|
/* If the newoffset will not fit in 14 bits (ldo), then
|
| 1068 |
|
|
handling this would take 4 or 5 instructions (2 to load
|
| 1069 |
|
|
the SYMBOL_REF + 1 or 2 to load the newoffset + 1 to
|
| 1070 |
|
|
add the new offset and the SYMBOL_REF.) Combine can
|
| 1071 |
|
|
not handle 4->2 or 5->2 combinations, so do not create
|
| 1072 |
|
|
them. */
|
| 1073 |
|
|
if (! VAL_14_BITS_P (newoffset)
|
| 1074 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
|
| 1075 |
|
|
{
|
| 1076 |
|
|
rtx const_part = plus_constant (XEXP (x, 0), newoffset);
|
| 1077 |
|
|
rtx tmp_reg
|
| 1078 |
|
|
= force_reg (Pmode,
|
| 1079 |
|
|
gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, const_part));
|
| 1080 |
|
|
ptr_reg
|
| 1081 |
|
|
= force_reg (Pmode,
|
| 1082 |
|
|
gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode,
|
| 1083 |
|
|
tmp_reg, const_part));
|
| 1084 |
|
|
}
|
| 1085 |
|
|
else
|
| 1086 |
|
|
{
|
| 1087 |
|
|
if (! VAL_14_BITS_P (newoffset))
|
| 1088 |
|
|
int_part = force_reg (Pmode, GEN_INT (newoffset));
|
| 1089 |
|
|
else
|
| 1090 |
|
|
int_part = GEN_INT (newoffset);
|
| 1091 |
|
|
|
| 1092 |
|
|
ptr_reg = force_reg (Pmode,
|
| 1093 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
| 1094 |
|
|
force_reg (Pmode, XEXP (x, 0)),
|
| 1095 |
|
|
int_part));
|
| 1096 |
|
|
}
|
| 1097 |
|
|
return plus_constant (ptr_reg, offset - newoffset);
|
| 1098 |
|
|
}
|
| 1099 |
|
|
|
| 1100 |
|
|
/* Handle (plus (mult (a) (shadd_constant)) (b)). */
|
| 1101 |
|
|
|
| 1102 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT
|
| 1103 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1104 |
|
|
&& pa_shadd_constant_p (INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)))
|
| 1105 |
|
|
&& (OBJECT_P (XEXP (x, 1))
|
| 1106 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == SUBREG)
|
| 1107 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) != CONST)
|
| 1108 |
|
|
{
|
| 1109 |
|
|
int val = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1));
|
| 1110 |
|
|
rtx reg1, reg2;
|
| 1111 |
|
|
|
| 1112 |
|
|
reg1 = XEXP (x, 1);
|
| 1113 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg1) != REG)
|
| 1114 |
|
|
reg1 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (reg1, 0));
|
| 1115 |
|
|
|
| 1116 |
|
|
reg2 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
|
| 1117 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg2) != REG)
|
| 1118 |
|
|
reg2 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (reg2, 0));
|
| 1119 |
|
|
|
| 1120 |
|
|
return force_reg (Pmode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
| 1121 |
|
|
gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode,
|
| 1122 |
|
|
reg2,
|
| 1123 |
|
|
GEN_INT (val)),
|
| 1124 |
|
|
reg1));
|
| 1125 |
|
|
}
|
| 1126 |
|
|
|
| 1127 |
|
|
/* Similarly for (plus (plus (mult (a) (shadd_constant)) (b)) (c)).
|
| 1128 |
|
|
|
| 1129 |
|
|
Only do so for floating point modes since this is more speculative
|
| 1130 |
|
|
and we lose if it's an integer store. */
|
| 1131 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
|
| 1132 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
|
| 1133 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == MULT
|
| 1134 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1135 |
|
|
&& pa_shadd_constant_p (INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 1)))
|
| 1136 |
|
|
&& (mode == SFmode || mode == DFmode))
|
| 1137 |
|
|
{
|
| 1138 |
|
|
|
| 1139 |
|
|
/* First, try and figure out what to use as a base register. */
|
| 1140 |
|
|
rtx reg1, reg2, base, idx;
|
| 1141 |
|
|
|
| 1142 |
|
|
reg1 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
|
| 1143 |
|
|
reg2 = XEXP (x, 1);
|
| 1144 |
|
|
base = NULL_RTX;
|
| 1145 |
|
|
idx = NULL_RTX;
|
| 1146 |
|
|
|
| 1147 |
|
|
/* Make sure they're both regs. If one was a SYMBOL_REF [+ const],
|
| 1148 |
|
|
then pa_emit_move_sequence will turn on REG_POINTER so we'll know
|
| 1149 |
|
|
it's a base register below. */
|
| 1150 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg1) != REG)
|
| 1151 |
|
|
reg1 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (reg1, 0));
|
| 1152 |
|
|
|
| 1153 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg2) != REG)
|
| 1154 |
|
|
reg2 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (reg2, 0));
|
| 1155 |
|
|
|
| 1156 |
|
|
/* Figure out what the base and index are. */
|
| 1157 |
|
|
|
| 1158 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg1) == REG
|
| 1159 |
|
|
&& REG_POINTER (reg1))
|
| 1160 |
|
|
{
|
| 1161 |
|
|
base = reg1;
|
| 1162 |
|
|
idx = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
| 1163 |
|
|
gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode,
|
| 1164 |
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 0),
|
| 1165 |
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 1)),
|
| 1166 |
|
|
XEXP (x, 1));
|
| 1167 |
|
|
}
|
| 1168 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (reg2) == REG
|
| 1169 |
|
|
&& REG_POINTER (reg2))
|
| 1170 |
|
|
{
|
| 1171 |
|
|
base = reg2;
|
| 1172 |
|
|
idx = XEXP (x, 0);
|
| 1173 |
|
|
}
|
| 1174 |
|
|
|
| 1175 |
|
|
if (base == 0)
|
| 1176 |
|
|
return orig;
|
| 1177 |
|
|
|
| 1178 |
|
|
/* If the index adds a large constant, try to scale the
|
| 1179 |
|
|
constant so that it can be loaded with only one insn. */
|
| 1180 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (idx, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1181 |
|
|
&& VAL_14_BITS_P (INTVAL (XEXP (idx, 1))
|
| 1182 |
|
|
/ INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (idx, 0), 1)))
|
| 1183 |
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (idx, 1)) % INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (idx, 0), 1)) == 0)
|
| 1184 |
|
|
{
|
| 1185 |
|
|
/* Divide the CONST_INT by the scale factor, then add it to A. */
|
| 1186 |
|
|
int val = INTVAL (XEXP (idx, 1));
|
| 1187 |
|
|
|
| 1188 |
|
|
val /= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (idx, 0), 1));
|
| 1189 |
|
|
reg1 = XEXP (XEXP (idx, 0), 0);
|
| 1190 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg1) != REG)
|
| 1191 |
|
|
reg1 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (reg1, 0));
|
| 1192 |
|
|
|
| 1193 |
|
|
reg1 = force_reg (Pmode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, reg1, GEN_INT (val)));
|
| 1194 |
|
|
|
| 1195 |
|
|
/* We can now generate a simple scaled indexed address. */
|
| 1196 |
|
|
return
|
| 1197 |
|
|
force_reg
|
| 1198 |
|
|
(Pmode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
| 1199 |
|
|
gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, reg1,
|
| 1200 |
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (idx, 0), 1)),
|
| 1201 |
|
|
base));
|
| 1202 |
|
|
}
|
| 1203 |
|
|
|
| 1204 |
|
|
/* If B + C is still a valid base register, then add them. */
|
| 1205 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (idx, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1206 |
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (idx, 1)) <= 4096
|
| 1207 |
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (idx, 1)) >= -4096)
|
| 1208 |
|
|
{
|
| 1209 |
|
|
int val = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (idx, 0), 1));
|
| 1210 |
|
|
rtx reg1, reg2;
|
| 1211 |
|
|
|
| 1212 |
|
|
reg1 = force_reg (Pmode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, base, XEXP (idx, 1)));
|
| 1213 |
|
|
|
| 1214 |
|
|
reg2 = XEXP (XEXP (idx, 0), 0);
|
| 1215 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg2) != CONST_INT)
|
| 1216 |
|
|
reg2 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (reg2, 0));
|
| 1217 |
|
|
|
| 1218 |
|
|
return force_reg (Pmode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
| 1219 |
|
|
gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode,
|
| 1220 |
|
|
reg2,
|
| 1221 |
|
|
GEN_INT (val)),
|
| 1222 |
|
|
reg1));
|
| 1223 |
|
|
}
|
| 1224 |
|
|
|
| 1225 |
|
|
/* Get the index into a register, then add the base + index and
|
| 1226 |
|
|
return a register holding the result. */
|
| 1227 |
|
|
|
| 1228 |
|
|
/* First get A into a register. */
|
| 1229 |
|
|
reg1 = XEXP (XEXP (idx, 0), 0);
|
| 1230 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg1) != REG)
|
| 1231 |
|
|
reg1 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (reg1, 0));
|
| 1232 |
|
|
|
| 1233 |
|
|
/* And get B into a register. */
|
| 1234 |
|
|
reg2 = XEXP (idx, 1);
|
| 1235 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg2) != REG)
|
| 1236 |
|
|
reg2 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (reg2, 0));
|
| 1237 |
|
|
|
| 1238 |
|
|
reg1 = force_reg (Pmode,
|
| 1239 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
| 1240 |
|
|
gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, reg1,
|
| 1241 |
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (idx, 0), 1)),
|
| 1242 |
|
|
reg2));
|
| 1243 |
|
|
|
| 1244 |
|
|
/* Add the result to our base register and return. */
|
| 1245 |
|
|
return force_reg (Pmode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, base, reg1));
|
| 1246 |
|
|
|
| 1247 |
|
|
}
|
| 1248 |
|
|
|
| 1249 |
|
|
/* Uh-oh. We might have an address for x[n-100000]. This needs
|
| 1250 |
|
|
special handling to avoid creating an indexed memory address
|
| 1251 |
|
|
with x-100000 as the base.
|
| 1252 |
|
|
|
| 1253 |
|
|
If the constant part is small enough, then it's still safe because
|
| 1254 |
|
|
there is a guard page at the beginning and end of the data segment.
|
| 1255 |
|
|
|
| 1256 |
|
|
Scaled references are common enough that we want to try and rearrange the
|
| 1257 |
|
|
terms so that we can use indexing for these addresses too. Only
|
| 1258 |
|
|
do the optimization for floatint point modes. */
|
| 1259 |
|
|
|
| 1260 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
|
| 1261 |
|
|
&& pa_symbolic_expression_p (XEXP (x, 1)))
|
| 1262 |
|
|
{
|
| 1263 |
|
|
/* Ugly. We modify things here so that the address offset specified
|
| 1264 |
|
|
by the index expression is computed first, then added to x to form
|
| 1265 |
|
|
the entire address. */
|
| 1266 |
|
|
|
| 1267 |
|
|
rtx regx1, regx2, regy1, regy2, y;
|
| 1268 |
|
|
|
| 1269 |
|
|
/* Strip off any CONST. */
|
| 1270 |
|
|
y = XEXP (x, 1);
|
| 1271 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (y) == CONST)
|
| 1272 |
|
|
y = XEXP (y, 0);
|
| 1273 |
|
|
|
| 1274 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (y) == PLUS || GET_CODE (y) == MINUS)
|
| 1275 |
|
|
{
|
| 1276 |
|
|
/* See if this looks like
|
| 1277 |
|
|
(plus (mult (reg) (shadd_const))
|
| 1278 |
|
|
(const (plus (symbol_ref) (const_int))))
|
| 1279 |
|
|
|
| 1280 |
|
|
Where const_int is small. In that case the const
|
| 1281 |
|
|
expression is a valid pointer for indexing.
|
| 1282 |
|
|
|
| 1283 |
|
|
If const_int is big, but can be divided evenly by shadd_const
|
| 1284 |
|
|
and added to (reg). This allows more scaled indexed addresses. */
|
| 1285 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
|
| 1286 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT
|
| 1287 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1288 |
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (y, 1)) >= -4096
|
| 1289 |
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (y, 1)) <= 4095
|
| 1290 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1291 |
|
|
&& pa_shadd_constant_p (INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))))
|
| 1292 |
|
|
{
|
| 1293 |
|
|
int val = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1));
|
| 1294 |
|
|
rtx reg1, reg2;
|
| 1295 |
|
|
|
| 1296 |
|
|
reg1 = XEXP (x, 1);
|
| 1297 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg1) != REG)
|
| 1298 |
|
|
reg1 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (reg1, 0));
|
| 1299 |
|
|
|
| 1300 |
|
|
reg2 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
|
| 1301 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg2) != REG)
|
| 1302 |
|
|
reg2 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (reg2, 0));
|
| 1303 |
|
|
|
| 1304 |
|
|
return force_reg (Pmode,
|
| 1305 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
| 1306 |
|
|
gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode,
|
| 1307 |
|
|
reg2,
|
| 1308 |
|
|
GEN_INT (val)),
|
| 1309 |
|
|
reg1));
|
| 1310 |
|
|
}
|
| 1311 |
|
|
else if ((mode == DFmode || mode == SFmode)
|
| 1312 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
|
| 1313 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT
|
| 1314 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1315 |
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (y, 1)) % INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == 0
|
| 1316 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1317 |
|
|
&& pa_shadd_constant_p (INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))))
|
| 1318 |
|
|
{
|
| 1319 |
|
|
regx1
|
| 1320 |
|
|
= force_reg (Pmode, GEN_INT (INTVAL (XEXP (y, 1))
|
| 1321 |
|
|
/ INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))));
|
| 1322 |
|
|
regx2 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
|
| 1323 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (regx2) != REG)
|
| 1324 |
|
|
regx2 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (regx2, 0));
|
| 1325 |
|
|
regx2 = force_reg (Pmode, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (y), Pmode,
|
| 1326 |
|
|
regx2, regx1));
|
| 1327 |
|
|
return
|
| 1328 |
|
|
force_reg (Pmode,
|
| 1329 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
| 1330 |
|
|
gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, regx2,
|
| 1331 |
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)),
|
| 1332 |
|
|
force_reg (Pmode, XEXP (y, 0))));
|
| 1333 |
|
|
}
|
| 1334 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (y, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1335 |
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (y, 1)) >= -4096
|
| 1336 |
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (y, 1)) <= 4095)
|
| 1337 |
|
|
{
|
| 1338 |
|
|
/* This is safe because of the guard page at the
|
| 1339 |
|
|
beginning and end of the data space. Just
|
| 1340 |
|
|
return the original address. */
|
| 1341 |
|
|
return orig;
|
| 1342 |
|
|
}
|
| 1343 |
|
|
else
|
| 1344 |
|
|
{
|
| 1345 |
|
|
/* Doesn't look like one we can optimize. */
|
| 1346 |
|
|
regx1 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), 0));
|
| 1347 |
|
|
regy1 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), 0));
|
| 1348 |
|
|
regy2 = force_reg (Pmode, force_operand (XEXP (y, 1), 0));
|
| 1349 |
|
|
regx1 = force_reg (Pmode,
|
| 1350 |
|
|
gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (y), Pmode,
|
| 1351 |
|
|
regx1, regy2));
|
| 1352 |
|
|
return force_reg (Pmode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, regx1, regy1));
|
| 1353 |
|
|
}
|
| 1354 |
|
|
}
|
| 1355 |
|
|
}
|
| 1356 |
|
|
|
| 1357 |
|
|
return orig;
|
| 1358 |
|
|
}
|
| 1359 |
|
|
|
| 1360 |
|
|
/* Implement the TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST hook.
|
| 1361 |
|
|
|
| 1362 |
|
|
Compute extra cost of moving data between one register class
|
| 1363 |
|
|
and another.
|
| 1364 |
|
|
|
| 1365 |
|
|
Make moves from SAR so expensive they should never happen. We used to
|
| 1366 |
|
|
have 0xffff here, but that generates overflow in rare cases.
|
| 1367 |
|
|
|
| 1368 |
|
|
Copies involving a FP register and a non-FP register are relatively
|
| 1369 |
|
|
expensive because they must go through memory.
|
| 1370 |
|
|
|
| 1371 |
|
|
Other copies are reasonably cheap. */
|
| 1372 |
|
|
|
| 1373 |
|
|
static int
|
| 1374 |
|
|
hppa_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 1375 |
|
|
reg_class_t from, reg_class_t to)
|
| 1376 |
|
|
{
|
| 1377 |
|
|
if (from == SHIFT_REGS)
|
| 1378 |
|
|
return 0x100;
|
| 1379 |
|
|
else if (to == SHIFT_REGS && FP_REG_CLASS_P (from))
|
| 1380 |
|
|
return 18;
|
| 1381 |
|
|
else if ((FP_REG_CLASS_P (from) && ! FP_REG_CLASS_P (to))
|
| 1382 |
|
|
|| (FP_REG_CLASS_P (to) && ! FP_REG_CLASS_P (from)))
|
| 1383 |
|
|
return 16;
|
| 1384 |
|
|
else
|
| 1385 |
|
|
return 2;
|
| 1386 |
|
|
}
|
| 1387 |
|
|
|
| 1388 |
|
|
/* For the HPPA, REG and REG+CONST is cost 0
|
| 1389 |
|
|
and addresses involving symbolic constants are cost 2.
|
| 1390 |
|
|
|
| 1391 |
|
|
PIC addresses are very expensive.
|
| 1392 |
|
|
|
| 1393 |
|
|
It is no coincidence that this has the same structure
|
| 1394 |
|
|
as GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS. */
|
| 1395 |
|
|
|
| 1396 |
|
|
static int
|
| 1397 |
|
|
hppa_address_cost (rtx X,
|
| 1398 |
|
|
bool speed ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 1399 |
|
|
{
|
| 1400 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (X))
|
| 1401 |
|
|
{
|
| 1402 |
|
|
case REG:
|
| 1403 |
|
|
case PLUS:
|
| 1404 |
|
|
case LO_SUM:
|
| 1405 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 1406 |
|
|
case HIGH:
|
| 1407 |
|
|
return 2;
|
| 1408 |
|
|
default:
|
| 1409 |
|
|
return 4;
|
| 1410 |
|
|
}
|
| 1411 |
|
|
}
|
| 1412 |
|
|
|
| 1413 |
|
|
/* Compute a (partial) cost for rtx X. Return true if the complete
|
| 1414 |
|
|
cost has been computed, and false if subexpressions should be
|
| 1415 |
|
|
scanned. In either case, *TOTAL contains the cost result. */
|
| 1416 |
|
|
|
| 1417 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 1418 |
|
|
hppa_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int opno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 1419 |
|
|
int *total, bool speed ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 1420 |
|
|
{
|
| 1421 |
|
|
switch (code)
|
| 1422 |
|
|
{
|
| 1423 |
|
|
case CONST_INT:
|
| 1424 |
|
|
if (INTVAL (x) == 0)
|
| 1425 |
|
|
*total = 0;
|
| 1426 |
|
|
else if (INT_14_BITS (x))
|
| 1427 |
|
|
*total = 1;
|
| 1428 |
|
|
else
|
| 1429 |
|
|
*total = 2;
|
| 1430 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 1431 |
|
|
|
| 1432 |
|
|
case HIGH:
|
| 1433 |
|
|
*total = 2;
|
| 1434 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 1435 |
|
|
|
| 1436 |
|
|
case CONST:
|
| 1437 |
|
|
case LABEL_REF:
|
| 1438 |
|
|
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
| 1439 |
|
|
*total = 4;
|
| 1440 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 1441 |
|
|
|
| 1442 |
|
|
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
| 1443 |
|
|
if ((x == CONST0_RTX (DFmode) || x == CONST0_RTX (SFmode))
|
| 1444 |
|
|
&& outer_code != SET)
|
| 1445 |
|
|
*total = 0;
|
| 1446 |
|
|
else
|
| 1447 |
|
|
*total = 8;
|
| 1448 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 1449 |
|
|
|
| 1450 |
|
|
case MULT:
|
| 1451 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) == MODE_FLOAT)
|
| 1452 |
|
|
*total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
|
| 1453 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_PA_11 && !TARGET_DISABLE_FPREGS && !TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT)
|
| 1454 |
|
|
*total = COSTS_N_INSNS (8);
|
| 1455 |
|
|
else
|
| 1456 |
|
|
*total = COSTS_N_INSNS (20);
|
| 1457 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 1458 |
|
|
|
| 1459 |
|
|
case DIV:
|
| 1460 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) == MODE_FLOAT)
|
| 1461 |
|
|
{
|
| 1462 |
|
|
*total = COSTS_N_INSNS (14);
|
| 1463 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 1464 |
|
|
}
|
| 1465 |
|
|
/* FALLTHRU */
|
| 1466 |
|
|
|
| 1467 |
|
|
case UDIV:
|
| 1468 |
|
|
case MOD:
|
| 1469 |
|
|
case UMOD:
|
| 1470 |
|
|
*total = COSTS_N_INSNS (60);
|
| 1471 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 1472 |
|
|
|
| 1473 |
|
|
case PLUS: /* this includes shNadd insns */
|
| 1474 |
|
|
case MINUS:
|
| 1475 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) == MODE_FLOAT)
|
| 1476 |
|
|
*total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
|
| 1477 |
|
|
else
|
| 1478 |
|
|
*total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
|
| 1479 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 1480 |
|
|
|
| 1481 |
|
|
case ASHIFT:
|
| 1482 |
|
|
case ASHIFTRT:
|
| 1483 |
|
|
case LSHIFTRT:
|
| 1484 |
|
|
*total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
|
| 1485 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 1486 |
|
|
|
| 1487 |
|
|
default:
|
| 1488 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 1489 |
|
|
}
|
| 1490 |
|
|
}
|
| 1491 |
|
|
|
| 1492 |
|
|
/* Ensure mode of ORIG, a REG rtx, is MODE. Returns either ORIG or a
|
| 1493 |
|
|
new rtx with the correct mode. */
|
| 1494 |
|
|
static inline rtx
|
| 1495 |
|
|
force_mode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx orig)
|
| 1496 |
|
|
{
|
| 1497 |
|
|
if (mode == GET_MODE (orig))
|
| 1498 |
|
|
return orig;
|
| 1499 |
|
|
|
| 1500 |
|
|
gcc_assert (REGNO (orig) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
|
| 1501 |
|
|
|
| 1502 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (orig));
|
| 1503 |
|
|
}
|
| 1504 |
|
|
|
| 1505 |
|
|
/* Return 1 if *X is a thread-local symbol. */
|
| 1506 |
|
|
|
| 1507 |
|
|
static int
|
| 1508 |
|
|
pa_tls_symbol_ref_1 (rtx *x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 1509 |
|
|
{
|
| 1510 |
|
|
return PA_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P (*x);
|
| 1511 |
|
|
}
|
| 1512 |
|
|
|
| 1513 |
|
|
/* Return 1 if X contains a thread-local symbol. */
|
| 1514 |
|
|
|
| 1515 |
|
|
bool
|
| 1516 |
|
|
pa_tls_referenced_p (rtx x)
|
| 1517 |
|
|
{
|
| 1518 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_HAVE_TLS)
|
| 1519 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 1520 |
|
|
|
| 1521 |
|
|
return for_each_rtx (&x, &pa_tls_symbol_ref_1, 0);
|
| 1522 |
|
|
}
|
| 1523 |
|
|
|
| 1524 |
|
|
/* Implement TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM. */
|
| 1525 |
|
|
|
| 1526 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 1527 |
|
|
pa_cannot_force_const_mem (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx x)
|
| 1528 |
|
|
{
|
| 1529 |
|
|
return pa_tls_referenced_p (x);
|
| 1530 |
|
|
}
|
| 1531 |
|
|
|
| 1532 |
|
|
/* Emit insns to move operands[1] into operands[0].
|
| 1533 |
|
|
|
| 1534 |
|
|
Return 1 if we have written out everything that needs to be done to
|
| 1535 |
|
|
do the move. Otherwise, return 0 and the caller will emit the move
|
| 1536 |
|
|
normally.
|
| 1537 |
|
|
|
| 1538 |
|
|
Note SCRATCH_REG may not be in the proper mode depending on how it
|
| 1539 |
|
|
will be used. This routine is responsible for creating a new copy
|
| 1540 |
|
|
of SCRATCH_REG in the proper mode. */
|
| 1541 |
|
|
|
| 1542 |
|
|
int
|
| 1543 |
|
|
pa_emit_move_sequence (rtx *operands, enum machine_mode mode, rtx scratch_reg)
|
| 1544 |
|
|
{
|
| 1545 |
|
|
register rtx operand0 = operands[0];
|
| 1546 |
|
|
register rtx operand1 = operands[1];
|
| 1547 |
|
|
register rtx tem;
|
| 1548 |
|
|
|
| 1549 |
|
|
/* We can only handle indexed addresses in the destination operand
|
| 1550 |
|
|
of floating point stores. Thus, we need to break out indexed
|
| 1551 |
|
|
addresses from the destination operand. */
|
| 1552 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operand0) == MEM && IS_INDEX_ADDR_P (XEXP (operand0, 0)))
|
| 1553 |
|
|
{
|
| 1554 |
|
|
gcc_assert (can_create_pseudo_p ());
|
| 1555 |
|
|
|
| 1556 |
|
|
tem = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (operand0, 0));
|
| 1557 |
|
|
operand0 = replace_equiv_address (operand0, tem);
|
| 1558 |
|
|
}
|
| 1559 |
|
|
|
| 1560 |
|
|
/* On targets with non-equivalent space registers, break out unscaled
|
| 1561 |
|
|
indexed addresses from the source operand before the final CSE.
|
| 1562 |
|
|
We have to do this because the REG_POINTER flag is not correctly
|
| 1563 |
|
|
carried through various optimization passes and CSE may substitute
|
| 1564 |
|
|
a pseudo without the pointer set for one with the pointer set. As
|
| 1565 |
|
|
a result, we loose various opportunities to create insns with
|
| 1566 |
|
|
unscaled indexed addresses. */
|
| 1567 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS
|
| 1568 |
|
|
&& !cse_not_expected
|
| 1569 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operand1) == MEM
|
| 1570 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (operand1, 0)) == PLUS
|
| 1571 |
|
|
&& REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 0))
|
| 1572 |
|
|
&& REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 1)))
|
| 1573 |
|
|
operand1
|
| 1574 |
|
|
= replace_equiv_address (operand1,
|
| 1575 |
|
|
copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (operand1, 0)));
|
| 1576 |
|
|
|
| 1577 |
|
|
if (scratch_reg
|
| 1578 |
|
|
&& reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operand0) == REG
|
| 1579 |
|
|
&& REGNO (operand0) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
| 1580 |
|
|
operand0 = reg_equiv_mem (REGNO (operand0));
|
| 1581 |
|
|
else if (scratch_reg
|
| 1582 |
|
|
&& reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operand0) == SUBREG
|
| 1583 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (operand0)) == REG
|
| 1584 |
|
|
&& REGNO (SUBREG_REG (operand0)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
| 1585 |
|
|
{
|
| 1586 |
|
|
/* We must not alter SUBREG_BYTE (operand0) since that would confuse
|
| 1587 |
|
|
the code which tracks sets/uses for delete_output_reload. */
|
| 1588 |
|
|
rtx temp = gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (operand0),
|
| 1589 |
|
|
reg_equiv_mem (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (operand0))),
|
| 1590 |
|
|
SUBREG_BYTE (operand0));
|
| 1591 |
|
|
operand0 = alter_subreg (&temp);
|
| 1592 |
|
|
}
|
| 1593 |
|
|
|
| 1594 |
|
|
if (scratch_reg
|
| 1595 |
|
|
&& reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operand1) == REG
|
| 1596 |
|
|
&& REGNO (operand1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
| 1597 |
|
|
operand1 = reg_equiv_mem (REGNO (operand1));
|
| 1598 |
|
|
else if (scratch_reg
|
| 1599 |
|
|
&& reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operand1) == SUBREG
|
| 1600 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (operand1)) == REG
|
| 1601 |
|
|
&& REGNO (SUBREG_REG (operand1)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
| 1602 |
|
|
{
|
| 1603 |
|
|
/* We must not alter SUBREG_BYTE (operand0) since that would confuse
|
| 1604 |
|
|
the code which tracks sets/uses for delete_output_reload. */
|
| 1605 |
|
|
rtx temp = gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (operand1),
|
| 1606 |
|
|
reg_equiv_mem (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (operand1))),
|
| 1607 |
|
|
SUBREG_BYTE (operand1));
|
| 1608 |
|
|
operand1 = alter_subreg (&temp);
|
| 1609 |
|
|
}
|
| 1610 |
|
|
|
| 1611 |
|
|
if (scratch_reg && reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operand0) == MEM
|
| 1612 |
|
|
&& ((tem = find_replacement (&XEXP (operand0, 0)))
|
| 1613 |
|
|
!= XEXP (operand0, 0)))
|
| 1614 |
|
|
operand0 = replace_equiv_address (operand0, tem);
|
| 1615 |
|
|
|
| 1616 |
|
|
if (scratch_reg && reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operand1) == MEM
|
| 1617 |
|
|
&& ((tem = find_replacement (&XEXP (operand1, 0)))
|
| 1618 |
|
|
!= XEXP (operand1, 0)))
|
| 1619 |
|
|
operand1 = replace_equiv_address (operand1, tem);
|
| 1620 |
|
|
|
| 1621 |
|
|
/* Handle secondary reloads for loads/stores of FP registers from
|
| 1622 |
|
|
REG+D addresses where D does not fit in 5 or 14 bits, including
|
| 1623 |
|
|
(subreg (mem (addr))) cases. */
|
| 1624 |
|
|
if (scratch_reg
|
| 1625 |
|
|
&& fp_reg_operand (operand0, mode)
|
| 1626 |
|
|
&& ((GET_CODE (operand1) == MEM
|
| 1627 |
|
|
&& !memory_address_p ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 ? SFmode : DFmode),
|
| 1628 |
|
|
XEXP (operand1, 0)))
|
| 1629 |
|
|
|| ((GET_CODE (operand1) == SUBREG
|
| 1630 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (operand1, 0)) == MEM
|
| 1631 |
|
|
&& !memory_address_p ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4
|
| 1632 |
|
|
? SFmode : DFmode),
|
| 1633 |
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 0))))))
|
| 1634 |
|
|
{
|
| 1635 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operand1) == SUBREG)
|
| 1636 |
|
|
operand1 = XEXP (operand1, 0);
|
| 1637 |
|
|
|
| 1638 |
|
|
/* SCRATCH_REG will hold an address and maybe the actual data. We want
|
| 1639 |
|
|
it in WORD_MODE regardless of what mode it was originally given
|
| 1640 |
|
|
to us. */
|
| 1641 |
|
|
scratch_reg = force_mode (word_mode, scratch_reg);
|
| 1642 |
|
|
|
| 1643 |
|
|
/* D might not fit in 14 bits either; for such cases load D into
|
| 1644 |
|
|
scratch reg. */
|
| 1645 |
|
|
if (!memory_address_p (Pmode, XEXP (operand1, 0)))
|
| 1646 |
|
|
{
|
| 1647 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (scratch_reg, XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 1));
|
| 1648 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (scratch_reg,
|
| 1649 |
|
|
gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (XEXP (operand1, 0)),
|
| 1650 |
|
|
Pmode,
|
| 1651 |
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 0),
|
| 1652 |
|
|
scratch_reg));
|
| 1653 |
|
|
}
|
| 1654 |
|
|
else
|
| 1655 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (scratch_reg, XEXP (operand1, 0));
|
| 1656 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operand0,
|
| 1657 |
|
|
replace_equiv_address (operand1, scratch_reg)));
|
| 1658 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 1659 |
|
|
}
|
| 1660 |
|
|
else if (scratch_reg
|
| 1661 |
|
|
&& fp_reg_operand (operand1, mode)
|
| 1662 |
|
|
&& ((GET_CODE (operand0) == MEM
|
| 1663 |
|
|
&& !memory_address_p ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4
|
| 1664 |
|
|
? SFmode : DFmode),
|
| 1665 |
|
|
XEXP (operand0, 0)))
|
| 1666 |
|
|
|| ((GET_CODE (operand0) == SUBREG)
|
| 1667 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (operand0, 0)) == MEM
|
| 1668 |
|
|
&& !memory_address_p ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4
|
| 1669 |
|
|
? SFmode : DFmode),
|
| 1670 |
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (operand0, 0), 0)))))
|
| 1671 |
|
|
{
|
| 1672 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operand0) == SUBREG)
|
| 1673 |
|
|
operand0 = XEXP (operand0, 0);
|
| 1674 |
|
|
|
| 1675 |
|
|
/* SCRATCH_REG will hold an address and maybe the actual data. We want
|
| 1676 |
|
|
it in WORD_MODE regardless of what mode it was originally given
|
| 1677 |
|
|
to us. */
|
| 1678 |
|
|
scratch_reg = force_mode (word_mode, scratch_reg);
|
| 1679 |
|
|
|
| 1680 |
|
|
/* D might not fit in 14 bits either; for such cases load D into
|
| 1681 |
|
|
scratch reg. */
|
| 1682 |
|
|
if (!memory_address_p (Pmode, XEXP (operand0, 0)))
|
| 1683 |
|
|
{
|
| 1684 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (scratch_reg, XEXP (XEXP (operand0, 0), 1));
|
| 1685 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (scratch_reg, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (XEXP (operand0,
|
| 1686 |
|
|
0)),
|
| 1687 |
|
|
Pmode,
|
| 1688 |
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (operand0, 0),
|
| 1689 |
|
|
0),
|
| 1690 |
|
|
scratch_reg));
|
| 1691 |
|
|
}
|
| 1692 |
|
|
else
|
| 1693 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (scratch_reg, XEXP (operand0, 0));
|
| 1694 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
|
| 1695 |
|
|
replace_equiv_address (operand0, scratch_reg),
|
| 1696 |
|
|
operand1));
|
| 1697 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 1698 |
|
|
}
|
| 1699 |
|
|
/* Handle secondary reloads for loads of FP registers from constant
|
| 1700 |
|
|
expressions by forcing the constant into memory.
|
| 1701 |
|
|
|
| 1702 |
|
|
Use scratch_reg to hold the address of the memory location.
|
| 1703 |
|
|
|
| 1704 |
|
|
The proper fix is to change TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS to return
|
| 1705 |
|
|
NO_REGS when presented with a const_int and a register class
|
| 1706 |
|
|
containing only FP registers. Doing so unfortunately creates
|
| 1707 |
|
|
more problems than it solves. Fix this for 2.5. */
|
| 1708 |
|
|
else if (scratch_reg
|
| 1709 |
|
|
&& CONSTANT_P (operand1)
|
| 1710 |
|
|
&& fp_reg_operand (operand0, mode))
|
| 1711 |
|
|
{
|
| 1712 |
|
|
rtx const_mem, xoperands[2];
|
| 1713 |
|
|
|
| 1714 |
|
|
/* SCRATCH_REG will hold an address and maybe the actual data. We want
|
| 1715 |
|
|
it in WORD_MODE regardless of what mode it was originally given
|
| 1716 |
|
|
to us. */
|
| 1717 |
|
|
scratch_reg = force_mode (word_mode, scratch_reg);
|
| 1718 |
|
|
|
| 1719 |
|
|
/* Force the constant into memory and put the address of the
|
| 1720 |
|
|
memory location into scratch_reg. */
|
| 1721 |
|
|
const_mem = force_const_mem (mode, operand1);
|
| 1722 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = scratch_reg;
|
| 1723 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = XEXP (const_mem, 0);
|
| 1724 |
|
|
pa_emit_move_sequence (xoperands, Pmode, 0);
|
| 1725 |
|
|
|
| 1726 |
|
|
/* Now load the destination register. */
|
| 1727 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (mode, operand0,
|
| 1728 |
|
|
replace_equiv_address (const_mem, scratch_reg)));
|
| 1729 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 1730 |
|
|
}
|
| 1731 |
|
|
/* Handle secondary reloads for SAR. These occur when trying to load
|
| 1732 |
|
|
the SAR from memory or a constant. */
|
| 1733 |
|
|
else if (scratch_reg
|
| 1734 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operand0) == REG
|
| 1735 |
|
|
&& REGNO (operand0) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
| 1736 |
|
|
&& REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operand0)) == SHIFT_REGS
|
| 1737 |
|
|
&& (GET_CODE (operand1) == MEM || GET_CODE (operand1) == CONST_INT))
|
| 1738 |
|
|
{
|
| 1739 |
|
|
/* D might not fit in 14 bits either; for such cases load D into
|
| 1740 |
|
|
scratch reg. */
|
| 1741 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operand1) == MEM
|
| 1742 |
|
|
&& !memory_address_p (GET_MODE (operand0), XEXP (operand1, 0)))
|
| 1743 |
|
|
{
|
| 1744 |
|
|
/* We are reloading the address into the scratch register, so we
|
| 1745 |
|
|
want to make sure the scratch register is a full register. */
|
| 1746 |
|
|
scratch_reg = force_mode (word_mode, scratch_reg);
|
| 1747 |
|
|
|
| 1748 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (scratch_reg, XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 1));
|
| 1749 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (scratch_reg, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (XEXP (operand1,
|
| 1750 |
|
|
0)),
|
| 1751 |
|
|
Pmode,
|
| 1752 |
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0),
|
| 1753 |
|
|
0),
|
| 1754 |
|
|
scratch_reg));
|
| 1755 |
|
|
|
| 1756 |
|
|
/* Now we are going to load the scratch register from memory,
|
| 1757 |
|
|
we want to load it in the same width as the original MEM,
|
| 1758 |
|
|
which must be the same as the width of the ultimate destination,
|
| 1759 |
|
|
OPERAND0. */
|
| 1760 |
|
|
scratch_reg = force_mode (GET_MODE (operand0), scratch_reg);
|
| 1761 |
|
|
|
| 1762 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (scratch_reg,
|
| 1763 |
|
|
replace_equiv_address (operand1, scratch_reg));
|
| 1764 |
|
|
}
|
| 1765 |
|
|
else
|
| 1766 |
|
|
{
|
| 1767 |
|
|
/* We want to load the scratch register using the same mode as
|
| 1768 |
|
|
the ultimate destination. */
|
| 1769 |
|
|
scratch_reg = force_mode (GET_MODE (operand0), scratch_reg);
|
| 1770 |
|
|
|
| 1771 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (scratch_reg, operand1);
|
| 1772 |
|
|
}
|
| 1773 |
|
|
|
| 1774 |
|
|
/* And emit the insn to set the ultimate destination. We know that
|
| 1775 |
|
|
the scratch register has the same mode as the destination at this
|
| 1776 |
|
|
point. */
|
| 1777 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (operand0, scratch_reg);
|
| 1778 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 1779 |
|
|
}
|
| 1780 |
|
|
/* Handle the most common case: storing into a register. */
|
| 1781 |
|
|
else if (register_operand (operand0, mode))
|
| 1782 |
|
|
{
|
| 1783 |
|
|
/* Legitimize TLS symbol references. This happens for references
|
| 1784 |
|
|
that aren't a legitimate constant. */
|
| 1785 |
|
|
if (PA_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P (operand1))
|
| 1786 |
|
|
operand1 = legitimize_tls_address (operand1);
|
| 1787 |
|
|
|
| 1788 |
|
|
if (register_operand (operand1, mode)
|
| 1789 |
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (operand1) == CONST_INT
|
| 1790 |
|
|
&& pa_cint_ok_for_move (INTVAL (operand1)))
|
| 1791 |
|
|
|| (operand1 == CONST0_RTX (mode))
|
| 1792 |
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (operand1) == HIGH
|
| 1793 |
|
|
&& !symbolic_operand (XEXP (operand1, 0), VOIDmode))
|
| 1794 |
|
|
/* Only `general_operands' can come here, so MEM is ok. */
|
| 1795 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (operand1) == MEM)
|
| 1796 |
|
|
{
|
| 1797 |
|
|
/* Various sets are created during RTL generation which don't
|
| 1798 |
|
|
have the REG_POINTER flag correctly set. After the CSE pass,
|
| 1799 |
|
|
instruction recognition can fail if we don't consistently
|
| 1800 |
|
|
set this flag when performing register copies. This should
|
| 1801 |
|
|
also improve the opportunities for creating insns that use
|
| 1802 |
|
|
unscaled indexing. */
|
| 1803 |
|
|
if (REG_P (operand0) && REG_P (operand1))
|
| 1804 |
|
|
{
|
| 1805 |
|
|
if (REG_POINTER (operand1)
|
| 1806 |
|
|
&& !REG_POINTER (operand0)
|
| 1807 |
|
|
&& !HARD_REGISTER_P (operand0))
|
| 1808 |
|
|
copy_reg_pointer (operand0, operand1);
|
| 1809 |
|
|
}
|
| 1810 |
|
|
|
| 1811 |
|
|
/* When MEMs are broken out, the REG_POINTER flag doesn't
|
| 1812 |
|
|
get set. In some cases, we can set the REG_POINTER flag
|
| 1813 |
|
|
from the declaration for the MEM. */
|
| 1814 |
|
|
if (REG_P (operand0)
|
| 1815 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operand1) == MEM
|
| 1816 |
|
|
&& !REG_POINTER (operand0))
|
| 1817 |
|
|
{
|
| 1818 |
|
|
tree decl = MEM_EXPR (operand1);
|
| 1819 |
|
|
|
| 1820 |
|
|
/* Set the register pointer flag and register alignment
|
| 1821 |
|
|
if the declaration for this memory reference is a
|
| 1822 |
|
|
pointer type. */
|
| 1823 |
|
|
if (decl)
|
| 1824 |
|
|
{
|
| 1825 |
|
|
tree type;
|
| 1826 |
|
|
|
| 1827 |
|
|
/* If this is a COMPONENT_REF, use the FIELD_DECL from
|
| 1828 |
|
|
tree operand 1. */
|
| 1829 |
|
|
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == COMPONENT_REF)
|
| 1830 |
|
|
decl = TREE_OPERAND (decl, 1);
|
| 1831 |
|
|
|
| 1832 |
|
|
type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
|
| 1833 |
|
|
type = strip_array_types (type);
|
| 1834 |
|
|
|
| 1835 |
|
|
if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type))
|
| 1836 |
|
|
{
|
| 1837 |
|
|
int align;
|
| 1838 |
|
|
|
| 1839 |
|
|
type = TREE_TYPE (type);
|
| 1840 |
|
|
/* Using TYPE_ALIGN_OK is rather conservative as
|
| 1841 |
|
|
only the ada frontend actually sets it. */
|
| 1842 |
|
|
align = (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (type) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type)
|
| 1843 |
|
|
: BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
| 1844 |
|
|
mark_reg_pointer (operand0, align);
|
| 1845 |
|
|
}
|
| 1846 |
|
|
}
|
| 1847 |
|
|
}
|
| 1848 |
|
|
|
| 1849 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operand0, operand1));
|
| 1850 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 1851 |
|
|
}
|
| 1852 |
|
|
}
|
| 1853 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (operand0) == MEM)
|
| 1854 |
|
|
{
|
| 1855 |
|
|
if (mode == DFmode && operand1 == CONST0_RTX (mode)
|
| 1856 |
|
|
&& !(reload_in_progress || reload_completed))
|
| 1857 |
|
|
{
|
| 1858 |
|
|
rtx temp = gen_reg_rtx (DFmode);
|
| 1859 |
|
|
|
| 1860 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp, operand1));
|
| 1861 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operand0, temp));
|
| 1862 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 1863 |
|
|
}
|
| 1864 |
|
|
if (register_operand (operand1, mode) || operand1 == CONST0_RTX (mode))
|
| 1865 |
|
|
{
|
| 1866 |
|
|
/* Run this case quickly. */
|
| 1867 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operand0, operand1));
|
| 1868 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 1869 |
|
|
}
|
| 1870 |
|
|
if (! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed))
|
| 1871 |
|
|
{
|
| 1872 |
|
|
operands[0] = validize_mem (operand0);
|
| 1873 |
|
|
operands[1] = operand1 = force_reg (mode, operand1);
|
| 1874 |
|
|
}
|
| 1875 |
|
|
}
|
| 1876 |
|
|
|
| 1877 |
|
|
/* Simplify the source if we need to.
|
| 1878 |
|
|
Note we do have to handle function labels here, even though we do
|
| 1879 |
|
|
not consider them legitimate constants. Loop optimizations can
|
| 1880 |
|
|
call the emit_move_xxx with one as a source. */
|
| 1881 |
|
|
if ((GET_CODE (operand1) != HIGH && immediate_operand (operand1, mode))
|
| 1882 |
|
|
|| function_label_operand (operand1, VOIDmode)
|
| 1883 |
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (operand1) == HIGH
|
| 1884 |
|
|
&& symbolic_operand (XEXP (operand1, 0), mode)))
|
| 1885 |
|
|
{
|
| 1886 |
|
|
int ishighonly = 0;
|
| 1887 |
|
|
|
| 1888 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operand1) == HIGH)
|
| 1889 |
|
|
{
|
| 1890 |
|
|
ishighonly = 1;
|
| 1891 |
|
|
operand1 = XEXP (operand1, 0);
|
| 1892 |
|
|
}
|
| 1893 |
|
|
if (symbolic_operand (operand1, mode))
|
| 1894 |
|
|
{
|
| 1895 |
|
|
/* Argh. The assembler and linker can't handle arithmetic
|
| 1896 |
|
|
involving plabels.
|
| 1897 |
|
|
|
| 1898 |
|
|
So we force the plabel into memory, load operand0 from
|
| 1899 |
|
|
the memory location, then add in the constant part. */
|
| 1900 |
|
|
if ((GET_CODE (operand1) == CONST
|
| 1901 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (operand1, 0)) == PLUS
|
| 1902 |
|
|
&& function_label_operand (XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 0),
|
| 1903 |
|
|
VOIDmode))
|
| 1904 |
|
|
|| function_label_operand (operand1, VOIDmode))
|
| 1905 |
|
|
{
|
| 1906 |
|
|
rtx temp, const_part;
|
| 1907 |
|
|
|
| 1908 |
|
|
/* Figure out what (if any) scratch register to use. */
|
| 1909 |
|
|
if (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
|
| 1910 |
|
|
{
|
| 1911 |
|
|
scratch_reg = scratch_reg ? scratch_reg : operand0;
|
| 1912 |
|
|
/* SCRATCH_REG will hold an address and maybe the actual
|
| 1913 |
|
|
data. We want it in WORD_MODE regardless of what mode it
|
| 1914 |
|
|
was originally given to us. */
|
| 1915 |
|
|
scratch_reg = force_mode (word_mode, scratch_reg);
|
| 1916 |
|
|
}
|
| 1917 |
|
|
else if (flag_pic)
|
| 1918 |
|
|
scratch_reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 1919 |
|
|
|
| 1920 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operand1) == CONST)
|
| 1921 |
|
|
{
|
| 1922 |
|
|
/* Save away the constant part of the expression. */
|
| 1923 |
|
|
const_part = XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 1);
|
| 1924 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (const_part) == CONST_INT);
|
| 1925 |
|
|
|
| 1926 |
|
|
/* Force the function label into memory. */
|
| 1927 |
|
|
temp = force_const_mem (mode, XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 0));
|
| 1928 |
|
|
}
|
| 1929 |
|
|
else
|
| 1930 |
|
|
{
|
| 1931 |
|
|
/* No constant part. */
|
| 1932 |
|
|
const_part = NULL_RTX;
|
| 1933 |
|
|
|
| 1934 |
|
|
/* Force the function label into memory. */
|
| 1935 |
|
|
temp = force_const_mem (mode, operand1);
|
| 1936 |
|
|
}
|
| 1937 |
|
|
|
| 1938 |
|
|
|
| 1939 |
|
|
/* Get the address of the memory location. PIC-ify it if
|
| 1940 |
|
|
necessary. */
|
| 1941 |
|
|
temp = XEXP (temp, 0);
|
| 1942 |
|
|
if (flag_pic)
|
| 1943 |
|
|
temp = legitimize_pic_address (temp, mode, scratch_reg);
|
| 1944 |
|
|
|
| 1945 |
|
|
/* Put the address of the memory location into our destination
|
| 1946 |
|
|
register. */
|
| 1947 |
|
|
operands[1] = temp;
|
| 1948 |
|
|
pa_emit_move_sequence (operands, mode, scratch_reg);
|
| 1949 |
|
|
|
| 1950 |
|
|
/* Now load from the memory location into our destination
|
| 1951 |
|
|
register. */
|
| 1952 |
|
|
operands[1] = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, operands[0]);
|
| 1953 |
|
|
pa_emit_move_sequence (operands, mode, scratch_reg);
|
| 1954 |
|
|
|
| 1955 |
|
|
/* And add back in the constant part. */
|
| 1956 |
|
|
if (const_part != NULL_RTX)
|
| 1957 |
|
|
expand_inc (operand0, const_part);
|
| 1958 |
|
|
|
| 1959 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 1960 |
|
|
}
|
| 1961 |
|
|
|
| 1962 |
|
|
if (flag_pic)
|
| 1963 |
|
|
{
|
| 1964 |
|
|
rtx temp;
|
| 1965 |
|
|
|
| 1966 |
|
|
if (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
|
| 1967 |
|
|
{
|
| 1968 |
|
|
temp = scratch_reg ? scratch_reg : operand0;
|
| 1969 |
|
|
/* TEMP will hold an address and maybe the actual
|
| 1970 |
|
|
data. We want it in WORD_MODE regardless of what mode it
|
| 1971 |
|
|
was originally given to us. */
|
| 1972 |
|
|
temp = force_mode (word_mode, temp);
|
| 1973 |
|
|
}
|
| 1974 |
|
|
else
|
| 1975 |
|
|
temp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 1976 |
|
|
|
| 1977 |
|
|
/* (const (plus (symbol) (const_int))) must be forced to
|
| 1978 |
|
|
memory during/after reload if the const_int will not fit
|
| 1979 |
|
|
in 14 bits. */
|
| 1980 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operand1) == CONST
|
| 1981 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (operand1, 0)) == PLUS
|
| 1982 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
|
| 1983 |
|
|
&& !INT_14_BITS (XEXP (XEXP (operand1, 0), 1))
|
| 1984 |
|
|
&& (reload_completed || reload_in_progress)
|
| 1985 |
|
|
&& flag_pic)
|
| 1986 |
|
|
{
|
| 1987 |
|
|
rtx const_mem = force_const_mem (mode, operand1);
|
| 1988 |
|
|
operands[1] = legitimize_pic_address (XEXP (const_mem, 0),
|
| 1989 |
|
|
mode, temp);
|
| 1990 |
|
|
operands[1] = replace_equiv_address (const_mem, operands[1]);
|
| 1991 |
|
|
pa_emit_move_sequence (operands, mode, temp);
|
| 1992 |
|
|
}
|
| 1993 |
|
|
else
|
| 1994 |
|
|
{
|
| 1995 |
|
|
operands[1] = legitimize_pic_address (operand1, mode, temp);
|
| 1996 |
|
|
if (REG_P (operand0) && REG_P (operands[1]))
|
| 1997 |
|
|
copy_reg_pointer (operand0, operands[1]);
|
| 1998 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operand0, operands[1]));
|
| 1999 |
|
|
}
|
| 2000 |
|
|
}
|
| 2001 |
|
|
/* On the HPPA, references to data space are supposed to use dp,
|
| 2002 |
|
|
register 27, but showing it in the RTL inhibits various cse
|
| 2003 |
|
|
and loop optimizations. */
|
| 2004 |
|
|
else
|
| 2005 |
|
|
{
|
| 2006 |
|
|
rtx temp, set;
|
| 2007 |
|
|
|
| 2008 |
|
|
if (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
|
| 2009 |
|
|
{
|
| 2010 |
|
|
temp = scratch_reg ? scratch_reg : operand0;
|
| 2011 |
|
|
/* TEMP will hold an address and maybe the actual
|
| 2012 |
|
|
data. We want it in WORD_MODE regardless of what mode it
|
| 2013 |
|
|
was originally given to us. */
|
| 2014 |
|
|
temp = force_mode (word_mode, temp);
|
| 2015 |
|
|
}
|
| 2016 |
|
|
else
|
| 2017 |
|
|
temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
| 2018 |
|
|
|
| 2019 |
|
|
/* Loading a SYMBOL_REF into a register makes that register
|
| 2020 |
|
|
safe to be used as the base in an indexed address.
|
| 2021 |
|
|
|
| 2022 |
|
|
Don't mark hard registers though. That loses. */
|
| 2023 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operand0) == REG
|
| 2024 |
|
|
&& REGNO (operand0) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
| 2025 |
|
|
mark_reg_pointer (operand0, BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
| 2026 |
|
|
if (REGNO (temp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
| 2027 |
|
|
mark_reg_pointer (temp, BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
| 2028 |
|
|
|
| 2029 |
|
|
if (ishighonly)
|
| 2030 |
|
|
set = gen_rtx_SET (mode, operand0, temp);
|
| 2031 |
|
|
else
|
| 2032 |
|
|
set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
|
| 2033 |
|
|
operand0,
|
| 2034 |
|
|
gen_rtx_LO_SUM (mode, temp, operand1));
|
| 2035 |
|
|
|
| 2036 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
|
| 2037 |
|
|
temp,
|
| 2038 |
|
|
gen_rtx_HIGH (mode, operand1)));
|
| 2039 |
|
|
emit_insn (set);
|
| 2040 |
|
|
|
| 2041 |
|
|
}
|
| 2042 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 2043 |
|
|
}
|
| 2044 |
|
|
else if (pa_tls_referenced_p (operand1))
|
| 2045 |
|
|
{
|
| 2046 |
|
|
rtx tmp = operand1;
|
| 2047 |
|
|
rtx addend = NULL;
|
| 2048 |
|
|
|
| 2049 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (tmp) == CONST && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 0)) == PLUS)
|
| 2050 |
|
|
{
|
| 2051 |
|
|
addend = XEXP (XEXP (tmp, 0), 1);
|
| 2052 |
|
|
tmp = XEXP (XEXP (tmp, 0), 0);
|
| 2053 |
|
|
}
|
| 2054 |
|
|
|
| 2055 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF);
|
| 2056 |
|
|
tmp = legitimize_tls_address (tmp);
|
| 2057 |
|
|
if (addend)
|
| 2058 |
|
|
{
|
| 2059 |
|
|
tmp = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, tmp, addend);
|
| 2060 |
|
|
tmp = force_operand (tmp, operands[0]);
|
| 2061 |
|
|
}
|
| 2062 |
|
|
operands[1] = tmp;
|
| 2063 |
|
|
}
|
| 2064 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (operand1) != CONST_INT
|
| 2065 |
|
|
|| !pa_cint_ok_for_move (INTVAL (operand1)))
|
| 2066 |
|
|
{
|
| 2067 |
|
|
rtx insn, temp;
|
| 2068 |
|
|
rtx op1 = operand1;
|
| 2069 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT value = 0;
|
| 2070 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT insv = 0;
|
| 2071 |
|
|
int insert = 0;
|
| 2072 |
|
|
|
| 2073 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operand1) == CONST_INT)
|
| 2074 |
|
|
value = INTVAL (operand1);
|
| 2075 |
|
|
|
| 2076 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT
|
| 2077 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operand1) == CONST_INT
|
| 2078 |
|
|
&& HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > 32
|
| 2079 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (operand0)) > 32)
|
| 2080 |
|
|
{
|
| 2081 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT nval;
|
| 2082 |
|
|
|
| 2083 |
|
|
/* Extract the low order 32 bits of the value and sign extend.
|
| 2084 |
|
|
If the new value is the same as the original value, we can
|
| 2085 |
|
|
can use the original value as-is. If the new value is
|
| 2086 |
|
|
different, we use it and insert the most-significant 32-bits
|
| 2087 |
|
|
of the original value into the final result. */
|
| 2088 |
|
|
nval = ((value & (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 2 << 31) - 1))
|
| 2089 |
|
|
^ ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << 31)) - ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << 31);
|
| 2090 |
|
|
if (value != nval)
|
| 2091 |
|
|
{
|
| 2092 |
|
|
#if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > 32
|
| 2093 |
|
|
insv = value >= 0 ? value >> 32 : ~(~value >> 32);
|
| 2094 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 2095 |
|
|
insert = 1;
|
| 2096 |
|
|
value = nval;
|
| 2097 |
|
|
operand1 = GEN_INT (nval);
|
| 2098 |
|
|
}
|
| 2099 |
|
|
}
|
| 2100 |
|
|
|
| 2101 |
|
|
if (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
|
| 2102 |
|
|
temp = scratch_reg ? scratch_reg : operand0;
|
| 2103 |
|
|
else
|
| 2104 |
|
|
temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
| 2105 |
|
|
|
| 2106 |
|
|
/* We don't directly split DImode constants on 32-bit targets
|
| 2107 |
|
|
because PLUS uses an 11-bit immediate and the insn sequence
|
| 2108 |
|
|
generated is not as efficient as the one using HIGH/LO_SUM. */
|
| 2109 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operand1) == CONST_INT
|
| 2110 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD
|
| 2111 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
| 2112 |
|
|
&& !insert)
|
| 2113 |
|
|
{
|
| 2114 |
|
|
/* Directly break constant into high and low parts. This
|
| 2115 |
|
|
provides better optimization opportunities because various
|
| 2116 |
|
|
passes recognize constants split with PLUS but not LO_SUM.
|
| 2117 |
|
|
We use a 14-bit signed low part except when the addition
|
| 2118 |
|
|
of 0x4000 to the high part might change the sign of the
|
| 2119 |
|
|
high part. */
|
| 2120 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT low = value & 0x3fff;
|
| 2121 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT high = value & ~ 0x3fff;
|
| 2122 |
|
|
|
| 2123 |
|
|
if (low >= 0x2000)
|
| 2124 |
|
|
{
|
| 2125 |
|
|
if (high == 0x7fffc000 || (mode == HImode && high == 0x4000))
|
| 2126 |
|
|
high += 0x2000;
|
| 2127 |
|
|
else
|
| 2128 |
|
|
high += 0x4000;
|
| 2129 |
|
|
}
|
| 2130 |
|
|
|
| 2131 |
|
|
low = value - high;
|
| 2132 |
|
|
|
| 2133 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp, GEN_INT (high)));
|
| 2134 |
|
|
operands[1] = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, temp, GEN_INT (low));
|
| 2135 |
|
|
}
|
| 2136 |
|
|
else
|
| 2137 |
|
|
{
|
| 2138 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp,
|
| 2139 |
|
|
gen_rtx_HIGH (mode, operand1)));
|
| 2140 |
|
|
operands[1] = gen_rtx_LO_SUM (mode, temp, operand1);
|
| 2141 |
|
|
}
|
| 2142 |
|
|
|
| 2143 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (operands[0], operands[1]);
|
| 2144 |
|
|
|
| 2145 |
|
|
/* Now insert the most significant 32 bits of the value
|
| 2146 |
|
|
into the register. When we don't have a second register
|
| 2147 |
|
|
available, it could take up to nine instructions to load
|
| 2148 |
|
|
a 64-bit integer constant. Prior to reload, we force
|
| 2149 |
|
|
constants that would take more than three instructions
|
| 2150 |
|
|
to load to the constant pool. During and after reload,
|
| 2151 |
|
|
we have to handle all possible values. */
|
| 2152 |
|
|
if (insert)
|
| 2153 |
|
|
{
|
| 2154 |
|
|
/* Use a HIGH/LO_SUM/INSV sequence if we have a second
|
| 2155 |
|
|
register and the value to be inserted is outside the
|
| 2156 |
|
|
range that can be loaded with three depdi instructions. */
|
| 2157 |
|
|
if (temp != operand0 && (insv >= 16384 || insv < -16384))
|
| 2158 |
|
|
{
|
| 2159 |
|
|
operand1 = GEN_INT (insv);
|
| 2160 |
|
|
|
| 2161 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp,
|
| 2162 |
|
|
gen_rtx_HIGH (mode, operand1)));
|
| 2163 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (temp, gen_rtx_LO_SUM (mode, temp, operand1));
|
| 2164 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_insv (operand0, GEN_INT (32),
|
| 2165 |
|
|
const0_rtx, temp));
|
| 2166 |
|
|
}
|
| 2167 |
|
|
else
|
| 2168 |
|
|
{
|
| 2169 |
|
|
int len = 5, pos = 27;
|
| 2170 |
|
|
|
| 2171 |
|
|
/* Insert the bits using the depdi instruction. */
|
| 2172 |
|
|
while (pos >= 0)
|
| 2173 |
|
|
{
|
| 2174 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT v5 = ((insv & 31) ^ 16) - 16;
|
| 2175 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT sign = v5 < 0;
|
| 2176 |
|
|
|
| 2177 |
|
|
/* Left extend the insertion. */
|
| 2178 |
|
|
insv = (insv >= 0 ? insv >> len : ~(~insv >> len));
|
| 2179 |
|
|
while (pos > 0 && (insv & 1) == sign)
|
| 2180 |
|
|
{
|
| 2181 |
|
|
insv = (insv >= 0 ? insv >> 1 : ~(~insv >> 1));
|
| 2182 |
|
|
len += 1;
|
| 2183 |
|
|
pos -= 1;
|
| 2184 |
|
|
}
|
| 2185 |
|
|
|
| 2186 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_insv (operand0, GEN_INT (len),
|
| 2187 |
|
|
GEN_INT (pos), GEN_INT (v5)));
|
| 2188 |
|
|
|
| 2189 |
|
|
len = pos > 0 && pos < 5 ? pos : 5;
|
| 2190 |
|
|
pos -= len;
|
| 2191 |
|
|
}
|
| 2192 |
|
|
}
|
| 2193 |
|
|
}
|
| 2194 |
|
|
|
| 2195 |
|
|
set_unique_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, op1);
|
| 2196 |
|
|
|
| 2197 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 2198 |
|
|
}
|
| 2199 |
|
|
}
|
| 2200 |
|
|
/* Now have insn-emit do whatever it normally does. */
|
| 2201 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 2202 |
|
|
}
|
| 2203 |
|
|
|
| 2204 |
|
|
/* Examine EXP and return nonzero if it contains an ADDR_EXPR (meaning
|
| 2205 |
|
|
it will need a link/runtime reloc). */
|
| 2206 |
|
|
|
| 2207 |
|
|
int
|
| 2208 |
|
|
pa_reloc_needed (tree exp)
|
| 2209 |
|
|
{
|
| 2210 |
|
|
int reloc = 0;
|
| 2211 |
|
|
|
| 2212 |
|
|
switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
|
| 2213 |
|
|
{
|
| 2214 |
|
|
case ADDR_EXPR:
|
| 2215 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 2216 |
|
|
|
| 2217 |
|
|
case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
|
| 2218 |
|
|
case PLUS_EXPR:
|
| 2219 |
|
|
case MINUS_EXPR:
|
| 2220 |
|
|
reloc = pa_reloc_needed (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
| 2221 |
|
|
reloc |= pa_reloc_needed (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
|
| 2222 |
|
|
break;
|
| 2223 |
|
|
|
| 2224 |
|
|
CASE_CONVERT:
|
| 2225 |
|
|
case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
|
| 2226 |
|
|
reloc = pa_reloc_needed (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
| 2227 |
|
|
break;
|
| 2228 |
|
|
|
| 2229 |
|
|
case CONSTRUCTOR:
|
| 2230 |
|
|
{
|
| 2231 |
|
|
tree value;
|
| 2232 |
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
|
| 2233 |
|
|
|
| 2234 |
|
|
FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), ix, value)
|
| 2235 |
|
|
if (value)
|
| 2236 |
|
|
reloc |= pa_reloc_needed (value);
|
| 2237 |
|
|
}
|
| 2238 |
|
|
break;
|
| 2239 |
|
|
|
| 2240 |
|
|
case ERROR_MARK:
|
| 2241 |
|
|
break;
|
| 2242 |
|
|
|
| 2243 |
|
|
default:
|
| 2244 |
|
|
break;
|
| 2245 |
|
|
}
|
| 2246 |
|
|
return reloc;
|
| 2247 |
|
|
}
|
| 2248 |
|
|
|
| 2249 |
|
|
|
| 2250 |
|
|
/* Return the best assembler insn template
|
| 2251 |
|
|
for moving operands[1] into operands[0] as a fullword. */
|
| 2252 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 2253 |
|
|
pa_singlemove_string (rtx *operands)
|
| 2254 |
|
|
{
|
| 2255 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT intval;
|
| 2256 |
|
|
|
| 2257 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == MEM)
|
| 2258 |
|
|
return "stw %r1,%0";
|
| 2259 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == MEM)
|
| 2260 |
|
|
return "ldw %1,%0";
|
| 2261 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_DOUBLE)
|
| 2262 |
|
|
{
|
| 2263 |
|
|
long i;
|
| 2264 |
|
|
REAL_VALUE_TYPE d;
|
| 2265 |
|
|
|
| 2266 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_MODE (operands[1]) == SFmode);
|
| 2267 |
|
|
|
| 2268 |
|
|
/* Translate the CONST_DOUBLE to a CONST_INT with the same target
|
| 2269 |
|
|
bit pattern. */
|
| 2270 |
|
|
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (d, operands[1]);
|
| 2271 |
|
|
REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (d, i);
|
| 2272 |
|
|
|
| 2273 |
|
|
operands[1] = GEN_INT (i);
|
| 2274 |
|
|
/* Fall through to CONST_INT case. */
|
| 2275 |
|
|
}
|
| 2276 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_INT)
|
| 2277 |
|
|
{
|
| 2278 |
|
|
intval = INTVAL (operands[1]);
|
| 2279 |
|
|
|
| 2280 |
|
|
if (VAL_14_BITS_P (intval))
|
| 2281 |
|
|
return "ldi %1,%0";
|
| 2282 |
|
|
else if ((intval & 0x7ff) == 0)
|
| 2283 |
|
|
return "ldil L'%1,%0";
|
| 2284 |
|
|
else if (pa_zdepi_cint_p (intval))
|
| 2285 |
|
|
return "{zdepi %Z1,%0|depwi,z %Z1,%0}";
|
| 2286 |
|
|
else
|
| 2287 |
|
|
return "ldil L'%1,%0\n\tldo R'%1(%0),%0";
|
| 2288 |
|
|
}
|
| 2289 |
|
|
return "copy %1,%0";
|
| 2290 |
|
|
}
|
| 2291 |
|
|
|
| 2292 |
|
|
|
| 2293 |
|
|
/* Compute position (in OP[1]) and width (in OP[2])
|
| 2294 |
|
|
useful for copying IMM to a register using the zdepi
|
| 2295 |
|
|
instructions. Store the immediate value to insert in OP[0]. */
|
| 2296 |
|
|
static void
|
| 2297 |
|
|
compute_zdepwi_operands (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT imm, unsigned *op)
|
| 2298 |
|
|
{
|
| 2299 |
|
|
int lsb, len;
|
| 2300 |
|
|
|
| 2301 |
|
|
/* Find the least significant set bit in IMM. */
|
| 2302 |
|
|
for (lsb = 0; lsb < 32; lsb++)
|
| 2303 |
|
|
{
|
| 2304 |
|
|
if ((imm & 1) != 0)
|
| 2305 |
|
|
break;
|
| 2306 |
|
|
imm >>= 1;
|
| 2307 |
|
|
}
|
| 2308 |
|
|
|
| 2309 |
|
|
/* Choose variants based on *sign* of the 5-bit field. */
|
| 2310 |
|
|
if ((imm & 0x10) == 0)
|
| 2311 |
|
|
len = (lsb <= 28) ? 4 : 32 - lsb;
|
| 2312 |
|
|
else
|
| 2313 |
|
|
{
|
| 2314 |
|
|
/* Find the width of the bitstring in IMM. */
|
| 2315 |
|
|
for (len = 5; len < 32 - lsb; len++)
|
| 2316 |
|
|
{
|
| 2317 |
|
|
if ((imm & ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << len)) == 0)
|
| 2318 |
|
|
break;
|
| 2319 |
|
|
}
|
| 2320 |
|
|
|
| 2321 |
|
|
/* Sign extend IMM as a 5-bit value. */
|
| 2322 |
|
|
imm = (imm & 0xf) - 0x10;
|
| 2323 |
|
|
}
|
| 2324 |
|
|
|
| 2325 |
|
|
op[0] = imm;
|
| 2326 |
|
|
op[1] = 31 - lsb;
|
| 2327 |
|
|
op[2] = len;
|
| 2328 |
|
|
}
|
| 2329 |
|
|
|
| 2330 |
|
|
/* Compute position (in OP[1]) and width (in OP[2])
|
| 2331 |
|
|
useful for copying IMM to a register using the depdi,z
|
| 2332 |
|
|
instructions. Store the immediate value to insert in OP[0]. */
|
| 2333 |
|
|
|
| 2334 |
|
|
static void
|
| 2335 |
|
|
compute_zdepdi_operands (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT imm, unsigned *op)
|
| 2336 |
|
|
{
|
| 2337 |
|
|
int lsb, len, maxlen;
|
| 2338 |
|
|
|
| 2339 |
|
|
maxlen = MIN (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, 64);
|
| 2340 |
|
|
|
| 2341 |
|
|
/* Find the least significant set bit in IMM. */
|
| 2342 |
|
|
for (lsb = 0; lsb < maxlen; lsb++)
|
| 2343 |
|
|
{
|
| 2344 |
|
|
if ((imm & 1) != 0)
|
| 2345 |
|
|
break;
|
| 2346 |
|
|
imm >>= 1;
|
| 2347 |
|
|
}
|
| 2348 |
|
|
|
| 2349 |
|
|
/* Choose variants based on *sign* of the 5-bit field. */
|
| 2350 |
|
|
if ((imm & 0x10) == 0)
|
| 2351 |
|
|
len = (lsb <= maxlen - 4) ? 4 : maxlen - lsb;
|
| 2352 |
|
|
else
|
| 2353 |
|
|
{
|
| 2354 |
|
|
/* Find the width of the bitstring in IMM. */
|
| 2355 |
|
|
for (len = 5; len < maxlen - lsb; len++)
|
| 2356 |
|
|
{
|
| 2357 |
|
|
if ((imm & ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << len)) == 0)
|
| 2358 |
|
|
break;
|
| 2359 |
|
|
}
|
| 2360 |
|
|
|
| 2361 |
|
|
/* Extend length if host is narrow and IMM is negative. */
|
| 2362 |
|
|
if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 && len == maxlen - lsb)
|
| 2363 |
|
|
len += 32;
|
| 2364 |
|
|
|
| 2365 |
|
|
/* Sign extend IMM as a 5-bit value. */
|
| 2366 |
|
|
imm = (imm & 0xf) - 0x10;
|
| 2367 |
|
|
}
|
| 2368 |
|
|
|
| 2369 |
|
|
op[0] = imm;
|
| 2370 |
|
|
op[1] = 63 - lsb;
|
| 2371 |
|
|
op[2] = len;
|
| 2372 |
|
|
}
|
| 2373 |
|
|
|
| 2374 |
|
|
/* Output assembler code to perform a doubleword move insn
|
| 2375 |
|
|
with operands OPERANDS. */
|
| 2376 |
|
|
|
| 2377 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 2378 |
|
|
pa_output_move_double (rtx *operands)
|
| 2379 |
|
|
{
|
| 2380 |
|
|
enum { REGOP, OFFSOP, MEMOP, CNSTOP, RNDOP } optype0, optype1;
|
| 2381 |
|
|
rtx latehalf[2];
|
| 2382 |
|
|
rtx addreg0 = 0, addreg1 = 0;
|
| 2383 |
|
|
|
| 2384 |
|
|
/* First classify both operands. */
|
| 2385 |
|
|
|
| 2386 |
|
|
if (REG_P (operands[0]))
|
| 2387 |
|
|
optype0 = REGOP;
|
| 2388 |
|
|
else if (offsettable_memref_p (operands[0]))
|
| 2389 |
|
|
optype0 = OFFSOP;
|
| 2390 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == MEM)
|
| 2391 |
|
|
optype0 = MEMOP;
|
| 2392 |
|
|
else
|
| 2393 |
|
|
optype0 = RNDOP;
|
| 2394 |
|
|
|
| 2395 |
|
|
if (REG_P (operands[1]))
|
| 2396 |
|
|
optype1 = REGOP;
|
| 2397 |
|
|
else if (CONSTANT_P (operands[1]))
|
| 2398 |
|
|
optype1 = CNSTOP;
|
| 2399 |
|
|
else if (offsettable_memref_p (operands[1]))
|
| 2400 |
|
|
optype1 = OFFSOP;
|
| 2401 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == MEM)
|
| 2402 |
|
|
optype1 = MEMOP;
|
| 2403 |
|
|
else
|
| 2404 |
|
|
optype1 = RNDOP;
|
| 2405 |
|
|
|
| 2406 |
|
|
/* Check for the cases that the operand constraints are not
|
| 2407 |
|
|
supposed to allow to happen. */
|
| 2408 |
|
|
gcc_assert (optype0 == REGOP || optype1 == REGOP);
|
| 2409 |
|
|
|
| 2410 |
|
|
/* Handle copies between general and floating registers. */
|
| 2411 |
|
|
|
| 2412 |
|
|
if (optype0 == REGOP && optype1 == REGOP
|
| 2413 |
|
|
&& FP_REG_P (operands[0]) ^ FP_REG_P (operands[1]))
|
| 2414 |
|
|
{
|
| 2415 |
|
|
if (FP_REG_P (operands[0]))
|
| 2416 |
|
|
{
|
| 2417 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stws|stw} %1,-16(%%sp)", operands);
|
| 2418 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stws|stw} %R1,-12(%%sp)", operands);
|
| 2419 |
|
|
return "{fldds|fldd} -16(%%sp),%0";
|
| 2420 |
|
|
}
|
| 2421 |
|
|
else
|
| 2422 |
|
|
{
|
| 2423 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{fstds|fstd} %1,-16(%%sp)", operands);
|
| 2424 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{ldws|ldw} -16(%%sp),%0", operands);
|
| 2425 |
|
|
return "{ldws|ldw} -12(%%sp),%R0";
|
| 2426 |
|
|
}
|
| 2427 |
|
|
}
|
| 2428 |
|
|
|
| 2429 |
|
|
/* Handle auto decrementing and incrementing loads and stores
|
| 2430 |
|
|
specifically, since the structure of the function doesn't work
|
| 2431 |
|
|
for them without major modification. Do it better when we learn
|
| 2432 |
|
|
this port about the general inc/dec addressing of PA.
|
| 2433 |
|
|
(This was written by tege. Chide him if it doesn't work.) */
|
| 2434 |
|
|
|
| 2435 |
|
|
if (optype0 == MEMOP)
|
| 2436 |
|
|
{
|
| 2437 |
|
|
/* We have to output the address syntax ourselves, since print_operand
|
| 2438 |
|
|
doesn't deal with the addresses we want to use. Fix this later. */
|
| 2439 |
|
|
|
| 2440 |
|
|
rtx addr = XEXP (operands[0], 0);
|
| 2441 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (addr) == POST_DEC)
|
| 2442 |
|
|
{
|
| 2443 |
|
|
rtx high_reg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, operands[1], 0);
|
| 2444 |
|
|
|
| 2445 |
|
|
operands[0] = XEXP (addr, 0);
|
| 2446 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG
|
| 2447 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[0]) == REG);
|
| 2448 |
|
|
|
| 2449 |
|
|
gcc_assert (!reg_overlap_mentioned_p (high_reg, addr));
|
| 2450 |
|
|
|
| 2451 |
|
|
/* No overlap between high target register and address
|
| 2452 |
|
|
register. (We do this in a non-obvious way to
|
| 2453 |
|
|
save a register file writeback) */
|
| 2454 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (addr) == POST_INC)
|
| 2455 |
|
|
return "{stws|stw},ma %1,8(%0)\n\tstw %R1,-4(%0)";
|
| 2456 |
|
|
return "{stws|stw},ma %1,-8(%0)\n\tstw %R1,12(%0)";
|
| 2457 |
|
|
}
|
| 2458 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (addr) == PRE_DEC)
|
| 2459 |
|
|
{
|
| 2460 |
|
|
rtx high_reg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, operands[1], 0);
|
| 2461 |
|
|
|
| 2462 |
|
|
operands[0] = XEXP (addr, 0);
|
| 2463 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG
|
| 2464 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[0]) == REG);
|
| 2465 |
|
|
|
| 2466 |
|
|
gcc_assert (!reg_overlap_mentioned_p (high_reg, addr));
|
| 2467 |
|
|
/* No overlap between high target register and address
|
| 2468 |
|
|
register. (We do this in a non-obvious way to save a
|
| 2469 |
|
|
register file writeback) */
|
| 2470 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (addr) == PRE_INC)
|
| 2471 |
|
|
return "{stws|stw},mb %1,8(%0)\n\tstw %R1,4(%0)";
|
| 2472 |
|
|
return "{stws|stw},mb %1,-8(%0)\n\tstw %R1,4(%0)";
|
| 2473 |
|
|
}
|
| 2474 |
|
|
}
|
| 2475 |
|
|
if (optype1 == MEMOP)
|
| 2476 |
|
|
{
|
| 2477 |
|
|
/* We have to output the address syntax ourselves, since print_operand
|
| 2478 |
|
|
doesn't deal with the addresses we want to use. Fix this later. */
|
| 2479 |
|
|
|
| 2480 |
|
|
rtx addr = XEXP (operands[1], 0);
|
| 2481 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (addr) == POST_DEC)
|
| 2482 |
|
|
{
|
| 2483 |
|
|
rtx high_reg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, operands[0], 0);
|
| 2484 |
|
|
|
| 2485 |
|
|
operands[1] = XEXP (addr, 0);
|
| 2486 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == REG
|
| 2487 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG);
|
| 2488 |
|
|
|
| 2489 |
|
|
if (!reg_overlap_mentioned_p (high_reg, addr))
|
| 2490 |
|
|
{
|
| 2491 |
|
|
/* No overlap between high target register and address
|
| 2492 |
|
|
register. (We do this in a non-obvious way to
|
| 2493 |
|
|
save a register file writeback) */
|
| 2494 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (addr) == POST_INC)
|
| 2495 |
|
|
return "{ldws|ldw},ma 8(%1),%0\n\tldw -4(%1),%R0";
|
| 2496 |
|
|
return "{ldws|ldw},ma -8(%1),%0\n\tldw 12(%1),%R0";
|
| 2497 |
|
|
}
|
| 2498 |
|
|
else
|
| 2499 |
|
|
{
|
| 2500 |
|
|
/* This is an undefined situation. We should load into the
|
| 2501 |
|
|
address register *and* update that register. Probably
|
| 2502 |
|
|
we don't need to handle this at all. */
|
| 2503 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (addr) == POST_INC)
|
| 2504 |
|
|
return "ldw 4(%1),%R0\n\t{ldws|ldw},ma 8(%1),%0";
|
| 2505 |
|
|
return "ldw 4(%1),%R0\n\t{ldws|ldw},ma -8(%1),%0";
|
| 2506 |
|
|
}
|
| 2507 |
|
|
}
|
| 2508 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (addr) == PRE_DEC)
|
| 2509 |
|
|
{
|
| 2510 |
|
|
rtx high_reg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, operands[0], 0);
|
| 2511 |
|
|
|
| 2512 |
|
|
operands[1] = XEXP (addr, 0);
|
| 2513 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == REG
|
| 2514 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG);
|
| 2515 |
|
|
|
| 2516 |
|
|
if (!reg_overlap_mentioned_p (high_reg, addr))
|
| 2517 |
|
|
{
|
| 2518 |
|
|
/* No overlap between high target register and address
|
| 2519 |
|
|
register. (We do this in a non-obvious way to
|
| 2520 |
|
|
save a register file writeback) */
|
| 2521 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (addr) == PRE_INC)
|
| 2522 |
|
|
return "{ldws|ldw},mb 8(%1),%0\n\tldw 4(%1),%R0";
|
| 2523 |
|
|
return "{ldws|ldw},mb -8(%1),%0\n\tldw 4(%1),%R0";
|
| 2524 |
|
|
}
|
| 2525 |
|
|
else
|
| 2526 |
|
|
{
|
| 2527 |
|
|
/* This is an undefined situation. We should load into the
|
| 2528 |
|
|
address register *and* update that register. Probably
|
| 2529 |
|
|
we don't need to handle this at all. */
|
| 2530 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (addr) == PRE_INC)
|
| 2531 |
|
|
return "ldw 12(%1),%R0\n\t{ldws|ldw},mb 8(%1),%0";
|
| 2532 |
|
|
return "ldw -4(%1),%R0\n\t{ldws|ldw},mb -8(%1),%0";
|
| 2533 |
|
|
}
|
| 2534 |
|
|
}
|
| 2535 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS
|
| 2536 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 0)) == MULT)
|
| 2537 |
|
|
{
|
| 2538 |
|
|
rtx xoperands[4];
|
| 2539 |
|
|
rtx high_reg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, operands[0], 0);
|
| 2540 |
|
|
|
| 2541 |
|
|
if (!reg_overlap_mentioned_p (high_reg, addr))
|
| 2542 |
|
|
{
|
| 2543 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = high_reg;
|
| 2544 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = XEXP (addr, 1);
|
| 2545 |
|
|
xoperands[2] = XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 0);
|
| 2546 |
|
|
xoperands[3] = XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 1);
|
| 2547 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{sh%O3addl %2,%1,%0|shladd,l %2,%O3,%1,%0}",
|
| 2548 |
|
|
xoperands);
|
| 2549 |
|
|
return "ldw 4(%0),%R0\n\tldw 0(%0),%0";
|
| 2550 |
|
|
}
|
| 2551 |
|
|
else
|
| 2552 |
|
|
{
|
| 2553 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = high_reg;
|
| 2554 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = XEXP (addr, 1);
|
| 2555 |
|
|
xoperands[2] = XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 0);
|
| 2556 |
|
|
xoperands[3] = XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 1);
|
| 2557 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{sh%O3addl %2,%1,%R0|shladd,l %2,%O3,%1,%R0}",
|
| 2558 |
|
|
xoperands);
|
| 2559 |
|
|
return "ldw 0(%R0),%0\n\tldw 4(%R0),%R0";
|
| 2560 |
|
|
}
|
| 2561 |
|
|
}
|
| 2562 |
|
|
}
|
| 2563 |
|
|
|
| 2564 |
|
|
/* If an operand is an unoffsettable memory ref, find a register
|
| 2565 |
|
|
we can increment temporarily to make it refer to the second word. */
|
| 2566 |
|
|
|
| 2567 |
|
|
if (optype0 == MEMOP)
|
| 2568 |
|
|
addreg0 = find_addr_reg (XEXP (operands[0], 0));
|
| 2569 |
|
|
|
| 2570 |
|
|
if (optype1 == MEMOP)
|
| 2571 |
|
|
addreg1 = find_addr_reg (XEXP (operands[1], 0));
|
| 2572 |
|
|
|
| 2573 |
|
|
/* Ok, we can do one word at a time.
|
| 2574 |
|
|
Normally we do the low-numbered word first.
|
| 2575 |
|
|
|
| 2576 |
|
|
In either case, set up in LATEHALF the operands to use
|
| 2577 |
|
|
for the high-numbered word and in some cases alter the
|
| 2578 |
|
|
operands in OPERANDS to be suitable for the low-numbered word. */
|
| 2579 |
|
|
|
| 2580 |
|
|
if (optype0 == REGOP)
|
| 2581 |
|
|
latehalf[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[0]) + 1);
|
| 2582 |
|
|
else if (optype0 == OFFSOP)
|
| 2583 |
|
|
latehalf[0] = adjust_address (operands[0], SImode, 4);
|
| 2584 |
|
|
else
|
| 2585 |
|
|
latehalf[0] = operands[0];
|
| 2586 |
|
|
|
| 2587 |
|
|
if (optype1 == REGOP)
|
| 2588 |
|
|
latehalf[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[1]) + 1);
|
| 2589 |
|
|
else if (optype1 == OFFSOP)
|
| 2590 |
|
|
latehalf[1] = adjust_address (operands[1], SImode, 4);
|
| 2591 |
|
|
else if (optype1 == CNSTOP)
|
| 2592 |
|
|
split_double (operands[1], &operands[1], &latehalf[1]);
|
| 2593 |
|
|
else
|
| 2594 |
|
|
latehalf[1] = operands[1];
|
| 2595 |
|
|
|
| 2596 |
|
|
/* If the first move would clobber the source of the second one,
|
| 2597 |
|
|
do them in the other order.
|
| 2598 |
|
|
|
| 2599 |
|
|
This can happen in two cases:
|
| 2600 |
|
|
|
| 2601 |
|
|
mem -> register where the first half of the destination register
|
| 2602 |
|
|
is the same register used in the memory's address. Reload
|
| 2603 |
|
|
can create such insns.
|
| 2604 |
|
|
|
| 2605 |
|
|
mem in this case will be either register indirect or register
|
| 2606 |
|
|
indirect plus a valid offset.
|
| 2607 |
|
|
|
| 2608 |
|
|
register -> register move where REGNO(dst) == REGNO(src + 1)
|
| 2609 |
|
|
someone (Tim/Tege?) claimed this can happen for parameter loads.
|
| 2610 |
|
|
|
| 2611 |
|
|
Handle mem -> register case first. */
|
| 2612 |
|
|
if (optype0 == REGOP
|
| 2613 |
|
|
&& (optype1 == MEMOP || optype1 == OFFSOP)
|
| 2614 |
|
|
&& refers_to_regno_p (REGNO (operands[0]), REGNO (operands[0]) + 1,
|
| 2615 |
|
|
operands[1], 0))
|
| 2616 |
|
|
{
|
| 2617 |
|
|
/* Do the late half first. */
|
| 2618 |
|
|
if (addreg1)
|
| 2619 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo 4(%0),%0", &addreg1);
|
| 2620 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (pa_singlemove_string (latehalf), latehalf);
|
| 2621 |
|
|
|
| 2622 |
|
|
/* Then clobber. */
|
| 2623 |
|
|
if (addreg1)
|
| 2624 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo -4(%0),%0", &addreg1);
|
| 2625 |
|
|
return pa_singlemove_string (operands);
|
| 2626 |
|
|
}
|
| 2627 |
|
|
|
| 2628 |
|
|
/* Now handle register -> register case. */
|
| 2629 |
|
|
if (optype0 == REGOP && optype1 == REGOP
|
| 2630 |
|
|
&& REGNO (operands[0]) == REGNO (operands[1]) + 1)
|
| 2631 |
|
|
{
|
| 2632 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (pa_singlemove_string (latehalf), latehalf);
|
| 2633 |
|
|
return pa_singlemove_string (operands);
|
| 2634 |
|
|
}
|
| 2635 |
|
|
|
| 2636 |
|
|
/* Normal case: do the two words, low-numbered first. */
|
| 2637 |
|
|
|
| 2638 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (pa_singlemove_string (operands), operands);
|
| 2639 |
|
|
|
| 2640 |
|
|
/* Make any unoffsettable addresses point at high-numbered word. */
|
| 2641 |
|
|
if (addreg0)
|
| 2642 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo 4(%0),%0", &addreg0);
|
| 2643 |
|
|
if (addreg1)
|
| 2644 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo 4(%0),%0", &addreg1);
|
| 2645 |
|
|
|
| 2646 |
|
|
/* Do that word. */
|
| 2647 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (pa_singlemove_string (latehalf), latehalf);
|
| 2648 |
|
|
|
| 2649 |
|
|
/* Undo the adds we just did. */
|
| 2650 |
|
|
if (addreg0)
|
| 2651 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo -4(%0),%0", &addreg0);
|
| 2652 |
|
|
if (addreg1)
|
| 2653 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo -4(%0),%0", &addreg1);
|
| 2654 |
|
|
|
| 2655 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 2656 |
|
|
}
|
| 2657 |
|
|
|
| 2658 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 2659 |
|
|
pa_output_fp_move_double (rtx *operands)
|
| 2660 |
|
|
{
|
| 2661 |
|
|
if (FP_REG_P (operands[0]))
|
| 2662 |
|
|
{
|
| 2663 |
|
|
if (FP_REG_P (operands[1])
|
| 2664 |
|
|
|| operands[1] == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (operands[0])))
|
| 2665 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("fcpy,dbl %f1,%0", operands);
|
| 2666 |
|
|
else
|
| 2667 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("fldd%F1 %1,%0", operands);
|
| 2668 |
|
|
}
|
| 2669 |
|
|
else if (FP_REG_P (operands[1]))
|
| 2670 |
|
|
{
|
| 2671 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("fstd%F0 %1,%0", operands);
|
| 2672 |
|
|
}
|
| 2673 |
|
|
else
|
| 2674 |
|
|
{
|
| 2675 |
|
|
rtx xoperands[2];
|
| 2676 |
|
|
|
| 2677 |
|
|
gcc_assert (operands[1] == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (operands[0])));
|
| 2678 |
|
|
|
| 2679 |
|
|
/* This is a pain. You have to be prepared to deal with an
|
| 2680 |
|
|
arbitrary address here including pre/post increment/decrement.
|
| 2681 |
|
|
|
| 2682 |
|
|
so avoid this in the MD. */
|
| 2683 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == REG);
|
| 2684 |
|
|
|
| 2685 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[0]) + 1);
|
| 2686 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = operands[0];
|
| 2687 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("copy %%r0,%0\n\tcopy %%r0,%1", xoperands);
|
| 2688 |
|
|
}
|
| 2689 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 2690 |
|
|
}
|
| 2691 |
|
|
|
| 2692 |
|
|
/* Return a REG that occurs in ADDR with coefficient 1.
|
| 2693 |
|
|
ADDR can be effectively incremented by incrementing REG. */
|
| 2694 |
|
|
|
| 2695 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 2696 |
|
|
find_addr_reg (rtx addr)
|
| 2697 |
|
|
{
|
| 2698 |
|
|
while (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS)
|
| 2699 |
|
|
{
|
| 2700 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 0)) == REG)
|
| 2701 |
|
|
addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
|
| 2702 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 1)) == REG)
|
| 2703 |
|
|
addr = XEXP (addr, 1);
|
| 2704 |
|
|
else if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (addr, 0)))
|
| 2705 |
|
|
addr = XEXP (addr, 1);
|
| 2706 |
|
|
else if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (addr, 1)))
|
| 2707 |
|
|
addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
|
| 2708 |
|
|
else
|
| 2709 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 2710 |
|
|
}
|
| 2711 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (addr) == REG);
|
| 2712 |
|
|
return addr;
|
| 2713 |
|
|
}
|
| 2714 |
|
|
|
| 2715 |
|
|
/* Emit code to perform a block move.
|
| 2716 |
|
|
|
| 2717 |
|
|
OPERANDS[0] is the destination pointer as a REG, clobbered.
|
| 2718 |
|
|
OPERANDS[1] is the source pointer as a REG, clobbered.
|
| 2719 |
|
|
OPERANDS[2] is a register for temporary storage.
|
| 2720 |
|
|
OPERANDS[3] is a register for temporary storage.
|
| 2721 |
|
|
OPERANDS[4] is the size as a CONST_INT
|
| 2722 |
|
|
OPERANDS[5] is the alignment safe to use, as a CONST_INT.
|
| 2723 |
|
|
OPERANDS[6] is another temporary register. */
|
| 2724 |
|
|
|
| 2725 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 2726 |
|
|
pa_output_block_move (rtx *operands, int size_is_constant ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 2727 |
|
|
{
|
| 2728 |
|
|
int align = INTVAL (operands[5]);
|
| 2729 |
|
|
unsigned long n_bytes = INTVAL (operands[4]);
|
| 2730 |
|
|
|
| 2731 |
|
|
/* We can't move more than a word at a time because the PA
|
| 2732 |
|
|
has no longer integer move insns. (Could use fp mem ops?) */
|
| 2733 |
|
|
if (align > (TARGET_64BIT ? 8 : 4))
|
| 2734 |
|
|
align = (TARGET_64BIT ? 8 : 4);
|
| 2735 |
|
|
|
| 2736 |
|
|
/* Note that we know each loop below will execute at least twice
|
| 2737 |
|
|
(else we would have open-coded the copy). */
|
| 2738 |
|
|
switch (align)
|
| 2739 |
|
|
{
|
| 2740 |
|
|
case 8:
|
| 2741 |
|
|
/* Pre-adjust the loop counter. */
|
| 2742 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (n_bytes - 16);
|
| 2743 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldi %4,%2", operands);
|
| 2744 |
|
|
|
| 2745 |
|
|
/* Copying loop. */
|
| 2746 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd,ma 8(%1),%3", operands);
|
| 2747 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd,ma 8(%1),%6", operands);
|
| 2748 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("std,ma %3,8(%0)", operands);
|
| 2749 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,>= -16,%2,.-12", operands);
|
| 2750 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("std,ma %6,8(%0)", operands);
|
| 2751 |
|
|
|
| 2752 |
|
|
/* Handle the residual. There could be up to 7 bytes of
|
| 2753 |
|
|
residual to copy! */
|
| 2754 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 16 != 0)
|
| 2755 |
|
|
{
|
| 2756 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (n_bytes % 8);
|
| 2757 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 16 >= 8)
|
| 2758 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd,ma 8(%1),%3", operands);
|
| 2759 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 8 != 0)
|
| 2760 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd 0(%1),%6", operands);
|
| 2761 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 16 >= 8)
|
| 2762 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("std,ma %3,8(%0)", operands);
|
| 2763 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 8 != 0)
|
| 2764 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stdby,e %6,%4(%0)", operands);
|
| 2765 |
|
|
}
|
| 2766 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 2767 |
|
|
|
| 2768 |
|
|
case 4:
|
| 2769 |
|
|
/* Pre-adjust the loop counter. */
|
| 2770 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (n_bytes - 8);
|
| 2771 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldi %4,%2", operands);
|
| 2772 |
|
|
|
| 2773 |
|
|
/* Copying loop. */
|
| 2774 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{ldws|ldw},ma 4(%1),%3", operands);
|
| 2775 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{ldws|ldw},ma 4(%1),%6", operands);
|
| 2776 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stws|stw},ma %3,4(%0)", operands);
|
| 2777 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,>= -8,%2,.-12", operands);
|
| 2778 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stws|stw},ma %6,4(%0)", operands);
|
| 2779 |
|
|
|
| 2780 |
|
|
/* Handle the residual. There could be up to 7 bytes of
|
| 2781 |
|
|
residual to copy! */
|
| 2782 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 8 != 0)
|
| 2783 |
|
|
{
|
| 2784 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (n_bytes % 4);
|
| 2785 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 8 >= 4)
|
| 2786 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{ldws|ldw},ma 4(%1),%3", operands);
|
| 2787 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 4 != 0)
|
| 2788 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw 0(%1),%6", operands);
|
| 2789 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 8 >= 4)
|
| 2790 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stws|stw},ma %3,4(%0)", operands);
|
| 2791 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 4 != 0)
|
| 2792 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stbys|stby},e %6,%4(%0)", operands);
|
| 2793 |
|
|
}
|
| 2794 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 2795 |
|
|
|
| 2796 |
|
|
case 2:
|
| 2797 |
|
|
/* Pre-adjust the loop counter. */
|
| 2798 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (n_bytes - 4);
|
| 2799 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldi %4,%2", operands);
|
| 2800 |
|
|
|
| 2801 |
|
|
/* Copying loop. */
|
| 2802 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{ldhs|ldh},ma 2(%1),%3", operands);
|
| 2803 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{ldhs|ldh},ma 2(%1),%6", operands);
|
| 2804 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{sths|sth},ma %3,2(%0)", operands);
|
| 2805 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,>= -4,%2,.-12", operands);
|
| 2806 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{sths|sth},ma %6,2(%0)", operands);
|
| 2807 |
|
|
|
| 2808 |
|
|
/* Handle the residual. */
|
| 2809 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 4 != 0)
|
| 2810 |
|
|
{
|
| 2811 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 4 >= 2)
|
| 2812 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{ldhs|ldh},ma 2(%1),%3", operands);
|
| 2813 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 2 != 0)
|
| 2814 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldb 0(%1),%6", operands);
|
| 2815 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 4 >= 2)
|
| 2816 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{sths|sth},ma %3,2(%0)", operands);
|
| 2817 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 2 != 0)
|
| 2818 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stb %6,0(%0)", operands);
|
| 2819 |
|
|
}
|
| 2820 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 2821 |
|
|
|
| 2822 |
|
|
case 1:
|
| 2823 |
|
|
/* Pre-adjust the loop counter. */
|
| 2824 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (n_bytes - 2);
|
| 2825 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldi %4,%2", operands);
|
| 2826 |
|
|
|
| 2827 |
|
|
/* Copying loop. */
|
| 2828 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{ldbs|ldb},ma 1(%1),%3", operands);
|
| 2829 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{ldbs|ldb},ma 1(%1),%6", operands);
|
| 2830 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stbs|stb},ma %3,1(%0)", operands);
|
| 2831 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,>= -2,%2,.-12", operands);
|
| 2832 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stbs|stb},ma %6,1(%0)", operands);
|
| 2833 |
|
|
|
| 2834 |
|
|
/* Handle the residual. */
|
| 2835 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 2 != 0)
|
| 2836 |
|
|
{
|
| 2837 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldb 0(%1),%3", operands);
|
| 2838 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stb %3,0(%0)", operands);
|
| 2839 |
|
|
}
|
| 2840 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 2841 |
|
|
|
| 2842 |
|
|
default:
|
| 2843 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 2844 |
|
|
}
|
| 2845 |
|
|
}
|
| 2846 |
|
|
|
| 2847 |
|
|
/* Count the number of insns necessary to handle this block move.
|
| 2848 |
|
|
|
| 2849 |
|
|
Basic structure is the same as emit_block_move, except that we
|
| 2850 |
|
|
count insns rather than emit them. */
|
| 2851 |
|
|
|
| 2852 |
|
|
static int
|
| 2853 |
|
|
compute_movmem_length (rtx insn)
|
| 2854 |
|
|
{
|
| 2855 |
|
|
rtx pat = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 2856 |
|
|
unsigned int align = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 7), 0));
|
| 2857 |
|
|
unsigned long n_bytes = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 6), 0));
|
| 2858 |
|
|
unsigned int n_insns = 0;
|
| 2859 |
|
|
|
| 2860 |
|
|
/* We can't move more than four bytes at a time because the PA
|
| 2861 |
|
|
has no longer integer move insns. (Could use fp mem ops?) */
|
| 2862 |
|
|
if (align > (TARGET_64BIT ? 8 : 4))
|
| 2863 |
|
|
align = (TARGET_64BIT ? 8 : 4);
|
| 2864 |
|
|
|
| 2865 |
|
|
/* The basic copying loop. */
|
| 2866 |
|
|
n_insns = 6;
|
| 2867 |
|
|
|
| 2868 |
|
|
/* Residuals. */
|
| 2869 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % (2 * align) != 0)
|
| 2870 |
|
|
{
|
| 2871 |
|
|
if ((n_bytes % (2 * align)) >= align)
|
| 2872 |
|
|
n_insns += 2;
|
| 2873 |
|
|
|
| 2874 |
|
|
if ((n_bytes % align) != 0)
|
| 2875 |
|
|
n_insns += 2;
|
| 2876 |
|
|
}
|
| 2877 |
|
|
|
| 2878 |
|
|
/* Lengths are expressed in bytes now; each insn is 4 bytes. */
|
| 2879 |
|
|
return n_insns * 4;
|
| 2880 |
|
|
}
|
| 2881 |
|
|
|
| 2882 |
|
|
/* Emit code to perform a block clear.
|
| 2883 |
|
|
|
| 2884 |
|
|
OPERANDS[0] is the destination pointer as a REG, clobbered.
|
| 2885 |
|
|
OPERANDS[1] is a register for temporary storage.
|
| 2886 |
|
|
OPERANDS[2] is the size as a CONST_INT
|
| 2887 |
|
|
OPERANDS[3] is the alignment safe to use, as a CONST_INT. */
|
| 2888 |
|
|
|
| 2889 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 2890 |
|
|
pa_output_block_clear (rtx *operands, int size_is_constant ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 2891 |
|
|
{
|
| 2892 |
|
|
int align = INTVAL (operands[3]);
|
| 2893 |
|
|
unsigned long n_bytes = INTVAL (operands[2]);
|
| 2894 |
|
|
|
| 2895 |
|
|
/* We can't clear more than a word at a time because the PA
|
| 2896 |
|
|
has no longer integer move insns. */
|
| 2897 |
|
|
if (align > (TARGET_64BIT ? 8 : 4))
|
| 2898 |
|
|
align = (TARGET_64BIT ? 8 : 4);
|
| 2899 |
|
|
|
| 2900 |
|
|
/* Note that we know each loop below will execute at least twice
|
| 2901 |
|
|
(else we would have open-coded the copy). */
|
| 2902 |
|
|
switch (align)
|
| 2903 |
|
|
{
|
| 2904 |
|
|
case 8:
|
| 2905 |
|
|
/* Pre-adjust the loop counter. */
|
| 2906 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (n_bytes - 16);
|
| 2907 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldi %2,%1", operands);
|
| 2908 |
|
|
|
| 2909 |
|
|
/* Loop. */
|
| 2910 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("std,ma %%r0,8(%0)", operands);
|
| 2911 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,>= -16,%1,.-4", operands);
|
| 2912 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("std,ma %%r0,8(%0)", operands);
|
| 2913 |
|
|
|
| 2914 |
|
|
/* Handle the residual. There could be up to 7 bytes of
|
| 2915 |
|
|
residual to copy! */
|
| 2916 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 16 != 0)
|
| 2917 |
|
|
{
|
| 2918 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (n_bytes % 8);
|
| 2919 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 16 >= 8)
|
| 2920 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("std,ma %%r0,8(%0)", operands);
|
| 2921 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 8 != 0)
|
| 2922 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stdby,e %%r0,%2(%0)", operands);
|
| 2923 |
|
|
}
|
| 2924 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 2925 |
|
|
|
| 2926 |
|
|
case 4:
|
| 2927 |
|
|
/* Pre-adjust the loop counter. */
|
| 2928 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (n_bytes - 8);
|
| 2929 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldi %2,%1", operands);
|
| 2930 |
|
|
|
| 2931 |
|
|
/* Loop. */
|
| 2932 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stws|stw},ma %%r0,4(%0)", operands);
|
| 2933 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,>= -8,%1,.-4", operands);
|
| 2934 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stws|stw},ma %%r0,4(%0)", operands);
|
| 2935 |
|
|
|
| 2936 |
|
|
/* Handle the residual. There could be up to 7 bytes of
|
| 2937 |
|
|
residual to copy! */
|
| 2938 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 8 != 0)
|
| 2939 |
|
|
{
|
| 2940 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (n_bytes % 4);
|
| 2941 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 8 >= 4)
|
| 2942 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stws|stw},ma %%r0,4(%0)", operands);
|
| 2943 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 4 != 0)
|
| 2944 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stbys|stby},e %%r0,%2(%0)", operands);
|
| 2945 |
|
|
}
|
| 2946 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 2947 |
|
|
|
| 2948 |
|
|
case 2:
|
| 2949 |
|
|
/* Pre-adjust the loop counter. */
|
| 2950 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (n_bytes - 4);
|
| 2951 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldi %2,%1", operands);
|
| 2952 |
|
|
|
| 2953 |
|
|
/* Loop. */
|
| 2954 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{sths|sth},ma %%r0,2(%0)", operands);
|
| 2955 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,>= -4,%1,.-4", operands);
|
| 2956 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{sths|sth},ma %%r0,2(%0)", operands);
|
| 2957 |
|
|
|
| 2958 |
|
|
/* Handle the residual. */
|
| 2959 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 4 != 0)
|
| 2960 |
|
|
{
|
| 2961 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 4 >= 2)
|
| 2962 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{sths|sth},ma %%r0,2(%0)", operands);
|
| 2963 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 2 != 0)
|
| 2964 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stb %%r0,0(%0)", operands);
|
| 2965 |
|
|
}
|
| 2966 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 2967 |
|
|
|
| 2968 |
|
|
case 1:
|
| 2969 |
|
|
/* Pre-adjust the loop counter. */
|
| 2970 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (n_bytes - 2);
|
| 2971 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldi %2,%1", operands);
|
| 2972 |
|
|
|
| 2973 |
|
|
/* Loop. */
|
| 2974 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stbs|stb},ma %%r0,1(%0)", operands);
|
| 2975 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,>= -2,%1,.-4", operands);
|
| 2976 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{stbs|stb},ma %%r0,1(%0)", operands);
|
| 2977 |
|
|
|
| 2978 |
|
|
/* Handle the residual. */
|
| 2979 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % 2 != 0)
|
| 2980 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stb %%r0,0(%0)", operands);
|
| 2981 |
|
|
|
| 2982 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 2983 |
|
|
|
| 2984 |
|
|
default:
|
| 2985 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 2986 |
|
|
}
|
| 2987 |
|
|
}
|
| 2988 |
|
|
|
| 2989 |
|
|
/* Count the number of insns necessary to handle this block move.
|
| 2990 |
|
|
|
| 2991 |
|
|
Basic structure is the same as emit_block_move, except that we
|
| 2992 |
|
|
count insns rather than emit them. */
|
| 2993 |
|
|
|
| 2994 |
|
|
static int
|
| 2995 |
|
|
compute_clrmem_length (rtx insn)
|
| 2996 |
|
|
{
|
| 2997 |
|
|
rtx pat = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 2998 |
|
|
unsigned int align = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 4), 0));
|
| 2999 |
|
|
unsigned long n_bytes = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 3), 0));
|
| 3000 |
|
|
unsigned int n_insns = 0;
|
| 3001 |
|
|
|
| 3002 |
|
|
/* We can't clear more than a word at a time because the PA
|
| 3003 |
|
|
has no longer integer move insns. */
|
| 3004 |
|
|
if (align > (TARGET_64BIT ? 8 : 4))
|
| 3005 |
|
|
align = (TARGET_64BIT ? 8 : 4);
|
| 3006 |
|
|
|
| 3007 |
|
|
/* The basic loop. */
|
| 3008 |
|
|
n_insns = 4;
|
| 3009 |
|
|
|
| 3010 |
|
|
/* Residuals. */
|
| 3011 |
|
|
if (n_bytes % (2 * align) != 0)
|
| 3012 |
|
|
{
|
| 3013 |
|
|
if ((n_bytes % (2 * align)) >= align)
|
| 3014 |
|
|
n_insns++;
|
| 3015 |
|
|
|
| 3016 |
|
|
if ((n_bytes % align) != 0)
|
| 3017 |
|
|
n_insns++;
|
| 3018 |
|
|
}
|
| 3019 |
|
|
|
| 3020 |
|
|
/* Lengths are expressed in bytes now; each insn is 4 bytes. */
|
| 3021 |
|
|
return n_insns * 4;
|
| 3022 |
|
|
}
|
| 3023 |
|
|
|
| 3024 |
|
|
|
| 3025 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 3026 |
|
|
pa_output_and (rtx *operands)
|
| 3027 |
|
|
{
|
| 3028 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[2]) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (operands[2]) != 0)
|
| 3029 |
|
|
{
|
| 3030 |
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = INTVAL (operands[2]);
|
| 3031 |
|
|
int ls0, ls1, ms0, p, len;
|
| 3032 |
|
|
|
| 3033 |
|
|
for (ls0 = 0; ls0 < 32; ls0++)
|
| 3034 |
|
|
if ((mask & (1 << ls0)) == 0)
|
| 3035 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3036 |
|
|
|
| 3037 |
|
|
for (ls1 = ls0; ls1 < 32; ls1++)
|
| 3038 |
|
|
if ((mask & (1 << ls1)) != 0)
|
| 3039 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3040 |
|
|
|
| 3041 |
|
|
for (ms0 = ls1; ms0 < 32; ms0++)
|
| 3042 |
|
|
if ((mask & (1 << ms0)) == 0)
|
| 3043 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3044 |
|
|
|
| 3045 |
|
|
gcc_assert (ms0 == 32);
|
| 3046 |
|
|
|
| 3047 |
|
|
if (ls1 == 32)
|
| 3048 |
|
|
{
|
| 3049 |
|
|
len = ls0;
|
| 3050 |
|
|
|
| 3051 |
|
|
gcc_assert (len);
|
| 3052 |
|
|
|
| 3053 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (len);
|
| 3054 |
|
|
return "{extru|extrw,u} %1,31,%2,%0";
|
| 3055 |
|
|
}
|
| 3056 |
|
|
else
|
| 3057 |
|
|
{
|
| 3058 |
|
|
/* We could use this `depi' for the case above as well, but `depi'
|
| 3059 |
|
|
requires one more register file access than an `extru'. */
|
| 3060 |
|
|
|
| 3061 |
|
|
p = 31 - ls0;
|
| 3062 |
|
|
len = ls1 - ls0;
|
| 3063 |
|
|
|
| 3064 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (p);
|
| 3065 |
|
|
operands[3] = GEN_INT (len);
|
| 3066 |
|
|
return "{depi|depwi} 0,%2,%3,%0";
|
| 3067 |
|
|
}
|
| 3068 |
|
|
}
|
| 3069 |
|
|
else
|
| 3070 |
|
|
return "and %1,%2,%0";
|
| 3071 |
|
|
}
|
| 3072 |
|
|
|
| 3073 |
|
|
/* Return a string to perform a bitwise-and of operands[1] with operands[2]
|
| 3074 |
|
|
storing the result in operands[0]. */
|
| 3075 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 3076 |
|
|
pa_output_64bit_and (rtx *operands)
|
| 3077 |
|
|
{
|
| 3078 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[2]) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (operands[2]) != 0)
|
| 3079 |
|
|
{
|
| 3080 |
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = INTVAL (operands[2]);
|
| 3081 |
|
|
int ls0, ls1, ms0, p, len;
|
| 3082 |
|
|
|
| 3083 |
|
|
for (ls0 = 0; ls0 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT; ls0++)
|
| 3084 |
|
|
if ((mask & ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << ls0)) == 0)
|
| 3085 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3086 |
|
|
|
| 3087 |
|
|
for (ls1 = ls0; ls1 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT; ls1++)
|
| 3088 |
|
|
if ((mask & ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << ls1)) != 0)
|
| 3089 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3090 |
|
|
|
| 3091 |
|
|
for (ms0 = ls1; ms0 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT; ms0++)
|
| 3092 |
|
|
if ((mask & ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << ms0)) == 0)
|
| 3093 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3094 |
|
|
|
| 3095 |
|
|
gcc_assert (ms0 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
|
| 3096 |
|
|
|
| 3097 |
|
|
if (ls1 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
| 3098 |
|
|
{
|
| 3099 |
|
|
len = ls0;
|
| 3100 |
|
|
|
| 3101 |
|
|
gcc_assert (len);
|
| 3102 |
|
|
|
| 3103 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (len);
|
| 3104 |
|
|
return "extrd,u %1,63,%2,%0";
|
| 3105 |
|
|
}
|
| 3106 |
|
|
else
|
| 3107 |
|
|
{
|
| 3108 |
|
|
/* We could use this `depi' for the case above as well, but `depi'
|
| 3109 |
|
|
requires one more register file access than an `extru'. */
|
| 3110 |
|
|
|
| 3111 |
|
|
p = 63 - ls0;
|
| 3112 |
|
|
len = ls1 - ls0;
|
| 3113 |
|
|
|
| 3114 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (p);
|
| 3115 |
|
|
operands[3] = GEN_INT (len);
|
| 3116 |
|
|
return "depdi 0,%2,%3,%0";
|
| 3117 |
|
|
}
|
| 3118 |
|
|
}
|
| 3119 |
|
|
else
|
| 3120 |
|
|
return "and %1,%2,%0";
|
| 3121 |
|
|
}
|
| 3122 |
|
|
|
| 3123 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 3124 |
|
|
pa_output_ior (rtx *operands)
|
| 3125 |
|
|
{
|
| 3126 |
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = INTVAL (operands[2]);
|
| 3127 |
|
|
int bs0, bs1, p, len;
|
| 3128 |
|
|
|
| 3129 |
|
|
if (INTVAL (operands[2]) == 0)
|
| 3130 |
|
|
return "copy %1,%0";
|
| 3131 |
|
|
|
| 3132 |
|
|
for (bs0 = 0; bs0 < 32; bs0++)
|
| 3133 |
|
|
if ((mask & (1 << bs0)) != 0)
|
| 3134 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3135 |
|
|
|
| 3136 |
|
|
for (bs1 = bs0; bs1 < 32; bs1++)
|
| 3137 |
|
|
if ((mask & (1 << bs1)) == 0)
|
| 3138 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3139 |
|
|
|
| 3140 |
|
|
gcc_assert (bs1 == 32 || ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bs1) > mask);
|
| 3141 |
|
|
|
| 3142 |
|
|
p = 31 - bs0;
|
| 3143 |
|
|
len = bs1 - bs0;
|
| 3144 |
|
|
|
| 3145 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (p);
|
| 3146 |
|
|
operands[3] = GEN_INT (len);
|
| 3147 |
|
|
return "{depi|depwi} -1,%2,%3,%0";
|
| 3148 |
|
|
}
|
| 3149 |
|
|
|
| 3150 |
|
|
/* Return a string to perform a bitwise-and of operands[1] with operands[2]
|
| 3151 |
|
|
storing the result in operands[0]. */
|
| 3152 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 3153 |
|
|
pa_output_64bit_ior (rtx *operands)
|
| 3154 |
|
|
{
|
| 3155 |
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = INTVAL (operands[2]);
|
| 3156 |
|
|
int bs0, bs1, p, len;
|
| 3157 |
|
|
|
| 3158 |
|
|
if (INTVAL (operands[2]) == 0)
|
| 3159 |
|
|
return "copy %1,%0";
|
| 3160 |
|
|
|
| 3161 |
|
|
for (bs0 = 0; bs0 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT; bs0++)
|
| 3162 |
|
|
if ((mask & ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bs0)) != 0)
|
| 3163 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3164 |
|
|
|
| 3165 |
|
|
for (bs1 = bs0; bs1 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT; bs1++)
|
| 3166 |
|
|
if ((mask & ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bs1)) == 0)
|
| 3167 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3168 |
|
|
|
| 3169 |
|
|
gcc_assert (bs1 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
| 3170 |
|
|
|| ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bs1) > mask);
|
| 3171 |
|
|
|
| 3172 |
|
|
p = 63 - bs0;
|
| 3173 |
|
|
len = bs1 - bs0;
|
| 3174 |
|
|
|
| 3175 |
|
|
operands[2] = GEN_INT (p);
|
| 3176 |
|
|
operands[3] = GEN_INT (len);
|
| 3177 |
|
|
return "depdi -1,%2,%3,%0";
|
| 3178 |
|
|
}
|
| 3179 |
|
|
|
| 3180 |
|
|
/* Target hook for assembling integer objects. This code handles
|
| 3181 |
|
|
aligned SI and DI integers specially since function references
|
| 3182 |
|
|
must be preceded by P%. */
|
| 3183 |
|
|
|
| 3184 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 3185 |
|
|
pa_assemble_integer (rtx x, unsigned int size, int aligned_p)
|
| 3186 |
|
|
{
|
| 3187 |
|
|
if (size == UNITS_PER_WORD
|
| 3188 |
|
|
&& aligned_p
|
| 3189 |
|
|
&& function_label_operand (x, VOIDmode))
|
| 3190 |
|
|
{
|
| 3191 |
|
|
fputs (size == 8? "\t.dword\tP%" : "\t.word\tP%", asm_out_file);
|
| 3192 |
|
|
output_addr_const (asm_out_file, x);
|
| 3193 |
|
|
fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
|
| 3194 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 3195 |
|
|
}
|
| 3196 |
|
|
return default_assemble_integer (x, size, aligned_p);
|
| 3197 |
|
|
}
|
| 3198 |
|
|
|
| 3199 |
|
|
/* Output an ascii string. */
|
| 3200 |
|
|
void
|
| 3201 |
|
|
pa_output_ascii (FILE *file, const char *p, int size)
|
| 3202 |
|
|
{
|
| 3203 |
|
|
int i;
|
| 3204 |
|
|
int chars_output;
|
| 3205 |
|
|
unsigned char partial_output[16]; /* Max space 4 chars can occupy. */
|
| 3206 |
|
|
|
| 3207 |
|
|
/* The HP assembler can only take strings of 256 characters at one
|
| 3208 |
|
|
time. This is a limitation on input line length, *not* the
|
| 3209 |
|
|
length of the string. Sigh. Even worse, it seems that the
|
| 3210 |
|
|
restriction is in number of input characters (see \xnn &
|
| 3211 |
|
|
\whatever). So we have to do this very carefully. */
|
| 3212 |
|
|
|
| 3213 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.STRING \"", file);
|
| 3214 |
|
|
|
| 3215 |
|
|
chars_output = 0;
|
| 3216 |
|
|
for (i = 0; i < size; i += 4)
|
| 3217 |
|
|
{
|
| 3218 |
|
|
int co = 0;
|
| 3219 |
|
|
int io = 0;
|
| 3220 |
|
|
for (io = 0, co = 0; io < MIN (4, size - i); io++)
|
| 3221 |
|
|
{
|
| 3222 |
|
|
register unsigned int c = (unsigned char) p[i + io];
|
| 3223 |
|
|
|
| 3224 |
|
|
if (c == '\"' || c == '\\')
|
| 3225 |
|
|
partial_output[co++] = '\\';
|
| 3226 |
|
|
if (c >= ' ' && c < 0177)
|
| 3227 |
|
|
partial_output[co++] = c;
|
| 3228 |
|
|
else
|
| 3229 |
|
|
{
|
| 3230 |
|
|
unsigned int hexd;
|
| 3231 |
|
|
partial_output[co++] = '\\';
|
| 3232 |
|
|
partial_output[co++] = 'x';
|
| 3233 |
|
|
hexd = c / 16 - 0 + '0';
|
| 3234 |
|
|
if (hexd > '9')
|
| 3235 |
|
|
hexd -= '9' - 'a' + 1;
|
| 3236 |
|
|
partial_output[co++] = hexd;
|
| 3237 |
|
|
hexd = c % 16 - 0 + '0';
|
| 3238 |
|
|
if (hexd > '9')
|
| 3239 |
|
|
hexd -= '9' - 'a' + 1;
|
| 3240 |
|
|
partial_output[co++] = hexd;
|
| 3241 |
|
|
}
|
| 3242 |
|
|
}
|
| 3243 |
|
|
if (chars_output + co > 243)
|
| 3244 |
|
|
{
|
| 3245 |
|
|
fputs ("\"\n\t.STRING \"", file);
|
| 3246 |
|
|
chars_output = 0;
|
| 3247 |
|
|
}
|
| 3248 |
|
|
fwrite (partial_output, 1, (size_t) co, file);
|
| 3249 |
|
|
chars_output += co;
|
| 3250 |
|
|
co = 0;
|
| 3251 |
|
|
}
|
| 3252 |
|
|
fputs ("\"\n", file);
|
| 3253 |
|
|
}
|
| 3254 |
|
|
|
| 3255 |
|
|
/* Try to rewrite floating point comparisons & branches to avoid
|
| 3256 |
|
|
useless add,tr insns.
|
| 3257 |
|
|
|
| 3258 |
|
|
CHECK_NOTES is nonzero if we should examine REG_DEAD notes
|
| 3259 |
|
|
to see if FPCC is dead. CHECK_NOTES is nonzero for the
|
| 3260 |
|
|
first attempt to remove useless add,tr insns. It is zero
|
| 3261 |
|
|
for the second pass as reorg sometimes leaves bogus REG_DEAD
|
| 3262 |
|
|
notes lying around.
|
| 3263 |
|
|
|
| 3264 |
|
|
When CHECK_NOTES is zero we can only eliminate add,tr insns
|
| 3265 |
|
|
when there's a 1:1 correspondence between fcmp and ftest/fbranch
|
| 3266 |
|
|
instructions. */
|
| 3267 |
|
|
static void
|
| 3268 |
|
|
remove_useless_addtr_insns (int check_notes)
|
| 3269 |
|
|
{
|
| 3270 |
|
|
rtx insn;
|
| 3271 |
|
|
static int pass = 0;
|
| 3272 |
|
|
|
| 3273 |
|
|
/* This is fairly cheap, so always run it when optimizing. */
|
| 3274 |
|
|
if (optimize > 0)
|
| 3275 |
|
|
{
|
| 3276 |
|
|
int fcmp_count = 0;
|
| 3277 |
|
|
int fbranch_count = 0;
|
| 3278 |
|
|
|
| 3279 |
|
|
/* Walk all the insns in this function looking for fcmp & fbranch
|
| 3280 |
|
|
instructions. Keep track of how many of each we find. */
|
| 3281 |
|
|
for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = next_insn (insn))
|
| 3282 |
|
|
{
|
| 3283 |
|
|
rtx tmp;
|
| 3284 |
|
|
|
| 3285 |
|
|
/* Ignore anything that isn't an INSN or a JUMP_INSN. */
|
| 3286 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) != INSN && GET_CODE (insn) != JUMP_INSN)
|
| 3287 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 3288 |
|
|
|
| 3289 |
|
|
tmp = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 3290 |
|
|
|
| 3291 |
|
|
/* It must be a set. */
|
| 3292 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (tmp) != SET)
|
| 3293 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 3294 |
|
|
|
| 3295 |
|
|
/* If the destination is CCFP, then we've found an fcmp insn. */
|
| 3296 |
|
|
tmp = SET_DEST (tmp);
|
| 3297 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG && REGNO (tmp) == 0)
|
| 3298 |
|
|
{
|
| 3299 |
|
|
fcmp_count++;
|
| 3300 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 3301 |
|
|
}
|
| 3302 |
|
|
|
| 3303 |
|
|
tmp = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 3304 |
|
|
/* If this is an fbranch instruction, bump the fbranch counter. */
|
| 3305 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SET
|
| 3306 |
|
|
&& SET_DEST (tmp) == pc_rtx
|
| 3307 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SET_SRC (tmp)) == IF_THEN_ELSE
|
| 3308 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (tmp), 0)) == NE
|
| 3309 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (tmp), 0), 0)) == REG
|
| 3310 |
|
|
&& REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (tmp), 0), 0)) == 0)
|
| 3311 |
|
|
{
|
| 3312 |
|
|
fbranch_count++;
|
| 3313 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 3314 |
|
|
}
|
| 3315 |
|
|
}
|
| 3316 |
|
|
|
| 3317 |
|
|
|
| 3318 |
|
|
/* Find all floating point compare + branch insns. If possible,
|
| 3319 |
|
|
reverse the comparison & the branch to avoid add,tr insns. */
|
| 3320 |
|
|
for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = next_insn (insn))
|
| 3321 |
|
|
{
|
| 3322 |
|
|
rtx tmp, next;
|
| 3323 |
|
|
|
| 3324 |
|
|
/* Ignore anything that isn't an INSN. */
|
| 3325 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) != INSN)
|
| 3326 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 3327 |
|
|
|
| 3328 |
|
|
tmp = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 3329 |
|
|
|
| 3330 |
|
|
/* It must be a set. */
|
| 3331 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (tmp) != SET)
|
| 3332 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 3333 |
|
|
|
| 3334 |
|
|
/* The destination must be CCFP, which is register zero. */
|
| 3335 |
|
|
tmp = SET_DEST (tmp);
|
| 3336 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (tmp) != REG || REGNO (tmp) != 0)
|
| 3337 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 3338 |
|
|
|
| 3339 |
|
|
/* INSN should be a set of CCFP.
|
| 3340 |
|
|
|
| 3341 |
|
|
See if the result of this insn is used in a reversed FP
|
| 3342 |
|
|
conditional branch. If so, reverse our condition and
|
| 3343 |
|
|
the branch. Doing so avoids useless add,tr insns. */
|
| 3344 |
|
|
next = next_insn (insn);
|
| 3345 |
|
|
while (next)
|
| 3346 |
|
|
{
|
| 3347 |
|
|
/* Jumps, calls and labels stop our search. */
|
| 3348 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (next) == JUMP_INSN
|
| 3349 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (next) == CALL_INSN
|
| 3350 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (next) == CODE_LABEL)
|
| 3351 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3352 |
|
|
|
| 3353 |
|
|
/* As does another fcmp insn. */
|
| 3354 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (next) == INSN
|
| 3355 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (next)) == SET
|
| 3356 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SET_DEST (PATTERN (next))) == REG
|
| 3357 |
|
|
&& REGNO (SET_DEST (PATTERN (next))) == 0)
|
| 3358 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3359 |
|
|
|
| 3360 |
|
|
next = next_insn (next);
|
| 3361 |
|
|
}
|
| 3362 |
|
|
|
| 3363 |
|
|
/* Is NEXT_INSN a branch? */
|
| 3364 |
|
|
if (next
|
| 3365 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (next) == JUMP_INSN)
|
| 3366 |
|
|
{
|
| 3367 |
|
|
rtx pattern = PATTERN (next);
|
| 3368 |
|
|
|
| 3369 |
|
|
/* If it a reversed fp conditional branch (e.g. uses add,tr)
|
| 3370 |
|
|
and CCFP dies, then reverse our conditional and the branch
|
| 3371 |
|
|
to avoid the add,tr. */
|
| 3372 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pattern) == SET
|
| 3373 |
|
|
&& SET_DEST (pattern) == pc_rtx
|
| 3374 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SET_SRC (pattern)) == IF_THEN_ELSE
|
| 3375 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (pattern), 0)) == NE
|
| 3376 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (pattern), 0), 0)) == REG
|
| 3377 |
|
|
&& REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (pattern), 0), 0)) == 0
|
| 3378 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (pattern), 1)) == PC
|
| 3379 |
|
|
&& (fcmp_count == fbranch_count
|
| 3380 |
|
|
|| (check_notes
|
| 3381 |
|
|
&& find_regno_note (next, REG_DEAD, 0))))
|
| 3382 |
|
|
{
|
| 3383 |
|
|
/* Reverse the branch. */
|
| 3384 |
|
|
tmp = XEXP (SET_SRC (pattern), 1);
|
| 3385 |
|
|
XEXP (SET_SRC (pattern), 1) = XEXP (SET_SRC (pattern), 2);
|
| 3386 |
|
|
XEXP (SET_SRC (pattern), 2) = tmp;
|
| 3387 |
|
|
INSN_CODE (next) = -1;
|
| 3388 |
|
|
|
| 3389 |
|
|
/* Reverse our condition. */
|
| 3390 |
|
|
tmp = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 3391 |
|
|
PUT_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 1),
|
| 3392 |
|
|
(reverse_condition_maybe_unordered
|
| 3393 |
|
|
(GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 1)))));
|
| 3394 |
|
|
}
|
| 3395 |
|
|
}
|
| 3396 |
|
|
}
|
| 3397 |
|
|
}
|
| 3398 |
|
|
|
| 3399 |
|
|
pass = !pass;
|
| 3400 |
|
|
|
| 3401 |
|
|
}
|
| 3402 |
|
|
|
| 3403 |
|
|
/* You may have trouble believing this, but this is the 32 bit HP-PA
|
| 3404 |
|
|
stack layout. Wow.
|
| 3405 |
|
|
|
| 3406 |
|
|
Offset Contents
|
| 3407 |
|
|
|
| 3408 |
|
|
Variable arguments (optional; any number may be allocated)
|
| 3409 |
|
|
|
| 3410 |
|
|
SP-(4*(N+9)) arg word N
|
| 3411 |
|
|
: :
|
| 3412 |
|
|
SP-56 arg word 5
|
| 3413 |
|
|
SP-52 arg word 4
|
| 3414 |
|
|
|
| 3415 |
|
|
Fixed arguments (must be allocated; may remain unused)
|
| 3416 |
|
|
|
| 3417 |
|
|
SP-48 arg word 3
|
| 3418 |
|
|
SP-44 arg word 2
|
| 3419 |
|
|
SP-40 arg word 1
|
| 3420 |
|
|
SP-36 arg word 0
|
| 3421 |
|
|
|
| 3422 |
|
|
Frame Marker
|
| 3423 |
|
|
|
| 3424 |
|
|
SP-32 External Data Pointer (DP)
|
| 3425 |
|
|
SP-28 External sr4
|
| 3426 |
|
|
SP-24 External/stub RP (RP')
|
| 3427 |
|
|
SP-20 Current RP
|
| 3428 |
|
|
SP-16 Static Link
|
| 3429 |
|
|
SP-12 Clean up
|
| 3430 |
|
|
SP-8 Calling Stub RP (RP'')
|
| 3431 |
|
|
SP-4 Previous SP
|
| 3432 |
|
|
|
| 3433 |
|
|
Top of Frame
|
| 3434 |
|
|
|
| 3435 |
|
|
SP-0 Stack Pointer (points to next available address)
|
| 3436 |
|
|
|
| 3437 |
|
|
*/
|
| 3438 |
|
|
|
| 3439 |
|
|
/* This function saves registers as follows. Registers marked with ' are
|
| 3440 |
|
|
this function's registers (as opposed to the previous function's).
|
| 3441 |
|
|
If a frame_pointer isn't needed, r4 is saved as a general register;
|
| 3442 |
|
|
the space for the frame pointer is still allocated, though, to keep
|
| 3443 |
|
|
things simple.
|
| 3444 |
|
|
|
| 3445 |
|
|
|
| 3446 |
|
|
Top of Frame
|
| 3447 |
|
|
|
| 3448 |
|
|
SP (FP') Previous FP
|
| 3449 |
|
|
SP + 4 Alignment filler (sigh)
|
| 3450 |
|
|
SP + 8 Space for locals reserved here.
|
| 3451 |
|
|
.
|
| 3452 |
|
|
.
|
| 3453 |
|
|
.
|
| 3454 |
|
|
SP + n All call saved register used.
|
| 3455 |
|
|
.
|
| 3456 |
|
|
.
|
| 3457 |
|
|
.
|
| 3458 |
|
|
SP + o All call saved fp registers used.
|
| 3459 |
|
|
.
|
| 3460 |
|
|
.
|
| 3461 |
|
|
.
|
| 3462 |
|
|
SP + p (SP') points to next available address.
|
| 3463 |
|
|
|
| 3464 |
|
|
*/
|
| 3465 |
|
|
|
| 3466 |
|
|
/* Global variables set by output_function_prologue(). */
|
| 3467 |
|
|
/* Size of frame. Need to know this to emit return insns from
|
| 3468 |
|
|
leaf procedures. */
|
| 3469 |
|
|
static HOST_WIDE_INT actual_fsize, local_fsize;
|
| 3470 |
|
|
static int save_fregs;
|
| 3471 |
|
|
|
| 3472 |
|
|
/* Emit RTL to store REG at the memory location specified by BASE+DISP.
|
| 3473 |
|
|
Handle case where DISP > 8k by using the add_high_const patterns.
|
| 3474 |
|
|
|
| 3475 |
|
|
Note in DISP > 8k case, we will leave the high part of the address
|
| 3476 |
|
|
in %r1. There is code in expand_hppa_{prologue,epilogue} that knows this.*/
|
| 3477 |
|
|
|
| 3478 |
|
|
static void
|
| 3479 |
|
|
store_reg (int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT disp, int base)
|
| 3480 |
|
|
{
|
| 3481 |
|
|
rtx insn, dest, src, basereg;
|
| 3482 |
|
|
|
| 3483 |
|
|
src = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, reg);
|
| 3484 |
|
|
basereg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base);
|
| 3485 |
|
|
if (VAL_14_BITS_P (disp))
|
| 3486 |
|
|
{
|
| 3487 |
|
|
dest = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, plus_constant (basereg, disp));
|
| 3488 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (dest, src);
|
| 3489 |
|
|
}
|
| 3490 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_64BIT && !VAL_32_BITS_P (disp))
|
| 3491 |
|
|
{
|
| 3492 |
|
|
rtx delta = GEN_INT (disp);
|
| 3493 |
|
|
rtx tmpreg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 1);
|
| 3494 |
|
|
|
| 3495 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmpreg, delta);
|
| 3496 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (tmpreg, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tmpreg, basereg));
|
| 3497 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES)
|
| 3498 |
|
|
{
|
| 3499 |
|
|
add_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
|
| 3500 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tmpreg,
|
| 3501 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, basereg, delta)));
|
| 3502 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
|
| 3503 |
|
|
}
|
| 3504 |
|
|
dest = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, tmpreg);
|
| 3505 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (dest, src);
|
| 3506 |
|
|
}
|
| 3507 |
|
|
else
|
| 3508 |
|
|
{
|
| 3509 |
|
|
rtx delta = GEN_INT (disp);
|
| 3510 |
|
|
rtx high = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, basereg, gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, delta));
|
| 3511 |
|
|
rtx tmpreg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 1);
|
| 3512 |
|
|
|
| 3513 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmpreg, high);
|
| 3514 |
|
|
dest = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, tmpreg, delta));
|
| 3515 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (dest, src);
|
| 3516 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES)
|
| 3517 |
|
|
add_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
|
| 3518 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
|
| 3519 |
|
|
gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode,
|
| 3520 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode,
|
| 3521 |
|
|
basereg,
|
| 3522 |
|
|
delta)),
|
| 3523 |
|
|
src));
|
| 3524 |
|
|
}
|
| 3525 |
|
|
|
| 3526 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES)
|
| 3527 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
|
| 3528 |
|
|
}
|
| 3529 |
|
|
|
| 3530 |
|
|
/* Emit RTL to store REG at the memory location specified by BASE and then
|
| 3531 |
|
|
add MOD to BASE. MOD must be <= 8k. */
|
| 3532 |
|
|
|
| 3533 |
|
|
static void
|
| 3534 |
|
|
store_reg_modify (int base, int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT mod)
|
| 3535 |
|
|
{
|
| 3536 |
|
|
rtx insn, basereg, srcreg, delta;
|
| 3537 |
|
|
|
| 3538 |
|
|
gcc_assert (VAL_14_BITS_P (mod));
|
| 3539 |
|
|
|
| 3540 |
|
|
basereg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base);
|
| 3541 |
|
|
srcreg = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, reg);
|
| 3542 |
|
|
delta = GEN_INT (mod);
|
| 3543 |
|
|
|
| 3544 |
|
|
insn = emit_insn (gen_post_store (basereg, srcreg, delta));
|
| 3545 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES)
|
| 3546 |
|
|
{
|
| 3547 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
|
| 3548 |
|
|
|
| 3549 |
|
|
/* RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P must be set on each frame related set
|
| 3550 |
|
|
in a parallel with more than one element. */
|
| 3551 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)) = 1;
|
| 3552 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 1)) = 1;
|
| 3553 |
|
|
}
|
| 3554 |
|
|
}
|
| 3555 |
|
|
|
| 3556 |
|
|
/* Emit RTL to set REG to the value specified by BASE+DISP. Handle case
|
| 3557 |
|
|
where DISP > 8k by using the add_high_const patterns. NOTE indicates
|
| 3558 |
|
|
whether to add a frame note or not.
|
| 3559 |
|
|
|
| 3560 |
|
|
In the DISP > 8k case, we leave the high part of the address in %r1.
|
| 3561 |
|
|
There is code in expand_hppa_{prologue,epilogue} that knows about this. */
|
| 3562 |
|
|
|
| 3563 |
|
|
static void
|
| 3564 |
|
|
set_reg_plus_d (int reg, int base, HOST_WIDE_INT disp, int note)
|
| 3565 |
|
|
{
|
| 3566 |
|
|
rtx insn;
|
| 3567 |
|
|
|
| 3568 |
|
|
if (VAL_14_BITS_P (disp))
|
| 3569 |
|
|
{
|
| 3570 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, reg),
|
| 3571 |
|
|
plus_constant (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base), disp));
|
| 3572 |
|
|
}
|
| 3573 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_64BIT && !VAL_32_BITS_P (disp))
|
| 3574 |
|
|
{
|
| 3575 |
|
|
rtx basereg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base);
|
| 3576 |
|
|
rtx delta = GEN_INT (disp);
|
| 3577 |
|
|
rtx tmpreg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 1);
|
| 3578 |
|
|
|
| 3579 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmpreg, delta);
|
| 3580 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, reg),
|
| 3581 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tmpreg, basereg));
|
| 3582 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES)
|
| 3583 |
|
|
add_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
|
| 3584 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tmpreg,
|
| 3585 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, basereg, delta)));
|
| 3586 |
|
|
}
|
| 3587 |
|
|
else
|
| 3588 |
|
|
{
|
| 3589 |
|
|
rtx basereg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base);
|
| 3590 |
|
|
rtx delta = GEN_INT (disp);
|
| 3591 |
|
|
rtx tmpreg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 1);
|
| 3592 |
|
|
|
| 3593 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmpreg,
|
| 3594 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, basereg,
|
| 3595 |
|
|
gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, delta)));
|
| 3596 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, reg),
|
| 3597 |
|
|
gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, tmpreg, delta));
|
| 3598 |
|
|
}
|
| 3599 |
|
|
|
| 3600 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES && note)
|
| 3601 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
|
| 3602 |
|
|
}
|
| 3603 |
|
|
|
| 3604 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT
|
| 3605 |
|
|
pa_compute_frame_size (HOST_WIDE_INT size, int *fregs_live)
|
| 3606 |
|
|
{
|
| 3607 |
|
|
int freg_saved = 0;
|
| 3608 |
|
|
int i, j;
|
| 3609 |
|
|
|
| 3610 |
|
|
/* The code in pa_expand_prologue and pa_expand_epilogue must
|
| 3611 |
|
|
be consistent with the rounding and size calculation done here.
|
| 3612 |
|
|
Change them at the same time. */
|
| 3613 |
|
|
|
| 3614 |
|
|
/* We do our own stack alignment. First, round the size of the
|
| 3615 |
|
|
stack locals up to a word boundary. */
|
| 3616 |
|
|
size = (size + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) & ~(UNITS_PER_WORD - 1);
|
| 3617 |
|
|
|
| 3618 |
|
|
/* Space for previous frame pointer + filler. If any frame is
|
| 3619 |
|
|
allocated, we need to add in the STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET. We
|
| 3620 |
|
|
waste some space here for the sake of HP compatibility. The
|
| 3621 |
|
|
first slot is only used when the frame pointer is needed. */
|
| 3622 |
|
|
if (size || frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 3623 |
|
|
size += STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET;
|
| 3624 |
|
|
|
| 3625 |
|
|
/* If the current function calls __builtin_eh_return, then we need
|
| 3626 |
|
|
to allocate stack space for registers that will hold data for
|
| 3627 |
|
|
the exception handler. */
|
| 3628 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES && crtl->calls_eh_return)
|
| 3629 |
|
|
{
|
| 3630 |
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
| 3631 |
|
|
|
| 3632 |
|
|
for (i = 0; EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i) != INVALID_REGNUM; ++i)
|
| 3633 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 3634 |
|
|
size += i * UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 3635 |
|
|
}
|
| 3636 |
|
|
|
| 3637 |
|
|
/* Account for space used by the callee general register saves. */
|
| 3638 |
|
|
for (i = 18, j = frame_pointer_needed ? 4 : 3; i >= j; i--)
|
| 3639 |
|
|
if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i))
|
| 3640 |
|
|
size += UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 3641 |
|
|
|
| 3642 |
|
|
/* Account for space used by the callee floating point register saves. */
|
| 3643 |
|
|
for (i = FP_SAVED_REG_LAST; i >= FP_SAVED_REG_FIRST; i -= FP_REG_STEP)
|
| 3644 |
|
|
if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i)
|
| 3645 |
|
|
|| (!TARGET_64BIT && df_regs_ever_live_p (i + 1)))
|
| 3646 |
|
|
{
|
| 3647 |
|
|
freg_saved = 1;
|
| 3648 |
|
|
|
| 3649 |
|
|
/* We always save both halves of the FP register, so always
|
| 3650 |
|
|
increment the frame size by 8 bytes. */
|
| 3651 |
|
|
size += 8;
|
| 3652 |
|
|
}
|
| 3653 |
|
|
|
| 3654 |
|
|
/* If any of the floating registers are saved, account for the
|
| 3655 |
|
|
alignment needed for the floating point register save block. */
|
| 3656 |
|
|
if (freg_saved)
|
| 3657 |
|
|
{
|
| 3658 |
|
|
size = (size + 7) & ~7;
|
| 3659 |
|
|
if (fregs_live)
|
| 3660 |
|
|
*fregs_live = 1;
|
| 3661 |
|
|
}
|
| 3662 |
|
|
|
| 3663 |
|
|
/* The various ABIs include space for the outgoing parameters in the
|
| 3664 |
|
|
size of the current function's stack frame. We don't need to align
|
| 3665 |
|
|
for the outgoing arguments as their alignment is set by the final
|
| 3666 |
|
|
rounding for the frame as a whole. */
|
| 3667 |
|
|
size += crtl->outgoing_args_size;
|
| 3668 |
|
|
|
| 3669 |
|
|
/* Allocate space for the fixed frame marker. This space must be
|
| 3670 |
|
|
allocated for any function that makes calls or allocates
|
| 3671 |
|
|
stack space. */
|
| 3672 |
|
|
if (!current_function_is_leaf || size)
|
| 3673 |
|
|
size += TARGET_64BIT ? 48 : 32;
|
| 3674 |
|
|
|
| 3675 |
|
|
/* Finally, round to the preferred stack boundary. */
|
| 3676 |
|
|
return ((size + PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
|
| 3677 |
|
|
& ~(PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT - 1));
|
| 3678 |
|
|
}
|
| 3679 |
|
|
|
| 3680 |
|
|
/* Generate the assembly code for function entry. FILE is a stdio
|
| 3681 |
|
|
stream to output the code to. SIZE is an int: how many units of
|
| 3682 |
|
|
temporary storage to allocate.
|
| 3683 |
|
|
|
| 3684 |
|
|
Refer to the array `regs_ever_live' to determine which registers to
|
| 3685 |
|
|
save; `regs_ever_live[I]' is nonzero if register number I is ever
|
| 3686 |
|
|
used in the function. This function is responsible for knowing
|
| 3687 |
|
|
which registers should not be saved even if used. */
|
| 3688 |
|
|
|
| 3689 |
|
|
/* On HP-PA, move-double insns between fpu and cpu need an 8-byte block
|
| 3690 |
|
|
of memory. If any fpu reg is used in the function, we allocate
|
| 3691 |
|
|
such a block here, at the bottom of the frame, just in case it's needed.
|
| 3692 |
|
|
|
| 3693 |
|
|
If this function is a leaf procedure, then we may choose not
|
| 3694 |
|
|
to do a "save" insn. The decision about whether or not
|
| 3695 |
|
|
to do this is made in regclass.c. */
|
| 3696 |
|
|
|
| 3697 |
|
|
static void
|
| 3698 |
|
|
pa_output_function_prologue (FILE *file, HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 3699 |
|
|
{
|
| 3700 |
|
|
/* The function's label and associated .PROC must never be
|
| 3701 |
|
|
separated and must be output *after* any profiling declarations
|
| 3702 |
|
|
to avoid changing spaces/subspaces within a procedure. */
|
| 3703 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (file, XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0), 0));
|
| 3704 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.PROC\n", file);
|
| 3705 |
|
|
|
| 3706 |
|
|
/* pa_expand_prologue does the dirty work now. We just need
|
| 3707 |
|
|
to output the assembler directives which denote the start
|
| 3708 |
|
|
of a function. */
|
| 3709 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "\t.CALLINFO FRAME=" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, actual_fsize);
|
| 3710 |
|
|
if (current_function_is_leaf)
|
| 3711 |
|
|
fputs (",NO_CALLS", file);
|
| 3712 |
|
|
else
|
| 3713 |
|
|
fputs (",CALLS", file);
|
| 3714 |
|
|
if (rp_saved)
|
| 3715 |
|
|
fputs (",SAVE_RP", file);
|
| 3716 |
|
|
|
| 3717 |
|
|
/* The SAVE_SP flag is used to indicate that register %r3 is stored
|
| 3718 |
|
|
at the beginning of the frame and that it is used as the frame
|
| 3719 |
|
|
pointer for the frame. We do this because our current frame
|
| 3720 |
|
|
layout doesn't conform to that specified in the HP runtime
|
| 3721 |
|
|
documentation and we need a way to indicate to programs such as
|
| 3722 |
|
|
GDB where %r3 is saved. The SAVE_SP flag was chosen because it
|
| 3723 |
|
|
isn't used by HP compilers but is supported by the assembler.
|
| 3724 |
|
|
However, SAVE_SP is supposed to indicate that the previous stack
|
| 3725 |
|
|
pointer has been saved in the frame marker. */
|
| 3726 |
|
|
if (frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 3727 |
|
|
fputs (",SAVE_SP", file);
|
| 3728 |
|
|
|
| 3729 |
|
|
/* Pass on information about the number of callee register saves
|
| 3730 |
|
|
performed in the prologue.
|
| 3731 |
|
|
|
| 3732 |
|
|
The compiler is supposed to pass the highest register number
|
| 3733 |
|
|
saved, the assembler then has to adjust that number before
|
| 3734 |
|
|
entering it into the unwind descriptor (to account for any
|
| 3735 |
|
|
caller saved registers with lower register numbers than the
|
| 3736 |
|
|
first callee saved register). */
|
| 3737 |
|
|
if (gr_saved)
|
| 3738 |
|
|
fprintf (file, ",ENTRY_GR=%d", gr_saved + 2);
|
| 3739 |
|
|
|
| 3740 |
|
|
if (fr_saved)
|
| 3741 |
|
|
fprintf (file, ",ENTRY_FR=%d", fr_saved + 11);
|
| 3742 |
|
|
|
| 3743 |
|
|
fputs ("\n\t.ENTRY\n", file);
|
| 3744 |
|
|
|
| 3745 |
|
|
remove_useless_addtr_insns (0);
|
| 3746 |
|
|
}
|
| 3747 |
|
|
|
| 3748 |
|
|
void
|
| 3749 |
|
|
pa_expand_prologue (void)
|
| 3750 |
|
|
{
|
| 3751 |
|
|
int merge_sp_adjust_with_store = 0;
|
| 3752 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size = get_frame_size ();
|
| 3753 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
|
| 3754 |
|
|
int i;
|
| 3755 |
|
|
rtx insn, tmpreg;
|
| 3756 |
|
|
|
| 3757 |
|
|
gr_saved = 0;
|
| 3758 |
|
|
fr_saved = 0;
|
| 3759 |
|
|
save_fregs = 0;
|
| 3760 |
|
|
|
| 3761 |
|
|
/* Compute total size for frame pointer, filler, locals and rounding to
|
| 3762 |
|
|
the next word boundary. Similar code appears in pa_compute_frame_size
|
| 3763 |
|
|
and must be changed in tandem with this code. */
|
| 3764 |
|
|
local_fsize = (size + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) & ~(UNITS_PER_WORD - 1);
|
| 3765 |
|
|
if (local_fsize || frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 3766 |
|
|
local_fsize += STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET;
|
| 3767 |
|
|
|
| 3768 |
|
|
actual_fsize = pa_compute_frame_size (size, &save_fregs);
|
| 3769 |
|
|
if (flag_stack_usage_info)
|
| 3770 |
|
|
current_function_static_stack_size = actual_fsize;
|
| 3771 |
|
|
|
| 3772 |
|
|
/* Compute a few things we will use often. */
|
| 3773 |
|
|
tmpreg = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, 1);
|
| 3774 |
|
|
|
| 3775 |
|
|
/* Save RP first. The calling conventions manual states RP will
|
| 3776 |
|
|
always be stored into the caller's frame at sp - 20 or sp - 16
|
| 3777 |
|
|
depending on which ABI is in use. */
|
| 3778 |
|
|
if (df_regs_ever_live_p (2) || crtl->calls_eh_return)
|
| 3779 |
|
|
{
|
| 3780 |
|
|
store_reg (2, TARGET_64BIT ? -16 : -20, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 3781 |
|
|
rp_saved = true;
|
| 3782 |
|
|
}
|
| 3783 |
|
|
else
|
| 3784 |
|
|
rp_saved = false;
|
| 3785 |
|
|
|
| 3786 |
|
|
/* Allocate the local frame and set up the frame pointer if needed. */
|
| 3787 |
|
|
if (actual_fsize != 0)
|
| 3788 |
|
|
{
|
| 3789 |
|
|
if (frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 3790 |
|
|
{
|
| 3791 |
|
|
/* Copy the old frame pointer temporarily into %r1. Set up the
|
| 3792 |
|
|
new stack pointer, then store away the saved old frame pointer
|
| 3793 |
|
|
into the stack at sp and at the same time update the stack
|
| 3794 |
|
|
pointer by actual_fsize bytes. Two versions, first
|
| 3795 |
|
|
handles small (<8k) frames. The second handles large (>=8k)
|
| 3796 |
|
|
frames. */
|
| 3797 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (tmpreg, hard_frame_pointer_rtx);
|
| 3798 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES)
|
| 3799 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
|
| 3800 |
|
|
|
| 3801 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx);
|
| 3802 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES)
|
| 3803 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
|
| 3804 |
|
|
|
| 3805 |
|
|
if (VAL_14_BITS_P (actual_fsize))
|
| 3806 |
|
|
store_reg_modify (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, 1, actual_fsize);
|
| 3807 |
|
|
else
|
| 3808 |
|
|
{
|
| 3809 |
|
|
/* It is incorrect to store the saved frame pointer at *sp,
|
| 3810 |
|
|
then increment sp (writes beyond the current stack boundary).
|
| 3811 |
|
|
|
| 3812 |
|
|
So instead use stwm to store at *sp and post-increment the
|
| 3813 |
|
|
stack pointer as an atomic operation. Then increment sp to
|
| 3814 |
|
|
finish allocating the new frame. */
|
| 3815 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT adjust1 = 8192 - 64;
|
| 3816 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT adjust2 = actual_fsize - adjust1;
|
| 3817 |
|
|
|
| 3818 |
|
|
store_reg_modify (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, 1, adjust1);
|
| 3819 |
|
|
set_reg_plus_d (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM,
|
| 3820 |
|
|
adjust2, 1);
|
| 3821 |
|
|
}
|
| 3822 |
|
|
|
| 3823 |
|
|
/* We set SAVE_SP in frames that need a frame pointer. Thus,
|
| 3824 |
|
|
we need to store the previous stack pointer (frame pointer)
|
| 3825 |
|
|
into the frame marker on targets that use the HP unwind
|
| 3826 |
|
|
library. This allows the HP unwind library to be used to
|
| 3827 |
|
|
unwind GCC frames. However, we are not fully compatible
|
| 3828 |
|
|
with the HP library because our frame layout differs from
|
| 3829 |
|
|
that specified in the HP runtime specification.
|
| 3830 |
|
|
|
| 3831 |
|
|
We don't want a frame note on this instruction as the frame
|
| 3832 |
|
|
marker moves during dynamic stack allocation.
|
| 3833 |
|
|
|
| 3834 |
|
|
This instruction also serves as a blockage to prevent
|
| 3835 |
|
|
register spills from being scheduled before the stack
|
| 3836 |
|
|
pointer is raised. This is necessary as we store
|
| 3837 |
|
|
registers using the frame pointer as a base register,
|
| 3838 |
|
|
and the frame pointer is set before sp is raised. */
|
| 3839 |
|
|
if (TARGET_HPUX_UNWIND_LIBRARY)
|
| 3840 |
|
|
{
|
| 3841 |
|
|
rtx addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, stack_pointer_rtx,
|
| 3842 |
|
|
GEN_INT (TARGET_64BIT ? -8 : -4));
|
| 3843 |
|
|
|
| 3844 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, addr),
|
| 3845 |
|
|
hard_frame_pointer_rtx);
|
| 3846 |
|
|
}
|
| 3847 |
|
|
else
|
| 3848 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
|
| 3849 |
|
|
}
|
| 3850 |
|
|
/* no frame pointer needed. */
|
| 3851 |
|
|
else
|
| 3852 |
|
|
{
|
| 3853 |
|
|
/* In some cases we can perform the first callee register save
|
| 3854 |
|
|
and allocating the stack frame at the same time. If so, just
|
| 3855 |
|
|
make a note of it and defer allocating the frame until saving
|
| 3856 |
|
|
the callee registers. */
|
| 3857 |
|
|
if (VAL_14_BITS_P (actual_fsize) && local_fsize == 0)
|
| 3858 |
|
|
merge_sp_adjust_with_store = 1;
|
| 3859 |
|
|
/* Can not optimize. Adjust the stack frame by actual_fsize
|
| 3860 |
|
|
bytes. */
|
| 3861 |
|
|
else
|
| 3862 |
|
|
set_reg_plus_d (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM,
|
| 3863 |
|
|
actual_fsize, 1);
|
| 3864 |
|
|
}
|
| 3865 |
|
|
}
|
| 3866 |
|
|
|
| 3867 |
|
|
/* Normal register save.
|
| 3868 |
|
|
|
| 3869 |
|
|
Do not save the frame pointer in the frame_pointer_needed case. It
|
| 3870 |
|
|
was done earlier. */
|
| 3871 |
|
|
if (frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 3872 |
|
|
{
|
| 3873 |
|
|
offset = local_fsize;
|
| 3874 |
|
|
|
| 3875 |
|
|
/* Saving the EH return data registers in the frame is the simplest
|
| 3876 |
|
|
way to get the frame unwind information emitted. We put them
|
| 3877 |
|
|
just before the general registers. */
|
| 3878 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES && crtl->calls_eh_return)
|
| 3879 |
|
|
{
|
| 3880 |
|
|
unsigned int i, regno;
|
| 3881 |
|
|
|
| 3882 |
|
|
for (i = 0; ; ++i)
|
| 3883 |
|
|
{
|
| 3884 |
|
|
regno = EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i);
|
| 3885 |
|
|
if (regno == INVALID_REGNUM)
|
| 3886 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3887 |
|
|
|
| 3888 |
|
|
store_reg (regno, offset, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 3889 |
|
|
offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 3890 |
|
|
}
|
| 3891 |
|
|
}
|
| 3892 |
|
|
|
| 3893 |
|
|
for (i = 18; i >= 4; i--)
|
| 3894 |
|
|
if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i) && ! call_used_regs[i])
|
| 3895 |
|
|
{
|
| 3896 |
|
|
store_reg (i, offset, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 3897 |
|
|
offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 3898 |
|
|
gr_saved++;
|
| 3899 |
|
|
}
|
| 3900 |
|
|
/* Account for %r3 which is saved in a special place. */
|
| 3901 |
|
|
gr_saved++;
|
| 3902 |
|
|
}
|
| 3903 |
|
|
/* No frame pointer needed. */
|
| 3904 |
|
|
else
|
| 3905 |
|
|
{
|
| 3906 |
|
|
offset = local_fsize - actual_fsize;
|
| 3907 |
|
|
|
| 3908 |
|
|
/* Saving the EH return data registers in the frame is the simplest
|
| 3909 |
|
|
way to get the frame unwind information emitted. */
|
| 3910 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES && crtl->calls_eh_return)
|
| 3911 |
|
|
{
|
| 3912 |
|
|
unsigned int i, regno;
|
| 3913 |
|
|
|
| 3914 |
|
|
for (i = 0; ; ++i)
|
| 3915 |
|
|
{
|
| 3916 |
|
|
regno = EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i);
|
| 3917 |
|
|
if (regno == INVALID_REGNUM)
|
| 3918 |
|
|
break;
|
| 3919 |
|
|
|
| 3920 |
|
|
/* If merge_sp_adjust_with_store is nonzero, then we can
|
| 3921 |
|
|
optimize the first save. */
|
| 3922 |
|
|
if (merge_sp_adjust_with_store)
|
| 3923 |
|
|
{
|
| 3924 |
|
|
store_reg_modify (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, regno, -offset);
|
| 3925 |
|
|
merge_sp_adjust_with_store = 0;
|
| 3926 |
|
|
}
|
| 3927 |
|
|
else
|
| 3928 |
|
|
store_reg (regno, offset, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 3929 |
|
|
offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 3930 |
|
|
}
|
| 3931 |
|
|
}
|
| 3932 |
|
|
|
| 3933 |
|
|
for (i = 18; i >= 3; i--)
|
| 3934 |
|
|
if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i) && ! call_used_regs[i])
|
| 3935 |
|
|
{
|
| 3936 |
|
|
/* If merge_sp_adjust_with_store is nonzero, then we can
|
| 3937 |
|
|
optimize the first GR save. */
|
| 3938 |
|
|
if (merge_sp_adjust_with_store)
|
| 3939 |
|
|
{
|
| 3940 |
|
|
store_reg_modify (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, i, -offset);
|
| 3941 |
|
|
merge_sp_adjust_with_store = 0;
|
| 3942 |
|
|
}
|
| 3943 |
|
|
else
|
| 3944 |
|
|
store_reg (i, offset, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 3945 |
|
|
offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 3946 |
|
|
gr_saved++;
|
| 3947 |
|
|
}
|
| 3948 |
|
|
|
| 3949 |
|
|
/* If we wanted to merge the SP adjustment with a GR save, but we never
|
| 3950 |
|
|
did any GR saves, then just emit the adjustment here. */
|
| 3951 |
|
|
if (merge_sp_adjust_with_store)
|
| 3952 |
|
|
set_reg_plus_d (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM,
|
| 3953 |
|
|
actual_fsize, 1);
|
| 3954 |
|
|
}
|
| 3955 |
|
|
|
| 3956 |
|
|
/* The hppa calling conventions say that %r19, the pic offset
|
| 3957 |
|
|
register, is saved at sp - 32 (in this function's frame)
|
| 3958 |
|
|
when generating PIC code. FIXME: What is the correct thing
|
| 3959 |
|
|
to do for functions which make no calls and allocate no
|
| 3960 |
|
|
frame? Do we need to allocate a frame, or can we just omit
|
| 3961 |
|
|
the save? For now we'll just omit the save.
|
| 3962 |
|
|
|
| 3963 |
|
|
We don't want a note on this insn as the frame marker can
|
| 3964 |
|
|
move if there is a dynamic stack allocation. */
|
| 3965 |
|
|
if (flag_pic && actual_fsize != 0 && !TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 3966 |
|
|
{
|
| 3967 |
|
|
rtx addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (-32));
|
| 3968 |
|
|
|
| 3969 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, addr), pic_offset_table_rtx);
|
| 3970 |
|
|
|
| 3971 |
|
|
}
|
| 3972 |
|
|
|
| 3973 |
|
|
/* Align pointer properly (doubleword boundary). */
|
| 3974 |
|
|
offset = (offset + 7) & ~7;
|
| 3975 |
|
|
|
| 3976 |
|
|
/* Floating point register store. */
|
| 3977 |
|
|
if (save_fregs)
|
| 3978 |
|
|
{
|
| 3979 |
|
|
rtx base;
|
| 3980 |
|
|
|
| 3981 |
|
|
/* First get the frame or stack pointer to the start of the FP register
|
| 3982 |
|
|
save area. */
|
| 3983 |
|
|
if (frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 3984 |
|
|
{
|
| 3985 |
|
|
set_reg_plus_d (1, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, offset, 0);
|
| 3986 |
|
|
base = hard_frame_pointer_rtx;
|
| 3987 |
|
|
}
|
| 3988 |
|
|
else
|
| 3989 |
|
|
{
|
| 3990 |
|
|
set_reg_plus_d (1, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, offset, 0);
|
| 3991 |
|
|
base = stack_pointer_rtx;
|
| 3992 |
|
|
}
|
| 3993 |
|
|
|
| 3994 |
|
|
/* Now actually save the FP registers. */
|
| 3995 |
|
|
for (i = FP_SAVED_REG_LAST; i >= FP_SAVED_REG_FIRST; i -= FP_REG_STEP)
|
| 3996 |
|
|
{
|
| 3997 |
|
|
if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i)
|
| 3998 |
|
|
|| (! TARGET_64BIT && df_regs_ever_live_p (i + 1)))
|
| 3999 |
|
|
{
|
| 4000 |
|
|
rtx addr, insn, reg;
|
| 4001 |
|
|
addr = gen_rtx_MEM (DFmode, gen_rtx_POST_INC (DFmode, tmpreg));
|
| 4002 |
|
|
reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, i);
|
| 4003 |
|
|
insn = emit_move_insn (addr, reg);
|
| 4004 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES)
|
| 4005 |
|
|
{
|
| 4006 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
|
| 4007 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 4008 |
|
|
{
|
| 4009 |
|
|
rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DFmode,
|
| 4010 |
|
|
plus_constant (base, offset));
|
| 4011 |
|
|
add_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
|
| 4012 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, mem, reg));
|
| 4013 |
|
|
}
|
| 4014 |
|
|
else
|
| 4015 |
|
|
{
|
| 4016 |
|
|
rtx meml = gen_rtx_MEM (SFmode,
|
| 4017 |
|
|
plus_constant (base, offset));
|
| 4018 |
|
|
rtx memr = gen_rtx_MEM (SFmode,
|
| 4019 |
|
|
plus_constant (base, offset + 4));
|
| 4020 |
|
|
rtx regl = gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, i);
|
| 4021 |
|
|
rtx regr = gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, i + 1);
|
| 4022 |
|
|
rtx setl = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, meml, regl);
|
| 4023 |
|
|
rtx setr = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, memr, regr);
|
| 4024 |
|
|
rtvec vec;
|
| 4025 |
|
|
|
| 4026 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (setl) = 1;
|
| 4027 |
|
|
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (setr) = 1;
|
| 4028 |
|
|
vec = gen_rtvec (2, setl, setr);
|
| 4029 |
|
|
add_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
|
| 4030 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SEQUENCE (VOIDmode, vec));
|
| 4031 |
|
|
}
|
| 4032 |
|
|
}
|
| 4033 |
|
|
offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (DFmode);
|
| 4034 |
|
|
fr_saved++;
|
| 4035 |
|
|
}
|
| 4036 |
|
|
}
|
| 4037 |
|
|
}
|
| 4038 |
|
|
}
|
| 4039 |
|
|
|
| 4040 |
|
|
/* Emit RTL to load REG from the memory location specified by BASE+DISP.
|
| 4041 |
|
|
Handle case where DISP > 8k by using the add_high_const patterns. */
|
| 4042 |
|
|
|
| 4043 |
|
|
static void
|
| 4044 |
|
|
load_reg (int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT disp, int base)
|
| 4045 |
|
|
{
|
| 4046 |
|
|
rtx dest = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, reg);
|
| 4047 |
|
|
rtx basereg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base);
|
| 4048 |
|
|
rtx src;
|
| 4049 |
|
|
|
| 4050 |
|
|
if (VAL_14_BITS_P (disp))
|
| 4051 |
|
|
src = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, plus_constant (basereg, disp));
|
| 4052 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_64BIT && !VAL_32_BITS_P (disp))
|
| 4053 |
|
|
{
|
| 4054 |
|
|
rtx delta = GEN_INT (disp);
|
| 4055 |
|
|
rtx tmpreg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 1);
|
| 4056 |
|
|
|
| 4057 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmpreg, delta);
|
| 4058 |
|
|
if (TARGET_DISABLE_INDEXING)
|
| 4059 |
|
|
{
|
| 4060 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmpreg, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tmpreg, basereg));
|
| 4061 |
|
|
src = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, tmpreg);
|
| 4062 |
|
|
}
|
| 4063 |
|
|
else
|
| 4064 |
|
|
src = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tmpreg, basereg));
|
| 4065 |
|
|
}
|
| 4066 |
|
|
else
|
| 4067 |
|
|
{
|
| 4068 |
|
|
rtx delta = GEN_INT (disp);
|
| 4069 |
|
|
rtx high = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, basereg, gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, delta));
|
| 4070 |
|
|
rtx tmpreg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 1);
|
| 4071 |
|
|
|
| 4072 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmpreg, high);
|
| 4073 |
|
|
src = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, tmpreg, delta));
|
| 4074 |
|
|
}
|
| 4075 |
|
|
|
| 4076 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (dest, src);
|
| 4077 |
|
|
}
|
| 4078 |
|
|
|
| 4079 |
|
|
/* Update the total code bytes output to the text section. */
|
| 4080 |
|
|
|
| 4081 |
|
|
static void
|
| 4082 |
|
|
update_total_code_bytes (unsigned int nbytes)
|
| 4083 |
|
|
{
|
| 4084 |
|
|
if ((TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME || !TARGET_GAS || !TARGET_SOM)
|
| 4085 |
|
|
&& !IN_NAMED_SECTION_P (cfun->decl))
|
| 4086 |
|
|
{
|
| 4087 |
|
|
unsigned int old_total = total_code_bytes;
|
| 4088 |
|
|
|
| 4089 |
|
|
total_code_bytes += nbytes;
|
| 4090 |
|
|
|
| 4091 |
|
|
/* Be prepared to handle overflows. */
|
| 4092 |
|
|
if (old_total > total_code_bytes)
|
| 4093 |
|
|
total_code_bytes = UINT_MAX;
|
| 4094 |
|
|
}
|
| 4095 |
|
|
}
|
| 4096 |
|
|
|
| 4097 |
|
|
/* This function generates the assembly code for function exit.
|
| 4098 |
|
|
Args are as for output_function_prologue ().
|
| 4099 |
|
|
|
| 4100 |
|
|
The function epilogue should not depend on the current stack
|
| 4101 |
|
|
pointer! It should use the frame pointer only. This is mandatory
|
| 4102 |
|
|
because of alloca; we also take advantage of it to omit stack
|
| 4103 |
|
|
adjustments before returning. */
|
| 4104 |
|
|
|
| 4105 |
|
|
static void
|
| 4106 |
|
|
pa_output_function_epilogue (FILE *file, HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 4107 |
|
|
{
|
| 4108 |
|
|
rtx insn = get_last_insn ();
|
| 4109 |
|
|
|
| 4110 |
|
|
last_address = 0;
|
| 4111 |
|
|
|
| 4112 |
|
|
/* pa_expand_epilogue does the dirty work now. We just need
|
| 4113 |
|
|
to output the assembler directives which denote the end
|
| 4114 |
|
|
of a function.
|
| 4115 |
|
|
|
| 4116 |
|
|
To make debuggers happy, emit a nop if the epilogue was completely
|
| 4117 |
|
|
eliminated due to a volatile call as the last insn in the
|
| 4118 |
|
|
current function. That way the return address (in %r2) will
|
| 4119 |
|
|
always point to a valid instruction in the current function. */
|
| 4120 |
|
|
|
| 4121 |
|
|
/* Get the last real insn. */
|
| 4122 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE)
|
| 4123 |
|
|
insn = prev_real_insn (insn);
|
| 4124 |
|
|
|
| 4125 |
|
|
/* If it is a sequence, then look inside. */
|
| 4126 |
|
|
if (insn && GET_CODE (insn) == INSN && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
|
| 4127 |
|
|
insn = XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0);
|
| 4128 |
|
|
|
| 4129 |
|
|
/* If insn is a CALL_INSN, then it must be a call to a volatile
|
| 4130 |
|
|
function (otherwise there would be epilogue insns). */
|
| 4131 |
|
|
if (insn && GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
|
| 4132 |
|
|
{
|
| 4133 |
|
|
fputs ("\tnop\n", file);
|
| 4134 |
|
|
last_address += 4;
|
| 4135 |
|
|
}
|
| 4136 |
|
|
|
| 4137 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.EXIT\n\t.PROCEND\n", file);
|
| 4138 |
|
|
|
| 4139 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOM && TARGET_GAS)
|
| 4140 |
|
|
{
|
| 4141 |
|
|
/* We done with this subspace except possibly for some additional
|
| 4142 |
|
|
debug information. Forget that we are in this subspace to ensure
|
| 4143 |
|
|
that the next function is output in its own subspace. */
|
| 4144 |
|
|
in_section = NULL;
|
| 4145 |
|
|
cfun->machine->in_nsubspa = 2;
|
| 4146 |
|
|
}
|
| 4147 |
|
|
|
| 4148 |
|
|
if (INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ())
|
| 4149 |
|
|
{
|
| 4150 |
|
|
insn = get_last_nonnote_insn ();
|
| 4151 |
|
|
last_address += INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn));
|
| 4152 |
|
|
if (INSN_P (insn))
|
| 4153 |
|
|
last_address += insn_default_length (insn);
|
| 4154 |
|
|
last_address = ((last_address + FUNCTION_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
|
| 4155 |
|
|
& ~(FUNCTION_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT - 1));
|
| 4156 |
|
|
}
|
| 4157 |
|
|
else
|
| 4158 |
|
|
last_address = UINT_MAX;
|
| 4159 |
|
|
|
| 4160 |
|
|
/* Finally, update the total number of code bytes output so far. */
|
| 4161 |
|
|
update_total_code_bytes (last_address);
|
| 4162 |
|
|
}
|
| 4163 |
|
|
|
| 4164 |
|
|
void
|
| 4165 |
|
|
pa_expand_epilogue (void)
|
| 4166 |
|
|
{
|
| 4167 |
|
|
rtx tmpreg;
|
| 4168 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
|
| 4169 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT ret_off = 0;
|
| 4170 |
|
|
int i;
|
| 4171 |
|
|
int merge_sp_adjust_with_load = 0;
|
| 4172 |
|
|
|
| 4173 |
|
|
/* We will use this often. */
|
| 4174 |
|
|
tmpreg = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, 1);
|
| 4175 |
|
|
|
| 4176 |
|
|
/* Try to restore RP early to avoid load/use interlocks when
|
| 4177 |
|
|
RP gets used in the return (bv) instruction. This appears to still
|
| 4178 |
|
|
be necessary even when we schedule the prologue and epilogue. */
|
| 4179 |
|
|
if (rp_saved)
|
| 4180 |
|
|
{
|
| 4181 |
|
|
ret_off = TARGET_64BIT ? -16 : -20;
|
| 4182 |
|
|
if (frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 4183 |
|
|
{
|
| 4184 |
|
|
load_reg (2, ret_off, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 4185 |
|
|
ret_off = 0;
|
| 4186 |
|
|
}
|
| 4187 |
|
|
else
|
| 4188 |
|
|
{
|
| 4189 |
|
|
/* No frame pointer, and stack is smaller than 8k. */
|
| 4190 |
|
|
if (VAL_14_BITS_P (ret_off - actual_fsize))
|
| 4191 |
|
|
{
|
| 4192 |
|
|
load_reg (2, ret_off - actual_fsize, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 4193 |
|
|
ret_off = 0;
|
| 4194 |
|
|
}
|
| 4195 |
|
|
}
|
| 4196 |
|
|
}
|
| 4197 |
|
|
|
| 4198 |
|
|
/* General register restores. */
|
| 4199 |
|
|
if (frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 4200 |
|
|
{
|
| 4201 |
|
|
offset = local_fsize;
|
| 4202 |
|
|
|
| 4203 |
|
|
/* If the current function calls __builtin_eh_return, then we need
|
| 4204 |
|
|
to restore the saved EH data registers. */
|
| 4205 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES && crtl->calls_eh_return)
|
| 4206 |
|
|
{
|
| 4207 |
|
|
unsigned int i, regno;
|
| 4208 |
|
|
|
| 4209 |
|
|
for (i = 0; ; ++i)
|
| 4210 |
|
|
{
|
| 4211 |
|
|
regno = EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i);
|
| 4212 |
|
|
if (regno == INVALID_REGNUM)
|
| 4213 |
|
|
break;
|
| 4214 |
|
|
|
| 4215 |
|
|
load_reg (regno, offset, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 4216 |
|
|
offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 4217 |
|
|
}
|
| 4218 |
|
|
}
|
| 4219 |
|
|
|
| 4220 |
|
|
for (i = 18; i >= 4; i--)
|
| 4221 |
|
|
if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i) && ! call_used_regs[i])
|
| 4222 |
|
|
{
|
| 4223 |
|
|
load_reg (i, offset, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 4224 |
|
|
offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 4225 |
|
|
}
|
| 4226 |
|
|
}
|
| 4227 |
|
|
else
|
| 4228 |
|
|
{
|
| 4229 |
|
|
offset = local_fsize - actual_fsize;
|
| 4230 |
|
|
|
| 4231 |
|
|
/* If the current function calls __builtin_eh_return, then we need
|
| 4232 |
|
|
to restore the saved EH data registers. */
|
| 4233 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES && crtl->calls_eh_return)
|
| 4234 |
|
|
{
|
| 4235 |
|
|
unsigned int i, regno;
|
| 4236 |
|
|
|
| 4237 |
|
|
for (i = 0; ; ++i)
|
| 4238 |
|
|
{
|
| 4239 |
|
|
regno = EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i);
|
| 4240 |
|
|
if (regno == INVALID_REGNUM)
|
| 4241 |
|
|
break;
|
| 4242 |
|
|
|
| 4243 |
|
|
/* Only for the first load.
|
| 4244 |
|
|
merge_sp_adjust_with_load holds the register load
|
| 4245 |
|
|
with which we will merge the sp adjustment. */
|
| 4246 |
|
|
if (merge_sp_adjust_with_load == 0
|
| 4247 |
|
|
&& local_fsize == 0
|
| 4248 |
|
|
&& VAL_14_BITS_P (-actual_fsize))
|
| 4249 |
|
|
merge_sp_adjust_with_load = regno;
|
| 4250 |
|
|
else
|
| 4251 |
|
|
load_reg (regno, offset, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 4252 |
|
|
offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 4253 |
|
|
}
|
| 4254 |
|
|
}
|
| 4255 |
|
|
|
| 4256 |
|
|
for (i = 18; i >= 3; i--)
|
| 4257 |
|
|
{
|
| 4258 |
|
|
if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i) && ! call_used_regs[i])
|
| 4259 |
|
|
{
|
| 4260 |
|
|
/* Only for the first load.
|
| 4261 |
|
|
merge_sp_adjust_with_load holds the register load
|
| 4262 |
|
|
with which we will merge the sp adjustment. */
|
| 4263 |
|
|
if (merge_sp_adjust_with_load == 0
|
| 4264 |
|
|
&& local_fsize == 0
|
| 4265 |
|
|
&& VAL_14_BITS_P (-actual_fsize))
|
| 4266 |
|
|
merge_sp_adjust_with_load = i;
|
| 4267 |
|
|
else
|
| 4268 |
|
|
load_reg (i, offset, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 4269 |
|
|
offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 4270 |
|
|
}
|
| 4271 |
|
|
}
|
| 4272 |
|
|
}
|
| 4273 |
|
|
|
| 4274 |
|
|
/* Align pointer properly (doubleword boundary). */
|
| 4275 |
|
|
offset = (offset + 7) & ~7;
|
| 4276 |
|
|
|
| 4277 |
|
|
/* FP register restores. */
|
| 4278 |
|
|
if (save_fregs)
|
| 4279 |
|
|
{
|
| 4280 |
|
|
/* Adjust the register to index off of. */
|
| 4281 |
|
|
if (frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 4282 |
|
|
set_reg_plus_d (1, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, offset, 0);
|
| 4283 |
|
|
else
|
| 4284 |
|
|
set_reg_plus_d (1, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, offset, 0);
|
| 4285 |
|
|
|
| 4286 |
|
|
/* Actually do the restores now. */
|
| 4287 |
|
|
for (i = FP_SAVED_REG_LAST; i >= FP_SAVED_REG_FIRST; i -= FP_REG_STEP)
|
| 4288 |
|
|
if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i)
|
| 4289 |
|
|
|| (! TARGET_64BIT && df_regs_ever_live_p (i + 1)))
|
| 4290 |
|
|
{
|
| 4291 |
|
|
rtx src = gen_rtx_MEM (DFmode, gen_rtx_POST_INC (DFmode, tmpreg));
|
| 4292 |
|
|
rtx dest = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, i);
|
| 4293 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (dest, src);
|
| 4294 |
|
|
}
|
| 4295 |
|
|
}
|
| 4296 |
|
|
|
| 4297 |
|
|
/* Emit a blockage insn here to keep these insns from being moved to
|
| 4298 |
|
|
an earlier spot in the epilogue, or into the main instruction stream.
|
| 4299 |
|
|
|
| 4300 |
|
|
This is necessary as we must not cut the stack back before all the
|
| 4301 |
|
|
restores are finished. */
|
| 4302 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
|
| 4303 |
|
|
|
| 4304 |
|
|
/* Reset stack pointer (and possibly frame pointer). The stack
|
| 4305 |
|
|
pointer is initially set to fp + 64 to avoid a race condition. */
|
| 4306 |
|
|
if (frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 4307 |
|
|
{
|
| 4308 |
|
|
rtx delta = GEN_INT (-64);
|
| 4309 |
|
|
|
| 4310 |
|
|
set_reg_plus_d (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, 64, 0);
|
| 4311 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_pre_load (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
|
| 4312 |
|
|
stack_pointer_rtx, delta));
|
| 4313 |
|
|
}
|
| 4314 |
|
|
/* If we were deferring a callee register restore, do it now. */
|
| 4315 |
|
|
else if (merge_sp_adjust_with_load)
|
| 4316 |
|
|
{
|
| 4317 |
|
|
rtx delta = GEN_INT (-actual_fsize);
|
| 4318 |
|
|
rtx dest = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, merge_sp_adjust_with_load);
|
| 4319 |
|
|
|
| 4320 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_pre_load (dest, stack_pointer_rtx, delta));
|
| 4321 |
|
|
}
|
| 4322 |
|
|
else if (actual_fsize != 0)
|
| 4323 |
|
|
set_reg_plus_d (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM,
|
| 4324 |
|
|
- actual_fsize, 0);
|
| 4325 |
|
|
|
| 4326 |
|
|
/* If we haven't restored %r2 yet (no frame pointer, and a stack
|
| 4327 |
|
|
frame greater than 8k), do so now. */
|
| 4328 |
|
|
if (ret_off != 0)
|
| 4329 |
|
|
load_reg (2, ret_off, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 4330 |
|
|
|
| 4331 |
|
|
if (DO_FRAME_NOTES && crtl->calls_eh_return)
|
| 4332 |
|
|
{
|
| 4333 |
|
|
rtx sa = EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX;
|
| 4334 |
|
|
|
| 4335 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
|
| 4336 |
|
|
emit_insn (TARGET_64BIT
|
| 4337 |
|
|
? gen_subdi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx, sa)
|
| 4338 |
|
|
: gen_subsi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx, sa));
|
| 4339 |
|
|
}
|
| 4340 |
|
|
}
|
| 4341 |
|
|
|
| 4342 |
|
|
bool
|
| 4343 |
|
|
pa_can_use_return_insn (void)
|
| 4344 |
|
|
{
|
| 4345 |
|
|
if (!reload_completed)
|
| 4346 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 4347 |
|
|
|
| 4348 |
|
|
if (frame_pointer_needed)
|
| 4349 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 4350 |
|
|
|
| 4351 |
|
|
if (df_regs_ever_live_p (2))
|
| 4352 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 4353 |
|
|
|
| 4354 |
|
|
if (crtl->profile)
|
| 4355 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 4356 |
|
|
|
| 4357 |
|
|
return pa_compute_frame_size (get_frame_size (), 0) == 0;
|
| 4358 |
|
|
}
|
| 4359 |
|
|
|
| 4360 |
|
|
rtx
|
| 4361 |
|
|
hppa_pic_save_rtx (void)
|
| 4362 |
|
|
{
|
| 4363 |
|
|
return get_hard_reg_initial_val (word_mode, PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM);
|
| 4364 |
|
|
}
|
| 4365 |
|
|
|
| 4366 |
|
|
#ifndef NO_DEFERRED_PROFILE_COUNTERS
|
| 4367 |
|
|
#define NO_DEFERRED_PROFILE_COUNTERS 0
|
| 4368 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 4369 |
|
|
|
| 4370 |
|
|
|
| 4371 |
|
|
/* Vector of funcdef numbers. */
|
| 4372 |
|
|
static VEC(int,heap) *funcdef_nos;
|
| 4373 |
|
|
|
| 4374 |
|
|
/* Output deferred profile counters. */
|
| 4375 |
|
|
static void
|
| 4376 |
|
|
output_deferred_profile_counters (void)
|
| 4377 |
|
|
{
|
| 4378 |
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
| 4379 |
|
|
int align, n;
|
| 4380 |
|
|
|
| 4381 |
|
|
if (VEC_empty (int, funcdef_nos))
|
| 4382 |
|
|
return;
|
| 4383 |
|
|
|
| 4384 |
|
|
switch_to_section (data_section);
|
| 4385 |
|
|
align = MIN (BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT, LONG_TYPE_SIZE);
|
| 4386 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (align / BITS_PER_UNIT));
|
| 4387 |
|
|
|
| 4388 |
|
|
for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (int, funcdef_nos, i, n); i++)
|
| 4389 |
|
|
{
|
| 4390 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "LP", n);
|
| 4391 |
|
|
assemble_integer (const0_rtx, LONG_TYPE_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT, align, 1);
|
| 4392 |
|
|
}
|
| 4393 |
|
|
|
| 4394 |
|
|
VEC_free (int, heap, funcdef_nos);
|
| 4395 |
|
|
}
|
| 4396 |
|
|
|
| 4397 |
|
|
void
|
| 4398 |
|
|
hppa_profile_hook (int label_no)
|
| 4399 |
|
|
{
|
| 4400 |
|
|
/* We use SImode for the address of the function in both 32 and
|
| 4401 |
|
|
64-bit code to avoid having to provide DImode versions of the
|
| 4402 |
|
|
lcla2 and load_offset_label_address insn patterns. */
|
| 4403 |
|
|
rtx reg = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
|
| 4404 |
|
|
rtx label_rtx = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 4405 |
|
|
rtx begin_label_rtx, call_insn;
|
| 4406 |
|
|
char begin_label_name[16];
|
| 4407 |
|
|
|
| 4408 |
|
|
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (begin_label_name, FUNC_BEGIN_PROLOG_LABEL,
|
| 4409 |
|
|
label_no);
|
| 4410 |
|
|
begin_label_rtx = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, ggc_strdup (begin_label_name));
|
| 4411 |
|
|
|
| 4412 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 4413 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (arg_pointer_rtx,
|
| 4414 |
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
|
| 4415 |
|
|
GEN_INT (64)));
|
| 4416 |
|
|
|
| 4417 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, 26), gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, 2));
|
| 4418 |
|
|
|
| 4419 |
|
|
/* The address of the function is loaded into %r25 with an instruction-
|
| 4420 |
|
|
relative sequence that avoids the use of relocations. The sequence
|
| 4421 |
|
|
is split so that the load_offset_label_address instruction can
|
| 4422 |
|
|
occupy the delay slot of the call to _mcount. */
|
| 4423 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PA_20)
|
| 4424 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_lcla2 (reg, label_rtx));
|
| 4425 |
|
|
else
|
| 4426 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_lcla1 (reg, label_rtx));
|
| 4427 |
|
|
|
| 4428 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_load_offset_label_address (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 25),
|
| 4429 |
|
|
reg, begin_label_rtx, label_rtx));
|
| 4430 |
|
|
|
| 4431 |
|
|
#if !NO_DEFERRED_PROFILE_COUNTERS
|
| 4432 |
|
|
{
|
| 4433 |
|
|
rtx count_label_rtx, addr, r24;
|
| 4434 |
|
|
char count_label_name[16];
|
| 4435 |
|
|
|
| 4436 |
|
|
VEC_safe_push (int, heap, funcdef_nos, label_no);
|
| 4437 |
|
|
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (count_label_name, "LP", label_no);
|
| 4438 |
|
|
count_label_rtx = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, ggc_strdup (count_label_name));
|
| 4439 |
|
|
|
| 4440 |
|
|
addr = force_reg (Pmode, count_label_rtx);
|
| 4441 |
|
|
r24 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 24);
|
| 4442 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (r24, addr);
|
| 4443 |
|
|
|
| 4444 |
|
|
call_insn =
|
| 4445 |
|
|
emit_call_insn (gen_call (gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
|
| 4446 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
|
| 4447 |
|
|
"_mcount")),
|
| 4448 |
|
|
GEN_INT (TARGET_64BIT ? 24 : 12)));
|
| 4449 |
|
|
|
| 4450 |
|
|
use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (call_insn), r24);
|
| 4451 |
|
|
}
|
| 4452 |
|
|
#else
|
| 4453 |
|
|
|
| 4454 |
|
|
call_insn =
|
| 4455 |
|
|
emit_call_insn (gen_call (gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
|
| 4456 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
|
| 4457 |
|
|
"_mcount")),
|
| 4458 |
|
|
GEN_INT (TARGET_64BIT ? 16 : 8)));
|
| 4459 |
|
|
|
| 4460 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 4461 |
|
|
|
| 4462 |
|
|
use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (call_insn), gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 25));
|
| 4463 |
|
|
use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (call_insn), gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 26));
|
| 4464 |
|
|
|
| 4465 |
|
|
/* Indicate the _mcount call cannot throw, nor will it execute a
|
| 4466 |
|
|
non-local goto. */
|
| 4467 |
|
|
make_reg_eh_region_note_nothrow_nononlocal (call_insn);
|
| 4468 |
|
|
}
|
| 4469 |
|
|
|
| 4470 |
|
|
/* Fetch the return address for the frame COUNT steps up from
|
| 4471 |
|
|
the current frame, after the prologue. FRAMEADDR is the
|
| 4472 |
|
|
frame pointer of the COUNT frame.
|
| 4473 |
|
|
|
| 4474 |
|
|
We want to ignore any export stub remnants here. To handle this,
|
| 4475 |
|
|
we examine the code at the return address, and if it is an export
|
| 4476 |
|
|
stub, we return a memory rtx for the stub return address stored
|
| 4477 |
|
|
at frame-24.
|
| 4478 |
|
|
|
| 4479 |
|
|
The value returned is used in two different ways:
|
| 4480 |
|
|
|
| 4481 |
|
|
1. To find a function's caller.
|
| 4482 |
|
|
|
| 4483 |
|
|
2. To change the return address for a function.
|
| 4484 |
|
|
|
| 4485 |
|
|
This function handles most instances of case 1; however, it will
|
| 4486 |
|
|
fail if there are two levels of stubs to execute on the return
|
| 4487 |
|
|
path. The only way I believe that can happen is if the return value
|
| 4488 |
|
|
needs a parameter relocation, which never happens for C code.
|
| 4489 |
|
|
|
| 4490 |
|
|
This function handles most instances of case 2; however, it will
|
| 4491 |
|
|
fail if we did not originally have stub code on the return path
|
| 4492 |
|
|
but will need stub code on the new return path. This can happen if
|
| 4493 |
|
|
the caller & callee are both in the main program, but the new
|
| 4494 |
|
|
return location is in a shared library. */
|
| 4495 |
|
|
|
| 4496 |
|
|
rtx
|
| 4497 |
|
|
pa_return_addr_rtx (int count, rtx frameaddr)
|
| 4498 |
|
|
{
|
| 4499 |
|
|
rtx label;
|
| 4500 |
|
|
rtx rp;
|
| 4501 |
|
|
rtx saved_rp;
|
| 4502 |
|
|
rtx ins;
|
| 4503 |
|
|
|
| 4504 |
|
|
/* The instruction stream at the return address of a PA1.X export stub is:
|
| 4505 |
|
|
|
| 4506 |
|
|
0x4bc23fd1 | stub+8: ldw -18(sr0,sp),rp
|
| 4507 |
|
|
0x004010a1 | stub+12: ldsid (sr0,rp),r1
|
| 4508 |
|
|
0x00011820 | stub+16: mtsp r1,sr0
|
| 4509 |
|
|
0xe0400002 | stub+20: be,n 0(sr0,rp)
|
| 4510 |
|
|
|
| 4511 |
|
|
0xe0400002 must be specified as -532676606 so that it won't be
|
| 4512 |
|
|
rejected as an invalid immediate operand on 64-bit hosts.
|
| 4513 |
|
|
|
| 4514 |
|
|
The instruction stream at the return address of a PA2.0 export stub is:
|
| 4515 |
|
|
|
| 4516 |
|
|
0x4bc23fd1 | stub+8: ldw -18(sr0,sp),rp
|
| 4517 |
|
|
0xe840d002 | stub+12: bve,n (rp)
|
| 4518 |
|
|
*/
|
| 4519 |
|
|
|
| 4520 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT insns[4];
|
| 4521 |
|
|
int i, len;
|
| 4522 |
|
|
|
| 4523 |
|
|
if (count != 0)
|
| 4524 |
|
|
return NULL_RTX;
|
| 4525 |
|
|
|
| 4526 |
|
|
rp = get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, 2);
|
| 4527 |
|
|
|
| 4528 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT || TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS)
|
| 4529 |
|
|
return rp;
|
| 4530 |
|
|
|
| 4531 |
|
|
/* If there is no export stub then just use the value saved from
|
| 4532 |
|
|
the return pointer register. */
|
| 4533 |
|
|
|
| 4534 |
|
|
saved_rp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 4535 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (saved_rp, rp);
|
| 4536 |
|
|
|
| 4537 |
|
|
/* Get pointer to the instruction stream. We have to mask out the
|
| 4538 |
|
|
privilege level from the two low order bits of the return address
|
| 4539 |
|
|
pointer here so that ins will point to the start of the first
|
| 4540 |
|
|
instruction that would have been executed if we returned. */
|
| 4541 |
|
|
ins = copy_to_reg (gen_rtx_AND (Pmode, rp, MASK_RETURN_ADDR));
|
| 4542 |
|
|
label = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 4543 |
|
|
|
| 4544 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PA_20)
|
| 4545 |
|
|
{
|
| 4546 |
|
|
insns[0] = 0x4bc23fd1;
|
| 4547 |
|
|
insns[1] = -398405630;
|
| 4548 |
|
|
len = 2;
|
| 4549 |
|
|
}
|
| 4550 |
|
|
else
|
| 4551 |
|
|
{
|
| 4552 |
|
|
insns[0] = 0x4bc23fd1;
|
| 4553 |
|
|
insns[1] = 0x004010a1;
|
| 4554 |
|
|
insns[2] = 0x00011820;
|
| 4555 |
|
|
insns[3] = -532676606;
|
| 4556 |
|
|
len = 4;
|
| 4557 |
|
|
}
|
| 4558 |
|
|
|
| 4559 |
|
|
/* Check the instruction stream at the normal return address for the
|
| 4560 |
|
|
export stub. If it is an export stub, than our return address is
|
| 4561 |
|
|
really in -24[frameaddr]. */
|
| 4562 |
|
|
|
| 4563 |
|
|
for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
|
| 4564 |
|
|
{
|
| 4565 |
|
|
rtx op0 = gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, plus_constant (ins, i * 4));
|
| 4566 |
|
|
rtx op1 = GEN_INT (insns[i]);
|
| 4567 |
|
|
emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (op0, op1, NE, NULL, SImode, 0, label);
|
| 4568 |
|
|
}
|
| 4569 |
|
|
|
| 4570 |
|
|
/* Here we know that our return address points to an export
|
| 4571 |
|
|
stub. We don't want to return the address of the export stub,
|
| 4572 |
|
|
but rather the return address of the export stub. That return
|
| 4573 |
|
|
address is stored at -24[frameaddr]. */
|
| 4574 |
|
|
|
| 4575 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (saved_rp,
|
| 4576 |
|
|
gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
|
| 4577 |
|
|
memory_address (Pmode,
|
| 4578 |
|
|
plus_constant (frameaddr,
|
| 4579 |
|
|
-24))));
|
| 4580 |
|
|
|
| 4581 |
|
|
emit_label (label);
|
| 4582 |
|
|
|
| 4583 |
|
|
return saved_rp;
|
| 4584 |
|
|
}
|
| 4585 |
|
|
|
| 4586 |
|
|
void
|
| 4587 |
|
|
pa_emit_bcond_fp (rtx operands[])
|
| 4588 |
|
|
{
|
| 4589 |
|
|
enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (operands[0]);
|
| 4590 |
|
|
rtx operand0 = operands[1];
|
| 4591 |
|
|
rtx operand1 = operands[2];
|
| 4592 |
|
|
rtx label = operands[3];
|
| 4593 |
|
|
|
| 4594 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (CCFPmode, 0),
|
| 4595 |
|
|
gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, CCFPmode, operand0, operand1)));
|
| 4596 |
|
|
|
| 4597 |
|
|
emit_jump_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx,
|
| 4598 |
|
|
gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (VOIDmode,
|
| 4599 |
|
|
gen_rtx_fmt_ee (NE,
|
| 4600 |
|
|
VOIDmode,
|
| 4601 |
|
|
gen_rtx_REG (CCFPmode, 0),
|
| 4602 |
|
|
const0_rtx),
|
| 4603 |
|
|
gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, label),
|
| 4604 |
|
|
pc_rtx)));
|
| 4605 |
|
|
|
| 4606 |
|
|
}
|
| 4607 |
|
|
|
| 4608 |
|
|
/* Adjust the cost of a scheduling dependency. Return the new cost of
|
| 4609 |
|
|
a dependency LINK or INSN on DEP_INSN. COST is the current cost. */
|
| 4610 |
|
|
|
| 4611 |
|
|
static int
|
| 4612 |
|
|
pa_adjust_cost (rtx insn, rtx link, rtx dep_insn, int cost)
|
| 4613 |
|
|
{
|
| 4614 |
|
|
enum attr_type attr_type;
|
| 4615 |
|
|
|
| 4616 |
|
|
/* Don't adjust costs for a pa8000 chip, also do not adjust any
|
| 4617 |
|
|
true dependencies as they are described with bypasses now. */
|
| 4618 |
|
|
if (pa_cpu >= PROCESSOR_8000 || REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == 0)
|
| 4619 |
|
|
return cost;
|
| 4620 |
|
|
|
| 4621 |
|
|
if (! recog_memoized (insn))
|
| 4622 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4623 |
|
|
|
| 4624 |
|
|
attr_type = get_attr_type (insn);
|
| 4625 |
|
|
|
| 4626 |
|
|
switch (REG_NOTE_KIND (link))
|
| 4627 |
|
|
{
|
| 4628 |
|
|
case REG_DEP_ANTI:
|
| 4629 |
|
|
/* Anti dependency; DEP_INSN reads a register that INSN writes some
|
| 4630 |
|
|
cycles later. */
|
| 4631 |
|
|
|
| 4632 |
|
|
if (attr_type == TYPE_FPLOAD)
|
| 4633 |
|
|
{
|
| 4634 |
|
|
rtx pat = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 4635 |
|
|
rtx dep_pat = PATTERN (dep_insn);
|
| 4636 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
|
| 4637 |
|
|
{
|
| 4638 |
|
|
/* This happens for the fldXs,mb patterns. */
|
| 4639 |
|
|
pat = XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0);
|
| 4640 |
|
|
}
|
| 4641 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) != SET || GET_CODE (dep_pat) != SET)
|
| 4642 |
|
|
/* If this happens, we have to extend this to schedule
|
| 4643 |
|
|
optimally. Return 0 for now. */
|
| 4644 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4645 |
|
|
|
| 4646 |
|
|
if (reg_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (pat), SET_SRC (dep_pat)))
|
| 4647 |
|
|
{
|
| 4648 |
|
|
if (! recog_memoized (dep_insn))
|
| 4649 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4650 |
|
|
switch (get_attr_type (dep_insn))
|
| 4651 |
|
|
{
|
| 4652 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPALU:
|
| 4653 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPMULSGL:
|
| 4654 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPMULDBL:
|
| 4655 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPDIVSGL:
|
| 4656 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPDIVDBL:
|
| 4657 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPSQRTSGL:
|
| 4658 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPSQRTDBL:
|
| 4659 |
|
|
/* A fpload can't be issued until one cycle before a
|
| 4660 |
|
|
preceding arithmetic operation has finished if
|
| 4661 |
|
|
the target of the fpload is any of the sources
|
| 4662 |
|
|
(or destination) of the arithmetic operation. */
|
| 4663 |
|
|
return insn_default_latency (dep_insn) - 1;
|
| 4664 |
|
|
|
| 4665 |
|
|
default:
|
| 4666 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4667 |
|
|
}
|
| 4668 |
|
|
}
|
| 4669 |
|
|
}
|
| 4670 |
|
|
else if (attr_type == TYPE_FPALU)
|
| 4671 |
|
|
{
|
| 4672 |
|
|
rtx pat = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 4673 |
|
|
rtx dep_pat = PATTERN (dep_insn);
|
| 4674 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
|
| 4675 |
|
|
{
|
| 4676 |
|
|
/* This happens for the fldXs,mb patterns. */
|
| 4677 |
|
|
pat = XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0);
|
| 4678 |
|
|
}
|
| 4679 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) != SET || GET_CODE (dep_pat) != SET)
|
| 4680 |
|
|
/* If this happens, we have to extend this to schedule
|
| 4681 |
|
|
optimally. Return 0 for now. */
|
| 4682 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4683 |
|
|
|
| 4684 |
|
|
if (reg_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (pat), SET_SRC (dep_pat)))
|
| 4685 |
|
|
{
|
| 4686 |
|
|
if (! recog_memoized (dep_insn))
|
| 4687 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4688 |
|
|
switch (get_attr_type (dep_insn))
|
| 4689 |
|
|
{
|
| 4690 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPDIVSGL:
|
| 4691 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPDIVDBL:
|
| 4692 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPSQRTSGL:
|
| 4693 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPSQRTDBL:
|
| 4694 |
|
|
/* An ALU flop can't be issued until two cycles before a
|
| 4695 |
|
|
preceding divide or sqrt operation has finished if
|
| 4696 |
|
|
the target of the ALU flop is any of the sources
|
| 4697 |
|
|
(or destination) of the divide or sqrt operation. */
|
| 4698 |
|
|
return insn_default_latency (dep_insn) - 2;
|
| 4699 |
|
|
|
| 4700 |
|
|
default:
|
| 4701 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4702 |
|
|
}
|
| 4703 |
|
|
}
|
| 4704 |
|
|
}
|
| 4705 |
|
|
|
| 4706 |
|
|
/* For other anti dependencies, the cost is 0. */
|
| 4707 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4708 |
|
|
|
| 4709 |
|
|
case REG_DEP_OUTPUT:
|
| 4710 |
|
|
/* Output dependency; DEP_INSN writes a register that INSN writes some
|
| 4711 |
|
|
cycles later. */
|
| 4712 |
|
|
if (attr_type == TYPE_FPLOAD)
|
| 4713 |
|
|
{
|
| 4714 |
|
|
rtx pat = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 4715 |
|
|
rtx dep_pat = PATTERN (dep_insn);
|
| 4716 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
|
| 4717 |
|
|
{
|
| 4718 |
|
|
/* This happens for the fldXs,mb patterns. */
|
| 4719 |
|
|
pat = XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0);
|
| 4720 |
|
|
}
|
| 4721 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) != SET || GET_CODE (dep_pat) != SET)
|
| 4722 |
|
|
/* If this happens, we have to extend this to schedule
|
| 4723 |
|
|
optimally. Return 0 for now. */
|
| 4724 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4725 |
|
|
|
| 4726 |
|
|
if (reg_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (pat), SET_DEST (dep_pat)))
|
| 4727 |
|
|
{
|
| 4728 |
|
|
if (! recog_memoized (dep_insn))
|
| 4729 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4730 |
|
|
switch (get_attr_type (dep_insn))
|
| 4731 |
|
|
{
|
| 4732 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPALU:
|
| 4733 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPMULSGL:
|
| 4734 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPMULDBL:
|
| 4735 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPDIVSGL:
|
| 4736 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPDIVDBL:
|
| 4737 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPSQRTSGL:
|
| 4738 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPSQRTDBL:
|
| 4739 |
|
|
/* A fpload can't be issued until one cycle before a
|
| 4740 |
|
|
preceding arithmetic operation has finished if
|
| 4741 |
|
|
the target of the fpload is the destination of the
|
| 4742 |
|
|
arithmetic operation.
|
| 4743 |
|
|
|
| 4744 |
|
|
Exception: For PA7100LC, PA7200 and PA7300, the cost
|
| 4745 |
|
|
is 3 cycles, unless they bundle together. We also
|
| 4746 |
|
|
pay the penalty if the second insn is a fpload. */
|
| 4747 |
|
|
return insn_default_latency (dep_insn) - 1;
|
| 4748 |
|
|
|
| 4749 |
|
|
default:
|
| 4750 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4751 |
|
|
}
|
| 4752 |
|
|
}
|
| 4753 |
|
|
}
|
| 4754 |
|
|
else if (attr_type == TYPE_FPALU)
|
| 4755 |
|
|
{
|
| 4756 |
|
|
rtx pat = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 4757 |
|
|
rtx dep_pat = PATTERN (dep_insn);
|
| 4758 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
|
| 4759 |
|
|
{
|
| 4760 |
|
|
/* This happens for the fldXs,mb patterns. */
|
| 4761 |
|
|
pat = XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0);
|
| 4762 |
|
|
}
|
| 4763 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) != SET || GET_CODE (dep_pat) != SET)
|
| 4764 |
|
|
/* If this happens, we have to extend this to schedule
|
| 4765 |
|
|
optimally. Return 0 for now. */
|
| 4766 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4767 |
|
|
|
| 4768 |
|
|
if (reg_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (pat), SET_DEST (dep_pat)))
|
| 4769 |
|
|
{
|
| 4770 |
|
|
if (! recog_memoized (dep_insn))
|
| 4771 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4772 |
|
|
switch (get_attr_type (dep_insn))
|
| 4773 |
|
|
{
|
| 4774 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPDIVSGL:
|
| 4775 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPDIVDBL:
|
| 4776 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPSQRTSGL:
|
| 4777 |
|
|
case TYPE_FPSQRTDBL:
|
| 4778 |
|
|
/* An ALU flop can't be issued until two cycles before a
|
| 4779 |
|
|
preceding divide or sqrt operation has finished if
|
| 4780 |
|
|
the target of the ALU flop is also the target of
|
| 4781 |
|
|
the divide or sqrt operation. */
|
| 4782 |
|
|
return insn_default_latency (dep_insn) - 2;
|
| 4783 |
|
|
|
| 4784 |
|
|
default:
|
| 4785 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4786 |
|
|
}
|
| 4787 |
|
|
}
|
| 4788 |
|
|
}
|
| 4789 |
|
|
|
| 4790 |
|
|
/* For other output dependencies, the cost is 0. */
|
| 4791 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4792 |
|
|
|
| 4793 |
|
|
default:
|
| 4794 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 4795 |
|
|
}
|
| 4796 |
|
|
}
|
| 4797 |
|
|
|
| 4798 |
|
|
/* Adjust scheduling priorities. We use this to try and keep addil
|
| 4799 |
|
|
and the next use of %r1 close together. */
|
| 4800 |
|
|
static int
|
| 4801 |
|
|
pa_adjust_priority (rtx insn, int priority)
|
| 4802 |
|
|
{
|
| 4803 |
|
|
rtx set = single_set (insn);
|
| 4804 |
|
|
rtx src, dest;
|
| 4805 |
|
|
if (set)
|
| 4806 |
|
|
{
|
| 4807 |
|
|
src = SET_SRC (set);
|
| 4808 |
|
|
dest = SET_DEST (set);
|
| 4809 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
|
| 4810 |
|
|
&& symbolic_operand (XEXP (src, 1), VOIDmode)
|
| 4811 |
|
|
&& ! read_only_operand (XEXP (src, 1), VOIDmode))
|
| 4812 |
|
|
priority >>= 3;
|
| 4813 |
|
|
|
| 4814 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM
|
| 4815 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == LO_SUM
|
| 4816 |
|
|
&& symbolic_operand (XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 1), VOIDmode)
|
| 4817 |
|
|
&& ! read_only_operand (XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 1), VOIDmode))
|
| 4818 |
|
|
priority >>= 1;
|
| 4819 |
|
|
|
| 4820 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM
|
| 4821 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == LO_SUM
|
| 4822 |
|
|
&& symbolic_operand (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), VOIDmode)
|
| 4823 |
|
|
&& ! read_only_operand (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), VOIDmode))
|
| 4824 |
|
|
priority >>= 3;
|
| 4825 |
|
|
}
|
| 4826 |
|
|
return priority;
|
| 4827 |
|
|
}
|
| 4828 |
|
|
|
| 4829 |
|
|
/* The 700 can only issue a single insn at a time.
|
| 4830 |
|
|
The 7XXX processors can issue two insns at a time.
|
| 4831 |
|
|
The 8000 can issue 4 insns at a time. */
|
| 4832 |
|
|
static int
|
| 4833 |
|
|
pa_issue_rate (void)
|
| 4834 |
|
|
{
|
| 4835 |
|
|
switch (pa_cpu)
|
| 4836 |
|
|
{
|
| 4837 |
|
|
case PROCESSOR_700: return 1;
|
| 4838 |
|
|
case PROCESSOR_7100: return 2;
|
| 4839 |
|
|
case PROCESSOR_7100LC: return 2;
|
| 4840 |
|
|
case PROCESSOR_7200: return 2;
|
| 4841 |
|
|
case PROCESSOR_7300: return 2;
|
| 4842 |
|
|
case PROCESSOR_8000: return 4;
|
| 4843 |
|
|
|
| 4844 |
|
|
default:
|
| 4845 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 4846 |
|
|
}
|
| 4847 |
|
|
}
|
| 4848 |
|
|
|
| 4849 |
|
|
|
| 4850 |
|
|
|
| 4851 |
|
|
/* Return any length adjustment needed by INSN which already has its length
|
| 4852 |
|
|
computed as LENGTH. Return zero if no adjustment is necessary.
|
| 4853 |
|
|
|
| 4854 |
|
|
For the PA: function calls, millicode calls, and backwards short
|
| 4855 |
|
|
conditional branches with unfilled delay slots need an adjustment by +1
|
| 4856 |
|
|
(to account for the NOP which will be inserted into the instruction stream).
|
| 4857 |
|
|
|
| 4858 |
|
|
Also compute the length of an inline block move here as it is too
|
| 4859 |
|
|
complicated to express as a length attribute in pa.md. */
|
| 4860 |
|
|
int
|
| 4861 |
|
|
pa_adjust_insn_length (rtx insn, int length)
|
| 4862 |
|
|
{
|
| 4863 |
|
|
rtx pat = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 4864 |
|
|
|
| 4865 |
|
|
/* Jumps inside switch tables which have unfilled delay slots need
|
| 4866 |
|
|
adjustment. */
|
| 4867 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
|
| 4868 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL
|
| 4869 |
|
|
&& get_attr_type (insn) == TYPE_BTABLE_BRANCH)
|
| 4870 |
|
|
return 4;
|
| 4871 |
|
|
/* Millicode insn with an unfilled delay slot. */
|
| 4872 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
|
| 4873 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (pat) != SEQUENCE
|
| 4874 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (pat) != USE
|
| 4875 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (pat) != CLOBBER
|
| 4876 |
|
|
&& get_attr_type (insn) == TYPE_MILLI)
|
| 4877 |
|
|
return 4;
|
| 4878 |
|
|
/* Block move pattern. */
|
| 4879 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
|
| 4880 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL
|
| 4881 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0)) == SET
|
| 4882 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0), 0)) == MEM
|
| 4883 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0), 1)) == MEM
|
| 4884 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0), 0)) == BLKmode
|
| 4885 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0), 1)) == BLKmode)
|
| 4886 |
|
|
return compute_movmem_length (insn) - 4;
|
| 4887 |
|
|
/* Block clear pattern. */
|
| 4888 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
|
| 4889 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL
|
| 4890 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0)) == SET
|
| 4891 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0), 0)) == MEM
|
| 4892 |
|
|
&& XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0), 1) == const0_rtx
|
| 4893 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0), 0)) == BLKmode)
|
| 4894 |
|
|
return compute_clrmem_length (insn) - 4;
|
| 4895 |
|
|
/* Conditional branch with an unfilled delay slot. */
|
| 4896 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN && ! simplejump_p (insn))
|
| 4897 |
|
|
{
|
| 4898 |
|
|
/* Adjust a short backwards conditional with an unfilled delay slot. */
|
| 4899 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET
|
| 4900 |
|
|
&& length == 4
|
| 4901 |
|
|
&& JUMP_LABEL (insn) != NULL_RTX
|
| 4902 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn))
|
| 4903 |
|
|
return 4;
|
| 4904 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL
|
| 4905 |
|
|
&& get_attr_type (insn) == TYPE_PARALLEL_BRANCH
|
| 4906 |
|
|
&& length == 4)
|
| 4907 |
|
|
return 4;
|
| 4908 |
|
|
/* Adjust dbra insn with short backwards conditional branch with
|
| 4909 |
|
|
unfilled delay slot -- only for case where counter is in a
|
| 4910 |
|
|
general register register. */
|
| 4911 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL
|
| 4912 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 1)) == SET
|
| 4913 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 1), 0)) == REG
|
| 4914 |
|
|
&& ! FP_REG_P (XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 1), 0))
|
| 4915 |
|
|
&& length == 4
|
| 4916 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn))
|
| 4917 |
|
|
return 4;
|
| 4918 |
|
|
else
|
| 4919 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4920 |
|
|
}
|
| 4921 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 4922 |
|
|
}
|
| 4923 |
|
|
|
| 4924 |
|
|
/* Implement the TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P hook. */
|
| 4925 |
|
|
|
| 4926 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 4927 |
|
|
pa_print_operand_punct_valid_p (unsigned char code)
|
| 4928 |
|
|
{
|
| 4929 |
|
|
if (code == '@'
|
| 4930 |
|
|
|| code == '#'
|
| 4931 |
|
|
|| code == '*'
|
| 4932 |
|
|
|| code == '^')
|
| 4933 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 4934 |
|
|
|
| 4935 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 4936 |
|
|
}
|
| 4937 |
|
|
|
| 4938 |
|
|
/* Print operand X (an rtx) in assembler syntax to file FILE.
|
| 4939 |
|
|
CODE is a letter or dot (`z' in `%z0') or 0 if no letter was specified.
|
| 4940 |
|
|
For `%' followed by punctuation, CODE is the punctuation and X is null. */
|
| 4941 |
|
|
|
| 4942 |
|
|
void
|
| 4943 |
|
|
pa_print_operand (FILE *file, rtx x, int code)
|
| 4944 |
|
|
{
|
| 4945 |
|
|
switch (code)
|
| 4946 |
|
|
{
|
| 4947 |
|
|
case '#':
|
| 4948 |
|
|
/* Output a 'nop' if there's nothing for the delay slot. */
|
| 4949 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 4950 |
|
|
fputs ("\n\tnop", file);
|
| 4951 |
|
|
return;
|
| 4952 |
|
|
case '*':
|
| 4953 |
|
|
/* Output a nullification completer if there's nothing for the */
|
| 4954 |
|
|
/* delay slot or nullification is requested. */
|
| 4955 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0 ||
|
| 4956 |
|
|
(final_sequence &&
|
| 4957 |
|
|
INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0))))
|
| 4958 |
|
|
fputs (",n", file);
|
| 4959 |
|
|
return;
|
| 4960 |
|
|
case 'R':
|
| 4961 |
|
|
/* Print out the second register name of a register pair.
|
| 4962 |
|
|
I.e., R (6) => 7. */
|
| 4963 |
|
|
fputs (reg_names[REGNO (x) + 1], file);
|
| 4964 |
|
|
return;
|
| 4965 |
|
|
case 'r':
|
| 4966 |
|
|
/* A register or zero. */
|
| 4967 |
|
|
if (x == const0_rtx
|
| 4968 |
|
|
|| (x == CONST0_RTX (DFmode))
|
| 4969 |
|
|
|| (x == CONST0_RTX (SFmode)))
|
| 4970 |
|
|
{
|
| 4971 |
|
|
fputs ("%r0", file);
|
| 4972 |
|
|
return;
|
| 4973 |
|
|
}
|
| 4974 |
|
|
else
|
| 4975 |
|
|
break;
|
| 4976 |
|
|
case 'f':
|
| 4977 |
|
|
/* A register or zero (floating point). */
|
| 4978 |
|
|
if (x == const0_rtx
|
| 4979 |
|
|
|| (x == CONST0_RTX (DFmode))
|
| 4980 |
|
|
|| (x == CONST0_RTX (SFmode)))
|
| 4981 |
|
|
{
|
| 4982 |
|
|
fputs ("%fr0", file);
|
| 4983 |
|
|
return;
|
| 4984 |
|
|
}
|
| 4985 |
|
|
else
|
| 4986 |
|
|
break;
|
| 4987 |
|
|
case 'A':
|
| 4988 |
|
|
{
|
| 4989 |
|
|
rtx xoperands[2];
|
| 4990 |
|
|
|
| 4991 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
|
| 4992 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = XVECEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1), 0, 0);
|
| 4993 |
|
|
pa_output_global_address (file, xoperands[1], 0);
|
| 4994 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "(%s)", reg_names [REGNO (xoperands[0])]);
|
| 4995 |
|
|
return;
|
| 4996 |
|
|
}
|
| 4997 |
|
|
|
| 4998 |
|
|
case 'C': /* Plain (C)ondition */
|
| 4999 |
|
|
case 'X':
|
| 5000 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (x))
|
| 5001 |
|
|
{
|
| 5002 |
|
|
case EQ:
|
| 5003 |
|
|
fputs ("=", file); break;
|
| 5004 |
|
|
case NE:
|
| 5005 |
|
|
fputs ("<>", file); break;
|
| 5006 |
|
|
case GT:
|
| 5007 |
|
|
fputs (">", file); break;
|
| 5008 |
|
|
case GE:
|
| 5009 |
|
|
fputs (">=", file); break;
|
| 5010 |
|
|
case GEU:
|
| 5011 |
|
|
fputs (">>=", file); break;
|
| 5012 |
|
|
case GTU:
|
| 5013 |
|
|
fputs (">>", file); break;
|
| 5014 |
|
|
case LT:
|
| 5015 |
|
|
fputs ("<", file); break;
|
| 5016 |
|
|
case LE:
|
| 5017 |
|
|
fputs ("<=", file); break;
|
| 5018 |
|
|
case LEU:
|
| 5019 |
|
|
fputs ("<<=", file); break;
|
| 5020 |
|
|
case LTU:
|
| 5021 |
|
|
fputs ("<<", file); break;
|
| 5022 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5023 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 5024 |
|
|
}
|
| 5025 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5026 |
|
|
case 'N': /* Condition, (N)egated */
|
| 5027 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (x))
|
| 5028 |
|
|
{
|
| 5029 |
|
|
case EQ:
|
| 5030 |
|
|
fputs ("<>", file); break;
|
| 5031 |
|
|
case NE:
|
| 5032 |
|
|
fputs ("=", file); break;
|
| 5033 |
|
|
case GT:
|
| 5034 |
|
|
fputs ("<=", file); break;
|
| 5035 |
|
|
case GE:
|
| 5036 |
|
|
fputs ("<", file); break;
|
| 5037 |
|
|
case GEU:
|
| 5038 |
|
|
fputs ("<<", file); break;
|
| 5039 |
|
|
case GTU:
|
| 5040 |
|
|
fputs ("<<=", file); break;
|
| 5041 |
|
|
case LT:
|
| 5042 |
|
|
fputs (">=", file); break;
|
| 5043 |
|
|
case LE:
|
| 5044 |
|
|
fputs (">", file); break;
|
| 5045 |
|
|
case LEU:
|
| 5046 |
|
|
fputs (">>", file); break;
|
| 5047 |
|
|
case LTU:
|
| 5048 |
|
|
fputs (">>=", file); break;
|
| 5049 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5050 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 5051 |
|
|
}
|
| 5052 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5053 |
|
|
/* For floating point comparisons. Note that the output
|
| 5054 |
|
|
predicates are the complement of the desired mode. The
|
| 5055 |
|
|
conditions for GT, GE, LT, LE and LTGT cause an invalid
|
| 5056 |
|
|
operation exception if the result is unordered and this
|
| 5057 |
|
|
exception is enabled in the floating-point status register. */
|
| 5058 |
|
|
case 'Y':
|
| 5059 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (x))
|
| 5060 |
|
|
{
|
| 5061 |
|
|
case EQ:
|
| 5062 |
|
|
fputs ("!=", file); break;
|
| 5063 |
|
|
case NE:
|
| 5064 |
|
|
fputs ("=", file); break;
|
| 5065 |
|
|
case GT:
|
| 5066 |
|
|
fputs ("!>", file); break;
|
| 5067 |
|
|
case GE:
|
| 5068 |
|
|
fputs ("!>=", file); break;
|
| 5069 |
|
|
case LT:
|
| 5070 |
|
|
fputs ("!<", file); break;
|
| 5071 |
|
|
case LE:
|
| 5072 |
|
|
fputs ("!<=", file); break;
|
| 5073 |
|
|
case LTGT:
|
| 5074 |
|
|
fputs ("!<>", file); break;
|
| 5075 |
|
|
case UNLE:
|
| 5076 |
|
|
fputs ("!?<=", file); break;
|
| 5077 |
|
|
case UNLT:
|
| 5078 |
|
|
fputs ("!?<", file); break;
|
| 5079 |
|
|
case UNGE:
|
| 5080 |
|
|
fputs ("!?>=", file); break;
|
| 5081 |
|
|
case UNGT:
|
| 5082 |
|
|
fputs ("!?>", file); break;
|
| 5083 |
|
|
case UNEQ:
|
| 5084 |
|
|
fputs ("!?=", file); break;
|
| 5085 |
|
|
case UNORDERED:
|
| 5086 |
|
|
fputs ("!?", file); break;
|
| 5087 |
|
|
case ORDERED:
|
| 5088 |
|
|
fputs ("?", file); break;
|
| 5089 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5090 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 5091 |
|
|
}
|
| 5092 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5093 |
|
|
case 'S': /* Condition, operands are (S)wapped. */
|
| 5094 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (x))
|
| 5095 |
|
|
{
|
| 5096 |
|
|
case EQ:
|
| 5097 |
|
|
fputs ("=", file); break;
|
| 5098 |
|
|
case NE:
|
| 5099 |
|
|
fputs ("<>", file); break;
|
| 5100 |
|
|
case GT:
|
| 5101 |
|
|
fputs ("<", file); break;
|
| 5102 |
|
|
case GE:
|
| 5103 |
|
|
fputs ("<=", file); break;
|
| 5104 |
|
|
case GEU:
|
| 5105 |
|
|
fputs ("<<=", file); break;
|
| 5106 |
|
|
case GTU:
|
| 5107 |
|
|
fputs ("<<", file); break;
|
| 5108 |
|
|
case LT:
|
| 5109 |
|
|
fputs (">", file); break;
|
| 5110 |
|
|
case LE:
|
| 5111 |
|
|
fputs (">=", file); break;
|
| 5112 |
|
|
case LEU:
|
| 5113 |
|
|
fputs (">>=", file); break;
|
| 5114 |
|
|
case LTU:
|
| 5115 |
|
|
fputs (">>", file); break;
|
| 5116 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5117 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 5118 |
|
|
}
|
| 5119 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5120 |
|
|
case 'B': /* Condition, (B)oth swapped and negate. */
|
| 5121 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (x))
|
| 5122 |
|
|
{
|
| 5123 |
|
|
case EQ:
|
| 5124 |
|
|
fputs ("<>", file); break;
|
| 5125 |
|
|
case NE:
|
| 5126 |
|
|
fputs ("=", file); break;
|
| 5127 |
|
|
case GT:
|
| 5128 |
|
|
fputs (">=", file); break;
|
| 5129 |
|
|
case GE:
|
| 5130 |
|
|
fputs (">", file); break;
|
| 5131 |
|
|
case GEU:
|
| 5132 |
|
|
fputs (">>", file); break;
|
| 5133 |
|
|
case GTU:
|
| 5134 |
|
|
fputs (">>=", file); break;
|
| 5135 |
|
|
case LT:
|
| 5136 |
|
|
fputs ("<=", file); break;
|
| 5137 |
|
|
case LE:
|
| 5138 |
|
|
fputs ("<", file); break;
|
| 5139 |
|
|
case LEU:
|
| 5140 |
|
|
fputs ("<<", file); break;
|
| 5141 |
|
|
case LTU:
|
| 5142 |
|
|
fputs ("<<=", file); break;
|
| 5143 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5144 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 5145 |
|
|
}
|
| 5146 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5147 |
|
|
case 'k':
|
| 5148 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT);
|
| 5149 |
|
|
fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, ~INTVAL (x));
|
| 5150 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5151 |
|
|
case 'Q':
|
| 5152 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT);
|
| 5153 |
|
|
fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, 64 - (INTVAL (x) & 63));
|
| 5154 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5155 |
|
|
case 'L':
|
| 5156 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT);
|
| 5157 |
|
|
fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, 32 - (INTVAL (x) & 31));
|
| 5158 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5159 |
|
|
case 'O':
|
| 5160 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && exact_log2 (INTVAL (x)) >= 0);
|
| 5161 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "%d", exact_log2 (INTVAL (x)));
|
| 5162 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5163 |
|
|
case 'p':
|
| 5164 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT);
|
| 5165 |
|
|
fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, 63 - (INTVAL (x) & 63));
|
| 5166 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5167 |
|
|
case 'P':
|
| 5168 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT);
|
| 5169 |
|
|
fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, 31 - (INTVAL (x) & 31));
|
| 5170 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5171 |
|
|
case 'I':
|
| 5172 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
|
| 5173 |
|
|
fputs ("i", file);
|
| 5174 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5175 |
|
|
case 'M':
|
| 5176 |
|
|
case 'F':
|
| 5177 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
|
| 5178 |
|
|
{
|
| 5179 |
|
|
case PRE_DEC:
|
| 5180 |
|
|
case PRE_INC:
|
| 5181 |
|
|
if (ASSEMBLER_DIALECT == 0)
|
| 5182 |
|
|
fputs ("s,mb", file);
|
| 5183 |
|
|
else
|
| 5184 |
|
|
fputs (",mb", file);
|
| 5185 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5186 |
|
|
case POST_DEC:
|
| 5187 |
|
|
case POST_INC:
|
| 5188 |
|
|
if (ASSEMBLER_DIALECT == 0)
|
| 5189 |
|
|
fputs ("s,ma", file);
|
| 5190 |
|
|
else
|
| 5191 |
|
|
fputs (",ma", file);
|
| 5192 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5193 |
|
|
case PLUS:
|
| 5194 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == REG
|
| 5195 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == REG)
|
| 5196 |
|
|
{
|
| 5197 |
|
|
if (ASSEMBLER_DIALECT == 0)
|
| 5198 |
|
|
fputs ("x", file);
|
| 5199 |
|
|
}
|
| 5200 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == MULT
|
| 5201 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == MULT)
|
| 5202 |
|
|
{
|
| 5203 |
|
|
if (ASSEMBLER_DIALECT == 0)
|
| 5204 |
|
|
fputs ("x,s", file);
|
| 5205 |
|
|
else
|
| 5206 |
|
|
fputs (",s", file);
|
| 5207 |
|
|
}
|
| 5208 |
|
|
else if (code == 'F' && ASSEMBLER_DIALECT == 0)
|
| 5209 |
|
|
fputs ("s", file);
|
| 5210 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5211 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5212 |
|
|
if (code == 'F' && ASSEMBLER_DIALECT == 0)
|
| 5213 |
|
|
fputs ("s", file);
|
| 5214 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5215 |
|
|
}
|
| 5216 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5217 |
|
|
case 'G':
|
| 5218 |
|
|
pa_output_global_address (file, x, 0);
|
| 5219 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5220 |
|
|
case 'H':
|
| 5221 |
|
|
pa_output_global_address (file, x, 1);
|
| 5222 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5223 |
|
|
case 0: /* Don't do anything special */
|
| 5224 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5225 |
|
|
case 'Z':
|
| 5226 |
|
|
{
|
| 5227 |
|
|
unsigned op[3];
|
| 5228 |
|
|
compute_zdepwi_operands (INTVAL (x), op);
|
| 5229 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "%d,%d,%d", op[0], op[1], op[2]);
|
| 5230 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5231 |
|
|
}
|
| 5232 |
|
|
case 'z':
|
| 5233 |
|
|
{
|
| 5234 |
|
|
unsigned op[3];
|
| 5235 |
|
|
compute_zdepdi_operands (INTVAL (x), op);
|
| 5236 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "%d,%d,%d", op[0], op[1], op[2]);
|
| 5237 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5238 |
|
|
}
|
| 5239 |
|
|
case 'c':
|
| 5240 |
|
|
/* We can get here from a .vtable_inherit due to our
|
| 5241 |
|
|
CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P rejecting perfectly good constant
|
| 5242 |
|
|
addresses. */
|
| 5243 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5244 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5245 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 5246 |
|
|
}
|
| 5247 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
|
| 5248 |
|
|
{
|
| 5249 |
|
|
fputs (reg_names [REGNO (x)], file);
|
| 5250 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT && FP_REG_P (x) && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) <= 4)
|
| 5251 |
|
|
{
|
| 5252 |
|
|
fputs ("R", file);
|
| 5253 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5254 |
|
|
}
|
| 5255 |
|
|
if (FP_REG_P (x)
|
| 5256 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) <= 4
|
| 5257 |
|
|
&& (REGNO (x) & 1) == 0)
|
| 5258 |
|
|
fputs ("L", file);
|
| 5259 |
|
|
}
|
| 5260 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
|
| 5261 |
|
|
{
|
| 5262 |
|
|
int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
|
| 5263 |
|
|
rtx base = NULL_RTX;
|
| 5264 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
|
| 5265 |
|
|
{
|
| 5266 |
|
|
case PRE_DEC:
|
| 5267 |
|
|
case POST_DEC:
|
| 5268 |
|
|
base = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
|
| 5269 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "-%d(%s)", size, reg_names [REGNO (base)]);
|
| 5270 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5271 |
|
|
case PRE_INC:
|
| 5272 |
|
|
case POST_INC:
|
| 5273 |
|
|
base = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
|
| 5274 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "%d(%s)", size, reg_names [REGNO (base)]);
|
| 5275 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5276 |
|
|
case PLUS:
|
| 5277 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == MULT)
|
| 5278 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "%s(%s)",
|
| 5279 |
|
|
reg_names [REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 0))],
|
| 5280 |
|
|
reg_names [REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))]);
|
| 5281 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == MULT)
|
| 5282 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "%s(%s)",
|
| 5283 |
|
|
reg_names [REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1), 0))],
|
| 5284 |
|
|
reg_names [REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))]);
|
| 5285 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == REG
|
| 5286 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == REG)
|
| 5287 |
|
|
{
|
| 5288 |
|
|
/* Because the REG_POINTER flag can get lost during reload,
|
| 5289 |
|
|
GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS canonicalizes the order of the
|
| 5290 |
|
|
index and base registers in the combined move patterns. */
|
| 5291 |
|
|
rtx base = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
|
| 5292 |
|
|
rtx index = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
|
| 5293 |
|
|
|
| 5294 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "%s(%s)",
|
| 5295 |
|
|
reg_names [REGNO (index)], reg_names [REGNO (base)]);
|
| 5296 |
|
|
}
|
| 5297 |
|
|
else
|
| 5298 |
|
|
output_address (XEXP (x, 0));
|
| 5299 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5300 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5301 |
|
|
output_address (XEXP (x, 0));
|
| 5302 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5303 |
|
|
}
|
| 5304 |
|
|
}
|
| 5305 |
|
|
else
|
| 5306 |
|
|
output_addr_const (file, x);
|
| 5307 |
|
|
}
|
| 5308 |
|
|
|
| 5309 |
|
|
/* output a SYMBOL_REF or a CONST expression involving a SYMBOL_REF. */
|
| 5310 |
|
|
|
| 5311 |
|
|
void
|
| 5312 |
|
|
pa_output_global_address (FILE *file, rtx x, int round_constant)
|
| 5313 |
|
|
{
|
| 5314 |
|
|
|
| 5315 |
|
|
/* Imagine (high (const (plus ...))). */
|
| 5316 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == HIGH)
|
| 5317 |
|
|
x = XEXP (x, 0);
|
| 5318 |
|
|
|
| 5319 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF && read_only_operand (x, VOIDmode))
|
| 5320 |
|
|
output_addr_const (file, x);
|
| 5321 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF && !flag_pic)
|
| 5322 |
|
|
{
|
| 5323 |
|
|
output_addr_const (file, x);
|
| 5324 |
|
|
fputs ("-$global$", file);
|
| 5325 |
|
|
}
|
| 5326 |
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
|
| 5327 |
|
|
{
|
| 5328 |
|
|
const char *sep = "";
|
| 5329 |
|
|
int offset = 0; /* assembler wants -$global$ at end */
|
| 5330 |
|
|
rtx base = NULL_RTX;
|
| 5331 |
|
|
|
| 5332 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)))
|
| 5333 |
|
|
{
|
| 5334 |
|
|
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
| 5335 |
|
|
base = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
|
| 5336 |
|
|
output_addr_const (file, base);
|
| 5337 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5338 |
|
|
case CONST_INT:
|
| 5339 |
|
|
offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0));
|
| 5340 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5341 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5342 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 5343 |
|
|
}
|
| 5344 |
|
|
|
| 5345 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)))
|
| 5346 |
|
|
{
|
| 5347 |
|
|
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
| 5348 |
|
|
base = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
|
| 5349 |
|
|
output_addr_const (file, base);
|
| 5350 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5351 |
|
|
case CONST_INT:
|
| 5352 |
|
|
offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1));
|
| 5353 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5354 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5355 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 5356 |
|
|
}
|
| 5357 |
|
|
|
| 5358 |
|
|
/* How bogus. The compiler is apparently responsible for
|
| 5359 |
|
|
rounding the constant if it uses an LR field selector.
|
| 5360 |
|
|
|
| 5361 |
|
|
The linker and/or assembler seem a better place since
|
| 5362 |
|
|
they have to do this kind of thing already.
|
| 5363 |
|
|
|
| 5364 |
|
|
If we fail to do this, HP's optimizing linker may eliminate
|
| 5365 |
|
|
an addil, but not update the ldw/stw/ldo instruction that
|
| 5366 |
|
|
uses the result of the addil. */
|
| 5367 |
|
|
if (round_constant)
|
| 5368 |
|
|
offset = ((offset + 0x1000) & ~0x1fff);
|
| 5369 |
|
|
|
| 5370 |
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
|
| 5371 |
|
|
{
|
| 5372 |
|
|
case PLUS:
|
| 5373 |
|
|
if (offset < 0)
|
| 5374 |
|
|
{
|
| 5375 |
|
|
offset = -offset;
|
| 5376 |
|
|
sep = "-";
|
| 5377 |
|
|
}
|
| 5378 |
|
|
else
|
| 5379 |
|
|
sep = "+";
|
| 5380 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5381 |
|
|
|
| 5382 |
|
|
case MINUS:
|
| 5383 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
|
| 5384 |
|
|
sep = "-";
|
| 5385 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5386 |
|
|
|
| 5387 |
|
|
default:
|
| 5388 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 5389 |
|
|
}
|
| 5390 |
|
|
|
| 5391 |
|
|
if (!read_only_operand (base, VOIDmode) && !flag_pic)
|
| 5392 |
|
|
fputs ("-$global$", file);
|
| 5393 |
|
|
if (offset)
|
| 5394 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "%s%d", sep, offset);
|
| 5395 |
|
|
}
|
| 5396 |
|
|
else
|
| 5397 |
|
|
output_addr_const (file, x);
|
| 5398 |
|
|
}
|
| 5399 |
|
|
|
| 5400 |
|
|
/* Output boilerplate text to appear at the beginning of the file.
|
| 5401 |
|
|
There are several possible versions. */
|
| 5402 |
|
|
#define aputs(x) fputs(x, asm_out_file)
|
| 5403 |
|
|
static inline void
|
| 5404 |
|
|
pa_file_start_level (void)
|
| 5405 |
|
|
{
|
| 5406 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 5407 |
|
|
aputs ("\t.LEVEL 2.0w\n");
|
| 5408 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_PA_20)
|
| 5409 |
|
|
aputs ("\t.LEVEL 2.0\n");
|
| 5410 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_PA_11)
|
| 5411 |
|
|
aputs ("\t.LEVEL 1.1\n");
|
| 5412 |
|
|
else
|
| 5413 |
|
|
aputs ("\t.LEVEL 1.0\n");
|
| 5414 |
|
|
}
|
| 5415 |
|
|
|
| 5416 |
|
|
static inline void
|
| 5417 |
|
|
pa_file_start_space (int sortspace)
|
| 5418 |
|
|
{
|
| 5419 |
|
|
aputs ("\t.SPACE $PRIVATE$");
|
| 5420 |
|
|
if (sortspace)
|
| 5421 |
|
|
aputs (",SORT=16");
|
| 5422 |
|
|
aputs ("\n\t.SUBSPA $DATA$,QUAD=1,ALIGN=8,ACCESS=31");
|
| 5423 |
|
|
if (flag_tm)
|
| 5424 |
|
|
aputs ("\n\t.SUBSPA $TM_CLONE_TABLE$,QUAD=1,ALIGN=8,ACCESS=31");
|
| 5425 |
|
|
aputs ("\n\t.SUBSPA $BSS$,QUAD=1,ALIGN=8,ACCESS=31,ZERO,SORT=82"
|
| 5426 |
|
|
"\n\t.SPACE $TEXT$");
|
| 5427 |
|
|
if (sortspace)
|
| 5428 |
|
|
aputs (",SORT=8");
|
| 5429 |
|
|
aputs ("\n\t.SUBSPA $LIT$,QUAD=0,ALIGN=8,ACCESS=44"
|
| 5430 |
|
|
"\n\t.SUBSPA $CODE$,QUAD=0,ALIGN=8,ACCESS=44,CODE_ONLY\n");
|
| 5431 |
|
|
}
|
| 5432 |
|
|
|
| 5433 |
|
|
static inline void
|
| 5434 |
|
|
pa_file_start_file (int want_version)
|
| 5435 |
|
|
{
|
| 5436 |
|
|
if (write_symbols != NO_DEBUG)
|
| 5437 |
|
|
{
|
| 5438 |
|
|
output_file_directive (asm_out_file, main_input_filename);
|
| 5439 |
|
|
if (want_version)
|
| 5440 |
|
|
aputs ("\t.version\t\"01.01\"\n");
|
| 5441 |
|
|
}
|
| 5442 |
|
|
}
|
| 5443 |
|
|
|
| 5444 |
|
|
static inline void
|
| 5445 |
|
|
pa_file_start_mcount (const char *aswhat)
|
| 5446 |
|
|
{
|
| 5447 |
|
|
if (profile_flag)
|
| 5448 |
|
|
fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.IMPORT _mcount,%s\n", aswhat);
|
| 5449 |
|
|
}
|
| 5450 |
|
|
|
| 5451 |
|
|
static void
|
| 5452 |
|
|
pa_elf_file_start (void)
|
| 5453 |
|
|
{
|
| 5454 |
|
|
pa_file_start_level ();
|
| 5455 |
|
|
pa_file_start_mcount ("ENTRY");
|
| 5456 |
|
|
pa_file_start_file (0);
|
| 5457 |
|
|
}
|
| 5458 |
|
|
|
| 5459 |
|
|
static void
|
| 5460 |
|
|
pa_som_file_start (void)
|
| 5461 |
|
|
{
|
| 5462 |
|
|
pa_file_start_level ();
|
| 5463 |
|
|
pa_file_start_space (0);
|
| 5464 |
|
|
aputs ("\t.IMPORT $global$,DATA\n"
|
| 5465 |
|
|
"\t.IMPORT $$dyncall,MILLICODE\n");
|
| 5466 |
|
|
pa_file_start_mcount ("CODE");
|
| 5467 |
|
|
pa_file_start_file (0);
|
| 5468 |
|
|
}
|
| 5469 |
|
|
|
| 5470 |
|
|
static void
|
| 5471 |
|
|
pa_linux_file_start (void)
|
| 5472 |
|
|
{
|
| 5473 |
|
|
pa_file_start_file (1);
|
| 5474 |
|
|
pa_file_start_level ();
|
| 5475 |
|
|
pa_file_start_mcount ("CODE");
|
| 5476 |
|
|
}
|
| 5477 |
|
|
|
| 5478 |
|
|
static void
|
| 5479 |
|
|
pa_hpux64_gas_file_start (void)
|
| 5480 |
|
|
{
|
| 5481 |
|
|
pa_file_start_level ();
|
| 5482 |
|
|
#ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE
|
| 5483 |
|
|
if (profile_flag)
|
| 5484 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (asm_out_file, "_mcount", "function");
|
| 5485 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 5486 |
|
|
pa_file_start_file (1);
|
| 5487 |
|
|
}
|
| 5488 |
|
|
|
| 5489 |
|
|
static void
|
| 5490 |
|
|
pa_hpux64_hpas_file_start (void)
|
| 5491 |
|
|
{
|
| 5492 |
|
|
pa_file_start_level ();
|
| 5493 |
|
|
pa_file_start_space (1);
|
| 5494 |
|
|
pa_file_start_mcount ("CODE");
|
| 5495 |
|
|
pa_file_start_file (0);
|
| 5496 |
|
|
}
|
| 5497 |
|
|
#undef aputs
|
| 5498 |
|
|
|
| 5499 |
|
|
/* Search the deferred plabel list for SYMBOL and return its internal
|
| 5500 |
|
|
label. If an entry for SYMBOL is not found, a new entry is created. */
|
| 5501 |
|
|
|
| 5502 |
|
|
rtx
|
| 5503 |
|
|
pa_get_deferred_plabel (rtx symbol)
|
| 5504 |
|
|
{
|
| 5505 |
|
|
const char *fname = XSTR (symbol, 0);
|
| 5506 |
|
|
size_t i;
|
| 5507 |
|
|
|
| 5508 |
|
|
/* See if we have already put this function on the list of deferred
|
| 5509 |
|
|
plabels. This list is generally small, so a liner search is not
|
| 5510 |
|
|
too ugly. If it proves too slow replace it with something faster. */
|
| 5511 |
|
|
for (i = 0; i < n_deferred_plabels; i++)
|
| 5512 |
|
|
if (strcmp (fname, XSTR (deferred_plabels[i].symbol, 0)) == 0)
|
| 5513 |
|
|
break;
|
| 5514 |
|
|
|
| 5515 |
|
|
/* If the deferred plabel list is empty, or this entry was not found
|
| 5516 |
|
|
on the list, create a new entry on the list. */
|
| 5517 |
|
|
if (deferred_plabels == NULL || i == n_deferred_plabels)
|
| 5518 |
|
|
{
|
| 5519 |
|
|
tree id;
|
| 5520 |
|
|
|
| 5521 |
|
|
if (deferred_plabels == 0)
|
| 5522 |
|
|
deferred_plabels = ggc_alloc_deferred_plabel ();
|
| 5523 |
|
|
else
|
| 5524 |
|
|
deferred_plabels = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct deferred_plabel,
|
| 5525 |
|
|
deferred_plabels,
|
| 5526 |
|
|
n_deferred_plabels + 1);
|
| 5527 |
|
|
|
| 5528 |
|
|
i = n_deferred_plabels++;
|
| 5529 |
|
|
deferred_plabels[i].internal_label = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 5530 |
|
|
deferred_plabels[i].symbol = symbol;
|
| 5531 |
|
|
|
| 5532 |
|
|
/* Gross. We have just implicitly taken the address of this
|
| 5533 |
|
|
function. Mark it in the same manner as assemble_name. */
|
| 5534 |
|
|
id = maybe_get_identifier (targetm.strip_name_encoding (fname));
|
| 5535 |
|
|
if (id)
|
| 5536 |
|
|
mark_referenced (id);
|
| 5537 |
|
|
}
|
| 5538 |
|
|
|
| 5539 |
|
|
return deferred_plabels[i].internal_label;
|
| 5540 |
|
|
}
|
| 5541 |
|
|
|
| 5542 |
|
|
static void
|
| 5543 |
|
|
output_deferred_plabels (void)
|
| 5544 |
|
|
{
|
| 5545 |
|
|
size_t i;
|
| 5546 |
|
|
|
| 5547 |
|
|
/* If we have some deferred plabels, then we need to switch into the
|
| 5548 |
|
|
data or readonly data section, and align it to a 4 byte boundary
|
| 5549 |
|
|
before outputting the deferred plabels. */
|
| 5550 |
|
|
if (n_deferred_plabels)
|
| 5551 |
|
|
{
|
| 5552 |
|
|
switch_to_section (flag_pic ? data_section : readonly_data_section);
|
| 5553 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, TARGET_64BIT ? 3 : 2);
|
| 5554 |
|
|
}
|
| 5555 |
|
|
|
| 5556 |
|
|
/* Now output the deferred plabels. */
|
| 5557 |
|
|
for (i = 0; i < n_deferred_plabels; i++)
|
| 5558 |
|
|
{
|
| 5559 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "L",
|
| 5560 |
|
|
CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (deferred_plabels[i].internal_label));
|
| 5561 |
|
|
assemble_integer (deferred_plabels[i].symbol,
|
| 5562 |
|
|
TARGET_64BIT ? 8 : 4, TARGET_64BIT ? 64 : 32, 1);
|
| 5563 |
|
|
}
|
| 5564 |
|
|
}
|
| 5565 |
|
|
|
| 5566 |
|
|
/* Initialize optabs to point to emulation routines. */
|
| 5567 |
|
|
|
| 5568 |
|
|
static void
|
| 5569 |
|
|
pa_init_libfuncs (void)
|
| 5570 |
|
|
{
|
| 5571 |
|
|
if (HPUX_LONG_DOUBLE_LIBRARY)
|
| 5572 |
|
|
{
|
| 5573 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfadd");
|
| 5574 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfsub");
|
| 5575 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfmpy");
|
| 5576 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfdiv");
|
| 5577 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (smin_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qmin");
|
| 5578 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (smax_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfmax");
|
| 5579 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (sqrt_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfsqrt");
|
| 5580 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (abs_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfabs");
|
| 5581 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (neg_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfneg");
|
| 5582 |
|
|
|
| 5583 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (eq_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfeq");
|
| 5584 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (ne_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfne");
|
| 5585 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (gt_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfgt");
|
| 5586 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (ge_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfge");
|
| 5587 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (lt_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qflt");
|
| 5588 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (le_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfle");
|
| 5589 |
|
|
set_optab_libfunc (unord_optab, TFmode, "_U_Qfunord");
|
| 5590 |
|
|
|
| 5591 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (sext_optab, TFmode, SFmode, "_U_Qfcnvff_sgl_to_quad");
|
| 5592 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (sext_optab, TFmode, DFmode, "_U_Qfcnvff_dbl_to_quad");
|
| 5593 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (trunc_optab, SFmode, TFmode, "_U_Qfcnvff_quad_to_sgl");
|
| 5594 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (trunc_optab, DFmode, TFmode, "_U_Qfcnvff_quad_to_dbl");
|
| 5595 |
|
|
|
| 5596 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, TFmode,
|
| 5597 |
|
|
TARGET_64BIT ? "__U_Qfcnvfxt_quad_to_sgl"
|
| 5598 |
|
|
: "_U_Qfcnvfxt_quad_to_sgl");
|
| 5599 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, TFmode,
|
| 5600 |
|
|
"_U_Qfcnvfxt_quad_to_dbl");
|
| 5601 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, TFmode,
|
| 5602 |
|
|
"_U_Qfcnvfxt_quad_to_usgl");
|
| 5603 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, TFmode,
|
| 5604 |
|
|
"_U_Qfcnvfxt_quad_to_udbl");
|
| 5605 |
|
|
|
| 5606 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, TFmode, SImode,
|
| 5607 |
|
|
"_U_Qfcnvxf_sgl_to_quad");
|
| 5608 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, TFmode, DImode,
|
| 5609 |
|
|
"_U_Qfcnvxf_dbl_to_quad");
|
| 5610 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (ufloat_optab, TFmode, SImode,
|
| 5611 |
|
|
"_U_Qfcnvxf_usgl_to_quad");
|
| 5612 |
|
|
set_conv_libfunc (ufloat_optab, TFmode, DImode,
|
| 5613 |
|
|
"_U_Qfcnvxf_udbl_to_quad");
|
| 5614 |
|
|
}
|
| 5615 |
|
|
|
| 5616 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SYNC_LIBCALL)
|
| 5617 |
|
|
init_sync_libfuncs (UNITS_PER_WORD);
|
| 5618 |
|
|
}
|
| 5619 |
|
|
|
| 5620 |
|
|
/* HP's millicode routines mean something special to the assembler.
|
| 5621 |
|
|
Keep track of which ones we have used. */
|
| 5622 |
|
|
|
| 5623 |
|
|
enum millicodes { remI, remU, divI, divU, mulI, end1000 };
|
| 5624 |
|
|
static void import_milli (enum millicodes);
|
| 5625 |
|
|
static char imported[(int) end1000];
|
| 5626 |
|
|
static const char * const milli_names[] = {"remI", "remU", "divI", "divU", "mulI"};
|
| 5627 |
|
|
static const char import_string[] = ".IMPORT $$....,MILLICODE";
|
| 5628 |
|
|
#define MILLI_START 10
|
| 5629 |
|
|
|
| 5630 |
|
|
static void
|
| 5631 |
|
|
import_milli (enum millicodes code)
|
| 5632 |
|
|
{
|
| 5633 |
|
|
char str[sizeof (import_string)];
|
| 5634 |
|
|
|
| 5635 |
|
|
if (!imported[(int) code])
|
| 5636 |
|
|
{
|
| 5637 |
|
|
imported[(int) code] = 1;
|
| 5638 |
|
|
strcpy (str, import_string);
|
| 5639 |
|
|
strncpy (str + MILLI_START, milli_names[(int) code], 4);
|
| 5640 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (str, 0);
|
| 5641 |
|
|
}
|
| 5642 |
|
|
}
|
| 5643 |
|
|
|
| 5644 |
|
|
/* The register constraints have put the operands and return value in
|
| 5645 |
|
|
the proper registers. */
|
| 5646 |
|
|
|
| 5647 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 5648 |
|
|
pa_output_mul_insn (int unsignedp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx insn)
|
| 5649 |
|
|
{
|
| 5650 |
|
|
import_milli (mulI);
|
| 5651 |
|
|
return pa_output_millicode_call (insn, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "$$mulI"));
|
| 5652 |
|
|
}
|
| 5653 |
|
|
|
| 5654 |
|
|
/* Emit the rtl for doing a division by a constant. */
|
| 5655 |
|
|
|
| 5656 |
|
|
/* Do magic division millicodes exist for this value? */
|
| 5657 |
|
|
const int pa_magic_milli[]= {0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1};
|
| 5658 |
|
|
|
| 5659 |
|
|
/* We'll use an array to keep track of the magic millicodes and
|
| 5660 |
|
|
whether or not we've used them already. [n][0] is signed, [n][1] is
|
| 5661 |
|
|
unsigned. */
|
| 5662 |
|
|
|
| 5663 |
|
|
static int div_milli[16][2];
|
| 5664 |
|
|
|
| 5665 |
|
|
int
|
| 5666 |
|
|
pa_emit_hpdiv_const (rtx *operands, int unsignedp)
|
| 5667 |
|
|
{
|
| 5668 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[2]) == CONST_INT
|
| 5669 |
|
|
&& INTVAL (operands[2]) > 0
|
| 5670 |
|
|
&& INTVAL (operands[2]) < 16
|
| 5671 |
|
|
&& pa_magic_milli[INTVAL (operands[2])])
|
| 5672 |
|
|
{
|
| 5673 |
|
|
rtx ret = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, TARGET_64BIT ? 2 : 31);
|
| 5674 |
|
|
|
| 5675 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 26), operands[1]);
|
| 5676 |
|
|
emit
|
| 5677 |
|
|
(gen_rtx_PARALLEL
|
| 5678 |
|
|
(VOIDmode,
|
| 5679 |
|
|
gen_rtvec (6, gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 29),
|
| 5680 |
|
|
gen_rtx_fmt_ee (unsignedp ? UDIV : DIV,
|
| 5681 |
|
|
SImode,
|
| 5682 |
|
|
gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 26),
|
| 5683 |
|
|
operands[2])),
|
| 5684 |
|
|
gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, operands[4]),
|
| 5685 |
|
|
gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, operands[3]),
|
| 5686 |
|
|
gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 26)),
|
| 5687 |
|
|
gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 25)),
|
| 5688 |
|
|
gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, ret))));
|
| 5689 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (operands[0], gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 29));
|
| 5690 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 5691 |
|
|
}
|
| 5692 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 5693 |
|
|
}
|
| 5694 |
|
|
|
| 5695 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 5696 |
|
|
pa_output_div_insn (rtx *operands, int unsignedp, rtx insn)
|
| 5697 |
|
|
{
|
| 5698 |
|
|
int divisor;
|
| 5699 |
|
|
|
| 5700 |
|
|
/* If the divisor is a constant, try to use one of the special
|
| 5701 |
|
|
opcodes .*/
|
| 5702 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == CONST_INT)
|
| 5703 |
|
|
{
|
| 5704 |
|
|
static char buf[100];
|
| 5705 |
|
|
divisor = INTVAL (operands[0]);
|
| 5706 |
|
|
if (!div_milli[divisor][unsignedp])
|
| 5707 |
|
|
{
|
| 5708 |
|
|
div_milli[divisor][unsignedp] = 1;
|
| 5709 |
|
|
if (unsignedp)
|
| 5710 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (".IMPORT $$divU_%0,MILLICODE", operands);
|
| 5711 |
|
|
else
|
| 5712 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (".IMPORT $$divI_%0,MILLICODE", operands);
|
| 5713 |
|
|
}
|
| 5714 |
|
|
if (unsignedp)
|
| 5715 |
|
|
{
|
| 5716 |
|
|
sprintf (buf, "$$divU_" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
|
| 5717 |
|
|
INTVAL (operands[0]));
|
| 5718 |
|
|
return pa_output_millicode_call (insn,
|
| 5719 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, buf));
|
| 5720 |
|
|
}
|
| 5721 |
|
|
else
|
| 5722 |
|
|
{
|
| 5723 |
|
|
sprintf (buf, "$$divI_" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
|
| 5724 |
|
|
INTVAL (operands[0]));
|
| 5725 |
|
|
return pa_output_millicode_call (insn,
|
| 5726 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, buf));
|
| 5727 |
|
|
}
|
| 5728 |
|
|
}
|
| 5729 |
|
|
/* Divisor isn't a special constant. */
|
| 5730 |
|
|
else
|
| 5731 |
|
|
{
|
| 5732 |
|
|
if (unsignedp)
|
| 5733 |
|
|
{
|
| 5734 |
|
|
import_milli (divU);
|
| 5735 |
|
|
return pa_output_millicode_call (insn,
|
| 5736 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, "$$divU"));
|
| 5737 |
|
|
}
|
| 5738 |
|
|
else
|
| 5739 |
|
|
{
|
| 5740 |
|
|
import_milli (divI);
|
| 5741 |
|
|
return pa_output_millicode_call (insn,
|
| 5742 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, "$$divI"));
|
| 5743 |
|
|
}
|
| 5744 |
|
|
}
|
| 5745 |
|
|
}
|
| 5746 |
|
|
|
| 5747 |
|
|
/* Output a $$rem millicode to do mod. */
|
| 5748 |
|
|
|
| 5749 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 5750 |
|
|
pa_output_mod_insn (int unsignedp, rtx insn)
|
| 5751 |
|
|
{
|
| 5752 |
|
|
if (unsignedp)
|
| 5753 |
|
|
{
|
| 5754 |
|
|
import_milli (remU);
|
| 5755 |
|
|
return pa_output_millicode_call (insn,
|
| 5756 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, "$$remU"));
|
| 5757 |
|
|
}
|
| 5758 |
|
|
else
|
| 5759 |
|
|
{
|
| 5760 |
|
|
import_milli (remI);
|
| 5761 |
|
|
return pa_output_millicode_call (insn,
|
| 5762 |
|
|
gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, "$$remI"));
|
| 5763 |
|
|
}
|
| 5764 |
|
|
}
|
| 5765 |
|
|
|
| 5766 |
|
|
void
|
| 5767 |
|
|
pa_output_arg_descriptor (rtx call_insn)
|
| 5768 |
|
|
{
|
| 5769 |
|
|
const char *arg_regs[4];
|
| 5770 |
|
|
enum machine_mode arg_mode;
|
| 5771 |
|
|
rtx link;
|
| 5772 |
|
|
int i, output_flag = 0;
|
| 5773 |
|
|
int regno;
|
| 5774 |
|
|
|
| 5775 |
|
|
/* We neither need nor want argument location descriptors for the
|
| 5776 |
|
|
64bit runtime environment or the ELF32 environment. */
|
| 5777 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT || TARGET_ELF32)
|
| 5778 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5779 |
|
|
|
| 5780 |
|
|
for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
|
| 5781 |
|
|
arg_regs[i] = 0;
|
| 5782 |
|
|
|
| 5783 |
|
|
/* Specify explicitly that no argument relocations should take place
|
| 5784 |
|
|
if using the portable runtime calling conventions. */
|
| 5785 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME)
|
| 5786 |
|
|
{
|
| 5787 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.CALL ARGW0=NO,ARGW1=NO,ARGW2=NO,ARGW3=NO,RETVAL=NO\n",
|
| 5788 |
|
|
asm_out_file);
|
| 5789 |
|
|
return;
|
| 5790 |
|
|
}
|
| 5791 |
|
|
|
| 5792 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (call_insn) == CALL_INSN);
|
| 5793 |
|
|
for (link = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (call_insn);
|
| 5794 |
|
|
link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
|
| 5795 |
|
|
{
|
| 5796 |
|
|
rtx use = XEXP (link, 0);
|
| 5797 |
|
|
|
| 5798 |
|
|
if (! (GET_CODE (use) == USE
|
| 5799 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (use, 0)) == REG
|
| 5800 |
|
|
&& FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (REGNO (XEXP (use, 0)))))
|
| 5801 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 5802 |
|
|
|
| 5803 |
|
|
arg_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (use, 0));
|
| 5804 |
|
|
regno = REGNO (XEXP (use, 0));
|
| 5805 |
|
|
if (regno >= 23 && regno <= 26)
|
| 5806 |
|
|
{
|
| 5807 |
|
|
arg_regs[26 - regno] = "GR";
|
| 5808 |
|
|
if (arg_mode == DImode)
|
| 5809 |
|
|
arg_regs[25 - regno] = "GR";
|
| 5810 |
|
|
}
|
| 5811 |
|
|
else if (regno >= 32 && regno <= 39)
|
| 5812 |
|
|
{
|
| 5813 |
|
|
if (arg_mode == SFmode)
|
| 5814 |
|
|
arg_regs[(regno - 32) / 2] = "FR";
|
| 5815 |
|
|
else
|
| 5816 |
|
|
{
|
| 5817 |
|
|
#ifndef HP_FP_ARG_DESCRIPTOR_REVERSED
|
| 5818 |
|
|
arg_regs[(regno - 34) / 2] = "FR";
|
| 5819 |
|
|
arg_regs[(regno - 34) / 2 + 1] = "FU";
|
| 5820 |
|
|
#else
|
| 5821 |
|
|
arg_regs[(regno - 34) / 2] = "FU";
|
| 5822 |
|
|
arg_regs[(regno - 34) / 2 + 1] = "FR";
|
| 5823 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 5824 |
|
|
}
|
| 5825 |
|
|
}
|
| 5826 |
|
|
}
|
| 5827 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.CALL ", asm_out_file);
|
| 5828 |
|
|
for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
|
| 5829 |
|
|
{
|
| 5830 |
|
|
if (arg_regs[i])
|
| 5831 |
|
|
{
|
| 5832 |
|
|
if (output_flag++)
|
| 5833 |
|
|
fputc (',', asm_out_file);
|
| 5834 |
|
|
fprintf (asm_out_file, "ARGW%d=%s", i, arg_regs[i]);
|
| 5835 |
|
|
}
|
| 5836 |
|
|
}
|
| 5837 |
|
|
fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
|
| 5838 |
|
|
}
|
| 5839 |
|
|
|
| 5840 |
|
|
/* Inform reload about cases where moving X with a mode MODE to a register in
|
| 5841 |
|
|
RCLASS requires an extra scratch or immediate register. Return the class
|
| 5842 |
|
|
needed for the immediate register. */
|
| 5843 |
|
|
|
| 5844 |
|
|
static reg_class_t
|
| 5845 |
|
|
pa_secondary_reload (bool in_p, rtx x, reg_class_t rclass_i,
|
| 5846 |
|
|
enum machine_mode mode, secondary_reload_info *sri)
|
| 5847 |
|
|
{
|
| 5848 |
|
|
int regno;
|
| 5849 |
|
|
enum reg_class rclass = (enum reg_class) rclass_i;
|
| 5850 |
|
|
|
| 5851 |
|
|
/* Handle the easy stuff first. */
|
| 5852 |
|
|
if (rclass == R1_REGS)
|
| 5853 |
|
|
return NO_REGS;
|
| 5854 |
|
|
|
| 5855 |
|
|
if (REG_P (x))
|
| 5856 |
|
|
{
|
| 5857 |
|
|
regno = REGNO (x);
|
| 5858 |
|
|
if (rclass == BASE_REG_CLASS && regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
| 5859 |
|
|
return NO_REGS;
|
| 5860 |
|
|
}
|
| 5861 |
|
|
else
|
| 5862 |
|
|
regno = -1;
|
| 5863 |
|
|
|
| 5864 |
|
|
/* If we have something like (mem (mem (...)), we can safely assume the
|
| 5865 |
|
|
inner MEM will end up in a general register after reloading, so there's
|
| 5866 |
|
|
no need for a secondary reload. */
|
| 5867 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM)
|
| 5868 |
|
|
return NO_REGS;
|
| 5869 |
|
|
|
| 5870 |
|
|
/* Trying to load a constant into a FP register during PIC code
|
| 5871 |
|
|
generation requires %r1 as a scratch register. */
|
| 5872 |
|
|
if (flag_pic
|
| 5873 |
|
|
&& (mode == SImode || mode == DImode)
|
| 5874 |
|
|
&& FP_REG_CLASS_P (rclass)
|
| 5875 |
|
|
&& (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE))
|
| 5876 |
|
|
{
|
| 5877 |
|
|
sri->icode = (mode == SImode ? CODE_FOR_reload_insi_r1
|
| 5878 |
|
|
: CODE_FOR_reload_indi_r1);
|
| 5879 |
|
|
return NO_REGS;
|
| 5880 |
|
|
}
|
| 5881 |
|
|
|
| 5882 |
|
|
/* Secondary reloads of symbolic operands require %r1 as a scratch
|
| 5883 |
|
|
register when we're generating PIC code and when the operand isn't
|
| 5884 |
|
|
readonly. */
|
| 5885 |
|
|
if (pa_symbolic_expression_p (x))
|
| 5886 |
|
|
{
|
| 5887 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == HIGH)
|
| 5888 |
|
|
x = XEXP (x, 0);
|
| 5889 |
|
|
|
| 5890 |
|
|
if (flag_pic || !read_only_operand (x, VOIDmode))
|
| 5891 |
|
|
{
|
| 5892 |
|
|
gcc_assert (mode == SImode || mode == DImode);
|
| 5893 |
|
|
sri->icode = (mode == SImode ? CODE_FOR_reload_insi_r1
|
| 5894 |
|
|
: CODE_FOR_reload_indi_r1);
|
| 5895 |
|
|
return NO_REGS;
|
| 5896 |
|
|
}
|
| 5897 |
|
|
}
|
| 5898 |
|
|
|
| 5899 |
|
|
/* Profiling showed the PA port spends about 1.3% of its compilation
|
| 5900 |
|
|
time in true_regnum from calls inside pa_secondary_reload_class. */
|
| 5901 |
|
|
if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
|
| 5902 |
|
|
regno = true_regnum (x);
|
| 5903 |
|
|
|
| 5904 |
|
|
/* In order to allow 14-bit displacements in integer loads and stores,
|
| 5905 |
|
|
we need to prevent reload from generating out of range integer mode
|
| 5906 |
|
|
loads and stores to the floating point registers. Previously, we
|
| 5907 |
|
|
used to call for a secondary reload and have pa_emit_move_sequence()
|
| 5908 |
|
|
fix the instruction sequence. However, reload occasionally wouldn't
|
| 5909 |
|
|
generate the reload and we would end up with an invalid REG+D memory
|
| 5910 |
|
|
address. So, now we use an intermediate general register for most
|
| 5911 |
|
|
memory loads and stores. */
|
| 5912 |
|
|
if ((regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || regno == -1)
|
| 5913 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
| 5914 |
|
|
&& FP_REG_CLASS_P (rclass))
|
| 5915 |
|
|
{
|
| 5916 |
|
|
/* Reload passes (mem:SI (reg/f:DI 30 %r30) when it wants to check
|
| 5917 |
|
|
the secondary reload needed for a pseudo. It never passes a
|
| 5918 |
|
|
REG+D address. */
|
| 5919 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
|
| 5920 |
|
|
{
|
| 5921 |
|
|
x = XEXP (x, 0);
|
| 5922 |
|
|
|
| 5923 |
|
|
/* We don't need an intermediate for indexed and LO_SUM DLT
|
| 5924 |
|
|
memory addresses. When INT14_OK_STRICT is true, it might
|
| 5925 |
|
|
appear that we could directly allow register indirect
|
| 5926 |
|
|
memory addresses. However, this doesn't work because we
|
| 5927 |
|
|
don't support SUBREGs in floating-point register copies
|
| 5928 |
|
|
and reload doesn't tell us when it's going to use a SUBREG. */
|
| 5929 |
|
|
if (IS_INDEX_ADDR_P (x)
|
| 5930 |
|
|
|| IS_LO_SUM_DLT_ADDR_P (x))
|
| 5931 |
|
|
return NO_REGS;
|
| 5932 |
|
|
|
| 5933 |
|
|
/* Otherwise, we need an intermediate general register. */
|
| 5934 |
|
|
return GENERAL_REGS;
|
| 5935 |
|
|
}
|
| 5936 |
|
|
|
| 5937 |
|
|
/* Request a secondary reload with a general scratch register
|
| 5938 |
|
|
for everthing else. ??? Could symbolic operands be handled
|
| 5939 |
|
|
directly when generating non-pic PA 2.0 code? */
|
| 5940 |
|
|
sri->icode = (in_p
|
| 5941 |
|
|
? direct_optab_handler (reload_in_optab, mode)
|
| 5942 |
|
|
: direct_optab_handler (reload_out_optab, mode));
|
| 5943 |
|
|
return NO_REGS;
|
| 5944 |
|
|
}
|
| 5945 |
|
|
|
| 5946 |
|
|
/* A SAR<->FP register copy requires an intermediate general register
|
| 5947 |
|
|
and secondary memory. We need a secondary reload with a general
|
| 5948 |
|
|
scratch register for spills. */
|
| 5949 |
|
|
if (rclass == SHIFT_REGS)
|
| 5950 |
|
|
{
|
| 5951 |
|
|
/* Handle spill. */
|
| 5952 |
|
|
if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || regno < 0)
|
| 5953 |
|
|
{
|
| 5954 |
|
|
sri->icode = (in_p
|
| 5955 |
|
|
? direct_optab_handler (reload_in_optab, mode)
|
| 5956 |
|
|
: direct_optab_handler (reload_out_optab, mode));
|
| 5957 |
|
|
return NO_REGS;
|
| 5958 |
|
|
}
|
| 5959 |
|
|
|
| 5960 |
|
|
/* Handle FP copy. */
|
| 5961 |
|
|
if (FP_REG_CLASS_P (REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno)))
|
| 5962 |
|
|
return GENERAL_REGS;
|
| 5963 |
|
|
}
|
| 5964 |
|
|
|
| 5965 |
|
|
if (regno >= 0 && regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
| 5966 |
|
|
&& REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno) == SHIFT_REGS
|
| 5967 |
|
|
&& FP_REG_CLASS_P (rclass))
|
| 5968 |
|
|
return GENERAL_REGS;
|
| 5969 |
|
|
|
| 5970 |
|
|
return NO_REGS;
|
| 5971 |
|
|
}
|
| 5972 |
|
|
|
| 5973 |
|
|
/* Implement TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY. The argument pointer
|
| 5974 |
|
|
is only marked as live on entry by df-scan when it is a fixed
|
| 5975 |
|
|
register. It isn't a fixed register in the 64-bit runtime,
|
| 5976 |
|
|
so we need to mark it here. */
|
| 5977 |
|
|
|
| 5978 |
|
|
static void
|
| 5979 |
|
|
pa_extra_live_on_entry (bitmap regs)
|
| 5980 |
|
|
{
|
| 5981 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 5982 |
|
|
bitmap_set_bit (regs, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
| 5983 |
|
|
}
|
| 5984 |
|
|
|
| 5985 |
|
|
/* Implement EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX. The MEM needs to be volatile
|
| 5986 |
|
|
to prevent it from being deleted. */
|
| 5987 |
|
|
|
| 5988 |
|
|
rtx
|
| 5989 |
|
|
pa_eh_return_handler_rtx (void)
|
| 5990 |
|
|
{
|
| 5991 |
|
|
rtx tmp;
|
| 5992 |
|
|
|
| 5993 |
|
|
tmp = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
|
| 5994 |
|
|
TARGET_64BIT ? GEN_INT (-16) : GEN_INT (-20));
|
| 5995 |
|
|
tmp = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, tmp);
|
| 5996 |
|
|
tmp->volatil = 1;
|
| 5997 |
|
|
return tmp;
|
| 5998 |
|
|
}
|
| 5999 |
|
|
|
| 6000 |
|
|
/* In the 32-bit runtime, arguments larger than eight bytes are passed
|
| 6001 |
|
|
by invisible reference. As a GCC extension, we also pass anything
|
| 6002 |
|
|
with a zero or variable size by reference.
|
| 6003 |
|
|
|
| 6004 |
|
|
The 64-bit runtime does not describe passing any types by invisible
|
| 6005 |
|
|
reference. The internals of GCC can't currently handle passing
|
| 6006 |
|
|
empty structures, and zero or variable length arrays when they are
|
| 6007 |
|
|
not passed entirely on the stack or by reference. Thus, as a GCC
|
| 6008 |
|
|
extension, we pass these types by reference. The HP compiler doesn't
|
| 6009 |
|
|
support these types, so hopefully there shouldn't be any compatibility
|
| 6010 |
|
|
issues. This may have to be revisited when HP releases a C99 compiler
|
| 6011 |
|
|
or updates the ABI. */
|
| 6012 |
|
|
|
| 6013 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 6014 |
|
|
pa_pass_by_reference (cumulative_args_t ca ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 6015 |
|
|
enum machine_mode mode, const_tree type,
|
| 6016 |
|
|
bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 6017 |
|
|
{
|
| 6018 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size;
|
| 6019 |
|
|
|
| 6020 |
|
|
if (type)
|
| 6021 |
|
|
size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
|
| 6022 |
|
|
else
|
| 6023 |
|
|
size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
| 6024 |
|
|
|
| 6025 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 6026 |
|
|
return size <= 0;
|
| 6027 |
|
|
else
|
| 6028 |
|
|
return size <= 0 || size > 8;
|
| 6029 |
|
|
}
|
| 6030 |
|
|
|
| 6031 |
|
|
enum direction
|
| 6032 |
|
|
pa_function_arg_padding (enum machine_mode mode, const_tree type)
|
| 6033 |
|
|
{
|
| 6034 |
|
|
if (mode == BLKmode
|
| 6035 |
|
|
|| (TARGET_64BIT
|
| 6036 |
|
|
&& type
|
| 6037 |
|
|
&& (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
|
| 6038 |
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE
|
| 6039 |
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)))
|
| 6040 |
|
|
{
|
| 6041 |
|
|
/* Return none if justification is not required. */
|
| 6042 |
|
|
if (type
|
| 6043 |
|
|
&& TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST
|
| 6044 |
|
|
&& (int_size_in_bytes (type) * BITS_PER_UNIT) % PARM_BOUNDARY == 0)
|
| 6045 |
|
|
return none;
|
| 6046 |
|
|
|
| 6047 |
|
|
/* The directions set here are ignored when a BLKmode argument larger
|
| 6048 |
|
|
than a word is placed in a register. Different code is used for
|
| 6049 |
|
|
the stack and registers. This makes it difficult to have a
|
| 6050 |
|
|
consistent data representation for both the stack and registers.
|
| 6051 |
|
|
For both runtimes, the justification and padding for arguments on
|
| 6052 |
|
|
the stack and in registers should be identical. */
|
| 6053 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 6054 |
|
|
/* The 64-bit runtime specifies left justification for aggregates. */
|
| 6055 |
|
|
return upward;
|
| 6056 |
|
|
else
|
| 6057 |
|
|
/* The 32-bit runtime architecture specifies right justification.
|
| 6058 |
|
|
When the argument is passed on the stack, the argument is padded
|
| 6059 |
|
|
with garbage on the left. The HP compiler pads with zeros. */
|
| 6060 |
|
|
return downward;
|
| 6061 |
|
|
}
|
| 6062 |
|
|
|
| 6063 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < PARM_BOUNDARY)
|
| 6064 |
|
|
return downward;
|
| 6065 |
|
|
else
|
| 6066 |
|
|
return none;
|
| 6067 |
|
|
}
|
| 6068 |
|
|
|
| 6069 |
|
|
|
| 6070 |
|
|
/* Do what is necessary for `va_start'. We look at the current function
|
| 6071 |
|
|
to determine if stdargs or varargs is used and fill in an initial
|
| 6072 |
|
|
va_list. A pointer to this constructor is returned. */
|
| 6073 |
|
|
|
| 6074 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 6075 |
|
|
hppa_builtin_saveregs (void)
|
| 6076 |
|
|
{
|
| 6077 |
|
|
rtx offset, dest;
|
| 6078 |
|
|
tree fntype = TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl);
|
| 6079 |
|
|
int argadj = ((!stdarg_p (fntype))
|
| 6080 |
|
|
? UNITS_PER_WORD : 0);
|
| 6081 |
|
|
|
| 6082 |
|
|
if (argadj)
|
| 6083 |
|
|
offset = plus_constant (crtl->args.arg_offset_rtx, argadj);
|
| 6084 |
|
|
else
|
| 6085 |
|
|
offset = crtl->args.arg_offset_rtx;
|
| 6086 |
|
|
|
| 6087 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 6088 |
|
|
{
|
| 6089 |
|
|
int i, off;
|
| 6090 |
|
|
|
| 6091 |
|
|
/* Adjust for varargs/stdarg differences. */
|
| 6092 |
|
|
if (argadj)
|
| 6093 |
|
|
offset = plus_constant (crtl->args.arg_offset_rtx, -argadj);
|
| 6094 |
|
|
else
|
| 6095 |
|
|
offset = crtl->args.arg_offset_rtx;
|
| 6096 |
|
|
|
| 6097 |
|
|
/* We need to save %r26 .. %r19 inclusive starting at offset -64
|
| 6098 |
|
|
from the incoming arg pointer and growing to larger addresses. */
|
| 6099 |
|
|
for (i = 26, off = -64; i >= 19; i--, off += 8)
|
| 6100 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode,
|
| 6101 |
|
|
plus_constant (arg_pointer_rtx, off)),
|
| 6102 |
|
|
gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, i));
|
| 6103 |
|
|
|
| 6104 |
|
|
/* The incoming args pointer points just beyond the flushback area;
|
| 6105 |
|
|
normally this is not a serious concern. However, when we are doing
|
| 6106 |
|
|
varargs/stdargs we want to make the arg pointer point to the start
|
| 6107 |
|
|
of the incoming argument area. */
|
| 6108 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
|
| 6109 |
|
|
plus_constant (arg_pointer_rtx, -64));
|
| 6110 |
|
|
|
| 6111 |
|
|
/* Now return a pointer to the first anonymous argument. */
|
| 6112 |
|
|
return copy_to_reg (expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab,
|
| 6113 |
|
|
virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
|
| 6114 |
|
|
offset, 0, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
|
| 6115 |
|
|
}
|
| 6116 |
|
|
|
| 6117 |
|
|
/* Store general registers on the stack. */
|
| 6118 |
|
|
dest = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode,
|
| 6119 |
|
|
plus_constant (crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer,
|
| 6120 |
|
|
-16));
|
| 6121 |
|
|
set_mem_alias_set (dest, get_varargs_alias_set ());
|
| 6122 |
|
|
set_mem_align (dest, BITS_PER_WORD);
|
| 6123 |
|
|
move_block_from_reg (23, dest, 4);
|
| 6124 |
|
|
|
| 6125 |
|
|
/* move_block_from_reg will emit code to store the argument registers
|
| 6126 |
|
|
individually as scalar stores.
|
| 6127 |
|
|
|
| 6128 |
|
|
However, other insns may later load from the same addresses for
|
| 6129 |
|
|
a structure load (passing a struct to a varargs routine).
|
| 6130 |
|
|
|
| 6131 |
|
|
The alias code assumes that such aliasing can never happen, so we
|
| 6132 |
|
|
have to keep memory referencing insns from moving up beyond the
|
| 6133 |
|
|
last argument register store. So we emit a blockage insn here. */
|
| 6134 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
|
| 6135 |
|
|
|
| 6136 |
|
|
return copy_to_reg (expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab,
|
| 6137 |
|
|
crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer,
|
| 6138 |
|
|
offset, 0, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
|
| 6139 |
|
|
}
|
| 6140 |
|
|
|
| 6141 |
|
|
static void
|
| 6142 |
|
|
hppa_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg)
|
| 6143 |
|
|
{
|
| 6144 |
|
|
nextarg = expand_builtin_saveregs ();
|
| 6145 |
|
|
std_expand_builtin_va_start (valist, nextarg);
|
| 6146 |
|
|
}
|
| 6147 |
|
|
|
| 6148 |
|
|
static tree
|
| 6149 |
|
|
hppa_gimplify_va_arg_expr (tree valist, tree type, gimple_seq *pre_p,
|
| 6150 |
|
|
gimple_seq *post_p)
|
| 6151 |
|
|
{
|
| 6152 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 6153 |
|
|
{
|
| 6154 |
|
|
/* Args grow upward. We can use the generic routines. */
|
| 6155 |
|
|
return std_gimplify_va_arg_expr (valist, type, pre_p, post_p);
|
| 6156 |
|
|
}
|
| 6157 |
|
|
else /* !TARGET_64BIT */
|
| 6158 |
|
|
{
|
| 6159 |
|
|
tree ptr = build_pointer_type (type);
|
| 6160 |
|
|
tree valist_type;
|
| 6161 |
|
|
tree t, u;
|
| 6162 |
|
|
unsigned int size, ofs;
|
| 6163 |
|
|
bool indirect;
|
| 6164 |
|
|
|
| 6165 |
|
|
indirect = pass_by_reference (NULL, TYPE_MODE (type), type, 0);
|
| 6166 |
|
|
if (indirect)
|
| 6167 |
|
|
{
|
| 6168 |
|
|
type = ptr;
|
| 6169 |
|
|
ptr = build_pointer_type (type);
|
| 6170 |
|
|
}
|
| 6171 |
|
|
size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
|
| 6172 |
|
|
valist_type = TREE_TYPE (valist);
|
| 6173 |
|
|
|
| 6174 |
|
|
/* Args grow down. Not handled by generic routines. */
|
| 6175 |
|
|
|
| 6176 |
|
|
u = fold_convert (sizetype, size_in_bytes (type));
|
| 6177 |
|
|
u = fold_build1 (NEGATE_EXPR, sizetype, u);
|
| 6178 |
|
|
t = fold_build_pointer_plus (valist, u);
|
| 6179 |
|
|
|
| 6180 |
|
|
/* Align to 4 or 8 byte boundary depending on argument size. */
|
| 6181 |
|
|
|
| 6182 |
|
|
u = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (t), (HOST_WIDE_INT)(size > 4 ? -8 : -4));
|
| 6183 |
|
|
t = build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (t), t, u);
|
| 6184 |
|
|
t = fold_convert (valist_type, t);
|
| 6185 |
|
|
|
| 6186 |
|
|
t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, valist_type, valist, t);
|
| 6187 |
|
|
|
| 6188 |
|
|
ofs = (8 - size) % 4;
|
| 6189 |
|
|
if (ofs != 0)
|
| 6190 |
|
|
t = fold_build_pointer_plus_hwi (t, ofs);
|
| 6191 |
|
|
|
| 6192 |
|
|
t = fold_convert (ptr, t);
|
| 6193 |
|
|
t = build_va_arg_indirect_ref (t);
|
| 6194 |
|
|
|
| 6195 |
|
|
if (indirect)
|
| 6196 |
|
|
t = build_va_arg_indirect_ref (t);
|
| 6197 |
|
|
|
| 6198 |
|
|
return t;
|
| 6199 |
|
|
}
|
| 6200 |
|
|
}
|
| 6201 |
|
|
|
| 6202 |
|
|
/* True if MODE is valid for the target. By "valid", we mean able to
|
| 6203 |
|
|
be manipulated in non-trivial ways. In particular, this means all
|
| 6204 |
|
|
the arithmetic is supported.
|
| 6205 |
|
|
|
| 6206 |
|
|
Currently, TImode is not valid as the HP 64-bit runtime documentation
|
| 6207 |
|
|
doesn't document the alignment and calling conventions for this type.
|
| 6208 |
|
|
Thus, we return false when PRECISION is 2 * BITS_PER_WORD and
|
| 6209 |
|
|
2 * BITS_PER_WORD isn't equal LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE. */
|
| 6210 |
|
|
|
| 6211 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 6212 |
|
|
pa_scalar_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode mode)
|
| 6213 |
|
|
{
|
| 6214 |
|
|
int precision = GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode);
|
| 6215 |
|
|
|
| 6216 |
|
|
switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
|
| 6217 |
|
|
{
|
| 6218 |
|
|
case MODE_PARTIAL_INT:
|
| 6219 |
|
|
case MODE_INT:
|
| 6220 |
|
|
if (precision == CHAR_TYPE_SIZE)
|
| 6221 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 6222 |
|
|
if (precision == SHORT_TYPE_SIZE)
|
| 6223 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 6224 |
|
|
if (precision == INT_TYPE_SIZE)
|
| 6225 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 6226 |
|
|
if (precision == LONG_TYPE_SIZE)
|
| 6227 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 6228 |
|
|
if (precision == LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE)
|
| 6229 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 6230 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 6231 |
|
|
|
| 6232 |
|
|
case MODE_FLOAT:
|
| 6233 |
|
|
if (precision == FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE)
|
| 6234 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 6235 |
|
|
if (precision == DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE)
|
| 6236 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 6237 |
|
|
if (precision == LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE)
|
| 6238 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 6239 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 6240 |
|
|
|
| 6241 |
|
|
case MODE_DECIMAL_FLOAT:
|
| 6242 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 6243 |
|
|
|
| 6244 |
|
|
default:
|
| 6245 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 6246 |
|
|
}
|
| 6247 |
|
|
}
|
| 6248 |
|
|
|
| 6249 |
|
|
/* Return TRUE if INSN, a jump insn, has an unfilled delay slot and
|
| 6250 |
|
|
it branches into the delay slot. Otherwise, return FALSE. */
|
| 6251 |
|
|
|
| 6252 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 6253 |
|
|
branch_to_delay_slot_p (rtx insn)
|
| 6254 |
|
|
{
|
| 6255 |
|
|
rtx jump_insn;
|
| 6256 |
|
|
|
| 6257 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length ())
|
| 6258 |
|
|
return FALSE;
|
| 6259 |
|
|
|
| 6260 |
|
|
jump_insn = next_active_insn (JUMP_LABEL (insn));
|
| 6261 |
|
|
while (insn)
|
| 6262 |
|
|
{
|
| 6263 |
|
|
insn = next_active_insn (insn);
|
| 6264 |
|
|
if (jump_insn == insn)
|
| 6265 |
|
|
return TRUE;
|
| 6266 |
|
|
|
| 6267 |
|
|
/* We can't rely on the length of asms. So, we return FALSE when
|
| 6268 |
|
|
the branch is followed by an asm. */
|
| 6269 |
|
|
if (!insn
|
| 6270 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT
|
| 6271 |
|
|
|| extract_asm_operands (PATTERN (insn)) != NULL_RTX
|
| 6272 |
|
|
|| get_attr_length (insn) > 0)
|
| 6273 |
|
|
break;
|
| 6274 |
|
|
}
|
| 6275 |
|
|
|
| 6276 |
|
|
return FALSE;
|
| 6277 |
|
|
}
|
| 6278 |
|
|
|
| 6279 |
|
|
/* Return TRUE if INSN, a forward jump insn, needs a nop in its delay slot.
|
| 6280 |
|
|
|
| 6281 |
|
|
This occurs when INSN has an unfilled delay slot and is followed
|
| 6282 |
|
|
by an asm. Disaster can occur if the asm is empty and the jump
|
| 6283 |
|
|
branches into the delay slot. So, we add a nop in the delay slot
|
| 6284 |
|
|
when this occurs. */
|
| 6285 |
|
|
|
| 6286 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 6287 |
|
|
branch_needs_nop_p (rtx insn)
|
| 6288 |
|
|
{
|
| 6289 |
|
|
rtx jump_insn;
|
| 6290 |
|
|
|
| 6291 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length ())
|
| 6292 |
|
|
return FALSE;
|
| 6293 |
|
|
|
| 6294 |
|
|
jump_insn = next_active_insn (JUMP_LABEL (insn));
|
| 6295 |
|
|
while (insn)
|
| 6296 |
|
|
{
|
| 6297 |
|
|
insn = next_active_insn (insn);
|
| 6298 |
|
|
if (!insn || jump_insn == insn)
|
| 6299 |
|
|
return TRUE;
|
| 6300 |
|
|
|
| 6301 |
|
|
if (!(GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT
|
| 6302 |
|
|
|| extract_asm_operands (PATTERN (insn)) != NULL_RTX)
|
| 6303 |
|
|
&& get_attr_length (insn) > 0)
|
| 6304 |
|
|
break;
|
| 6305 |
|
|
}
|
| 6306 |
|
|
|
| 6307 |
|
|
return FALSE;
|
| 6308 |
|
|
}
|
| 6309 |
|
|
|
| 6310 |
|
|
/* Return TRUE if INSN, a forward jump insn, can use nullification
|
| 6311 |
|
|
to skip the following instruction. This avoids an extra cycle due
|
| 6312 |
|
|
to a mis-predicted branch when we fall through. */
|
| 6313 |
|
|
|
| 6314 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 6315 |
|
|
use_skip_p (rtx insn)
|
| 6316 |
|
|
{
|
| 6317 |
|
|
rtx jump_insn = next_active_insn (JUMP_LABEL (insn));
|
| 6318 |
|
|
|
| 6319 |
|
|
while (insn)
|
| 6320 |
|
|
{
|
| 6321 |
|
|
insn = next_active_insn (insn);
|
| 6322 |
|
|
|
| 6323 |
|
|
/* We can't rely on the length of asms, so we can't skip asms. */
|
| 6324 |
|
|
if (!insn
|
| 6325 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT
|
| 6326 |
|
|
|| extract_asm_operands (PATTERN (insn)) != NULL_RTX)
|
| 6327 |
|
|
break;
|
| 6328 |
|
|
if (get_attr_length (insn) == 4
|
| 6329 |
|
|
&& jump_insn == next_active_insn (insn))
|
| 6330 |
|
|
return TRUE;
|
| 6331 |
|
|
if (get_attr_length (insn) > 0)
|
| 6332 |
|
|
break;
|
| 6333 |
|
|
}
|
| 6334 |
|
|
|
| 6335 |
|
|
return FALSE;
|
| 6336 |
|
|
}
|
| 6337 |
|
|
|
| 6338 |
|
|
/* This routine handles all the normal conditional branch sequences we
|
| 6339 |
|
|
might need to generate. It handles compare immediate vs compare
|
| 6340 |
|
|
register, nullification of delay slots, varying length branches,
|
| 6341 |
|
|
negated branches, and all combinations of the above. It returns the
|
| 6342 |
|
|
output appropriate to emit the branch corresponding to all given
|
| 6343 |
|
|
parameters. */
|
| 6344 |
|
|
|
| 6345 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 6346 |
|
|
pa_output_cbranch (rtx *operands, int negated, rtx insn)
|
| 6347 |
|
|
{
|
| 6348 |
|
|
static char buf[100];
|
| 6349 |
|
|
bool useskip;
|
| 6350 |
|
|
int nullify = INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (insn);
|
| 6351 |
|
|
int length = get_attr_length (insn);
|
| 6352 |
|
|
int xdelay;
|
| 6353 |
|
|
|
| 6354 |
|
|
/* A conditional branch to the following instruction (e.g. the delay slot)
|
| 6355 |
|
|
is asking for a disaster. This can happen when not optimizing and
|
| 6356 |
|
|
when jump optimization fails.
|
| 6357 |
|
|
|
| 6358 |
|
|
While it is usually safe to emit nothing, this can fail if the
|
| 6359 |
|
|
preceding instruction is a nullified branch with an empty delay
|
| 6360 |
|
|
slot and the same branch target as this branch. We could check
|
| 6361 |
|
|
for this but jump optimization should eliminate nop jumps. It
|
| 6362 |
|
|
is always safe to emit a nop. */
|
| 6363 |
|
|
if (branch_to_delay_slot_p (insn))
|
| 6364 |
|
|
return "nop";
|
| 6365 |
|
|
|
| 6366 |
|
|
/* The doubleword form of the cmpib instruction doesn't have the LEU
|
| 6367 |
|
|
and GTU conditions while the cmpb instruction does. Since we accept
|
| 6368 |
|
|
zero for cmpb, we must ensure that we use cmpb for the comparison. */
|
| 6369 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[1]) == DImode && operands[2] == const0_rtx)
|
| 6370 |
|
|
operands[2] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 0);
|
| 6371 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[2]) == DImode && operands[1] == const0_rtx)
|
| 6372 |
|
|
operands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 0);
|
| 6373 |
|
|
|
| 6374 |
|
|
/* If this is a long branch with its delay slot unfilled, set `nullify'
|
| 6375 |
|
|
as it can nullify the delay slot and save a nop. */
|
| 6376 |
|
|
if (length == 8 && dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 6377 |
|
|
nullify = 1;
|
| 6378 |
|
|
|
| 6379 |
|
|
/* If this is a short forward conditional branch which did not get
|
| 6380 |
|
|
its delay slot filled, the delay slot can still be nullified. */
|
| 6381 |
|
|
if (! nullify && length == 4 && dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 6382 |
|
|
nullify = forward_branch_p (insn);
|
| 6383 |
|
|
|
| 6384 |
|
|
/* A forward branch over a single nullified insn can be done with a
|
| 6385 |
|
|
comclr instruction. This avoids a single cycle penalty due to
|
| 6386 |
|
|
mis-predicted branch if we fall through (branch not taken). */
|
| 6387 |
|
|
useskip = (length == 4 && nullify) ? use_skip_p (insn) : FALSE;
|
| 6388 |
|
|
|
| 6389 |
|
|
switch (length)
|
| 6390 |
|
|
{
|
| 6391 |
|
|
/* All short conditional branches except backwards with an unfilled
|
| 6392 |
|
|
delay slot. */
|
| 6393 |
|
|
case 4:
|
| 6394 |
|
|
if (useskip)
|
| 6395 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{com%I2clr,|cmp%I2clr,}");
|
| 6396 |
|
|
else
|
| 6397 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{com%I2b,|cmp%I2b,}");
|
| 6398 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[1]) == DImode)
|
| 6399 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "*");
|
| 6400 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6401 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "%B3");
|
| 6402 |
|
|
else
|
| 6403 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "%S3");
|
| 6404 |
|
|
if (useskip)
|
| 6405 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %2,%r1,%%r0");
|
| 6406 |
|
|
else if (nullify)
|
| 6407 |
|
|
{
|
| 6408 |
|
|
if (branch_needs_nop_p (insn))
|
| 6409 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n %2,%r1,%0%#");
|
| 6410 |
|
|
else
|
| 6411 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n %2,%r1,%0");
|
| 6412 |
|
|
}
|
| 6413 |
|
|
else
|
| 6414 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %2,%r1,%0");
|
| 6415 |
|
|
break;
|
| 6416 |
|
|
|
| 6417 |
|
|
/* All long conditionals. Note a short backward branch with an
|
| 6418 |
|
|
unfilled delay slot is treated just like a long backward branch
|
| 6419 |
|
|
with an unfilled delay slot. */
|
| 6420 |
|
|
case 8:
|
| 6421 |
|
|
/* Handle weird backwards branch with a filled delay slot
|
| 6422 |
|
|
which is nullified. */
|
| 6423 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () != 0
|
| 6424 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn)
|
| 6425 |
|
|
&& nullify)
|
| 6426 |
|
|
{
|
| 6427 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{com%I2b,|cmp%I2b,}");
|
| 6428 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[1]) == DImode)
|
| 6429 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "*");
|
| 6430 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6431 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "%S3");
|
| 6432 |
|
|
else
|
| 6433 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "%B3");
|
| 6434 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n %2,%r1,.+12\n\tb %0");
|
| 6435 |
|
|
}
|
| 6436 |
|
|
/* Handle short backwards branch with an unfilled delay slot.
|
| 6437 |
|
|
Using a comb;nop rather than comiclr;bl saves 1 cycle for both
|
| 6438 |
|
|
taken and untaken branches. */
|
| 6439 |
|
|
else if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0
|
| 6440 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn)
|
| 6441 |
|
|
&& INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ()
|
| 6442 |
|
|
&& VAL_14_BITS_P (INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (JUMP_LABEL (insn)))
|
| 6443 |
|
|
- INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)) - 8))
|
| 6444 |
|
|
{
|
| 6445 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{com%I2b,|cmp%I2b,}");
|
| 6446 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[1]) == DImode)
|
| 6447 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "*");
|
| 6448 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6449 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "%B3 %2,%r1,%0%#");
|
| 6450 |
|
|
else
|
| 6451 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "%S3 %2,%r1,%0%#");
|
| 6452 |
|
|
}
|
| 6453 |
|
|
else
|
| 6454 |
|
|
{
|
| 6455 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{com%I2clr,|cmp%I2clr,}");
|
| 6456 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[1]) == DImode)
|
| 6457 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "*");
|
| 6458 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6459 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "%S3");
|
| 6460 |
|
|
else
|
| 6461 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "%B3");
|
| 6462 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 6463 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %2,%r1,%%r0\n\tb,n %0");
|
| 6464 |
|
|
else
|
| 6465 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %2,%r1,%%r0\n\tb %0");
|
| 6466 |
|
|
}
|
| 6467 |
|
|
break;
|
| 6468 |
|
|
|
| 6469 |
|
|
default:
|
| 6470 |
|
|
/* The reversed conditional branch must branch over one additional
|
| 6471 |
|
|
instruction if the delay slot is filled and needs to be extracted
|
| 6472 |
|
|
by pa_output_lbranch. If the delay slot is empty or this is a
|
| 6473 |
|
|
nullified forward branch, the instruction after the reversed
|
| 6474 |
|
|
condition branch must be nullified. */
|
| 6475 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0
|
| 6476 |
|
|
|| (nullify && forward_branch_p (insn)))
|
| 6477 |
|
|
{
|
| 6478 |
|
|
nullify = 1;
|
| 6479 |
|
|
xdelay = 0;
|
| 6480 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length);
|
| 6481 |
|
|
}
|
| 6482 |
|
|
else
|
| 6483 |
|
|
{
|
| 6484 |
|
|
xdelay = 1;
|
| 6485 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length + 4);
|
| 6486 |
|
|
}
|
| 6487 |
|
|
|
| 6488 |
|
|
/* Create a reversed conditional branch which branches around
|
| 6489 |
|
|
the following insns. */
|
| 6490 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[1]) != DImode)
|
| 6491 |
|
|
{
|
| 6492 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 6493 |
|
|
{
|
| 6494 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6495 |
|
|
strcpy (buf,
|
| 6496 |
|
|
"{com%I2b,%S3,n %2,%r1,.+%4|cmp%I2b,%S3,n %2,%r1,.+%4}");
|
| 6497 |
|
|
else
|
| 6498 |
|
|
strcpy (buf,
|
| 6499 |
|
|
"{com%I2b,%B3,n %2,%r1,.+%4|cmp%I2b,%B3,n %2,%r1,.+%4}");
|
| 6500 |
|
|
}
|
| 6501 |
|
|
else
|
| 6502 |
|
|
{
|
| 6503 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6504 |
|
|
strcpy (buf,
|
| 6505 |
|
|
"{com%I2b,%S3 %2,%r1,.+%4|cmp%I2b,%S3 %2,%r1,.+%4}");
|
| 6506 |
|
|
else
|
| 6507 |
|
|
strcpy (buf,
|
| 6508 |
|
|
"{com%I2b,%B3 %2,%r1,.+%4|cmp%I2b,%B3 %2,%r1,.+%4}");
|
| 6509 |
|
|
}
|
| 6510 |
|
|
}
|
| 6511 |
|
|
else
|
| 6512 |
|
|
{
|
| 6513 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 6514 |
|
|
{
|
| 6515 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6516 |
|
|
strcpy (buf,
|
| 6517 |
|
|
"{com%I2b,*%S3,n %2,%r1,.+%4|cmp%I2b,*%S3,n %2,%r1,.+%4}");
|
| 6518 |
|
|
else
|
| 6519 |
|
|
strcpy (buf,
|
| 6520 |
|
|
"{com%I2b,*%B3,n %2,%r1,.+%4|cmp%I2b,*%B3,n %2,%r1,.+%4}");
|
| 6521 |
|
|
}
|
| 6522 |
|
|
else
|
| 6523 |
|
|
{
|
| 6524 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6525 |
|
|
strcpy (buf,
|
| 6526 |
|
|
"{com%I2b,*%S3 %2,%r1,.+%4|cmp%I2b,*%S3 %2,%r1,.+%4}");
|
| 6527 |
|
|
else
|
| 6528 |
|
|
strcpy (buf,
|
| 6529 |
|
|
"{com%I2b,*%B3 %2,%r1,.+%4|cmp%I2b,*%B3 %2,%r1,.+%4}");
|
| 6530 |
|
|
}
|
| 6531 |
|
|
}
|
| 6532 |
|
|
|
| 6533 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (buf, operands);
|
| 6534 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (operands[0], insn, xdelay);
|
| 6535 |
|
|
}
|
| 6536 |
|
|
return buf;
|
| 6537 |
|
|
}
|
| 6538 |
|
|
|
| 6539 |
|
|
/* This routine handles output of long unconditional branches that
|
| 6540 |
|
|
exceed the maximum range of a simple branch instruction. Since
|
| 6541 |
|
|
we don't have a register available for the branch, we save register
|
| 6542 |
|
|
%r1 in the frame marker, load the branch destination DEST into %r1,
|
| 6543 |
|
|
execute the branch, and restore %r1 in the delay slot of the branch.
|
| 6544 |
|
|
|
| 6545 |
|
|
Since long branches may have an insn in the delay slot and the
|
| 6546 |
|
|
delay slot is used to restore %r1, we in general need to extract
|
| 6547 |
|
|
this insn and execute it before the branch. However, to facilitate
|
| 6548 |
|
|
use of this function by conditional branches, we also provide an
|
| 6549 |
|
|
option to not extract the delay insn so that it will be emitted
|
| 6550 |
|
|
after the long branch. So, if there is an insn in the delay slot,
|
| 6551 |
|
|
it is extracted if XDELAY is nonzero.
|
| 6552 |
|
|
|
| 6553 |
|
|
The lengths of the various long-branch sequences are 20, 16 and 24
|
| 6554 |
|
|
bytes for the portable runtime, non-PIC and PIC cases, respectively. */
|
| 6555 |
|
|
|
| 6556 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 6557 |
|
|
pa_output_lbranch (rtx dest, rtx insn, int xdelay)
|
| 6558 |
|
|
{
|
| 6559 |
|
|
rtx xoperands[2];
|
| 6560 |
|
|
|
| 6561 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = dest;
|
| 6562 |
|
|
|
| 6563 |
|
|
/* First, free up the delay slot. */
|
| 6564 |
|
|
if (xdelay && dbr_sequence_length () != 0)
|
| 6565 |
|
|
{
|
| 6566 |
|
|
/* We can't handle a jump in the delay slot. */
|
| 6567 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (insn)) != JUMP_INSN);
|
| 6568 |
|
|
|
| 6569 |
|
|
final_scan_insn (NEXT_INSN (insn), asm_out_file,
|
| 6570 |
|
|
optimize, 0, NULL);
|
| 6571 |
|
|
|
| 6572 |
|
|
/* Now delete the delay insn. */
|
| 6573 |
|
|
SET_INSN_DELETED (NEXT_INSN (insn));
|
| 6574 |
|
|
}
|
| 6575 |
|
|
|
| 6576 |
|
|
/* Output an insn to save %r1. The runtime documentation doesn't
|
| 6577 |
|
|
specify whether the "Clean Up" slot in the callers frame can
|
| 6578 |
|
|
be clobbered by the callee. It isn't copied by HP's builtin
|
| 6579 |
|
|
alloca, so this suggests that it can be clobbered if necessary.
|
| 6580 |
|
|
The "Static Link" location is copied by HP builtin alloca, so
|
| 6581 |
|
|
we avoid using it. Using the cleanup slot might be a problem
|
| 6582 |
|
|
if we have to interoperate with languages that pass cleanup
|
| 6583 |
|
|
information. However, it should be possible to handle these
|
| 6584 |
|
|
situations with GCC's asm feature.
|
| 6585 |
|
|
|
| 6586 |
|
|
The "Current RP" slot is reserved for the called procedure, so
|
| 6587 |
|
|
we try to use it when we don't have a frame of our own. It's
|
| 6588 |
|
|
rather unlikely that we won't have a frame when we need to emit
|
| 6589 |
|
|
a very long branch.
|
| 6590 |
|
|
|
| 6591 |
|
|
Really the way to go long term is a register scavenger; goto
|
| 6592 |
|
|
the target of the jump and find a register which we can use
|
| 6593 |
|
|
as a scratch to hold the value in %r1. Then, we wouldn't have
|
| 6594 |
|
|
to free up the delay slot or clobber a slot that may be needed
|
| 6595 |
|
|
for other purposes. */
|
| 6596 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 6597 |
|
|
{
|
| 6598 |
|
|
if (actual_fsize == 0 && !df_regs_ever_live_p (2))
|
| 6599 |
|
|
/* Use the return pointer slot in the frame marker. */
|
| 6600 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("std %%r1,-16(%%r30)", xoperands);
|
| 6601 |
|
|
else
|
| 6602 |
|
|
/* Use the slot at -40 in the frame marker since HP builtin
|
| 6603 |
|
|
alloca doesn't copy it. */
|
| 6604 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("std %%r1,-40(%%r30)", xoperands);
|
| 6605 |
|
|
}
|
| 6606 |
|
|
else
|
| 6607 |
|
|
{
|
| 6608 |
|
|
if (actual_fsize == 0 && !df_regs_ever_live_p (2))
|
| 6609 |
|
|
/* Use the return pointer slot in the frame marker. */
|
| 6610 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stw %%r1,-20(%%r30)", xoperands);
|
| 6611 |
|
|
else
|
| 6612 |
|
|
/* Use the "Clean Up" slot in the frame marker. In GCC,
|
| 6613 |
|
|
the only other use of this location is for copying a
|
| 6614 |
|
|
floating point double argument from a floating-point
|
| 6615 |
|
|
register to two general registers. The copy is done
|
| 6616 |
|
|
as an "atomic" operation when outputting a call, so it
|
| 6617 |
|
|
won't interfere with our using the location here. */
|
| 6618 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stw %%r1,-12(%%r30)", xoperands);
|
| 6619 |
|
|
}
|
| 6620 |
|
|
|
| 6621 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME)
|
| 6622 |
|
|
{
|
| 6623 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldil L'%0,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 6624 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 6625 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bv %%r0(%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 6626 |
|
|
}
|
| 6627 |
|
|
else if (flag_pic)
|
| 6628 |
|
|
{
|
| 6629 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{bl|b,l} .+8,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 6630 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOM || !TARGET_GAS)
|
| 6631 |
|
|
{
|
| 6632 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 6633 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%l0-%l1,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 6634 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "L",
|
| 6635 |
|
|
CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (xoperands[1]));
|
| 6636 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%l0-%l1(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 6637 |
|
|
}
|
| 6638 |
|
|
else
|
| 6639 |
|
|
{
|
| 6640 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%l0-$PIC_pcrel$0+4,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 6641 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%l0-$PIC_pcrel$0+8(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 6642 |
|
|
}
|
| 6643 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bv %%r0(%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 6644 |
|
|
}
|
| 6645 |
|
|
else
|
| 6646 |
|
|
/* Now output a very long branch to the original target. */
|
| 6647 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldil L'%l0,%%r1\n\tbe R'%l0(%%sr4,%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 6648 |
|
|
|
| 6649 |
|
|
/* Now restore the value of %r1 in the delay slot. */
|
| 6650 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 6651 |
|
|
{
|
| 6652 |
|
|
if (actual_fsize == 0 && !df_regs_ever_live_p (2))
|
| 6653 |
|
|
return "ldd -16(%%r30),%%r1";
|
| 6654 |
|
|
else
|
| 6655 |
|
|
return "ldd -40(%%r30),%%r1";
|
| 6656 |
|
|
}
|
| 6657 |
|
|
else
|
| 6658 |
|
|
{
|
| 6659 |
|
|
if (actual_fsize == 0 && !df_regs_ever_live_p (2))
|
| 6660 |
|
|
return "ldw -20(%%r30),%%r1";
|
| 6661 |
|
|
else
|
| 6662 |
|
|
return "ldw -12(%%r30),%%r1";
|
| 6663 |
|
|
}
|
| 6664 |
|
|
}
|
| 6665 |
|
|
|
| 6666 |
|
|
/* This routine handles all the branch-on-bit conditional branch sequences we
|
| 6667 |
|
|
might need to generate. It handles nullification of delay slots,
|
| 6668 |
|
|
varying length branches, negated branches and all combinations of the
|
| 6669 |
|
|
above. it returns the appropriate output template to emit the branch. */
|
| 6670 |
|
|
|
| 6671 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 6672 |
|
|
pa_output_bb (rtx *operands ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int negated, rtx insn, int which)
|
| 6673 |
|
|
{
|
| 6674 |
|
|
static char buf[100];
|
| 6675 |
|
|
bool useskip;
|
| 6676 |
|
|
int nullify = INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (insn);
|
| 6677 |
|
|
int length = get_attr_length (insn);
|
| 6678 |
|
|
int xdelay;
|
| 6679 |
|
|
|
| 6680 |
|
|
/* A conditional branch to the following instruction (e.g. the delay slot) is
|
| 6681 |
|
|
asking for a disaster. I do not think this can happen as this pattern
|
| 6682 |
|
|
is only used when optimizing; jump optimization should eliminate the
|
| 6683 |
|
|
jump. But be prepared just in case. */
|
| 6684 |
|
|
|
| 6685 |
|
|
if (branch_to_delay_slot_p (insn))
|
| 6686 |
|
|
return "nop";
|
| 6687 |
|
|
|
| 6688 |
|
|
/* If this is a long branch with its delay slot unfilled, set `nullify'
|
| 6689 |
|
|
as it can nullify the delay slot and save a nop. */
|
| 6690 |
|
|
if (length == 8 && dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 6691 |
|
|
nullify = 1;
|
| 6692 |
|
|
|
| 6693 |
|
|
/* If this is a short forward conditional branch which did not get
|
| 6694 |
|
|
its delay slot filled, the delay slot can still be nullified. */
|
| 6695 |
|
|
if (! nullify && length == 4 && dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 6696 |
|
|
nullify = forward_branch_p (insn);
|
| 6697 |
|
|
|
| 6698 |
|
|
/* A forward branch over a single nullified insn can be done with a
|
| 6699 |
|
|
extrs instruction. This avoids a single cycle penalty due to
|
| 6700 |
|
|
mis-predicted branch if we fall through (branch not taken). */
|
| 6701 |
|
|
useskip = (length == 4 && nullify) ? use_skip_p (insn) : FALSE;
|
| 6702 |
|
|
|
| 6703 |
|
|
switch (length)
|
| 6704 |
|
|
{
|
| 6705 |
|
|
|
| 6706 |
|
|
/* All short conditional branches except backwards with an unfilled
|
| 6707 |
|
|
delay slot. */
|
| 6708 |
|
|
case 4:
|
| 6709 |
|
|
if (useskip)
|
| 6710 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{extrs,|extrw,s,}");
|
| 6711 |
|
|
else
|
| 6712 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "bb,");
|
| 6713 |
|
|
if (useskip && GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6714 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "extrd,s,*");
|
| 6715 |
|
|
else if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6716 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "bb,*");
|
| 6717 |
|
|
if ((which == 0 && negated)
|
| 6718 |
|
|
|| (which == 1 && ! negated))
|
| 6719 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ">=");
|
| 6720 |
|
|
else
|
| 6721 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "<");
|
| 6722 |
|
|
if (useskip)
|
| 6723 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %0,%1,1,%%r0");
|
| 6724 |
|
|
else if (nullify && negated)
|
| 6725 |
|
|
{
|
| 6726 |
|
|
if (branch_needs_nop_p (insn))
|
| 6727 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n %0,%1,%3%#");
|
| 6728 |
|
|
else
|
| 6729 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n %0,%1,%3");
|
| 6730 |
|
|
}
|
| 6731 |
|
|
else if (nullify && ! negated)
|
| 6732 |
|
|
{
|
| 6733 |
|
|
if (branch_needs_nop_p (insn))
|
| 6734 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n %0,%1,%2%#");
|
| 6735 |
|
|
else
|
| 6736 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n %0,%1,%2");
|
| 6737 |
|
|
}
|
| 6738 |
|
|
else if (! nullify && negated)
|
| 6739 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %0,%1,%3");
|
| 6740 |
|
|
else if (! nullify && ! negated)
|
| 6741 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %0,%1,%2");
|
| 6742 |
|
|
break;
|
| 6743 |
|
|
|
| 6744 |
|
|
/* All long conditionals. Note a short backward branch with an
|
| 6745 |
|
|
unfilled delay slot is treated just like a long backward branch
|
| 6746 |
|
|
with an unfilled delay slot. */
|
| 6747 |
|
|
case 8:
|
| 6748 |
|
|
/* Handle weird backwards branch with a filled delay slot
|
| 6749 |
|
|
which is nullified. */
|
| 6750 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () != 0
|
| 6751 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn)
|
| 6752 |
|
|
&& nullify)
|
| 6753 |
|
|
{
|
| 6754 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "bb,");
|
| 6755 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6756 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "*");
|
| 6757 |
|
|
if ((which == 0 && negated)
|
| 6758 |
|
|
|| (which == 1 && ! negated))
|
| 6759 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "<");
|
| 6760 |
|
|
else
|
| 6761 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ">=");
|
| 6762 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6763 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n %0,%1,.+12\n\tb %3");
|
| 6764 |
|
|
else
|
| 6765 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n %0,%1,.+12\n\tb %2");
|
| 6766 |
|
|
}
|
| 6767 |
|
|
/* Handle short backwards branch with an unfilled delay slot.
|
| 6768 |
|
|
Using a bb;nop rather than extrs;bl saves 1 cycle for both
|
| 6769 |
|
|
taken and untaken branches. */
|
| 6770 |
|
|
else if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0
|
| 6771 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn)
|
| 6772 |
|
|
&& INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ()
|
| 6773 |
|
|
&& VAL_14_BITS_P (INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (JUMP_LABEL (insn)))
|
| 6774 |
|
|
- INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)) - 8))
|
| 6775 |
|
|
{
|
| 6776 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "bb,");
|
| 6777 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6778 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "*");
|
| 6779 |
|
|
if ((which == 0 && negated)
|
| 6780 |
|
|
|| (which == 1 && ! negated))
|
| 6781 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ">=");
|
| 6782 |
|
|
else
|
| 6783 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "<");
|
| 6784 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6785 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %0,%1,%3%#");
|
| 6786 |
|
|
else
|
| 6787 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %0,%1,%2%#");
|
| 6788 |
|
|
}
|
| 6789 |
|
|
else
|
| 6790 |
|
|
{
|
| 6791 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6792 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "extrd,s,*");
|
| 6793 |
|
|
else
|
| 6794 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{extrs,|extrw,s,}");
|
| 6795 |
|
|
if ((which == 0 && negated)
|
| 6796 |
|
|
|| (which == 1 && ! negated))
|
| 6797 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "<");
|
| 6798 |
|
|
else
|
| 6799 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ">=");
|
| 6800 |
|
|
if (nullify && negated)
|
| 6801 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %0,%1,1,%%r0\n\tb,n %3");
|
| 6802 |
|
|
else if (nullify && ! negated)
|
| 6803 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %0,%1,1,%%r0\n\tb,n %2");
|
| 6804 |
|
|
else if (negated)
|
| 6805 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %0,%1,1,%%r0\n\tb %3");
|
| 6806 |
|
|
else
|
| 6807 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %0,%1,1,%%r0\n\tb %2");
|
| 6808 |
|
|
}
|
| 6809 |
|
|
break;
|
| 6810 |
|
|
|
| 6811 |
|
|
default:
|
| 6812 |
|
|
/* The reversed conditional branch must branch over one additional
|
| 6813 |
|
|
instruction if the delay slot is filled and needs to be extracted
|
| 6814 |
|
|
by pa_output_lbranch. If the delay slot is empty or this is a
|
| 6815 |
|
|
nullified forward branch, the instruction after the reversed
|
| 6816 |
|
|
condition branch must be nullified. */
|
| 6817 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0
|
| 6818 |
|
|
|| (nullify && forward_branch_p (insn)))
|
| 6819 |
|
|
{
|
| 6820 |
|
|
nullify = 1;
|
| 6821 |
|
|
xdelay = 0;
|
| 6822 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length);
|
| 6823 |
|
|
}
|
| 6824 |
|
|
else
|
| 6825 |
|
|
{
|
| 6826 |
|
|
xdelay = 1;
|
| 6827 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length + 4);
|
| 6828 |
|
|
}
|
| 6829 |
|
|
|
| 6830 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6831 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "bb,*");
|
| 6832 |
|
|
else
|
| 6833 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "bb,");
|
| 6834 |
|
|
if ((which == 0 && negated)
|
| 6835 |
|
|
|| (which == 1 && !negated))
|
| 6836 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "<");
|
| 6837 |
|
|
else
|
| 6838 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ">=");
|
| 6839 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 6840 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n %0,%1,.+%4");
|
| 6841 |
|
|
else
|
| 6842 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " %0,%1,.+%4");
|
| 6843 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (buf, operands);
|
| 6844 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (negated ? operands[3] : operands[2],
|
| 6845 |
|
|
insn, xdelay);
|
| 6846 |
|
|
}
|
| 6847 |
|
|
return buf;
|
| 6848 |
|
|
}
|
| 6849 |
|
|
|
| 6850 |
|
|
/* This routine handles all the branch-on-variable-bit conditional branch
|
| 6851 |
|
|
sequences we might need to generate. It handles nullification of delay
|
| 6852 |
|
|
slots, varying length branches, negated branches and all combinations
|
| 6853 |
|
|
of the above. it returns the appropriate output template to emit the
|
| 6854 |
|
|
branch. */
|
| 6855 |
|
|
|
| 6856 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 6857 |
|
|
pa_output_bvb (rtx *operands ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int negated, rtx insn,
|
| 6858 |
|
|
int which)
|
| 6859 |
|
|
{
|
| 6860 |
|
|
static char buf[100];
|
| 6861 |
|
|
bool useskip;
|
| 6862 |
|
|
int nullify = INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (insn);
|
| 6863 |
|
|
int length = get_attr_length (insn);
|
| 6864 |
|
|
int xdelay;
|
| 6865 |
|
|
|
| 6866 |
|
|
/* A conditional branch to the following instruction (e.g. the delay slot) is
|
| 6867 |
|
|
asking for a disaster. I do not think this can happen as this pattern
|
| 6868 |
|
|
is only used when optimizing; jump optimization should eliminate the
|
| 6869 |
|
|
jump. But be prepared just in case. */
|
| 6870 |
|
|
|
| 6871 |
|
|
if (branch_to_delay_slot_p (insn))
|
| 6872 |
|
|
return "nop";
|
| 6873 |
|
|
|
| 6874 |
|
|
/* If this is a long branch with its delay slot unfilled, set `nullify'
|
| 6875 |
|
|
as it can nullify the delay slot and save a nop. */
|
| 6876 |
|
|
if (length == 8 && dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 6877 |
|
|
nullify = 1;
|
| 6878 |
|
|
|
| 6879 |
|
|
/* If this is a short forward conditional branch which did not get
|
| 6880 |
|
|
its delay slot filled, the delay slot can still be nullified. */
|
| 6881 |
|
|
if (! nullify && length == 4 && dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 6882 |
|
|
nullify = forward_branch_p (insn);
|
| 6883 |
|
|
|
| 6884 |
|
|
/* A forward branch over a single nullified insn can be done with a
|
| 6885 |
|
|
extrs instruction. This avoids a single cycle penalty due to
|
| 6886 |
|
|
mis-predicted branch if we fall through (branch not taken). */
|
| 6887 |
|
|
useskip = (length == 4 && nullify) ? use_skip_p (insn) : FALSE;
|
| 6888 |
|
|
|
| 6889 |
|
|
switch (length)
|
| 6890 |
|
|
{
|
| 6891 |
|
|
|
| 6892 |
|
|
/* All short conditional branches except backwards with an unfilled
|
| 6893 |
|
|
delay slot. */
|
| 6894 |
|
|
case 4:
|
| 6895 |
|
|
if (useskip)
|
| 6896 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{vextrs,|extrw,s,}");
|
| 6897 |
|
|
else
|
| 6898 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{bvb,|bb,}");
|
| 6899 |
|
|
if (useskip && GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6900 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "extrd,s,*");
|
| 6901 |
|
|
else if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6902 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "bb,*");
|
| 6903 |
|
|
if ((which == 0 && negated)
|
| 6904 |
|
|
|| (which == 1 && ! negated))
|
| 6905 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ">=");
|
| 6906 |
|
|
else
|
| 6907 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "<");
|
| 6908 |
|
|
if (useskip)
|
| 6909 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{ %0,1,%%r0| %0,%%sar,1,%%r0}");
|
| 6910 |
|
|
else if (nullify && negated)
|
| 6911 |
|
|
{
|
| 6912 |
|
|
if (branch_needs_nop_p (insn))
|
| 6913 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{,n %0,%3%#|,n %0,%%sar,%3%#}");
|
| 6914 |
|
|
else
|
| 6915 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{,n %0,%3|,n %0,%%sar,%3}");
|
| 6916 |
|
|
}
|
| 6917 |
|
|
else if (nullify && ! negated)
|
| 6918 |
|
|
{
|
| 6919 |
|
|
if (branch_needs_nop_p (insn))
|
| 6920 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{,n %0,%2%#|,n %0,%%sar,%2%#}");
|
| 6921 |
|
|
else
|
| 6922 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{,n %0,%2|,n %0,%%sar,%2}");
|
| 6923 |
|
|
}
|
| 6924 |
|
|
else if (! nullify && negated)
|
| 6925 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{ %0,%3| %0,%%sar,%3}");
|
| 6926 |
|
|
else if (! nullify && ! negated)
|
| 6927 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{ %0,%2| %0,%%sar,%2}");
|
| 6928 |
|
|
break;
|
| 6929 |
|
|
|
| 6930 |
|
|
/* All long conditionals. Note a short backward branch with an
|
| 6931 |
|
|
unfilled delay slot is treated just like a long backward branch
|
| 6932 |
|
|
with an unfilled delay slot. */
|
| 6933 |
|
|
case 8:
|
| 6934 |
|
|
/* Handle weird backwards branch with a filled delay slot
|
| 6935 |
|
|
which is nullified. */
|
| 6936 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () != 0
|
| 6937 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn)
|
| 6938 |
|
|
&& nullify)
|
| 6939 |
|
|
{
|
| 6940 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{bvb,|bb,}");
|
| 6941 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6942 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "*");
|
| 6943 |
|
|
if ((which == 0 && negated)
|
| 6944 |
|
|
|| (which == 1 && ! negated))
|
| 6945 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "<");
|
| 6946 |
|
|
else
|
| 6947 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ">=");
|
| 6948 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6949 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{,n %0,.+12\n\tb %3|,n %0,%%sar,.+12\n\tb %3}");
|
| 6950 |
|
|
else
|
| 6951 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{,n %0,.+12\n\tb %2|,n %0,%%sar,.+12\n\tb %2}");
|
| 6952 |
|
|
}
|
| 6953 |
|
|
/* Handle short backwards branch with an unfilled delay slot.
|
| 6954 |
|
|
Using a bb;nop rather than extrs;bl saves 1 cycle for both
|
| 6955 |
|
|
taken and untaken branches. */
|
| 6956 |
|
|
else if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0
|
| 6957 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn)
|
| 6958 |
|
|
&& INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ()
|
| 6959 |
|
|
&& VAL_14_BITS_P (INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (JUMP_LABEL (insn)))
|
| 6960 |
|
|
- INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)) - 8))
|
| 6961 |
|
|
{
|
| 6962 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{bvb,|bb,}");
|
| 6963 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6964 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "*");
|
| 6965 |
|
|
if ((which == 0 && negated)
|
| 6966 |
|
|
|| (which == 1 && ! negated))
|
| 6967 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ">=");
|
| 6968 |
|
|
else
|
| 6969 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "<");
|
| 6970 |
|
|
if (negated)
|
| 6971 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{ %0,%3%#| %0,%%sar,%3%#}");
|
| 6972 |
|
|
else
|
| 6973 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{ %0,%2%#| %0,%%sar,%2%#}");
|
| 6974 |
|
|
}
|
| 6975 |
|
|
else
|
| 6976 |
|
|
{
|
| 6977 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{vextrs,|extrw,s,}");
|
| 6978 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 6979 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "extrd,s,*");
|
| 6980 |
|
|
if ((which == 0 && negated)
|
| 6981 |
|
|
|| (which == 1 && ! negated))
|
| 6982 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "<");
|
| 6983 |
|
|
else
|
| 6984 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ">=");
|
| 6985 |
|
|
if (nullify && negated)
|
| 6986 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{ %0,1,%%r0\n\tb,n %3| %0,%%sar,1,%%r0\n\tb,n %3}");
|
| 6987 |
|
|
else if (nullify && ! negated)
|
| 6988 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{ %0,1,%%r0\n\tb,n %2| %0,%%sar,1,%%r0\n\tb,n %2}");
|
| 6989 |
|
|
else if (negated)
|
| 6990 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{ %0,1,%%r0\n\tb %3| %0,%%sar,1,%%r0\n\tb %3}");
|
| 6991 |
|
|
else
|
| 6992 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "{ %0,1,%%r0\n\tb %2| %0,%%sar,1,%%r0\n\tb %2}");
|
| 6993 |
|
|
}
|
| 6994 |
|
|
break;
|
| 6995 |
|
|
|
| 6996 |
|
|
default:
|
| 6997 |
|
|
/* The reversed conditional branch must branch over one additional
|
| 6998 |
|
|
instruction if the delay slot is filled and needs to be extracted
|
| 6999 |
|
|
by pa_output_lbranch. If the delay slot is empty or this is a
|
| 7000 |
|
|
nullified forward branch, the instruction after the reversed
|
| 7001 |
|
|
condition branch must be nullified. */
|
| 7002 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0
|
| 7003 |
|
|
|| (nullify && forward_branch_p (insn)))
|
| 7004 |
|
|
{
|
| 7005 |
|
|
nullify = 1;
|
| 7006 |
|
|
xdelay = 0;
|
| 7007 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length);
|
| 7008 |
|
|
}
|
| 7009 |
|
|
else
|
| 7010 |
|
|
{
|
| 7011 |
|
|
xdelay = 1;
|
| 7012 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length + 4);
|
| 7013 |
|
|
}
|
| 7014 |
|
|
|
| 7015 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) == DImode)
|
| 7016 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "bb,*");
|
| 7017 |
|
|
else
|
| 7018 |
|
|
strcpy (buf, "{bvb,|bb,}");
|
| 7019 |
|
|
if ((which == 0 && negated)
|
| 7020 |
|
|
|| (which == 1 && !negated))
|
| 7021 |
|
|
strcat (buf, "<");
|
| 7022 |
|
|
else
|
| 7023 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ">=");
|
| 7024 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 7025 |
|
|
strcat (buf, ",n {%0,.+%4|%0,%%sar,.+%4}");
|
| 7026 |
|
|
else
|
| 7027 |
|
|
strcat (buf, " {%0,.+%4|%0,%%sar,.+%4}");
|
| 7028 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (buf, operands);
|
| 7029 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (negated ? operands[3] : operands[2],
|
| 7030 |
|
|
insn, xdelay);
|
| 7031 |
|
|
}
|
| 7032 |
|
|
return buf;
|
| 7033 |
|
|
}
|
| 7034 |
|
|
|
| 7035 |
|
|
/* Return the output template for emitting a dbra type insn.
|
| 7036 |
|
|
|
| 7037 |
|
|
Note it may perform some output operations on its own before
|
| 7038 |
|
|
returning the final output string. */
|
| 7039 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 7040 |
|
|
pa_output_dbra (rtx *operands, rtx insn, int which_alternative)
|
| 7041 |
|
|
{
|
| 7042 |
|
|
int length = get_attr_length (insn);
|
| 7043 |
|
|
|
| 7044 |
|
|
/* A conditional branch to the following instruction (e.g. the delay slot) is
|
| 7045 |
|
|
asking for a disaster. Be prepared! */
|
| 7046 |
|
|
|
| 7047 |
|
|
if (branch_to_delay_slot_p (insn))
|
| 7048 |
|
|
{
|
| 7049 |
|
|
if (which_alternative == 0)
|
| 7050 |
|
|
return "ldo %1(%0),%0";
|
| 7051 |
|
|
else if (which_alternative == 1)
|
| 7052 |
|
|
{
|
| 7053 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{fstws|fstw} %0,-16(%%r30)", operands);
|
| 7054 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw -16(%%r30),%4", operands);
|
| 7055 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo %1(%4),%4\n\tstw %4,-16(%%r30)", operands);
|
| 7056 |
|
|
return "{fldws|fldw} -16(%%r30),%0";
|
| 7057 |
|
|
}
|
| 7058 |
|
|
else
|
| 7059 |
|
|
{
|
| 7060 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw %0,%4", operands);
|
| 7061 |
|
|
return "ldo %1(%4),%4\n\tstw %4,%0";
|
| 7062 |
|
|
}
|
| 7063 |
|
|
}
|
| 7064 |
|
|
|
| 7065 |
|
|
if (which_alternative == 0)
|
| 7066 |
|
|
{
|
| 7067 |
|
|
int nullify = INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (insn);
|
| 7068 |
|
|
int xdelay;
|
| 7069 |
|
|
|
| 7070 |
|
|
/* If this is a long branch with its delay slot unfilled, set `nullify'
|
| 7071 |
|
|
as it can nullify the delay slot and save a nop. */
|
| 7072 |
|
|
if (length == 8 && dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 7073 |
|
|
nullify = 1;
|
| 7074 |
|
|
|
| 7075 |
|
|
/* If this is a short forward conditional branch which did not get
|
| 7076 |
|
|
its delay slot filled, the delay slot can still be nullified. */
|
| 7077 |
|
|
if (! nullify && length == 4 && dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 7078 |
|
|
nullify = forward_branch_p (insn);
|
| 7079 |
|
|
|
| 7080 |
|
|
switch (length)
|
| 7081 |
|
|
{
|
| 7082 |
|
|
case 4:
|
| 7083 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 7084 |
|
|
{
|
| 7085 |
|
|
if (branch_needs_nop_p (insn))
|
| 7086 |
|
|
return "addib,%C2,n %1,%0,%3%#";
|
| 7087 |
|
|
else
|
| 7088 |
|
|
return "addib,%C2,n %1,%0,%3";
|
| 7089 |
|
|
}
|
| 7090 |
|
|
else
|
| 7091 |
|
|
return "addib,%C2 %1,%0,%3";
|
| 7092 |
|
|
|
| 7093 |
|
|
case 8:
|
| 7094 |
|
|
/* Handle weird backwards branch with a fulled delay slot
|
| 7095 |
|
|
which is nullified. */
|
| 7096 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () != 0
|
| 7097 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn)
|
| 7098 |
|
|
&& nullify)
|
| 7099 |
|
|
return "addib,%N2,n %1,%0,.+12\n\tb %3";
|
| 7100 |
|
|
/* Handle short backwards branch with an unfilled delay slot.
|
| 7101 |
|
|
Using a addb;nop rather than addi;bl saves 1 cycle for both
|
| 7102 |
|
|
taken and untaken branches. */
|
| 7103 |
|
|
else if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0
|
| 7104 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn)
|
| 7105 |
|
|
&& INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ()
|
| 7106 |
|
|
&& VAL_14_BITS_P (INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (JUMP_LABEL (insn)))
|
| 7107 |
|
|
- INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)) - 8))
|
| 7108 |
|
|
return "addib,%C2 %1,%0,%3%#";
|
| 7109 |
|
|
|
| 7110 |
|
|
/* Handle normal cases. */
|
| 7111 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 7112 |
|
|
return "addi,%N2 %1,%0,%0\n\tb,n %3";
|
| 7113 |
|
|
else
|
| 7114 |
|
|
return "addi,%N2 %1,%0,%0\n\tb %3";
|
| 7115 |
|
|
|
| 7116 |
|
|
default:
|
| 7117 |
|
|
/* The reversed conditional branch must branch over one additional
|
| 7118 |
|
|
instruction if the delay slot is filled and needs to be extracted
|
| 7119 |
|
|
by pa_output_lbranch. If the delay slot is empty or this is a
|
| 7120 |
|
|
nullified forward branch, the instruction after the reversed
|
| 7121 |
|
|
condition branch must be nullified. */
|
| 7122 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0
|
| 7123 |
|
|
|| (nullify && forward_branch_p (insn)))
|
| 7124 |
|
|
{
|
| 7125 |
|
|
nullify = 1;
|
| 7126 |
|
|
xdelay = 0;
|
| 7127 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length);
|
| 7128 |
|
|
}
|
| 7129 |
|
|
else
|
| 7130 |
|
|
{
|
| 7131 |
|
|
xdelay = 1;
|
| 7132 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length + 4);
|
| 7133 |
|
|
}
|
| 7134 |
|
|
|
| 7135 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 7136 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,%N2,n %1,%0,.+%4", operands);
|
| 7137 |
|
|
else
|
| 7138 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,%N2 %1,%0,.+%4", operands);
|
| 7139 |
|
|
|
| 7140 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (operands[3], insn, xdelay);
|
| 7141 |
|
|
}
|
| 7142 |
|
|
|
| 7143 |
|
|
}
|
| 7144 |
|
|
/* Deal with gross reload from FP register case. */
|
| 7145 |
|
|
else if (which_alternative == 1)
|
| 7146 |
|
|
{
|
| 7147 |
|
|
/* Move loop counter from FP register to MEM then into a GR,
|
| 7148 |
|
|
increment the GR, store the GR into MEM, and finally reload
|
| 7149 |
|
|
the FP register from MEM from within the branch's delay slot. */
|
| 7150 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{fstws|fstw} %0,-16(%%r30)\n\tldw -16(%%r30),%4",
|
| 7151 |
|
|
operands);
|
| 7152 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo %1(%4),%4\n\tstw %4,-16(%%r30)", operands);
|
| 7153 |
|
|
if (length == 24)
|
| 7154 |
|
|
return "{comb|cmpb},%S2 %%r0,%4,%3\n\t{fldws|fldw} -16(%%r30),%0";
|
| 7155 |
|
|
else if (length == 28)
|
| 7156 |
|
|
return "{comclr|cmpclr},%B2 %%r0,%4,%%r0\n\tb %3\n\t{fldws|fldw} -16(%%r30),%0";
|
| 7157 |
|
|
else
|
| 7158 |
|
|
{
|
| 7159 |
|
|
operands[5] = GEN_INT (length - 16);
|
| 7160 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{comb|cmpb},%B2 %%r0,%4,.+%5", operands);
|
| 7161 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{fldws|fldw} -16(%%r30),%0", operands);
|
| 7162 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (operands[3], insn, 0);
|
| 7163 |
|
|
}
|
| 7164 |
|
|
}
|
| 7165 |
|
|
/* Deal with gross reload from memory case. */
|
| 7166 |
|
|
else
|
| 7167 |
|
|
{
|
| 7168 |
|
|
/* Reload loop counter from memory, the store back to memory
|
| 7169 |
|
|
happens in the branch's delay slot. */
|
| 7170 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw %0,%4", operands);
|
| 7171 |
|
|
if (length == 12)
|
| 7172 |
|
|
return "addib,%C2 %1,%4,%3\n\tstw %4,%0";
|
| 7173 |
|
|
else if (length == 16)
|
| 7174 |
|
|
return "addi,%N2 %1,%4,%4\n\tb %3\n\tstw %4,%0";
|
| 7175 |
|
|
else
|
| 7176 |
|
|
{
|
| 7177 |
|
|
operands[5] = GEN_INT (length - 4);
|
| 7178 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addib,%N2 %1,%4,.+%5\n\tstw %4,%0", operands);
|
| 7179 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (operands[3], insn, 0);
|
| 7180 |
|
|
}
|
| 7181 |
|
|
}
|
| 7182 |
|
|
}
|
| 7183 |
|
|
|
| 7184 |
|
|
/* Return the output template for emitting a movb type insn.
|
| 7185 |
|
|
|
| 7186 |
|
|
Note it may perform some output operations on its own before
|
| 7187 |
|
|
returning the final output string. */
|
| 7188 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 7189 |
|
|
pa_output_movb (rtx *operands, rtx insn, int which_alternative,
|
| 7190 |
|
|
int reverse_comparison)
|
| 7191 |
|
|
{
|
| 7192 |
|
|
int length = get_attr_length (insn);
|
| 7193 |
|
|
|
| 7194 |
|
|
/* A conditional branch to the following instruction (e.g. the delay slot) is
|
| 7195 |
|
|
asking for a disaster. Be prepared! */
|
| 7196 |
|
|
|
| 7197 |
|
|
if (branch_to_delay_slot_p (insn))
|
| 7198 |
|
|
{
|
| 7199 |
|
|
if (which_alternative == 0)
|
| 7200 |
|
|
return "copy %1,%0";
|
| 7201 |
|
|
else if (which_alternative == 1)
|
| 7202 |
|
|
{
|
| 7203 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stw %1,-16(%%r30)", operands);
|
| 7204 |
|
|
return "{fldws|fldw} -16(%%r30),%0";
|
| 7205 |
|
|
}
|
| 7206 |
|
|
else if (which_alternative == 2)
|
| 7207 |
|
|
return "stw %1,%0";
|
| 7208 |
|
|
else
|
| 7209 |
|
|
return "mtsar %r1";
|
| 7210 |
|
|
}
|
| 7211 |
|
|
|
| 7212 |
|
|
/* Support the second variant. */
|
| 7213 |
|
|
if (reverse_comparison)
|
| 7214 |
|
|
PUT_CODE (operands[2], reverse_condition (GET_CODE (operands[2])));
|
| 7215 |
|
|
|
| 7216 |
|
|
if (which_alternative == 0)
|
| 7217 |
|
|
{
|
| 7218 |
|
|
int nullify = INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (insn);
|
| 7219 |
|
|
int xdelay;
|
| 7220 |
|
|
|
| 7221 |
|
|
/* If this is a long branch with its delay slot unfilled, set `nullify'
|
| 7222 |
|
|
as it can nullify the delay slot and save a nop. */
|
| 7223 |
|
|
if (length == 8 && dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 7224 |
|
|
nullify = 1;
|
| 7225 |
|
|
|
| 7226 |
|
|
/* If this is a short forward conditional branch which did not get
|
| 7227 |
|
|
its delay slot filled, the delay slot can still be nullified. */
|
| 7228 |
|
|
if (! nullify && length == 4 && dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 7229 |
|
|
nullify = forward_branch_p (insn);
|
| 7230 |
|
|
|
| 7231 |
|
|
switch (length)
|
| 7232 |
|
|
{
|
| 7233 |
|
|
case 4:
|
| 7234 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 7235 |
|
|
{
|
| 7236 |
|
|
if (branch_needs_nop_p (insn))
|
| 7237 |
|
|
return "movb,%C2,n %1,%0,%3%#";
|
| 7238 |
|
|
else
|
| 7239 |
|
|
return "movb,%C2,n %1,%0,%3";
|
| 7240 |
|
|
}
|
| 7241 |
|
|
else
|
| 7242 |
|
|
return "movb,%C2 %1,%0,%3";
|
| 7243 |
|
|
|
| 7244 |
|
|
case 8:
|
| 7245 |
|
|
/* Handle weird backwards branch with a filled delay slot
|
| 7246 |
|
|
which is nullified. */
|
| 7247 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () != 0
|
| 7248 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn)
|
| 7249 |
|
|
&& nullify)
|
| 7250 |
|
|
return "movb,%N2,n %1,%0,.+12\n\tb %3";
|
| 7251 |
|
|
|
| 7252 |
|
|
/* Handle short backwards branch with an unfilled delay slot.
|
| 7253 |
|
|
Using a movb;nop rather than or;bl saves 1 cycle for both
|
| 7254 |
|
|
taken and untaken branches. */
|
| 7255 |
|
|
else if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0
|
| 7256 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (insn)
|
| 7257 |
|
|
&& INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ()
|
| 7258 |
|
|
&& VAL_14_BITS_P (INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (JUMP_LABEL (insn)))
|
| 7259 |
|
|
- INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)) - 8))
|
| 7260 |
|
|
return "movb,%C2 %1,%0,%3%#";
|
| 7261 |
|
|
/* Handle normal cases. */
|
| 7262 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 7263 |
|
|
return "or,%N2 %1,%%r0,%0\n\tb,n %3";
|
| 7264 |
|
|
else
|
| 7265 |
|
|
return "or,%N2 %1,%%r0,%0\n\tb %3";
|
| 7266 |
|
|
|
| 7267 |
|
|
default:
|
| 7268 |
|
|
/* The reversed conditional branch must branch over one additional
|
| 7269 |
|
|
instruction if the delay slot is filled and needs to be extracted
|
| 7270 |
|
|
by pa_output_lbranch. If the delay slot is empty or this is a
|
| 7271 |
|
|
nullified forward branch, the instruction after the reversed
|
| 7272 |
|
|
condition branch must be nullified. */
|
| 7273 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0
|
| 7274 |
|
|
|| (nullify && forward_branch_p (insn)))
|
| 7275 |
|
|
{
|
| 7276 |
|
|
nullify = 1;
|
| 7277 |
|
|
xdelay = 0;
|
| 7278 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length);
|
| 7279 |
|
|
}
|
| 7280 |
|
|
else
|
| 7281 |
|
|
{
|
| 7282 |
|
|
xdelay = 1;
|
| 7283 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length + 4);
|
| 7284 |
|
|
}
|
| 7285 |
|
|
|
| 7286 |
|
|
if (nullify)
|
| 7287 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("movb,%N2,n %1,%0,.+%4", operands);
|
| 7288 |
|
|
else
|
| 7289 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("movb,%N2 %1,%0,.+%4", operands);
|
| 7290 |
|
|
|
| 7291 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (operands[3], insn, xdelay);
|
| 7292 |
|
|
}
|
| 7293 |
|
|
}
|
| 7294 |
|
|
/* Deal with gross reload for FP destination register case. */
|
| 7295 |
|
|
else if (which_alternative == 1)
|
| 7296 |
|
|
{
|
| 7297 |
|
|
/* Move source register to MEM, perform the branch test, then
|
| 7298 |
|
|
finally load the FP register from MEM from within the branch's
|
| 7299 |
|
|
delay slot. */
|
| 7300 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stw %1,-16(%%r30)", operands);
|
| 7301 |
|
|
if (length == 12)
|
| 7302 |
|
|
return "{comb|cmpb},%S2 %%r0,%1,%3\n\t{fldws|fldw} -16(%%r30),%0";
|
| 7303 |
|
|
else if (length == 16)
|
| 7304 |
|
|
return "{comclr|cmpclr},%B2 %%r0,%1,%%r0\n\tb %3\n\t{fldws|fldw} -16(%%r30),%0";
|
| 7305 |
|
|
else
|
| 7306 |
|
|
{
|
| 7307 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length - 4);
|
| 7308 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{comb|cmpb},%B2 %%r0,%1,.+%4", operands);
|
| 7309 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{fldws|fldw} -16(%%r30),%0", operands);
|
| 7310 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (operands[3], insn, 0);
|
| 7311 |
|
|
}
|
| 7312 |
|
|
}
|
| 7313 |
|
|
/* Deal with gross reload from memory case. */
|
| 7314 |
|
|
else if (which_alternative == 2)
|
| 7315 |
|
|
{
|
| 7316 |
|
|
/* Reload loop counter from memory, the store back to memory
|
| 7317 |
|
|
happens in the branch's delay slot. */
|
| 7318 |
|
|
if (length == 8)
|
| 7319 |
|
|
return "{comb|cmpb},%S2 %%r0,%1,%3\n\tstw %1,%0";
|
| 7320 |
|
|
else if (length == 12)
|
| 7321 |
|
|
return "{comclr|cmpclr},%B2 %%r0,%1,%%r0\n\tb %3\n\tstw %1,%0";
|
| 7322 |
|
|
else
|
| 7323 |
|
|
{
|
| 7324 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length);
|
| 7325 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{comb|cmpb},%B2 %%r0,%1,.+%4\n\tstw %1,%0",
|
| 7326 |
|
|
operands);
|
| 7327 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (operands[3], insn, 0);
|
| 7328 |
|
|
}
|
| 7329 |
|
|
}
|
| 7330 |
|
|
/* Handle SAR as a destination. */
|
| 7331 |
|
|
else
|
| 7332 |
|
|
{
|
| 7333 |
|
|
if (length == 8)
|
| 7334 |
|
|
return "{comb|cmpb},%S2 %%r0,%1,%3\n\tmtsar %r1";
|
| 7335 |
|
|
else if (length == 12)
|
| 7336 |
|
|
return "{comclr|cmpclr},%B2 %%r0,%1,%%r0\n\tb %3\n\tmtsar %r1";
|
| 7337 |
|
|
else
|
| 7338 |
|
|
{
|
| 7339 |
|
|
operands[4] = GEN_INT (length);
|
| 7340 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{comb|cmpb},%B2 %%r0,%1,.+%4\n\tmtsar %r1",
|
| 7341 |
|
|
operands);
|
| 7342 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (operands[3], insn, 0);
|
| 7343 |
|
|
}
|
| 7344 |
|
|
}
|
| 7345 |
|
|
}
|
| 7346 |
|
|
|
| 7347 |
|
|
/* Copy any FP arguments in INSN into integer registers. */
|
| 7348 |
|
|
static void
|
| 7349 |
|
|
copy_fp_args (rtx insn)
|
| 7350 |
|
|
{
|
| 7351 |
|
|
rtx link;
|
| 7352 |
|
|
rtx xoperands[2];
|
| 7353 |
|
|
|
| 7354 |
|
|
for (link = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
|
| 7355 |
|
|
{
|
| 7356 |
|
|
int arg_mode, regno;
|
| 7357 |
|
|
rtx use = XEXP (link, 0);
|
| 7358 |
|
|
|
| 7359 |
|
|
if (! (GET_CODE (use) == USE
|
| 7360 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (use, 0)) == REG
|
| 7361 |
|
|
&& FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (REGNO (XEXP (use, 0)))))
|
| 7362 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 7363 |
|
|
|
| 7364 |
|
|
arg_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (use, 0));
|
| 7365 |
|
|
regno = REGNO (XEXP (use, 0));
|
| 7366 |
|
|
|
| 7367 |
|
|
/* Is it a floating point register? */
|
| 7368 |
|
|
if (regno >= 32 && regno <= 39)
|
| 7369 |
|
|
{
|
| 7370 |
|
|
/* Copy the FP register into an integer register via memory. */
|
| 7371 |
|
|
if (arg_mode == SFmode)
|
| 7372 |
|
|
{
|
| 7373 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = XEXP (use, 0);
|
| 7374 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 26 - (regno - 32) / 2);
|
| 7375 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{fstws|fstw} %0,-16(%%sr0,%%r30)", xoperands);
|
| 7376 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw -16(%%sr0,%%r30),%1", xoperands);
|
| 7377 |
|
|
}
|
| 7378 |
|
|
else
|
| 7379 |
|
|
{
|
| 7380 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = XEXP (use, 0);
|
| 7381 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 25 - (regno - 34) / 2);
|
| 7382 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{fstds|fstd} %0,-16(%%sr0,%%r30)", xoperands);
|
| 7383 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw -12(%%sr0,%%r30),%R1", xoperands);
|
| 7384 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw -16(%%sr0,%%r30),%1", xoperands);
|
| 7385 |
|
|
}
|
| 7386 |
|
|
}
|
| 7387 |
|
|
}
|
| 7388 |
|
|
}
|
| 7389 |
|
|
|
| 7390 |
|
|
/* Compute length of the FP argument copy sequence for INSN. */
|
| 7391 |
|
|
static int
|
| 7392 |
|
|
length_fp_args (rtx insn)
|
| 7393 |
|
|
{
|
| 7394 |
|
|
int length = 0;
|
| 7395 |
|
|
rtx link;
|
| 7396 |
|
|
|
| 7397 |
|
|
for (link = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
|
| 7398 |
|
|
{
|
| 7399 |
|
|
int arg_mode, regno;
|
| 7400 |
|
|
rtx use = XEXP (link, 0);
|
| 7401 |
|
|
|
| 7402 |
|
|
if (! (GET_CODE (use) == USE
|
| 7403 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (use, 0)) == REG
|
| 7404 |
|
|
&& FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (REGNO (XEXP (use, 0)))))
|
| 7405 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 7406 |
|
|
|
| 7407 |
|
|
arg_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (use, 0));
|
| 7408 |
|
|
regno = REGNO (XEXP (use, 0));
|
| 7409 |
|
|
|
| 7410 |
|
|
/* Is it a floating point register? */
|
| 7411 |
|
|
if (regno >= 32 && regno <= 39)
|
| 7412 |
|
|
{
|
| 7413 |
|
|
if (arg_mode == SFmode)
|
| 7414 |
|
|
length += 8;
|
| 7415 |
|
|
else
|
| 7416 |
|
|
length += 12;
|
| 7417 |
|
|
}
|
| 7418 |
|
|
}
|
| 7419 |
|
|
|
| 7420 |
|
|
return length;
|
| 7421 |
|
|
}
|
| 7422 |
|
|
|
| 7423 |
|
|
/* Return the attribute length for the millicode call instruction INSN.
|
| 7424 |
|
|
The length must match the code generated by pa_output_millicode_call.
|
| 7425 |
|
|
We include the delay slot in the returned length as it is better to
|
| 7426 |
|
|
over estimate the length than to under estimate it. */
|
| 7427 |
|
|
|
| 7428 |
|
|
int
|
| 7429 |
|
|
pa_attr_length_millicode_call (rtx insn)
|
| 7430 |
|
|
{
|
| 7431 |
|
|
unsigned long distance = -1;
|
| 7432 |
|
|
unsigned long total = IN_NAMED_SECTION_P (cfun->decl) ? 0 : total_code_bytes;
|
| 7433 |
|
|
|
| 7434 |
|
|
if (INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ())
|
| 7435 |
|
|
{
|
| 7436 |
|
|
distance = (total + insn_current_reference_address (insn));
|
| 7437 |
|
|
if (distance < total)
|
| 7438 |
|
|
distance = -1;
|
| 7439 |
|
|
}
|
| 7440 |
|
|
|
| 7441 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 7442 |
|
|
{
|
| 7443 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_LONG_CALLS && distance < 7600000)
|
| 7444 |
|
|
return 8;
|
| 7445 |
|
|
|
| 7446 |
|
|
return 20;
|
| 7447 |
|
|
}
|
| 7448 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME)
|
| 7449 |
|
|
return 24;
|
| 7450 |
|
|
else
|
| 7451 |
|
|
{
|
| 7452 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_LONG_CALLS && distance < 240000)
|
| 7453 |
|
|
return 8;
|
| 7454 |
|
|
|
| 7455 |
|
|
if (TARGET_LONG_ABS_CALL && !flag_pic)
|
| 7456 |
|
|
return 12;
|
| 7457 |
|
|
|
| 7458 |
|
|
return 24;
|
| 7459 |
|
|
}
|
| 7460 |
|
|
}
|
| 7461 |
|
|
|
| 7462 |
|
|
/* INSN is a function call. It may have an unconditional jump
|
| 7463 |
|
|
in its delay slot.
|
| 7464 |
|
|
|
| 7465 |
|
|
CALL_DEST is the routine we are calling. */
|
| 7466 |
|
|
|
| 7467 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 7468 |
|
|
pa_output_millicode_call (rtx insn, rtx call_dest)
|
| 7469 |
|
|
{
|
| 7470 |
|
|
int attr_length = get_attr_length (insn);
|
| 7471 |
|
|
int seq_length = dbr_sequence_length ();
|
| 7472 |
|
|
int distance;
|
| 7473 |
|
|
rtx seq_insn;
|
| 7474 |
|
|
rtx xoperands[3];
|
| 7475 |
|
|
|
| 7476 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = call_dest;
|
| 7477 |
|
|
xoperands[2] = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, TARGET_64BIT ? 2 : 31);
|
| 7478 |
|
|
|
| 7479 |
|
|
/* Handle the common case where we are sure that the branch will
|
| 7480 |
|
|
reach the beginning of the $CODE$ subspace. The within reach
|
| 7481 |
|
|
form of the $$sh_func_adrs call has a length of 28. Because
|
| 7482 |
|
|
it has an attribute type of multi, it never has a nonzero
|
| 7483 |
|
|
sequence length. The length of the $$sh_func_adrs is the same
|
| 7484 |
|
|
as certain out of reach PIC calls to other routines. */
|
| 7485 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_LONG_CALLS
|
| 7486 |
|
|
&& ((seq_length == 0
|
| 7487 |
|
|
&& (attr_length == 12
|
| 7488 |
|
|
|| (attr_length == 28 && get_attr_type (insn) == TYPE_MULTI)))
|
| 7489 |
|
|
|| (seq_length != 0 && attr_length == 8)))
|
| 7490 |
|
|
{
|
| 7491 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{bl|b,l} %0,%2", xoperands);
|
| 7492 |
|
|
}
|
| 7493 |
|
|
else
|
| 7494 |
|
|
{
|
| 7495 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 7496 |
|
|
{
|
| 7497 |
|
|
/* It might seem that one insn could be saved by accessing
|
| 7498 |
|
|
the millicode function using the linkage table. However,
|
| 7499 |
|
|
this doesn't work in shared libraries and other dynamically
|
| 7500 |
|
|
loaded objects. Using a pc-relative sequence also avoids
|
| 7501 |
|
|
problems related to the implicit use of the gp register. */
|
| 7502 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("b,l .+8,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7503 |
|
|
|
| 7504 |
|
|
if (TARGET_GAS)
|
| 7505 |
|
|
{
|
| 7506 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%0-$PIC_pcrel$0+4,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7507 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0-$PIC_pcrel$0+8(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7508 |
|
|
}
|
| 7509 |
|
|
else
|
| 7510 |
|
|
{
|
| 7511 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 7512 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%0-%l1,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7513 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "L",
|
| 7514 |
|
|
CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (xoperands[1]));
|
| 7515 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0-%l1(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7516 |
|
|
}
|
| 7517 |
|
|
|
| 7518 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bve,l (%%r1),%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7519 |
|
|
}
|
| 7520 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME)
|
| 7521 |
|
|
{
|
| 7522 |
|
|
/* Pure portable runtime doesn't allow be/ble; we also don't
|
| 7523 |
|
|
have PIC support in the assembler/linker, so this sequence
|
| 7524 |
|
|
is needed. */
|
| 7525 |
|
|
|
| 7526 |
|
|
/* Get the address of our target into %r1. */
|
| 7527 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldil L'%0,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7528 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7529 |
|
|
|
| 7530 |
|
|
/* Get our return address into %r31. */
|
| 7531 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{bl|b,l} .+8,%%r31", xoperands);
|
| 7532 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addi 8,%%r31,%%r31", xoperands);
|
| 7533 |
|
|
|
| 7534 |
|
|
/* Jump to our target address in %r1. */
|
| 7535 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bv %%r0(%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7536 |
|
|
}
|
| 7537 |
|
|
else if (!flag_pic)
|
| 7538 |
|
|
{
|
| 7539 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldil L'%0,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7540 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PA_20)
|
| 7541 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("be,l R'%0(%%sr4,%%r1),%%sr0,%%r31", xoperands);
|
| 7542 |
|
|
else
|
| 7543 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ble R'%0(%%sr4,%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7544 |
|
|
}
|
| 7545 |
|
|
else
|
| 7546 |
|
|
{
|
| 7547 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{bl|b,l} .+8,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7548 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addi 16,%%r1,%%r31", xoperands);
|
| 7549 |
|
|
|
| 7550 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOM || !TARGET_GAS)
|
| 7551 |
|
|
{
|
| 7552 |
|
|
/* The HP assembler can generate relocations for the
|
| 7553 |
|
|
difference of two symbols. GAS can do this for a
|
| 7554 |
|
|
millicode symbol but not an arbitrary external
|
| 7555 |
|
|
symbol when generating SOM output. */
|
| 7556 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 7557 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "L",
|
| 7558 |
|
|
CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (xoperands[1]));
|
| 7559 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%0-%l1,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7560 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0-%l1(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7561 |
|
|
}
|
| 7562 |
|
|
else
|
| 7563 |
|
|
{
|
| 7564 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%0-$PIC_pcrel$0+8,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7565 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0-$PIC_pcrel$0+12(%%r1),%%r1",
|
| 7566 |
|
|
xoperands);
|
| 7567 |
|
|
}
|
| 7568 |
|
|
|
| 7569 |
|
|
/* Jump to our target address in %r1. */
|
| 7570 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bv %%r0(%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7571 |
|
|
}
|
| 7572 |
|
|
}
|
| 7573 |
|
|
|
| 7574 |
|
|
if (seq_length == 0)
|
| 7575 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("nop", xoperands);
|
| 7576 |
|
|
|
| 7577 |
|
|
/* We are done if there isn't a jump in the delay slot. */
|
| 7578 |
|
|
if (seq_length == 0 || GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (insn)) != JUMP_INSN)
|
| 7579 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 7580 |
|
|
|
| 7581 |
|
|
/* This call has an unconditional jump in its delay slot. */
|
| 7582 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = XEXP (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (insn)), 1);
|
| 7583 |
|
|
|
| 7584 |
|
|
/* See if the return address can be adjusted. Use the containing
|
| 7585 |
|
|
sequence insn's address. */
|
| 7586 |
|
|
if (INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ())
|
| 7587 |
|
|
{
|
| 7588 |
|
|
seq_insn = NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0)));
|
| 7589 |
|
|
distance = (INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (JUMP_LABEL (NEXT_INSN (insn))))
|
| 7590 |
|
|
- INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (seq_insn)) - 8);
|
| 7591 |
|
|
|
| 7592 |
|
|
if (VAL_14_BITS_P (distance))
|
| 7593 |
|
|
{
|
| 7594 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 7595 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo %0-%1(%2),%2", xoperands);
|
| 7596 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "L",
|
| 7597 |
|
|
CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (xoperands[1]));
|
| 7598 |
|
|
}
|
| 7599 |
|
|
else
|
| 7600 |
|
|
/* ??? This branch may not reach its target. */
|
| 7601 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("nop\n\tb,n %0", xoperands);
|
| 7602 |
|
|
}
|
| 7603 |
|
|
else
|
| 7604 |
|
|
/* ??? This branch may not reach its target. */
|
| 7605 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("nop\n\tb,n %0", xoperands);
|
| 7606 |
|
|
|
| 7607 |
|
|
/* Delete the jump. */
|
| 7608 |
|
|
SET_INSN_DELETED (NEXT_INSN (insn));
|
| 7609 |
|
|
|
| 7610 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 7611 |
|
|
}
|
| 7612 |
|
|
|
| 7613 |
|
|
/* Return the attribute length of the call instruction INSN. The SIBCALL
|
| 7614 |
|
|
flag indicates whether INSN is a regular call or a sibling call. The
|
| 7615 |
|
|
length returned must be longer than the code actually generated by
|
| 7616 |
|
|
pa_output_call. Since branch shortening is done before delay branch
|
| 7617 |
|
|
sequencing, there is no way to determine whether or not the delay
|
| 7618 |
|
|
slot will be filled during branch shortening. Even when the delay
|
| 7619 |
|
|
slot is filled, we may have to add a nop if the delay slot contains
|
| 7620 |
|
|
a branch that can't reach its target. Thus, we always have to include
|
| 7621 |
|
|
the delay slot in the length estimate. This used to be done in
|
| 7622 |
|
|
pa_adjust_insn_length but we do it here now as some sequences always
|
| 7623 |
|
|
fill the delay slot and we can save four bytes in the estimate for
|
| 7624 |
|
|
these sequences. */
|
| 7625 |
|
|
|
| 7626 |
|
|
int
|
| 7627 |
|
|
pa_attr_length_call (rtx insn, int sibcall)
|
| 7628 |
|
|
{
|
| 7629 |
|
|
int local_call;
|
| 7630 |
|
|
rtx call, call_dest;
|
| 7631 |
|
|
tree call_decl;
|
| 7632 |
|
|
int length = 0;
|
| 7633 |
|
|
rtx pat = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 7634 |
|
|
unsigned long distance = -1;
|
| 7635 |
|
|
|
| 7636 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN);
|
| 7637 |
|
|
|
| 7638 |
|
|
if (INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ())
|
| 7639 |
|
|
{
|
| 7640 |
|
|
unsigned long total;
|
| 7641 |
|
|
|
| 7642 |
|
|
total = IN_NAMED_SECTION_P (cfun->decl) ? 0 : total_code_bytes;
|
| 7643 |
|
|
distance = (total + insn_current_reference_address (insn));
|
| 7644 |
|
|
if (distance < total)
|
| 7645 |
|
|
distance = -1;
|
| 7646 |
|
|
}
|
| 7647 |
|
|
|
| 7648 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL);
|
| 7649 |
|
|
|
| 7650 |
|
|
/* Get the call rtx. */
|
| 7651 |
|
|
call = XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0);
|
| 7652 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (call) == SET)
|
| 7653 |
|
|
call = SET_SRC (call);
|
| 7654 |
|
|
|
| 7655 |
|
|
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (call) == CALL);
|
| 7656 |
|
|
|
| 7657 |
|
|
/* Determine if this is a local call. */
|
| 7658 |
|
|
call_dest = XEXP (XEXP (call, 0), 0);
|
| 7659 |
|
|
call_decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (call_dest);
|
| 7660 |
|
|
local_call = call_decl && targetm.binds_local_p (call_decl);
|
| 7661 |
|
|
|
| 7662 |
|
|
/* pc-relative branch. */
|
| 7663 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_LONG_CALLS
|
| 7664 |
|
|
&& ((TARGET_PA_20 && !sibcall && distance < 7600000)
|
| 7665 |
|
|
|| distance < 240000))
|
| 7666 |
|
|
length += 8;
|
| 7667 |
|
|
|
| 7668 |
|
|
/* 64-bit plabel sequence. */
|
| 7669 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_64BIT && !local_call)
|
| 7670 |
|
|
length += sibcall ? 28 : 24;
|
| 7671 |
|
|
|
| 7672 |
|
|
/* non-pic long absolute branch sequence. */
|
| 7673 |
|
|
else if ((TARGET_LONG_ABS_CALL || local_call) && !flag_pic)
|
| 7674 |
|
|
length += 12;
|
| 7675 |
|
|
|
| 7676 |
|
|
/* long pc-relative branch sequence. */
|
| 7677 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_LONG_PIC_SDIFF_CALL
|
| 7678 |
|
|
|| (TARGET_GAS && !TARGET_SOM
|
| 7679 |
|
|
&& (TARGET_LONG_PIC_PCREL_CALL || local_call)))
|
| 7680 |
|
|
{
|
| 7681 |
|
|
length += 20;
|
| 7682 |
|
|
|
| 7683 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_PA_20 && !TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS && (!local_call || flag_pic))
|
| 7684 |
|
|
length += 8;
|
| 7685 |
|
|
}
|
| 7686 |
|
|
|
| 7687 |
|
|
/* 32-bit plabel sequence. */
|
| 7688 |
|
|
else
|
| 7689 |
|
|
{
|
| 7690 |
|
|
length += 32;
|
| 7691 |
|
|
|
| 7692 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOM)
|
| 7693 |
|
|
length += length_fp_args (insn);
|
| 7694 |
|
|
|
| 7695 |
|
|
if (flag_pic)
|
| 7696 |
|
|
length += 4;
|
| 7697 |
|
|
|
| 7698 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_PA_20)
|
| 7699 |
|
|
{
|
| 7700 |
|
|
if (!sibcall)
|
| 7701 |
|
|
length += 8;
|
| 7702 |
|
|
|
| 7703 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS && (!local_call || flag_pic))
|
| 7704 |
|
|
length += 8;
|
| 7705 |
|
|
}
|
| 7706 |
|
|
}
|
| 7707 |
|
|
|
| 7708 |
|
|
return length;
|
| 7709 |
|
|
}
|
| 7710 |
|
|
|
| 7711 |
|
|
/* INSN is a function call. It may have an unconditional jump
|
| 7712 |
|
|
in its delay slot.
|
| 7713 |
|
|
|
| 7714 |
|
|
CALL_DEST is the routine we are calling. */
|
| 7715 |
|
|
|
| 7716 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 7717 |
|
|
pa_output_call (rtx insn, rtx call_dest, int sibcall)
|
| 7718 |
|
|
{
|
| 7719 |
|
|
int delay_insn_deleted = 0;
|
| 7720 |
|
|
int delay_slot_filled = 0;
|
| 7721 |
|
|
int seq_length = dbr_sequence_length ();
|
| 7722 |
|
|
tree call_decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (call_dest);
|
| 7723 |
|
|
int local_call = call_decl && targetm.binds_local_p (call_decl);
|
| 7724 |
|
|
rtx xoperands[2];
|
| 7725 |
|
|
|
| 7726 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = call_dest;
|
| 7727 |
|
|
|
| 7728 |
|
|
/* Handle the common case where we're sure that the branch will reach
|
| 7729 |
|
|
the beginning of the "$CODE$" subspace. This is the beginning of
|
| 7730 |
|
|
the current function if we are in a named section. */
|
| 7731 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_LONG_CALLS && pa_attr_length_call (insn, sibcall) == 8)
|
| 7732 |
|
|
{
|
| 7733 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, sibcall ? 0 : 2);
|
| 7734 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{bl|b,l} %0,%1", xoperands);
|
| 7735 |
|
|
}
|
| 7736 |
|
|
else
|
| 7737 |
|
|
{
|
| 7738 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT && !local_call)
|
| 7739 |
|
|
{
|
| 7740 |
|
|
/* ??? As far as I can tell, the HP linker doesn't support the
|
| 7741 |
|
|
long pc-relative sequence described in the 64-bit runtime
|
| 7742 |
|
|
architecture. So, we use a slightly longer indirect call. */
|
| 7743 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = pa_get_deferred_plabel (call_dest);
|
| 7744 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 7745 |
|
|
|
| 7746 |
|
|
/* If this isn't a sibcall, we put the load of %r27 into the
|
| 7747 |
|
|
delay slot. We can't do this in a sibcall as we don't
|
| 7748 |
|
|
have a second call-clobbered scratch register available. */
|
| 7749 |
|
|
if (seq_length != 0
|
| 7750 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (insn)) != JUMP_INSN
|
| 7751 |
|
|
&& !sibcall)
|
| 7752 |
|
|
{
|
| 7753 |
|
|
final_scan_insn (NEXT_INSN (insn), asm_out_file,
|
| 7754 |
|
|
optimize, 0, NULL);
|
| 7755 |
|
|
|
| 7756 |
|
|
/* Now delete the delay insn. */
|
| 7757 |
|
|
SET_INSN_DELETED (NEXT_INSN (insn));
|
| 7758 |
|
|
delay_insn_deleted = 1;
|
| 7759 |
|
|
}
|
| 7760 |
|
|
|
| 7761 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil LT'%0,%%r27", xoperands);
|
| 7762 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd RT'%0(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7763 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd 0(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7764 |
|
|
|
| 7765 |
|
|
if (sibcall)
|
| 7766 |
|
|
{
|
| 7767 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd 24(%%r1),%%r27", xoperands);
|
| 7768 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd 16(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7769 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bve (%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7770 |
|
|
}
|
| 7771 |
|
|
else
|
| 7772 |
|
|
{
|
| 7773 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd 16(%%r1),%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7774 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bve,l (%%r2),%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7775 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd 24(%%r1),%%r27", xoperands);
|
| 7776 |
|
|
delay_slot_filled = 1;
|
| 7777 |
|
|
}
|
| 7778 |
|
|
}
|
| 7779 |
|
|
else
|
| 7780 |
|
|
{
|
| 7781 |
|
|
int indirect_call = 0;
|
| 7782 |
|
|
|
| 7783 |
|
|
/* Emit a long call. There are several different sequences
|
| 7784 |
|
|
of increasing length and complexity. In most cases,
|
| 7785 |
|
|
they don't allow an instruction in the delay slot. */
|
| 7786 |
|
|
if (!((TARGET_LONG_ABS_CALL || local_call) && !flag_pic)
|
| 7787 |
|
|
&& !TARGET_LONG_PIC_SDIFF_CALL
|
| 7788 |
|
|
&& !(TARGET_GAS && !TARGET_SOM
|
| 7789 |
|
|
&& (TARGET_LONG_PIC_PCREL_CALL || local_call))
|
| 7790 |
|
|
&& !TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 7791 |
|
|
indirect_call = 1;
|
| 7792 |
|
|
|
| 7793 |
|
|
if (seq_length != 0
|
| 7794 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (insn)) != JUMP_INSN
|
| 7795 |
|
|
&& !sibcall
|
| 7796 |
|
|
&& (!TARGET_PA_20
|
| 7797 |
|
|
|| indirect_call
|
| 7798 |
|
|
|| ((TARGET_LONG_ABS_CALL || local_call) && !flag_pic)))
|
| 7799 |
|
|
{
|
| 7800 |
|
|
/* A non-jump insn in the delay slot. By definition we can
|
| 7801 |
|
|
emit this insn before the call (and in fact before argument
|
| 7802 |
|
|
relocating. */
|
| 7803 |
|
|
final_scan_insn (NEXT_INSN (insn), asm_out_file, optimize, 0,
|
| 7804 |
|
|
NULL);
|
| 7805 |
|
|
|
| 7806 |
|
|
/* Now delete the delay insn. */
|
| 7807 |
|
|
SET_INSN_DELETED (NEXT_INSN (insn));
|
| 7808 |
|
|
delay_insn_deleted = 1;
|
| 7809 |
|
|
}
|
| 7810 |
|
|
|
| 7811 |
|
|
if ((TARGET_LONG_ABS_CALL || local_call) && !flag_pic)
|
| 7812 |
|
|
{
|
| 7813 |
|
|
/* This is the best sequence for making long calls in
|
| 7814 |
|
|
non-pic code. Unfortunately, GNU ld doesn't provide
|
| 7815 |
|
|
the stub needed for external calls, and GAS's support
|
| 7816 |
|
|
for this with the SOM linker is buggy. It is safe
|
| 7817 |
|
|
to use this for local calls. */
|
| 7818 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldil L'%0,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7819 |
|
|
if (sibcall)
|
| 7820 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("be R'%0(%%sr4,%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7821 |
|
|
else
|
| 7822 |
|
|
{
|
| 7823 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PA_20)
|
| 7824 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("be,l R'%0(%%sr4,%%r1),%%sr0,%%r31",
|
| 7825 |
|
|
xoperands);
|
| 7826 |
|
|
else
|
| 7827 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ble R'%0(%%sr4,%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7828 |
|
|
|
| 7829 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("copy %%r31,%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7830 |
|
|
delay_slot_filled = 1;
|
| 7831 |
|
|
}
|
| 7832 |
|
|
}
|
| 7833 |
|
|
else
|
| 7834 |
|
|
{
|
| 7835 |
|
|
if (TARGET_LONG_PIC_SDIFF_CALL)
|
| 7836 |
|
|
{
|
| 7837 |
|
|
/* The HP assembler and linker can handle relocations
|
| 7838 |
|
|
for the difference of two symbols. The HP assembler
|
| 7839 |
|
|
recognizes the sequence as a pc-relative call and
|
| 7840 |
|
|
the linker provides stubs when needed. */
|
| 7841 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 7842 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{bl|b,l} .+8,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7843 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%0-%l1,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7844 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "L",
|
| 7845 |
|
|
CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (xoperands[1]));
|
| 7846 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0-%l1(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7847 |
|
|
}
|
| 7848 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_GAS && !TARGET_SOM
|
| 7849 |
|
|
&& (TARGET_LONG_PIC_PCREL_CALL || local_call))
|
| 7850 |
|
|
{
|
| 7851 |
|
|
/* GAS currently can't generate the relocations that
|
| 7852 |
|
|
are needed for the SOM linker under HP-UX using this
|
| 7853 |
|
|
sequence. The GNU linker doesn't generate the stubs
|
| 7854 |
|
|
that are needed for external calls on TARGET_ELF32
|
| 7855 |
|
|
with this sequence. For now, we have to use a
|
| 7856 |
|
|
longer plabel sequence when using GAS. */
|
| 7857 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{bl|b,l} .+8,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7858 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%0-$PIC_pcrel$0+4,%%r1",
|
| 7859 |
|
|
xoperands);
|
| 7860 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0-$PIC_pcrel$0+8(%%r1),%%r1",
|
| 7861 |
|
|
xoperands);
|
| 7862 |
|
|
}
|
| 7863 |
|
|
else
|
| 7864 |
|
|
{
|
| 7865 |
|
|
/* Emit a long plabel-based call sequence. This is
|
| 7866 |
|
|
essentially an inline implementation of $$dyncall.
|
| 7867 |
|
|
We don't actually try to call $$dyncall as this is
|
| 7868 |
|
|
as difficult as calling the function itself. */
|
| 7869 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = pa_get_deferred_plabel (call_dest);
|
| 7870 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 7871 |
|
|
|
| 7872 |
|
|
/* Since the call is indirect, FP arguments in registers
|
| 7873 |
|
|
need to be copied to the general registers. Then, the
|
| 7874 |
|
|
argument relocation stub will copy them back. */
|
| 7875 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOM)
|
| 7876 |
|
|
copy_fp_args (insn);
|
| 7877 |
|
|
|
| 7878 |
|
|
if (flag_pic)
|
| 7879 |
|
|
{
|
| 7880 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil LT'%0,%%r19", xoperands);
|
| 7881 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw RT'%0(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7882 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw 0(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7883 |
|
|
}
|
| 7884 |
|
|
else
|
| 7885 |
|
|
{
|
| 7886 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil LR'%0-$global$,%%r27",
|
| 7887 |
|
|
xoperands);
|
| 7888 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw RR'%0-$global$(%%r1),%%r1",
|
| 7889 |
|
|
xoperands);
|
| 7890 |
|
|
}
|
| 7891 |
|
|
|
| 7892 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bb,>=,n %%r1,30,.+16", xoperands);
|
| 7893 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("depi 0,31,2,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7894 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw 4(%%sr0,%%r1),%%r19", xoperands);
|
| 7895 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw 0(%%sr0,%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 7896 |
|
|
|
| 7897 |
|
|
if (!sibcall && !TARGET_PA_20)
|
| 7898 |
|
|
{
|
| 7899 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{bl|b,l} .+8,%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7900 |
|
|
if (TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS || (local_call && !flag_pic))
|
| 7901 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addi 8,%%r2,%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7902 |
|
|
else
|
| 7903 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addi 16,%%r2,%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7904 |
|
|
}
|
| 7905 |
|
|
}
|
| 7906 |
|
|
|
| 7907 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PA_20)
|
| 7908 |
|
|
{
|
| 7909 |
|
|
if (sibcall)
|
| 7910 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bve (%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7911 |
|
|
else
|
| 7912 |
|
|
{
|
| 7913 |
|
|
if (indirect_call)
|
| 7914 |
|
|
{
|
| 7915 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bve,l (%%r1),%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7916 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stw %%r2,-24(%%sp)", xoperands);
|
| 7917 |
|
|
delay_slot_filled = 1;
|
| 7918 |
|
|
}
|
| 7919 |
|
|
else
|
| 7920 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bve,l (%%r1),%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7921 |
|
|
}
|
| 7922 |
|
|
}
|
| 7923 |
|
|
else
|
| 7924 |
|
|
{
|
| 7925 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS && (!local_call || flag_pic))
|
| 7926 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldsid (%%r1),%%r31\n\tmtsp %%r31,%%sr0",
|
| 7927 |
|
|
xoperands);
|
| 7928 |
|
|
|
| 7929 |
|
|
if (sibcall)
|
| 7930 |
|
|
{
|
| 7931 |
|
|
if (TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS || (local_call && !flag_pic))
|
| 7932 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("be 0(%%sr4,%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7933 |
|
|
else
|
| 7934 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("be 0(%%sr0,%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7935 |
|
|
}
|
| 7936 |
|
|
else
|
| 7937 |
|
|
{
|
| 7938 |
|
|
if (TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS || (local_call && !flag_pic))
|
| 7939 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ble 0(%%sr4,%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7940 |
|
|
else
|
| 7941 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ble 0(%%sr0,%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 7942 |
|
|
|
| 7943 |
|
|
if (indirect_call)
|
| 7944 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("stw %%r31,-24(%%sp)", xoperands);
|
| 7945 |
|
|
else
|
| 7946 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("copy %%r31,%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7947 |
|
|
delay_slot_filled = 1;
|
| 7948 |
|
|
}
|
| 7949 |
|
|
}
|
| 7950 |
|
|
}
|
| 7951 |
|
|
}
|
| 7952 |
|
|
}
|
| 7953 |
|
|
|
| 7954 |
|
|
if (!delay_slot_filled && (seq_length == 0 || delay_insn_deleted))
|
| 7955 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("nop", xoperands);
|
| 7956 |
|
|
|
| 7957 |
|
|
/* We are done if there isn't a jump in the delay slot. */
|
| 7958 |
|
|
if (seq_length == 0
|
| 7959 |
|
|
|| delay_insn_deleted
|
| 7960 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (NEXT_INSN (insn)) != JUMP_INSN)
|
| 7961 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 7962 |
|
|
|
| 7963 |
|
|
/* A sibcall should never have a branch in the delay slot. */
|
| 7964 |
|
|
gcc_assert (!sibcall);
|
| 7965 |
|
|
|
| 7966 |
|
|
/* This call has an unconditional jump in its delay slot. */
|
| 7967 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = XEXP (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (insn)), 1);
|
| 7968 |
|
|
|
| 7969 |
|
|
if (!delay_slot_filled && INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ())
|
| 7970 |
|
|
{
|
| 7971 |
|
|
/* See if the return address can be adjusted. Use the containing
|
| 7972 |
|
|
sequence insn's address. This would break the regular call/return@
|
| 7973 |
|
|
relationship assumed by the table based eh unwinder, so only do that
|
| 7974 |
|
|
if the call is not possibly throwing. */
|
| 7975 |
|
|
rtx seq_insn = NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0)));
|
| 7976 |
|
|
int distance = (INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (JUMP_LABEL (NEXT_INSN (insn))))
|
| 7977 |
|
|
- INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (seq_insn)) - 8);
|
| 7978 |
|
|
|
| 7979 |
|
|
if (VAL_14_BITS_P (distance)
|
| 7980 |
|
|
&& !(can_throw_internal (insn) || can_throw_external (insn)))
|
| 7981 |
|
|
{
|
| 7982 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 7983 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo %0-%1(%%r2),%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 7984 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "L",
|
| 7985 |
|
|
CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (xoperands[1]));
|
| 7986 |
|
|
}
|
| 7987 |
|
|
else
|
| 7988 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("nop\n\tb,n %0", xoperands);
|
| 7989 |
|
|
}
|
| 7990 |
|
|
else
|
| 7991 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("b,n %0", xoperands);
|
| 7992 |
|
|
|
| 7993 |
|
|
/* Delete the jump. */
|
| 7994 |
|
|
SET_INSN_DELETED (NEXT_INSN (insn));
|
| 7995 |
|
|
|
| 7996 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 7997 |
|
|
}
|
| 7998 |
|
|
|
| 7999 |
|
|
/* Return the attribute length of the indirect call instruction INSN.
|
| 8000 |
|
|
The length must match the code generated by output_indirect call.
|
| 8001 |
|
|
The returned length includes the delay slot. Currently, the delay
|
| 8002 |
|
|
slot of an indirect call sequence is not exposed and it is used by
|
| 8003 |
|
|
the sequence itself. */
|
| 8004 |
|
|
|
| 8005 |
|
|
int
|
| 8006 |
|
|
pa_attr_length_indirect_call (rtx insn)
|
| 8007 |
|
|
{
|
| 8008 |
|
|
unsigned long distance = -1;
|
| 8009 |
|
|
unsigned long total = IN_NAMED_SECTION_P (cfun->decl) ? 0 : total_code_bytes;
|
| 8010 |
|
|
|
| 8011 |
|
|
if (INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ())
|
| 8012 |
|
|
{
|
| 8013 |
|
|
distance = (total + insn_current_reference_address (insn));
|
| 8014 |
|
|
if (distance < total)
|
| 8015 |
|
|
distance = -1;
|
| 8016 |
|
|
}
|
| 8017 |
|
|
|
| 8018 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 8019 |
|
|
return 12;
|
| 8020 |
|
|
|
| 8021 |
|
|
if (TARGET_FAST_INDIRECT_CALLS
|
| 8022 |
|
|
|| (!TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME
|
| 8023 |
|
|
&& ((TARGET_PA_20 && !TARGET_SOM && distance < 7600000)
|
| 8024 |
|
|
|| distance < 240000)))
|
| 8025 |
|
|
return 8;
|
| 8026 |
|
|
|
| 8027 |
|
|
if (flag_pic)
|
| 8028 |
|
|
return 24;
|
| 8029 |
|
|
|
| 8030 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME)
|
| 8031 |
|
|
return 20;
|
| 8032 |
|
|
|
| 8033 |
|
|
/* Out of reach, can use ble. */
|
| 8034 |
|
|
return 12;
|
| 8035 |
|
|
}
|
| 8036 |
|
|
|
| 8037 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 8038 |
|
|
pa_output_indirect_call (rtx insn, rtx call_dest)
|
| 8039 |
|
|
{
|
| 8040 |
|
|
rtx xoperands[1];
|
| 8041 |
|
|
|
| 8042 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 8043 |
|
|
{
|
| 8044 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = call_dest;
|
| 8045 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldd 16(%0),%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 8046 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bve,l (%%r2),%%r2\n\tldd 24(%0),%%r27", xoperands);
|
| 8047 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 8048 |
|
|
}
|
| 8049 |
|
|
|
| 8050 |
|
|
/* First the special case for kernels, level 0 systems, etc. */
|
| 8051 |
|
|
if (TARGET_FAST_INDIRECT_CALLS)
|
| 8052 |
|
|
return "ble 0(%%sr4,%%r22)\n\tcopy %%r31,%%r2";
|
| 8053 |
|
|
|
| 8054 |
|
|
/* Now the normal case -- we can reach $$dyncall directly or
|
| 8055 |
|
|
we're sure that we can get there via a long-branch stub.
|
| 8056 |
|
|
|
| 8057 |
|
|
No need to check target flags as the length uniquely identifies
|
| 8058 |
|
|
the remaining cases. */
|
| 8059 |
|
|
if (pa_attr_length_indirect_call (insn) == 8)
|
| 8060 |
|
|
{
|
| 8061 |
|
|
/* The HP linker sometimes substitutes a BLE for BL/B,L calls to
|
| 8062 |
|
|
$$dyncall. Since BLE uses %r31 as the link register, the 22-bit
|
| 8063 |
|
|
variant of the B,L instruction can't be used on the SOM target. */
|
| 8064 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PA_20 && !TARGET_SOM)
|
| 8065 |
|
|
return ".CALL\tARGW0=GR\n\tb,l $$dyncall,%%r2\n\tcopy %%r2,%%r31";
|
| 8066 |
|
|
else
|
| 8067 |
|
|
return ".CALL\tARGW0=GR\n\tbl $$dyncall,%%r31\n\tcopy %%r31,%%r2";
|
| 8068 |
|
|
}
|
| 8069 |
|
|
|
| 8070 |
|
|
/* Long millicode call, but we are not generating PIC or portable runtime
|
| 8071 |
|
|
code. */
|
| 8072 |
|
|
if (pa_attr_length_indirect_call (insn) == 12)
|
| 8073 |
|
|
return ".CALL\tARGW0=GR\n\tldil L'$$dyncall,%%r2\n\tble R'$$dyncall(%%sr4,%%r2)\n\tcopy %%r31,%%r2";
|
| 8074 |
|
|
|
| 8075 |
|
|
/* Long millicode call for portable runtime. */
|
| 8076 |
|
|
if (pa_attr_length_indirect_call (insn) == 20)
|
| 8077 |
|
|
return "ldil L'$$dyncall,%%r31\n\tldo R'$$dyncall(%%r31),%%r31\n\tblr %%r0,%%r2\n\tbv,n %%r0(%%r31)\n\tnop";
|
| 8078 |
|
|
|
| 8079 |
|
|
/* We need a long PIC call to $$dyncall. */
|
| 8080 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = NULL_RTX;
|
| 8081 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{bl|b,l} .+8,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8082 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOM || !TARGET_GAS)
|
| 8083 |
|
|
{
|
| 8084 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 8085 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'$$dyncall-%0,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8086 |
|
|
targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "L",
|
| 8087 |
|
|
CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (xoperands[0]));
|
| 8088 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'$$dyncall-%0(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8089 |
|
|
}
|
| 8090 |
|
|
else
|
| 8091 |
|
|
{
|
| 8092 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'$$dyncall-$PIC_pcrel$0+4,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8093 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'$$dyncall-$PIC_pcrel$0+8(%%r1),%%r1",
|
| 8094 |
|
|
xoperands);
|
| 8095 |
|
|
}
|
| 8096 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("blr %%r0,%%r2", xoperands);
|
| 8097 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bv,n %%r0(%%r1)\n\tnop", xoperands);
|
| 8098 |
|
|
return "";
|
| 8099 |
|
|
}
|
| 8100 |
|
|
|
| 8101 |
|
|
/* In HPUX 8.0's shared library scheme, special relocations are needed
|
| 8102 |
|
|
for function labels if they might be passed to a function
|
| 8103 |
|
|
in a shared library (because shared libraries don't live in code
|
| 8104 |
|
|
space), and special magic is needed to construct their address. */
|
| 8105 |
|
|
|
| 8106 |
|
|
void
|
| 8107 |
|
|
pa_encode_label (rtx sym)
|
| 8108 |
|
|
{
|
| 8109 |
|
|
const char *str = XSTR (sym, 0);
|
| 8110 |
|
|
int len = strlen (str) + 1;
|
| 8111 |
|
|
char *newstr, *p;
|
| 8112 |
|
|
|
| 8113 |
|
|
p = newstr = XALLOCAVEC (char, len + 1);
|
| 8114 |
|
|
*p++ = '@';
|
| 8115 |
|
|
strcpy (p, str);
|
| 8116 |
|
|
|
| 8117 |
|
|
XSTR (sym, 0) = ggc_alloc_string (newstr, len);
|
| 8118 |
|
|
}
|
| 8119 |
|
|
|
| 8120 |
|
|
static void
|
| 8121 |
|
|
pa_encode_section_info (tree decl, rtx rtl, int first)
|
| 8122 |
|
|
{
|
| 8123 |
|
|
int old_referenced = 0;
|
| 8124 |
|
|
|
| 8125 |
|
|
if (!first && MEM_P (rtl) && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
|
| 8126 |
|
|
old_referenced
|
| 8127 |
|
|
= SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & SYMBOL_FLAG_REFERENCED;
|
| 8128 |
|
|
|
| 8129 |
|
|
default_encode_section_info (decl, rtl, first);
|
| 8130 |
|
|
|
| 8131 |
|
|
if (first && TEXT_SPACE_P (decl))
|
| 8132 |
|
|
{
|
| 8133 |
|
|
SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (XEXP (rtl, 0)) = 1;
|
| 8134 |
|
|
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
|
| 8135 |
|
|
pa_encode_label (XEXP (rtl, 0));
|
| 8136 |
|
|
}
|
| 8137 |
|
|
else if (old_referenced)
|
| 8138 |
|
|
SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (XEXP (rtl, 0)) |= old_referenced;
|
| 8139 |
|
|
}
|
| 8140 |
|
|
|
| 8141 |
|
|
/* This is sort of inverse to pa_encode_section_info. */
|
| 8142 |
|
|
|
| 8143 |
|
|
static const char *
|
| 8144 |
|
|
pa_strip_name_encoding (const char *str)
|
| 8145 |
|
|
{
|
| 8146 |
|
|
str += (*str == '@');
|
| 8147 |
|
|
str += (*str == '*');
|
| 8148 |
|
|
return str;
|
| 8149 |
|
|
}
|
| 8150 |
|
|
|
| 8151 |
|
|
/* Returns 1 if OP is a function label involved in a simple addition
|
| 8152 |
|
|
with a constant. Used to keep certain patterns from matching
|
| 8153 |
|
|
during instruction combination. */
|
| 8154 |
|
|
int
|
| 8155 |
|
|
pa_is_function_label_plus_const (rtx op)
|
| 8156 |
|
|
{
|
| 8157 |
|
|
/* Strip off any CONST. */
|
| 8158 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST)
|
| 8159 |
|
|
op = XEXP (op, 0);
|
| 8160 |
|
|
|
| 8161 |
|
|
return (GET_CODE (op) == PLUS
|
| 8162 |
|
|
&& function_label_operand (XEXP (op, 0), VOIDmode)
|
| 8163 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 1)) == CONST_INT);
|
| 8164 |
|
|
}
|
| 8165 |
|
|
|
| 8166 |
|
|
/* Output assembly code for a thunk to FUNCTION. */
|
| 8167 |
|
|
|
| 8168 |
|
|
static void
|
| 8169 |
|
|
pa_asm_output_mi_thunk (FILE *file, tree thunk_fndecl, HOST_WIDE_INT delta,
|
| 8170 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 8171 |
|
|
tree function)
|
| 8172 |
|
|
{
|
| 8173 |
|
|
static unsigned int current_thunk_number;
|
| 8174 |
|
|
int val_14 = VAL_14_BITS_P (delta);
|
| 8175 |
|
|
unsigned int old_last_address = last_address, nbytes = 0;
|
| 8176 |
|
|
char label[16];
|
| 8177 |
|
|
rtx xoperands[4];
|
| 8178 |
|
|
|
| 8179 |
|
|
xoperands[0] = XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0);
|
| 8180 |
|
|
xoperands[1] = XEXP (DECL_RTL (thunk_fndecl), 0);
|
| 8181 |
|
|
xoperands[2] = GEN_INT (delta);
|
| 8182 |
|
|
|
| 8183 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (file, XSTR (xoperands[1], 0));
|
| 8184 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "\t.PROC\n\t.CALLINFO FRAME=0,NO_CALLS\n\t.ENTRY\n");
|
| 8185 |
|
|
|
| 8186 |
|
|
/* Output the thunk. We know that the function is in the same
|
| 8187 |
|
|
translation unit (i.e., the same space) as the thunk, and that
|
| 8188 |
|
|
thunks are output after their method. Thus, we don't need an
|
| 8189 |
|
|
external branch to reach the function. With SOM and GAS,
|
| 8190 |
|
|
functions and thunks are effectively in different sections.
|
| 8191 |
|
|
Thus, we can always use a IA-relative branch and the linker
|
| 8192 |
|
|
will add a long branch stub if necessary.
|
| 8193 |
|
|
|
| 8194 |
|
|
However, we have to be careful when generating PIC code on the
|
| 8195 |
|
|
SOM port to ensure that the sequence does not transfer to an
|
| 8196 |
|
|
import stub for the target function as this could clobber the
|
| 8197 |
|
|
return value saved at SP-24. This would also apply to the
|
| 8198 |
|
|
32-bit linux port if the multi-space model is implemented. */
|
| 8199 |
|
|
if ((!TARGET_LONG_CALLS && TARGET_SOM && !TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME
|
| 8200 |
|
|
&& !(flag_pic && TREE_PUBLIC (function))
|
| 8201 |
|
|
&& (TARGET_GAS || last_address < 262132))
|
| 8202 |
|
|
|| (!TARGET_LONG_CALLS && !TARGET_SOM && !TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME
|
| 8203 |
|
|
&& ((targetm_common.have_named_sections
|
| 8204 |
|
|
&& DECL_SECTION_NAME (thunk_fndecl) != NULL
|
| 8205 |
|
|
/* The GNU 64-bit linker has rather poor stub management.
|
| 8206 |
|
|
So, we use a long branch from thunks that aren't in
|
| 8207 |
|
|
the same section as the target function. */
|
| 8208 |
|
|
&& ((!TARGET_64BIT
|
| 8209 |
|
|
&& (DECL_SECTION_NAME (thunk_fndecl)
|
| 8210 |
|
|
!= DECL_SECTION_NAME (function)))
|
| 8211 |
|
|
|| ((DECL_SECTION_NAME (thunk_fndecl)
|
| 8212 |
|
|
== DECL_SECTION_NAME (function))
|
| 8213 |
|
|
&& last_address < 262132)))
|
| 8214 |
|
|
|| (targetm_common.have_named_sections
|
| 8215 |
|
|
&& DECL_SECTION_NAME (thunk_fndecl) == NULL
|
| 8216 |
|
|
&& DECL_SECTION_NAME (function) == NULL
|
| 8217 |
|
|
&& last_address < 262132)
|
| 8218 |
|
|
|| (!targetm_common.have_named_sections
|
| 8219 |
|
|
&& last_address < 262132))))
|
| 8220 |
|
|
{
|
| 8221 |
|
|
if (!val_14)
|
| 8222 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%2,%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8223 |
|
|
|
| 8224 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("b %0", xoperands);
|
| 8225 |
|
|
|
| 8226 |
|
|
if (val_14)
|
| 8227 |
|
|
{
|
| 8228 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo %2(%%r26),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8229 |
|
|
nbytes += 8;
|
| 8230 |
|
|
}
|
| 8231 |
|
|
else
|
| 8232 |
|
|
{
|
| 8233 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%2(%%r1),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8234 |
|
|
nbytes += 12;
|
| 8235 |
|
|
}
|
| 8236 |
|
|
}
|
| 8237 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 8238 |
|
|
{
|
| 8239 |
|
|
/* We only have one call-clobbered scratch register, so we can't
|
| 8240 |
|
|
make use of the delay slot if delta doesn't fit in 14 bits. */
|
| 8241 |
|
|
if (!val_14)
|
| 8242 |
|
|
{
|
| 8243 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%2,%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8244 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%2(%%r1),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8245 |
|
|
}
|
| 8246 |
|
|
|
| 8247 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("b,l .+8,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8248 |
|
|
|
| 8249 |
|
|
if (TARGET_GAS)
|
| 8250 |
|
|
{
|
| 8251 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%0-$PIC_pcrel$0+4,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8252 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0-$PIC_pcrel$0+8(%%r1),%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8253 |
|
|
}
|
| 8254 |
|
|
else
|
| 8255 |
|
|
{
|
| 8256 |
|
|
xoperands[3] = GEN_INT (val_14 ? 8 : 16);
|
| 8257 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%0-%1-%3,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8258 |
|
|
}
|
| 8259 |
|
|
|
| 8260 |
|
|
if (val_14)
|
| 8261 |
|
|
{
|
| 8262 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bv %%r0(%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 8263 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo %2(%%r26),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8264 |
|
|
nbytes += 20;
|
| 8265 |
|
|
}
|
| 8266 |
|
|
else
|
| 8267 |
|
|
{
|
| 8268 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bv,n %%r0(%%r1)", xoperands);
|
| 8269 |
|
|
nbytes += 24;
|
| 8270 |
|
|
}
|
| 8271 |
|
|
}
|
| 8272 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME)
|
| 8273 |
|
|
{
|
| 8274 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldil L'%0,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8275 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0(%%r1),%%r22", xoperands);
|
| 8276 |
|
|
|
| 8277 |
|
|
if (!val_14)
|
| 8278 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%2,%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8279 |
|
|
|
| 8280 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bv %%r0(%%r22)", xoperands);
|
| 8281 |
|
|
|
| 8282 |
|
|
if (val_14)
|
| 8283 |
|
|
{
|
| 8284 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo %2(%%r26),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8285 |
|
|
nbytes += 16;
|
| 8286 |
|
|
}
|
| 8287 |
|
|
else
|
| 8288 |
|
|
{
|
| 8289 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%2(%%r1),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8290 |
|
|
nbytes += 20;
|
| 8291 |
|
|
}
|
| 8292 |
|
|
}
|
| 8293 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_SOM && flag_pic && TREE_PUBLIC (function))
|
| 8294 |
|
|
{
|
| 8295 |
|
|
/* The function is accessible from outside this module. The only
|
| 8296 |
|
|
way to avoid an import stub between the thunk and function is to
|
| 8297 |
|
|
call the function directly with an indirect sequence similar to
|
| 8298 |
|
|
that used by $$dyncall. This is possible because $$dyncall acts
|
| 8299 |
|
|
as the import stub in an indirect call. */
|
| 8300 |
|
|
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LTHN", current_thunk_number);
|
| 8301 |
|
|
xoperands[3] = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, label);
|
| 8302 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil LT'%3,%%r19", xoperands);
|
| 8303 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw RT'%3(%%r1),%%r22", xoperands);
|
| 8304 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw 0(%%sr0,%%r22),%%r22", xoperands);
|
| 8305 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bb,>=,n %%r22,30,.+16", xoperands);
|
| 8306 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("depi 0,31,2,%%r22", xoperands);
|
| 8307 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw 4(%%sr0,%%r22),%%r19", xoperands);
|
| 8308 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldw 0(%%sr0,%%r22),%%r22", xoperands);
|
| 8309 |
|
|
|
| 8310 |
|
|
if (!val_14)
|
| 8311 |
|
|
{
|
| 8312 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%2,%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8313 |
|
|
nbytes += 4;
|
| 8314 |
|
|
}
|
| 8315 |
|
|
|
| 8316 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PA_20)
|
| 8317 |
|
|
{
|
| 8318 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bve (%%r22)", xoperands);
|
| 8319 |
|
|
nbytes += 36;
|
| 8320 |
|
|
}
|
| 8321 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS)
|
| 8322 |
|
|
{
|
| 8323 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("be 0(%%sr4,%%r22)", xoperands);
|
| 8324 |
|
|
nbytes += 36;
|
| 8325 |
|
|
}
|
| 8326 |
|
|
else
|
| 8327 |
|
|
{
|
| 8328 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldsid (%%sr0,%%r22),%%r21", xoperands);
|
| 8329 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("mtsp %%r21,%%sr0", xoperands);
|
| 8330 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("be 0(%%sr0,%%r22)", xoperands);
|
| 8331 |
|
|
nbytes += 44;
|
| 8332 |
|
|
}
|
| 8333 |
|
|
|
| 8334 |
|
|
if (val_14)
|
| 8335 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo %2(%%r26),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8336 |
|
|
else
|
| 8337 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%2(%%r1),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8338 |
|
|
}
|
| 8339 |
|
|
else if (flag_pic)
|
| 8340 |
|
|
{
|
| 8341 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("{bl|b,l} .+8,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8342 |
|
|
|
| 8343 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOM || !TARGET_GAS)
|
| 8344 |
|
|
{
|
| 8345 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%0-%1-8,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8346 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0-%1-8(%%r1),%%r22", xoperands);
|
| 8347 |
|
|
}
|
| 8348 |
|
|
else
|
| 8349 |
|
|
{
|
| 8350 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%0-$PIC_pcrel$0+4,%%r1", xoperands);
|
| 8351 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%0-$PIC_pcrel$0+8(%%r1),%%r22", xoperands);
|
| 8352 |
|
|
}
|
| 8353 |
|
|
|
| 8354 |
|
|
if (!val_14)
|
| 8355 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%2,%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8356 |
|
|
|
| 8357 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("bv %%r0(%%r22)", xoperands);
|
| 8358 |
|
|
|
| 8359 |
|
|
if (val_14)
|
| 8360 |
|
|
{
|
| 8361 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo %2(%%r26),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8362 |
|
|
nbytes += 20;
|
| 8363 |
|
|
}
|
| 8364 |
|
|
else
|
| 8365 |
|
|
{
|
| 8366 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%2(%%r1),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8367 |
|
|
nbytes += 24;
|
| 8368 |
|
|
}
|
| 8369 |
|
|
}
|
| 8370 |
|
|
else
|
| 8371 |
|
|
{
|
| 8372 |
|
|
if (!val_14)
|
| 8373 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("addil L'%2,%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8374 |
|
|
|
| 8375 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldil L'%0,%%r22", xoperands);
|
| 8376 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("be R'%0(%%sr4,%%r22)", xoperands);
|
| 8377 |
|
|
|
| 8378 |
|
|
if (val_14)
|
| 8379 |
|
|
{
|
| 8380 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo %2(%%r26),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8381 |
|
|
nbytes += 12;
|
| 8382 |
|
|
}
|
| 8383 |
|
|
else
|
| 8384 |
|
|
{
|
| 8385 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldo R'%2(%%r1),%%r26", xoperands);
|
| 8386 |
|
|
nbytes += 16;
|
| 8387 |
|
|
}
|
| 8388 |
|
|
}
|
| 8389 |
|
|
|
| 8390 |
|
|
fprintf (file, "\t.EXIT\n\t.PROCEND\n");
|
| 8391 |
|
|
|
| 8392 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOM && TARGET_GAS)
|
| 8393 |
|
|
{
|
| 8394 |
|
|
/* We done with this subspace except possibly for some additional
|
| 8395 |
|
|
debug information. Forget that we are in this subspace to ensure
|
| 8396 |
|
|
that the next function is output in its own subspace. */
|
| 8397 |
|
|
in_section = NULL;
|
| 8398 |
|
|
cfun->machine->in_nsubspa = 2;
|
| 8399 |
|
|
}
|
| 8400 |
|
|
|
| 8401 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOM && flag_pic && TREE_PUBLIC (function))
|
| 8402 |
|
|
{
|
| 8403 |
|
|
switch_to_section (data_section);
|
| 8404 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (".align 4", xoperands);
|
| 8405 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (file, label);
|
| 8406 |
|
|
output_asm_insn (".word P'%0", xoperands);
|
| 8407 |
|
|
}
|
| 8408 |
|
|
|
| 8409 |
|
|
current_thunk_number++;
|
| 8410 |
|
|
nbytes = ((nbytes + FUNCTION_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
|
| 8411 |
|
|
& ~(FUNCTION_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT - 1));
|
| 8412 |
|
|
last_address += nbytes;
|
| 8413 |
|
|
if (old_last_address > last_address)
|
| 8414 |
|
|
last_address = UINT_MAX;
|
| 8415 |
|
|
update_total_code_bytes (nbytes);
|
| 8416 |
|
|
}
|
| 8417 |
|
|
|
| 8418 |
|
|
/* Only direct calls to static functions are allowed to be sibling (tail)
|
| 8419 |
|
|
call optimized.
|
| 8420 |
|
|
|
| 8421 |
|
|
This restriction is necessary because some linker generated stubs will
|
| 8422 |
|
|
store return pointers into rp' in some cases which might clobber a
|
| 8423 |
|
|
live value already in rp'.
|
| 8424 |
|
|
|
| 8425 |
|
|
In a sibcall the current function and the target function share stack
|
| 8426 |
|
|
space. Thus if the path to the current function and the path to the
|
| 8427 |
|
|
target function save a value in rp', they save the value into the
|
| 8428 |
|
|
same stack slot, which has undesirable consequences.
|
| 8429 |
|
|
|
| 8430 |
|
|
Because of the deferred binding nature of shared libraries any function
|
| 8431 |
|
|
with external scope could be in a different load module and thus require
|
| 8432 |
|
|
rp' to be saved when calling that function. So sibcall optimizations
|
| 8433 |
|
|
can only be safe for static function.
|
| 8434 |
|
|
|
| 8435 |
|
|
Note that GCC never needs return value relocations, so we don't have to
|
| 8436 |
|
|
worry about static calls with return value relocations (which require
|
| 8437 |
|
|
saving rp').
|
| 8438 |
|
|
|
| 8439 |
|
|
It is safe to perform a sibcall optimization when the target function
|
| 8440 |
|
|
will never return. */
|
| 8441 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 8442 |
|
|
pa_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl, tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 8443 |
|
|
{
|
| 8444 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME)
|
| 8445 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 8446 |
|
|
|
| 8447 |
|
|
/* Sibcalls are ok for TARGET_ELF32 as along as the linker is used in
|
| 8448 |
|
|
single subspace mode and the call is not indirect. As far as I know,
|
| 8449 |
|
|
there is no operating system support for the multiple subspace mode.
|
| 8450 |
|
|
It might be possible to support indirect calls if we didn't use
|
| 8451 |
|
|
$$dyncall (see the indirect sequence generated in pa_output_call). */
|
| 8452 |
|
|
if (TARGET_ELF32)
|
| 8453 |
|
|
return (decl != NULL_TREE);
|
| 8454 |
|
|
|
| 8455 |
|
|
/* Sibcalls are not ok because the arg pointer register is not a fixed
|
| 8456 |
|
|
register. This prevents the sibcall optimization from occurring. In
|
| 8457 |
|
|
addition, there are problems with stub placement using GNU ld. This
|
| 8458 |
|
|
is because a normal sibcall branch uses a 17-bit relocation while
|
| 8459 |
|
|
a regular call branch uses a 22-bit relocation. As a result, more
|
| 8460 |
|
|
care needs to be taken in the placement of long-branch stubs. */
|
| 8461 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 8462 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 8463 |
|
|
|
| 8464 |
|
|
/* Sibcalls are only ok within a translation unit. */
|
| 8465 |
|
|
return (decl && !TREE_PUBLIC (decl));
|
| 8466 |
|
|
}
|
| 8467 |
|
|
|
| 8468 |
|
|
/* ??? Addition is not commutative on the PA due to the weird implicit
|
| 8469 |
|
|
space register selection rules for memory addresses. Therefore, we
|
| 8470 |
|
|
don't consider a + b == b + a, as this might be inside a MEM. */
|
| 8471 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 8472 |
|
|
pa_commutative_p (const_rtx x, int outer_code)
|
| 8473 |
|
|
{
|
| 8474 |
|
|
return (COMMUTATIVE_P (x)
|
| 8475 |
|
|
&& (TARGET_NO_SPACE_REGS
|
| 8476 |
|
|
|| (outer_code != UNKNOWN && outer_code != MEM)
|
| 8477 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (x) != PLUS));
|
| 8478 |
|
|
}
|
| 8479 |
|
|
|
| 8480 |
|
|
/* Returns 1 if the 6 operands specified in OPERANDS are suitable for
|
| 8481 |
|
|
use in fmpyadd instructions. */
|
| 8482 |
|
|
int
|
| 8483 |
|
|
pa_fmpyaddoperands (rtx *operands)
|
| 8484 |
|
|
{
|
| 8485 |
|
|
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (operands[0]);
|
| 8486 |
|
|
|
| 8487 |
|
|
/* Must be a floating point mode. */
|
| 8488 |
|
|
if (mode != SFmode && mode != DFmode)
|
| 8489 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8490 |
|
|
|
| 8491 |
|
|
/* All modes must be the same. */
|
| 8492 |
|
|
if (! (mode == GET_MODE (operands[1])
|
| 8493 |
|
|
&& mode == GET_MODE (operands[2])
|
| 8494 |
|
|
&& mode == GET_MODE (operands[3])
|
| 8495 |
|
|
&& mode == GET_MODE (operands[4])
|
| 8496 |
|
|
&& mode == GET_MODE (operands[5])))
|
| 8497 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8498 |
|
|
|
| 8499 |
|
|
/* All operands must be registers. */
|
| 8500 |
|
|
if (! (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG
|
| 8501 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[2]) == REG
|
| 8502 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[3]) == REG
|
| 8503 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[4]) == REG
|
| 8504 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[5]) == REG))
|
| 8505 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8506 |
|
|
|
| 8507 |
|
|
/* Only 2 real operands to the addition. One of the input operands must
|
| 8508 |
|
|
be the same as the output operand. */
|
| 8509 |
|
|
if (! rtx_equal_p (operands[3], operands[4])
|
| 8510 |
|
|
&& ! rtx_equal_p (operands[3], operands[5]))
|
| 8511 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8512 |
|
|
|
| 8513 |
|
|
/* Inout operand of add cannot conflict with any operands from multiply. */
|
| 8514 |
|
|
if (rtx_equal_p (operands[3], operands[0])
|
| 8515 |
|
|
|| rtx_equal_p (operands[3], operands[1])
|
| 8516 |
|
|
|| rtx_equal_p (operands[3], operands[2]))
|
| 8517 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8518 |
|
|
|
| 8519 |
|
|
/* multiply cannot feed into addition operands. */
|
| 8520 |
|
|
if (rtx_equal_p (operands[4], operands[0])
|
| 8521 |
|
|
|| rtx_equal_p (operands[5], operands[0]))
|
| 8522 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8523 |
|
|
|
| 8524 |
|
|
/* SFmode limits the registers to the upper 32 of the 32bit FP regs. */
|
| 8525 |
|
|
if (mode == SFmode
|
| 8526 |
|
|
&& (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[0])) != FPUPPER_REGS
|
| 8527 |
|
|
|| REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[1])) != FPUPPER_REGS
|
| 8528 |
|
|
|| REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[2])) != FPUPPER_REGS
|
| 8529 |
|
|
|| REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[3])) != FPUPPER_REGS
|
| 8530 |
|
|
|| REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[4])) != FPUPPER_REGS
|
| 8531 |
|
|
|| REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[5])) != FPUPPER_REGS))
|
| 8532 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8533 |
|
|
|
| 8534 |
|
|
/* Passed. Operands are suitable for fmpyadd. */
|
| 8535 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 8536 |
|
|
}
|
| 8537 |
|
|
|
| 8538 |
|
|
#if !defined(USE_COLLECT2)
|
| 8539 |
|
|
static void
|
| 8540 |
|
|
pa_asm_out_constructor (rtx symbol, int priority)
|
| 8541 |
|
|
{
|
| 8542 |
|
|
if (!function_label_operand (symbol, VOIDmode))
|
| 8543 |
|
|
pa_encode_label (symbol);
|
| 8544 |
|
|
|
| 8545 |
|
|
#ifdef CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
| 8546 |
|
|
default_ctor_section_asm_out_constructor (symbol, priority);
|
| 8547 |
|
|
#else
|
| 8548 |
|
|
# ifdef TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
|
| 8549 |
|
|
default_named_section_asm_out_constructor (symbol, priority);
|
| 8550 |
|
|
# else
|
| 8551 |
|
|
default_stabs_asm_out_constructor (symbol, priority);
|
| 8552 |
|
|
# endif
|
| 8553 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 8554 |
|
|
}
|
| 8555 |
|
|
|
| 8556 |
|
|
static void
|
| 8557 |
|
|
pa_asm_out_destructor (rtx symbol, int priority)
|
| 8558 |
|
|
{
|
| 8559 |
|
|
if (!function_label_operand (symbol, VOIDmode))
|
| 8560 |
|
|
pa_encode_label (symbol);
|
| 8561 |
|
|
|
| 8562 |
|
|
#ifdef DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
| 8563 |
|
|
default_dtor_section_asm_out_destructor (symbol, priority);
|
| 8564 |
|
|
#else
|
| 8565 |
|
|
# ifdef TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
|
| 8566 |
|
|
default_named_section_asm_out_destructor (symbol, priority);
|
| 8567 |
|
|
# else
|
| 8568 |
|
|
default_stabs_asm_out_destructor (symbol, priority);
|
| 8569 |
|
|
# endif
|
| 8570 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 8571 |
|
|
}
|
| 8572 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 8573 |
|
|
|
| 8574 |
|
|
/* This function places uninitialized global data in the bss section.
|
| 8575 |
|
|
The ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS macro needs to be defined to call this
|
| 8576 |
|
|
function on the SOM port to prevent uninitialized global data from
|
| 8577 |
|
|
being placed in the data section. */
|
| 8578 |
|
|
|
| 8579 |
|
|
void
|
| 8580 |
|
|
pa_asm_output_aligned_bss (FILE *stream,
|
| 8581 |
|
|
const char *name,
|
| 8582 |
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size,
|
| 8583 |
|
|
unsigned int align)
|
| 8584 |
|
|
{
|
| 8585 |
|
|
switch_to_section (bss_section);
|
| 8586 |
|
|
fprintf (stream, "\t.align %u\n", align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
| 8587 |
|
|
|
| 8588 |
|
|
#ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE
|
| 8589 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (stream, name, "object");
|
| 8590 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 8591 |
|
|
|
| 8592 |
|
|
#ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE
|
| 8593 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (stream, name, size);
|
| 8594 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 8595 |
|
|
|
| 8596 |
|
|
fprintf (stream, "\t.align %u\n", align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
| 8597 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (stream, name);
|
| 8598 |
|
|
fprintf (stream, "\t.block "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED"\n", size);
|
| 8599 |
|
|
}
|
| 8600 |
|
|
|
| 8601 |
|
|
/* Both the HP and GNU assemblers under HP-UX provide a .comm directive
|
| 8602 |
|
|
that doesn't allow the alignment of global common storage to be directly
|
| 8603 |
|
|
specified. The SOM linker aligns common storage based on the rounded
|
| 8604 |
|
|
value of the NUM_BYTES parameter in the .comm directive. It's not
|
| 8605 |
|
|
possible to use the .align directive as it doesn't affect the alignment
|
| 8606 |
|
|
of the label associated with a .comm directive. */
|
| 8607 |
|
|
|
| 8608 |
|
|
void
|
| 8609 |
|
|
pa_asm_output_aligned_common (FILE *stream,
|
| 8610 |
|
|
const char *name,
|
| 8611 |
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size,
|
| 8612 |
|
|
unsigned int align)
|
| 8613 |
|
|
{
|
| 8614 |
|
|
unsigned int max_common_align;
|
| 8615 |
|
|
|
| 8616 |
|
|
max_common_align = TARGET_64BIT ? 128 : (size >= 4096 ? 256 : 64);
|
| 8617 |
|
|
if (align > max_common_align)
|
| 8618 |
|
|
{
|
| 8619 |
|
|
warning (0, "alignment (%u) for %s exceeds maximum alignment "
|
| 8620 |
|
|
"for global common data. Using %u",
|
| 8621 |
|
|
align / BITS_PER_UNIT, name, max_common_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
| 8622 |
|
|
align = max_common_align;
|
| 8623 |
|
|
}
|
| 8624 |
|
|
|
| 8625 |
|
|
switch_to_section (bss_section);
|
| 8626 |
|
|
|
| 8627 |
|
|
assemble_name (stream, name);
|
| 8628 |
|
|
fprintf (stream, "\t.comm "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED"\n",
|
| 8629 |
|
|
MAX (size, align / BITS_PER_UNIT));
|
| 8630 |
|
|
}
|
| 8631 |
|
|
|
| 8632 |
|
|
/* We can't use .comm for local common storage as the SOM linker effectively
|
| 8633 |
|
|
treats the symbol as universal and uses the same storage for local symbols
|
| 8634 |
|
|
with the same name in different object files. The .block directive
|
| 8635 |
|
|
reserves an uninitialized block of storage. However, it's not common
|
| 8636 |
|
|
storage. Fortunately, GCC never requests common storage with the same
|
| 8637 |
|
|
name in any given translation unit. */
|
| 8638 |
|
|
|
| 8639 |
|
|
void
|
| 8640 |
|
|
pa_asm_output_aligned_local (FILE *stream,
|
| 8641 |
|
|
const char *name,
|
| 8642 |
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size,
|
| 8643 |
|
|
unsigned int align)
|
| 8644 |
|
|
{
|
| 8645 |
|
|
switch_to_section (bss_section);
|
| 8646 |
|
|
fprintf (stream, "\t.align %u\n", align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
| 8647 |
|
|
|
| 8648 |
|
|
#ifdef LOCAL_ASM_OP
|
| 8649 |
|
|
fprintf (stream, "%s", LOCAL_ASM_OP);
|
| 8650 |
|
|
assemble_name (stream, name);
|
| 8651 |
|
|
fprintf (stream, "\n");
|
| 8652 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 8653 |
|
|
|
| 8654 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (stream, name);
|
| 8655 |
|
|
fprintf (stream, "\t.block "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED"\n", size);
|
| 8656 |
|
|
}
|
| 8657 |
|
|
|
| 8658 |
|
|
/* Returns 1 if the 6 operands specified in OPERANDS are suitable for
|
| 8659 |
|
|
use in fmpysub instructions. */
|
| 8660 |
|
|
int
|
| 8661 |
|
|
pa_fmpysuboperands (rtx *operands)
|
| 8662 |
|
|
{
|
| 8663 |
|
|
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (operands[0]);
|
| 8664 |
|
|
|
| 8665 |
|
|
/* Must be a floating point mode. */
|
| 8666 |
|
|
if (mode != SFmode && mode != DFmode)
|
| 8667 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8668 |
|
|
|
| 8669 |
|
|
/* All modes must be the same. */
|
| 8670 |
|
|
if (! (mode == GET_MODE (operands[1])
|
| 8671 |
|
|
&& mode == GET_MODE (operands[2])
|
| 8672 |
|
|
&& mode == GET_MODE (operands[3])
|
| 8673 |
|
|
&& mode == GET_MODE (operands[4])
|
| 8674 |
|
|
&& mode == GET_MODE (operands[5])))
|
| 8675 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8676 |
|
|
|
| 8677 |
|
|
/* All operands must be registers. */
|
| 8678 |
|
|
if (! (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG
|
| 8679 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[2]) == REG
|
| 8680 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[3]) == REG
|
| 8681 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[4]) == REG
|
| 8682 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (operands[5]) == REG))
|
| 8683 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8684 |
|
|
|
| 8685 |
|
|
/* Only 2 real operands to the subtraction. Subtraction is not a commutative
|
| 8686 |
|
|
operation, so operands[4] must be the same as operand[3]. */
|
| 8687 |
|
|
if (! rtx_equal_p (operands[3], operands[4]))
|
| 8688 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8689 |
|
|
|
| 8690 |
|
|
/* multiply cannot feed into subtraction. */
|
| 8691 |
|
|
if (rtx_equal_p (operands[5], operands[0]))
|
| 8692 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8693 |
|
|
|
| 8694 |
|
|
/* Inout operand of sub cannot conflict with any operands from multiply. */
|
| 8695 |
|
|
if (rtx_equal_p (operands[3], operands[0])
|
| 8696 |
|
|
|| rtx_equal_p (operands[3], operands[1])
|
| 8697 |
|
|
|| rtx_equal_p (operands[3], operands[2]))
|
| 8698 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8699 |
|
|
|
| 8700 |
|
|
/* SFmode limits the registers to the upper 32 of the 32bit FP regs. */
|
| 8701 |
|
|
if (mode == SFmode
|
| 8702 |
|
|
&& (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[0])) != FPUPPER_REGS
|
| 8703 |
|
|
|| REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[1])) != FPUPPER_REGS
|
| 8704 |
|
|
|| REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[2])) != FPUPPER_REGS
|
| 8705 |
|
|
|| REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[3])) != FPUPPER_REGS
|
| 8706 |
|
|
|| REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[4])) != FPUPPER_REGS
|
| 8707 |
|
|
|| REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (operands[5])) != FPUPPER_REGS))
|
| 8708 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8709 |
|
|
|
| 8710 |
|
|
/* Passed. Operands are suitable for fmpysub. */
|
| 8711 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 8712 |
|
|
}
|
| 8713 |
|
|
|
| 8714 |
|
|
/* Return 1 if the given constant is 2, 4, or 8. These are the valid
|
| 8715 |
|
|
constants for shadd instructions. */
|
| 8716 |
|
|
int
|
| 8717 |
|
|
pa_shadd_constant_p (int val)
|
| 8718 |
|
|
{
|
| 8719 |
|
|
if (val == 2 || val == 4 || val == 8)
|
| 8720 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 8721 |
|
|
else
|
| 8722 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8723 |
|
|
}
|
| 8724 |
|
|
|
| 8725 |
|
|
/* Return TRUE if INSN branches forward. */
|
| 8726 |
|
|
|
| 8727 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 8728 |
|
|
forward_branch_p (rtx insn)
|
| 8729 |
|
|
{
|
| 8730 |
|
|
rtx lab = JUMP_LABEL (insn);
|
| 8731 |
|
|
|
| 8732 |
|
|
/* The INSN must have a jump label. */
|
| 8733 |
|
|
gcc_assert (lab != NULL_RTX);
|
| 8734 |
|
|
|
| 8735 |
|
|
if (INSN_ADDRESSES_SET_P ())
|
| 8736 |
|
|
return INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (lab)) > INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn));
|
| 8737 |
|
|
|
| 8738 |
|
|
while (insn)
|
| 8739 |
|
|
{
|
| 8740 |
|
|
if (insn == lab)
|
| 8741 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 8742 |
|
|
else
|
| 8743 |
|
|
insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
|
| 8744 |
|
|
}
|
| 8745 |
|
|
|
| 8746 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 8747 |
|
|
}
|
| 8748 |
|
|
|
| 8749 |
|
|
/* Return 1 if INSN is in the delay slot of a call instruction. */
|
| 8750 |
|
|
int
|
| 8751 |
|
|
pa_jump_in_call_delay (rtx insn)
|
| 8752 |
|
|
{
|
| 8753 |
|
|
|
| 8754 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) != JUMP_INSN)
|
| 8755 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8756 |
|
|
|
| 8757 |
|
|
if (PREV_INSN (insn)
|
| 8758 |
|
|
&& PREV_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn))
|
| 8759 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (next_real_insn (PREV_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)))) == INSN)
|
| 8760 |
|
|
{
|
| 8761 |
|
|
rtx test_insn = next_real_insn (PREV_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)));
|
| 8762 |
|
|
|
| 8763 |
|
|
return (GET_CODE (PATTERN (test_insn)) == SEQUENCE
|
| 8764 |
|
|
&& XVECEXP (PATTERN (test_insn), 0, 1) == insn);
|
| 8765 |
|
|
|
| 8766 |
|
|
}
|
| 8767 |
|
|
else
|
| 8768 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8769 |
|
|
}
|
| 8770 |
|
|
|
| 8771 |
|
|
/* Output an unconditional move and branch insn. */
|
| 8772 |
|
|
|
| 8773 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 8774 |
|
|
pa_output_parallel_movb (rtx *operands, rtx insn)
|
| 8775 |
|
|
{
|
| 8776 |
|
|
int length = get_attr_length (insn);
|
| 8777 |
|
|
|
| 8778 |
|
|
/* These are the cases in which we win. */
|
| 8779 |
|
|
if (length == 4)
|
| 8780 |
|
|
return "mov%I1b,tr %1,%0,%2";
|
| 8781 |
|
|
|
| 8782 |
|
|
/* None of the following cases win, but they don't lose either. */
|
| 8783 |
|
|
if (length == 8)
|
| 8784 |
|
|
{
|
| 8785 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 8786 |
|
|
{
|
| 8787 |
|
|
/* Nothing in the delay slot, fake it by putting the combined
|
| 8788 |
|
|
insn (the copy or add) in the delay slot of a bl. */
|
| 8789 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_INT)
|
| 8790 |
|
|
return "b %2\n\tldi %1,%0";
|
| 8791 |
|
|
else
|
| 8792 |
|
|
return "b %2\n\tcopy %1,%0";
|
| 8793 |
|
|
}
|
| 8794 |
|
|
else
|
| 8795 |
|
|
{
|
| 8796 |
|
|
/* Something in the delay slot, but we've got a long branch. */
|
| 8797 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_INT)
|
| 8798 |
|
|
return "ldi %1,%0\n\tb %2";
|
| 8799 |
|
|
else
|
| 8800 |
|
|
return "copy %1,%0\n\tb %2";
|
| 8801 |
|
|
}
|
| 8802 |
|
|
}
|
| 8803 |
|
|
|
| 8804 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_INT)
|
| 8805 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("ldi %1,%0", operands);
|
| 8806 |
|
|
else
|
| 8807 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("copy %1,%0", operands);
|
| 8808 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (operands[2], insn, 1);
|
| 8809 |
|
|
}
|
| 8810 |
|
|
|
| 8811 |
|
|
/* Output an unconditional add and branch insn. */
|
| 8812 |
|
|
|
| 8813 |
|
|
const char *
|
| 8814 |
|
|
pa_output_parallel_addb (rtx *operands, rtx insn)
|
| 8815 |
|
|
{
|
| 8816 |
|
|
int length = get_attr_length (insn);
|
| 8817 |
|
|
|
| 8818 |
|
|
/* To make life easy we want operand0 to be the shared input/output
|
| 8819 |
|
|
operand and operand1 to be the readonly operand. */
|
| 8820 |
|
|
if (operands[0] == operands[1])
|
| 8821 |
|
|
operands[1] = operands[2];
|
| 8822 |
|
|
|
| 8823 |
|
|
/* These are the cases in which we win. */
|
| 8824 |
|
|
if (length == 4)
|
| 8825 |
|
|
return "add%I1b,tr %1,%0,%3";
|
| 8826 |
|
|
|
| 8827 |
|
|
/* None of the following cases win, but they don't lose either. */
|
| 8828 |
|
|
if (length == 8)
|
| 8829 |
|
|
{
|
| 8830 |
|
|
if (dbr_sequence_length () == 0)
|
| 8831 |
|
|
/* Nothing in the delay slot, fake it by putting the combined
|
| 8832 |
|
|
insn (the copy or add) in the delay slot of a bl. */
|
| 8833 |
|
|
return "b %3\n\tadd%I1 %1,%0,%0";
|
| 8834 |
|
|
else
|
| 8835 |
|
|
/* Something in the delay slot, but we've got a long branch. */
|
| 8836 |
|
|
return "add%I1 %1,%0,%0\n\tb %3";
|
| 8837 |
|
|
}
|
| 8838 |
|
|
|
| 8839 |
|
|
output_asm_insn ("add%I1 %1,%0,%0", operands);
|
| 8840 |
|
|
return pa_output_lbranch (operands[3], insn, 1);
|
| 8841 |
|
|
}
|
| 8842 |
|
|
|
| 8843 |
|
|
/* Return nonzero if INSN (a jump insn) immediately follows a call
|
| 8844 |
|
|
to a named function. This is used to avoid filling the delay slot
|
| 8845 |
|
|
of the jump since it can usually be eliminated by modifying RP in
|
| 8846 |
|
|
the delay slot of the call. */
|
| 8847 |
|
|
|
| 8848 |
|
|
int
|
| 8849 |
|
|
pa_following_call (rtx insn)
|
| 8850 |
|
|
{
|
| 8851 |
|
|
if (! TARGET_JUMP_IN_DELAY)
|
| 8852 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8853 |
|
|
|
| 8854 |
|
|
/* Find the previous real insn, skipping NOTEs. */
|
| 8855 |
|
|
insn = PREV_INSN (insn);
|
| 8856 |
|
|
while (insn && GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE)
|
| 8857 |
|
|
insn = PREV_INSN (insn);
|
| 8858 |
|
|
|
| 8859 |
|
|
/* Check for CALL_INSNs and millicode calls. */
|
| 8860 |
|
|
if (insn
|
| 8861 |
|
|
&& ((GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN
|
| 8862 |
|
|
&& get_attr_type (insn) != TYPE_DYNCALL)
|
| 8863 |
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
|
| 8864 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != SEQUENCE
|
| 8865 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE
|
| 8866 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER
|
| 8867 |
|
|
&& get_attr_type (insn) == TYPE_MILLI)))
|
| 8868 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 8869 |
|
|
|
| 8870 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 8871 |
|
|
}
|
| 8872 |
|
|
|
| 8873 |
|
|
/* We use this hook to perform a PA specific optimization which is difficult
|
| 8874 |
|
|
to do in earlier passes.
|
| 8875 |
|
|
|
| 8876 |
|
|
We want the delay slots of branches within jump tables to be filled.
|
| 8877 |
|
|
None of the compiler passes at the moment even has the notion that a
|
| 8878 |
|
|
PA jump table doesn't contain addresses, but instead contains actual
|
| 8879 |
|
|
instructions!
|
| 8880 |
|
|
|
| 8881 |
|
|
Because we actually jump into the table, the addresses of each entry
|
| 8882 |
|
|
must stay constant in relation to the beginning of the table (which
|
| 8883 |
|
|
itself must stay constant relative to the instruction to jump into
|
| 8884 |
|
|
it). I don't believe we can guarantee earlier passes of the compiler
|
| 8885 |
|
|
will adhere to those rules.
|
| 8886 |
|
|
|
| 8887 |
|
|
So, late in the compilation process we find all the jump tables, and
|
| 8888 |
|
|
expand them into real code -- e.g. each entry in the jump table vector
|
| 8889 |
|
|
will get an appropriate label followed by a jump to the final target.
|
| 8890 |
|
|
|
| 8891 |
|
|
Reorg and the final jump pass can then optimize these branches and
|
| 8892 |
|
|
fill their delay slots. We end up with smaller, more efficient code.
|
| 8893 |
|
|
|
| 8894 |
|
|
The jump instructions within the table are special; we must be able
|
| 8895 |
|
|
to identify them during assembly output (if the jumps don't get filled
|
| 8896 |
|
|
we need to emit a nop rather than nullifying the delay slot)). We
|
| 8897 |
|
|
identify jumps in switch tables by using insns with the attribute
|
| 8898 |
|
|
type TYPE_BTABLE_BRANCH.
|
| 8899 |
|
|
|
| 8900 |
|
|
We also surround the jump table itself with BEGIN_BRTAB and END_BRTAB
|
| 8901 |
|
|
insns. This serves two purposes, first it prevents jump.c from
|
| 8902 |
|
|
noticing that the last N entries in the table jump to the instruction
|
| 8903 |
|
|
immediately after the table and deleting the jumps. Second, those
|
| 8904 |
|
|
insns mark where we should emit .begin_brtab and .end_brtab directives
|
| 8905 |
|
|
when using GAS (allows for better link time optimizations). */
|
| 8906 |
|
|
|
| 8907 |
|
|
static void
|
| 8908 |
|
|
pa_reorg (void)
|
| 8909 |
|
|
{
|
| 8910 |
|
|
rtx insn;
|
| 8911 |
|
|
|
| 8912 |
|
|
remove_useless_addtr_insns (1);
|
| 8913 |
|
|
|
| 8914 |
|
|
if (pa_cpu < PROCESSOR_8000)
|
| 8915 |
|
|
pa_combine_instructions ();
|
| 8916 |
|
|
|
| 8917 |
|
|
|
| 8918 |
|
|
/* This is fairly cheap, so always run it if optimizing. */
|
| 8919 |
|
|
if (optimize > 0 && !TARGET_BIG_SWITCH)
|
| 8920 |
|
|
{
|
| 8921 |
|
|
/* Find and explode all ADDR_VEC or ADDR_DIFF_VEC insns. */
|
| 8922 |
|
|
for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
| 8923 |
|
|
{
|
| 8924 |
|
|
rtx pattern, tmp, location, label;
|
| 8925 |
|
|
unsigned int length, i;
|
| 8926 |
|
|
|
| 8927 |
|
|
/* Find an ADDR_VEC or ADDR_DIFF_VEC insn to explode. */
|
| 8928 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) != JUMP_INSN
|
| 8929 |
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_VEC
|
| 8930 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_DIFF_VEC))
|
| 8931 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 8932 |
|
|
|
| 8933 |
|
|
/* Emit marker for the beginning of the branch table. */
|
| 8934 |
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_begin_brtab (), insn);
|
| 8935 |
|
|
|
| 8936 |
|
|
pattern = PATTERN (insn);
|
| 8937 |
|
|
location = PREV_INSN (insn);
|
| 8938 |
|
|
length = XVECLEN (pattern, GET_CODE (pattern) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC);
|
| 8939 |
|
|
|
| 8940 |
|
|
for (i = 0; i < length; i++)
|
| 8941 |
|
|
{
|
| 8942 |
|
|
/* Emit a label before each jump to keep jump.c from
|
| 8943 |
|
|
removing this code. */
|
| 8944 |
|
|
tmp = gen_label_rtx ();
|
| 8945 |
|
|
LABEL_NUSES (tmp) = 1;
|
| 8946 |
|
|
emit_label_after (tmp, location);
|
| 8947 |
|
|
location = NEXT_INSN (location);
|
| 8948 |
|
|
|
| 8949 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pattern) == ADDR_VEC)
|
| 8950 |
|
|
label = XEXP (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i), 0);
|
| 8951 |
|
|
else
|
| 8952 |
|
|
label = XEXP (XVECEXP (pattern, 1, i), 0);
|
| 8953 |
|
|
|
| 8954 |
|
|
tmp = gen_short_jump (label);
|
| 8955 |
|
|
|
| 8956 |
|
|
/* Emit the jump itself. */
|
| 8957 |
|
|
tmp = emit_jump_insn_after (tmp, location);
|
| 8958 |
|
|
JUMP_LABEL (tmp) = label;
|
| 8959 |
|
|
LABEL_NUSES (label)++;
|
| 8960 |
|
|
location = NEXT_INSN (location);
|
| 8961 |
|
|
|
| 8962 |
|
|
/* Emit a BARRIER after the jump. */
|
| 8963 |
|
|
emit_barrier_after (location);
|
| 8964 |
|
|
location = NEXT_INSN (location);
|
| 8965 |
|
|
}
|
| 8966 |
|
|
|
| 8967 |
|
|
/* Emit marker for the end of the branch table. */
|
| 8968 |
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_end_brtab (), location);
|
| 8969 |
|
|
location = NEXT_INSN (location);
|
| 8970 |
|
|
emit_barrier_after (location);
|
| 8971 |
|
|
|
| 8972 |
|
|
/* Delete the ADDR_VEC or ADDR_DIFF_VEC. */
|
| 8973 |
|
|
delete_insn (insn);
|
| 8974 |
|
|
}
|
| 8975 |
|
|
}
|
| 8976 |
|
|
else
|
| 8977 |
|
|
{
|
| 8978 |
|
|
/* Still need brtab marker insns. FIXME: the presence of these
|
| 8979 |
|
|
markers disables output of the branch table to readonly memory,
|
| 8980 |
|
|
and any alignment directives that might be needed. Possibly,
|
| 8981 |
|
|
the begin_brtab insn should be output before the label for the
|
| 8982 |
|
|
table. This doesn't matter at the moment since the tables are
|
| 8983 |
|
|
always output in the text section. */
|
| 8984 |
|
|
for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
| 8985 |
|
|
{
|
| 8986 |
|
|
/* Find an ADDR_VEC insn. */
|
| 8987 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) != JUMP_INSN
|
| 8988 |
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_VEC
|
| 8989 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_DIFF_VEC))
|
| 8990 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 8991 |
|
|
|
| 8992 |
|
|
/* Now generate markers for the beginning and end of the
|
| 8993 |
|
|
branch table. */
|
| 8994 |
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_begin_brtab (), insn);
|
| 8995 |
|
|
emit_insn_after (gen_end_brtab (), insn);
|
| 8996 |
|
|
}
|
| 8997 |
|
|
}
|
| 8998 |
|
|
}
|
| 8999 |
|
|
|
| 9000 |
|
|
/* The PA has a number of odd instructions which can perform multiple
|
| 9001 |
|
|
tasks at once. On first generation PA machines (PA1.0 and PA1.1)
|
| 9002 |
|
|
it may be profitable to combine two instructions into one instruction
|
| 9003 |
|
|
with two outputs. It's not profitable PA2.0 machines because the
|
| 9004 |
|
|
two outputs would take two slots in the reorder buffers.
|
| 9005 |
|
|
|
| 9006 |
|
|
This routine finds instructions which can be combined and combines
|
| 9007 |
|
|
them. We only support some of the potential combinations, and we
|
| 9008 |
|
|
only try common ways to find suitable instructions.
|
| 9009 |
|
|
|
| 9010 |
|
|
* addb can add two registers or a register and a small integer
|
| 9011 |
|
|
and jump to a nearby (+-8k) location. Normally the jump to the
|
| 9012 |
|
|
nearby location is conditional on the result of the add, but by
|
| 9013 |
|
|
using the "true" condition we can make the jump unconditional.
|
| 9014 |
|
|
Thus addb can perform two independent operations in one insn.
|
| 9015 |
|
|
|
| 9016 |
|
|
* movb is similar to addb in that it can perform a reg->reg
|
| 9017 |
|
|
or small immediate->reg copy and jump to a nearby (+-8k location).
|
| 9018 |
|
|
|
| 9019 |
|
|
* fmpyadd and fmpysub can perform a FP multiply and either an
|
| 9020 |
|
|
FP add or FP sub if the operands of the multiply and add/sub are
|
| 9021 |
|
|
independent (there are other minor restrictions). Note both
|
| 9022 |
|
|
the fmpy and fadd/fsub can in theory move to better spots according
|
| 9023 |
|
|
to data dependencies, but for now we require the fmpy stay at a
|
| 9024 |
|
|
fixed location.
|
| 9025 |
|
|
|
| 9026 |
|
|
* Many of the memory operations can perform pre & post updates
|
| 9027 |
|
|
of index registers. GCC's pre/post increment/decrement addressing
|
| 9028 |
|
|
is far too simple to take advantage of all the possibilities. This
|
| 9029 |
|
|
pass may not be suitable since those insns may not be independent.
|
| 9030 |
|
|
|
| 9031 |
|
|
* comclr can compare two ints or an int and a register, nullify
|
| 9032 |
|
|
the following instruction and zero some other register. This
|
| 9033 |
|
|
is more difficult to use as it's harder to find an insn which
|
| 9034 |
|
|
will generate a comclr than finding something like an unconditional
|
| 9035 |
|
|
branch. (conditional moves & long branches create comclr insns).
|
| 9036 |
|
|
|
| 9037 |
|
|
* Most arithmetic operations can conditionally skip the next
|
| 9038 |
|
|
instruction. They can be viewed as "perform this operation
|
| 9039 |
|
|
and conditionally jump to this nearby location" (where nearby
|
| 9040 |
|
|
is an insns away). These are difficult to use due to the
|
| 9041 |
|
|
branch length restrictions. */
|
| 9042 |
|
|
|
| 9043 |
|
|
static void
|
| 9044 |
|
|
pa_combine_instructions (void)
|
| 9045 |
|
|
{
|
| 9046 |
|
|
rtx anchor, new_rtx;
|
| 9047 |
|
|
|
| 9048 |
|
|
/* This can get expensive since the basic algorithm is on the
|
| 9049 |
|
|
order of O(n^2) (or worse). Only do it for -O2 or higher
|
| 9050 |
|
|
levels of optimization. */
|
| 9051 |
|
|
if (optimize < 2)
|
| 9052 |
|
|
return;
|
| 9053 |
|
|
|
| 9054 |
|
|
/* Walk down the list of insns looking for "anchor" insns which
|
| 9055 |
|
|
may be combined with "floating" insns. As the name implies,
|
| 9056 |
|
|
"anchor" instructions don't move, while "floating" insns may
|
| 9057 |
|
|
move around. */
|
| 9058 |
|
|
new_rtx = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX));
|
| 9059 |
|
|
new_rtx = make_insn_raw (new_rtx);
|
| 9060 |
|
|
|
| 9061 |
|
|
for (anchor = get_insns (); anchor; anchor = NEXT_INSN (anchor))
|
| 9062 |
|
|
{
|
| 9063 |
|
|
enum attr_pa_combine_type anchor_attr;
|
| 9064 |
|
|
enum attr_pa_combine_type floater_attr;
|
| 9065 |
|
|
|
| 9066 |
|
|
/* We only care about INSNs, JUMP_INSNs, and CALL_INSNs.
|
| 9067 |
|
|
Also ignore any special USE insns. */
|
| 9068 |
|
|
if ((GET_CODE (anchor) != INSN
|
| 9069 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (anchor) != JUMP_INSN
|
| 9070 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (anchor) != CALL_INSN)
|
| 9071 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (anchor)) == USE
|
| 9072 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (anchor)) == CLOBBER
|
| 9073 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (anchor)) == ADDR_VEC
|
| 9074 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (anchor)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
|
| 9075 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 9076 |
|
|
|
| 9077 |
|
|
anchor_attr = get_attr_pa_combine_type (anchor);
|
| 9078 |
|
|
/* See if anchor is an insn suitable for combination. */
|
| 9079 |
|
|
if (anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FMPY
|
| 9080 |
|
|
|| anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FADDSUB
|
| 9081 |
|
|
|| (anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_UNCOND_BRANCH
|
| 9082 |
|
|
&& ! forward_branch_p (anchor)))
|
| 9083 |
|
|
{
|
| 9084 |
|
|
rtx floater;
|
| 9085 |
|
|
|
| 9086 |
|
|
for (floater = PREV_INSN (anchor);
|
| 9087 |
|
|
floater;
|
| 9088 |
|
|
floater = PREV_INSN (floater))
|
| 9089 |
|
|
{
|
| 9090 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (floater) == NOTE
|
| 9091 |
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (floater) == INSN
|
| 9092 |
|
|
&& (GET_CODE (PATTERN (floater)) == USE
|
| 9093 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (floater)) == CLOBBER)))
|
| 9094 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 9095 |
|
|
|
| 9096 |
|
|
/* Anything except a regular INSN will stop our search. */
|
| 9097 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (floater) != INSN
|
| 9098 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (floater)) == ADDR_VEC
|
| 9099 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (floater)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
|
| 9100 |
|
|
{
|
| 9101 |
|
|
floater = NULL_RTX;
|
| 9102 |
|
|
break;
|
| 9103 |
|
|
}
|
| 9104 |
|
|
|
| 9105 |
|
|
/* See if FLOATER is suitable for combination with the
|
| 9106 |
|
|
anchor. */
|
| 9107 |
|
|
floater_attr = get_attr_pa_combine_type (floater);
|
| 9108 |
|
|
if ((anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FMPY
|
| 9109 |
|
|
&& floater_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FADDSUB)
|
| 9110 |
|
|
|| (anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FADDSUB
|
| 9111 |
|
|
&& floater_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FMPY))
|
| 9112 |
|
|
{
|
| 9113 |
|
|
/* If ANCHOR and FLOATER can be combined, then we're
|
| 9114 |
|
|
done with this pass. */
|
| 9115 |
|
|
if (pa_can_combine_p (new_rtx, anchor, floater, 0,
|
| 9116 |
|
|
SET_DEST (PATTERN (floater)),
|
| 9117 |
|
|
XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (floater)), 0),
|
| 9118 |
|
|
XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (floater)), 1)))
|
| 9119 |
|
|
break;
|
| 9120 |
|
|
}
|
| 9121 |
|
|
|
| 9122 |
|
|
else if (anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_UNCOND_BRANCH
|
| 9123 |
|
|
&& floater_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_ADDMOVE)
|
| 9124 |
|
|
{
|
| 9125 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (floater))) == PLUS)
|
| 9126 |
|
|
{
|
| 9127 |
|
|
if (pa_can_combine_p (new_rtx, anchor, floater, 0,
|
| 9128 |
|
|
SET_DEST (PATTERN (floater)),
|
| 9129 |
|
|
XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (floater)), 0),
|
| 9130 |
|
|
XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (floater)), 1)))
|
| 9131 |
|
|
break;
|
| 9132 |
|
|
}
|
| 9133 |
|
|
else
|
| 9134 |
|
|
{
|
| 9135 |
|
|
if (pa_can_combine_p (new_rtx, anchor, floater, 0,
|
| 9136 |
|
|
SET_DEST (PATTERN (floater)),
|
| 9137 |
|
|
SET_SRC (PATTERN (floater)),
|
| 9138 |
|
|
SET_SRC (PATTERN (floater))))
|
| 9139 |
|
|
break;
|
| 9140 |
|
|
}
|
| 9141 |
|
|
}
|
| 9142 |
|
|
}
|
| 9143 |
|
|
|
| 9144 |
|
|
/* If we didn't find anything on the backwards scan try forwards. */
|
| 9145 |
|
|
if (!floater
|
| 9146 |
|
|
&& (anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FMPY
|
| 9147 |
|
|
|| anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FADDSUB))
|
| 9148 |
|
|
{
|
| 9149 |
|
|
for (floater = anchor; floater; floater = NEXT_INSN (floater))
|
| 9150 |
|
|
{
|
| 9151 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (floater) == NOTE
|
| 9152 |
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (floater) == INSN
|
| 9153 |
|
|
&& (GET_CODE (PATTERN (floater)) == USE
|
| 9154 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (floater)) == CLOBBER)))
|
| 9155 |
|
|
|
| 9156 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 9157 |
|
|
|
| 9158 |
|
|
/* Anything except a regular INSN will stop our search. */
|
| 9159 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (floater) != INSN
|
| 9160 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (floater)) == ADDR_VEC
|
| 9161 |
|
|
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (floater)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
|
| 9162 |
|
|
{
|
| 9163 |
|
|
floater = NULL_RTX;
|
| 9164 |
|
|
break;
|
| 9165 |
|
|
}
|
| 9166 |
|
|
|
| 9167 |
|
|
/* See if FLOATER is suitable for combination with the
|
| 9168 |
|
|
anchor. */
|
| 9169 |
|
|
floater_attr = get_attr_pa_combine_type (floater);
|
| 9170 |
|
|
if ((anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FMPY
|
| 9171 |
|
|
&& floater_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FADDSUB)
|
| 9172 |
|
|
|| (anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FADDSUB
|
| 9173 |
|
|
&& floater_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FMPY))
|
| 9174 |
|
|
{
|
| 9175 |
|
|
/* If ANCHOR and FLOATER can be combined, then we're
|
| 9176 |
|
|
done with this pass. */
|
| 9177 |
|
|
if (pa_can_combine_p (new_rtx, anchor, floater, 1,
|
| 9178 |
|
|
SET_DEST (PATTERN (floater)),
|
| 9179 |
|
|
XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (floater)),
|
| 9180 |
|
|
0),
|
| 9181 |
|
|
XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (floater)),
|
| 9182 |
|
|
1)))
|
| 9183 |
|
|
break;
|
| 9184 |
|
|
}
|
| 9185 |
|
|
}
|
| 9186 |
|
|
}
|
| 9187 |
|
|
|
| 9188 |
|
|
/* FLOATER will be nonzero if we found a suitable floating
|
| 9189 |
|
|
insn for combination with ANCHOR. */
|
| 9190 |
|
|
if (floater
|
| 9191 |
|
|
&& (anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FADDSUB
|
| 9192 |
|
|
|| anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_FMPY))
|
| 9193 |
|
|
{
|
| 9194 |
|
|
/* Emit the new instruction and delete the old anchor. */
|
| 9195 |
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_rtx_PARALLEL
|
| 9196 |
|
|
(VOIDmode,
|
| 9197 |
|
|
gen_rtvec (2, PATTERN (anchor),
|
| 9198 |
|
|
PATTERN (floater))),
|
| 9199 |
|
|
anchor);
|
| 9200 |
|
|
|
| 9201 |
|
|
SET_INSN_DELETED (anchor);
|
| 9202 |
|
|
|
| 9203 |
|
|
/* Emit a special USE insn for FLOATER, then delete
|
| 9204 |
|
|
the floating insn. */
|
| 9205 |
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, floater), floater);
|
| 9206 |
|
|
delete_insn (floater);
|
| 9207 |
|
|
|
| 9208 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 9209 |
|
|
}
|
| 9210 |
|
|
else if (floater
|
| 9211 |
|
|
&& anchor_attr == PA_COMBINE_TYPE_UNCOND_BRANCH)
|
| 9212 |
|
|
{
|
| 9213 |
|
|
rtx temp;
|
| 9214 |
|
|
/* Emit the new_jump instruction and delete the old anchor. */
|
| 9215 |
|
|
temp
|
| 9216 |
|
|
= emit_jump_insn_before (gen_rtx_PARALLEL
|
| 9217 |
|
|
(VOIDmode,
|
| 9218 |
|
|
gen_rtvec (2, PATTERN (anchor),
|
| 9219 |
|
|
PATTERN (floater))),
|
| 9220 |
|
|
anchor);
|
| 9221 |
|
|
|
| 9222 |
|
|
JUMP_LABEL (temp) = JUMP_LABEL (anchor);
|
| 9223 |
|
|
SET_INSN_DELETED (anchor);
|
| 9224 |
|
|
|
| 9225 |
|
|
/* Emit a special USE insn for FLOATER, then delete
|
| 9226 |
|
|
the floating insn. */
|
| 9227 |
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, floater), floater);
|
| 9228 |
|
|
delete_insn (floater);
|
| 9229 |
|
|
continue;
|
| 9230 |
|
|
}
|
| 9231 |
|
|
}
|
| 9232 |
|
|
}
|
| 9233 |
|
|
}
|
| 9234 |
|
|
|
| 9235 |
|
|
static int
|
| 9236 |
|
|
pa_can_combine_p (rtx new_rtx, rtx anchor, rtx floater, int reversed, rtx dest,
|
| 9237 |
|
|
rtx src1, rtx src2)
|
| 9238 |
|
|
{
|
| 9239 |
|
|
int insn_code_number;
|
| 9240 |
|
|
rtx start, end;
|
| 9241 |
|
|
|
| 9242 |
|
|
/* Create a PARALLEL with the patterns of ANCHOR and
|
| 9243 |
|
|
FLOATER, try to recognize it, then test constraints
|
| 9244 |
|
|
for the resulting pattern.
|
| 9245 |
|
|
|
| 9246 |
|
|
If the pattern doesn't match or the constraints
|
| 9247 |
|
|
aren't met keep searching for a suitable floater
|
| 9248 |
|
|
insn. */
|
| 9249 |
|
|
XVECEXP (PATTERN (new_rtx), 0, 0) = PATTERN (anchor);
|
| 9250 |
|
|
XVECEXP (PATTERN (new_rtx), 0, 1) = PATTERN (floater);
|
| 9251 |
|
|
INSN_CODE (new_rtx) = -1;
|
| 9252 |
|
|
insn_code_number = recog_memoized (new_rtx);
|
| 9253 |
|
|
if (insn_code_number < 0
|
| 9254 |
|
|
|| (extract_insn (new_rtx), ! constrain_operands (1)))
|
| 9255 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 9256 |
|
|
|
| 9257 |
|
|
if (reversed)
|
| 9258 |
|
|
{
|
| 9259 |
|
|
start = anchor;
|
| 9260 |
|
|
end = floater;
|
| 9261 |
|
|
}
|
| 9262 |
|
|
else
|
| 9263 |
|
|
{
|
| 9264 |
|
|
start = floater;
|
| 9265 |
|
|
end = anchor;
|
| 9266 |
|
|
}
|
| 9267 |
|
|
|
| 9268 |
|
|
/* There's up to three operands to consider. One
|
| 9269 |
|
|
output and two inputs.
|
| 9270 |
|
|
|
| 9271 |
|
|
The output must not be used between FLOATER & ANCHOR
|
| 9272 |
|
|
exclusive. The inputs must not be set between
|
| 9273 |
|
|
FLOATER and ANCHOR exclusive. */
|
| 9274 |
|
|
|
| 9275 |
|
|
if (reg_used_between_p (dest, start, end))
|
| 9276 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 9277 |
|
|
|
| 9278 |
|
|
if (reg_set_between_p (src1, start, end))
|
| 9279 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 9280 |
|
|
|
| 9281 |
|
|
if (reg_set_between_p (src2, start, end))
|
| 9282 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 9283 |
|
|
|
| 9284 |
|
|
/* If we get here, then everything is good. */
|
| 9285 |
|
|
return 1;
|
| 9286 |
|
|
}
|
| 9287 |
|
|
|
| 9288 |
|
|
/* Return nonzero if references for INSN are delayed.
|
| 9289 |
|
|
|
| 9290 |
|
|
Millicode insns are actually function calls with some special
|
| 9291 |
|
|
constraints on arguments and register usage.
|
| 9292 |
|
|
|
| 9293 |
|
|
Millicode calls always expect their arguments in the integer argument
|
| 9294 |
|
|
registers, and always return their result in %r29 (ret1). They
|
| 9295 |
|
|
are expected to clobber their arguments, %r1, %r29, and the return
|
| 9296 |
|
|
pointer which is %r31 on 32-bit and %r2 on 64-bit, and nothing else.
|
| 9297 |
|
|
|
| 9298 |
|
|
This function tells reorg that the references to arguments and
|
| 9299 |
|
|
millicode calls do not appear to happen until after the millicode call.
|
| 9300 |
|
|
This allows reorg to put insns which set the argument registers into the
|
| 9301 |
|
|
delay slot of the millicode call -- thus they act more like traditional
|
| 9302 |
|
|
CALL_INSNs.
|
| 9303 |
|
|
|
| 9304 |
|
|
Note we cannot consider side effects of the insn to be delayed because
|
| 9305 |
|
|
the branch and link insn will clobber the return pointer. If we happened
|
| 9306 |
|
|
to use the return pointer in the delay slot of the call, then we lose.
|
| 9307 |
|
|
|
| 9308 |
|
|
get_attr_type will try to recognize the given insn, so make sure to
|
| 9309 |
|
|
filter out things it will not accept -- SEQUENCE, USE and CLOBBER insns
|
| 9310 |
|
|
in particular. */
|
| 9311 |
|
|
int
|
| 9312 |
|
|
pa_insn_refs_are_delayed (rtx insn)
|
| 9313 |
|
|
{
|
| 9314 |
|
|
return ((GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
|
| 9315 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != SEQUENCE
|
| 9316 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE
|
| 9317 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER
|
| 9318 |
|
|
&& get_attr_type (insn) == TYPE_MILLI));
|
| 9319 |
|
|
}
|
| 9320 |
|
|
|
| 9321 |
|
|
/* Promote the return value, but not the arguments. */
|
| 9322 |
|
|
|
| 9323 |
|
|
static enum machine_mode
|
| 9324 |
|
|
pa_promote_function_mode (const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 9325 |
|
|
enum machine_mode mode,
|
| 9326 |
|
|
int *punsignedp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 9327 |
|
|
const_tree fntype ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 9328 |
|
|
int for_return)
|
| 9329 |
|
|
{
|
| 9330 |
|
|
if (for_return == 0)
|
| 9331 |
|
|
return mode;
|
| 9332 |
|
|
return promote_mode (type, mode, punsignedp);
|
| 9333 |
|
|
}
|
| 9334 |
|
|
|
| 9335 |
|
|
/* On the HP-PA the value is found in register(s) 28(-29), unless
|
| 9336 |
|
|
the mode is SF or DF. Then the value is returned in fr4 (32).
|
| 9337 |
|
|
|
| 9338 |
|
|
This must perform the same promotions as PROMOTE_MODE, else promoting
|
| 9339 |
|
|
return values in TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE will not work correctly.
|
| 9340 |
|
|
|
| 9341 |
|
|
Small structures must be returned in a PARALLEL on PA64 in order
|
| 9342 |
|
|
to match the HP Compiler ABI. */
|
| 9343 |
|
|
|
| 9344 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 9345 |
|
|
pa_function_value (const_tree valtype,
|
| 9346 |
|
|
const_tree func ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 9347 |
|
|
bool outgoing ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 9348 |
|
|
{
|
| 9349 |
|
|
enum machine_mode valmode;
|
| 9350 |
|
|
|
| 9351 |
|
|
if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (valtype)
|
| 9352 |
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (valtype) == COMPLEX_TYPE
|
| 9353 |
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (valtype) == VECTOR_TYPE)
|
| 9354 |
|
|
{
|
| 9355 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 9356 |
|
|
{
|
| 9357 |
|
|
/* Aggregates with a size less than or equal to 128 bits are
|
| 9358 |
|
|
returned in GR 28(-29). They are left justified. The pad
|
| 9359 |
|
|
bits are undefined. Larger aggregates are returned in
|
| 9360 |
|
|
memory. */
|
| 9361 |
|
|
rtx loc[2];
|
| 9362 |
|
|
int i, offset = 0;
|
| 9363 |
|
|
int ub = int_size_in_bytes (valtype) <= UNITS_PER_WORD ? 1 : 2;
|
| 9364 |
|
|
|
| 9365 |
|
|
for (i = 0; i < ub; i++)
|
| 9366 |
|
|
{
|
| 9367 |
|
|
loc[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
|
| 9368 |
|
|
gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 28 + i),
|
| 9369 |
|
|
GEN_INT (offset));
|
| 9370 |
|
|
offset += 8;
|
| 9371 |
|
|
}
|
| 9372 |
|
|
|
| 9373 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (BLKmode, gen_rtvec_v (ub, loc));
|
| 9374 |
|
|
}
|
| 9375 |
|
|
else if (int_size_in_bytes (valtype) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
| 9376 |
|
|
{
|
| 9377 |
|
|
/* Aggregates 5 to 8 bytes in size are returned in general
|
| 9378 |
|
|
registers r28-r29 in the same manner as other non
|
| 9379 |
|
|
floating-point objects. The data is right-justified and
|
| 9380 |
|
|
zero-extended to 64 bits. This is opposite to the normal
|
| 9381 |
|
|
justification used on big endian targets and requires
|
| 9382 |
|
|
special treatment. */
|
| 9383 |
|
|
rtx loc = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
|
| 9384 |
|
|
gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 28), const0_rtx);
|
| 9385 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (BLKmode, gen_rtvec (1, loc));
|
| 9386 |
|
|
}
|
| 9387 |
|
|
}
|
| 9388 |
|
|
|
| 9389 |
|
|
if ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (valtype)
|
| 9390 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (valtype)) < BITS_PER_WORD)
|
| 9391 |
|
|
|| POINTER_TYPE_P (valtype))
|
| 9392 |
|
|
valmode = word_mode;
|
| 9393 |
|
|
else
|
| 9394 |
|
|
valmode = TYPE_MODE (valtype);
|
| 9395 |
|
|
|
| 9396 |
|
|
if (TREE_CODE (valtype) == REAL_TYPE
|
| 9397 |
|
|
&& !AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (valtype)
|
| 9398 |
|
|
&& TYPE_MODE (valtype) != TFmode
|
| 9399 |
|
|
&& !TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT)
|
| 9400 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_REG (valmode, 32);
|
| 9401 |
|
|
|
| 9402 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_REG (valmode, 28);
|
| 9403 |
|
|
}
|
| 9404 |
|
|
|
| 9405 |
|
|
/* Implement the TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE hook. */
|
| 9406 |
|
|
|
| 9407 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 9408 |
|
|
pa_libcall_value (enum machine_mode mode,
|
| 9409 |
|
|
const_rtx fun ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 9410 |
|
|
{
|
| 9411 |
|
|
if (! TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT
|
| 9412 |
|
|
&& (mode == SFmode || mode == DFmode))
|
| 9413 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_REG (mode, 32);
|
| 9414 |
|
|
else
|
| 9415 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_REG (mode, 28);
|
| 9416 |
|
|
}
|
| 9417 |
|
|
|
| 9418 |
|
|
/* Implement the TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P hook. */
|
| 9419 |
|
|
|
| 9420 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 9421 |
|
|
pa_function_value_regno_p (const unsigned int regno)
|
| 9422 |
|
|
{
|
| 9423 |
|
|
if (regno == 28
|
| 9424 |
|
|
|| (! TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT && regno == 32))
|
| 9425 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 9426 |
|
|
|
| 9427 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 9428 |
|
|
}
|
| 9429 |
|
|
|
| 9430 |
|
|
/* Update the data in CUM to advance over an argument
|
| 9431 |
|
|
of mode MODE and data type TYPE.
|
| 9432 |
|
|
(TYPE is null for libcalls where that information may not be available.) */
|
| 9433 |
|
|
|
| 9434 |
|
|
static void
|
| 9435 |
|
|
pa_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t cum_v, enum machine_mode mode,
|
| 9436 |
|
|
const_tree type, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 9437 |
|
|
{
|
| 9438 |
|
|
CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
|
| 9439 |
|
|
int arg_size = FUNCTION_ARG_SIZE (mode, type);
|
| 9440 |
|
|
|
| 9441 |
|
|
cum->nargs_prototype--;
|
| 9442 |
|
|
cum->words += (arg_size
|
| 9443 |
|
|
+ ((cum->words & 01)
|
| 9444 |
|
|
&& type != NULL_TREE
|
| 9445 |
|
|
&& arg_size > 1));
|
| 9446 |
|
|
}
|
| 9447 |
|
|
|
| 9448 |
|
|
/* Return the location of a parameter that is passed in a register or NULL
|
| 9449 |
|
|
if the parameter has any component that is passed in memory.
|
| 9450 |
|
|
|
| 9451 |
|
|
This is new code and will be pushed to into the net sources after
|
| 9452 |
|
|
further testing.
|
| 9453 |
|
|
|
| 9454 |
|
|
??? We might want to restructure this so that it looks more like other
|
| 9455 |
|
|
ports. */
|
| 9456 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 9457 |
|
|
pa_function_arg (cumulative_args_t cum_v, enum machine_mode mode,
|
| 9458 |
|
|
const_tree type, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 9459 |
|
|
{
|
| 9460 |
|
|
CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
|
| 9461 |
|
|
int max_arg_words = (TARGET_64BIT ? 8 : 4);
|
| 9462 |
|
|
int alignment = 0;
|
| 9463 |
|
|
int arg_size;
|
| 9464 |
|
|
int fpr_reg_base;
|
| 9465 |
|
|
int gpr_reg_base;
|
| 9466 |
|
|
rtx retval;
|
| 9467 |
|
|
|
| 9468 |
|
|
if (mode == VOIDmode)
|
| 9469 |
|
|
return NULL_RTX;
|
| 9470 |
|
|
|
| 9471 |
|
|
arg_size = FUNCTION_ARG_SIZE (mode, type);
|
| 9472 |
|
|
|
| 9473 |
|
|
/* If this arg would be passed partially or totally on the stack, then
|
| 9474 |
|
|
this routine should return zero. pa_arg_partial_bytes will
|
| 9475 |
|
|
handle arguments which are split between regs and stack slots if
|
| 9476 |
|
|
the ABI mandates split arguments. */
|
| 9477 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 9478 |
|
|
{
|
| 9479 |
|
|
/* The 32-bit ABI does not split arguments. */
|
| 9480 |
|
|
if (cum->words + arg_size > max_arg_words)
|
| 9481 |
|
|
return NULL_RTX;
|
| 9482 |
|
|
}
|
| 9483 |
|
|
else
|
| 9484 |
|
|
{
|
| 9485 |
|
|
if (arg_size > 1)
|
| 9486 |
|
|
alignment = cum->words & 1;
|
| 9487 |
|
|
if (cum->words + alignment >= max_arg_words)
|
| 9488 |
|
|
return NULL_RTX;
|
| 9489 |
|
|
}
|
| 9490 |
|
|
|
| 9491 |
|
|
/* The 32bit ABIs and the 64bit ABIs are rather different,
|
| 9492 |
|
|
particularly in their handling of FP registers. We might
|
| 9493 |
|
|
be able to cleverly share code between them, but I'm not
|
| 9494 |
|
|
going to bother in the hope that splitting them up results
|
| 9495 |
|
|
in code that is more easily understood. */
|
| 9496 |
|
|
|
| 9497 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 9498 |
|
|
{
|
| 9499 |
|
|
/* Advance the base registers to their current locations.
|
| 9500 |
|
|
|
| 9501 |
|
|
Remember, gprs grow towards smaller register numbers while
|
| 9502 |
|
|
fprs grow to higher register numbers. Also remember that
|
| 9503 |
|
|
although FP regs are 32-bit addressable, we pretend that
|
| 9504 |
|
|
the registers are 64-bits wide. */
|
| 9505 |
|
|
gpr_reg_base = 26 - cum->words;
|
| 9506 |
|
|
fpr_reg_base = 32 + cum->words;
|
| 9507 |
|
|
|
| 9508 |
|
|
/* Arguments wider than one word and small aggregates need special
|
| 9509 |
|
|
treatment. */
|
| 9510 |
|
|
if (arg_size > 1
|
| 9511 |
|
|
|| mode == BLKmode
|
| 9512 |
|
|
|| (type && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
|
| 9513 |
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE
|
| 9514 |
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)))
|
| 9515 |
|
|
{
|
| 9516 |
|
|
/* Double-extended precision (80-bit), quad-precision (128-bit)
|
| 9517 |
|
|
and aggregates including complex numbers are aligned on
|
| 9518 |
|
|
128-bit boundaries. The first eight 64-bit argument slots
|
| 9519 |
|
|
are associated one-to-one, with general registers r26
|
| 9520 |
|
|
through r19, and also with floating-point registers fr4
|
| 9521 |
|
|
through fr11. Arguments larger than one word are always
|
| 9522 |
|
|
passed in general registers.
|
| 9523 |
|
|
|
| 9524 |
|
|
Using a PARALLEL with a word mode register results in left
|
| 9525 |
|
|
justified data on a big-endian target. */
|
| 9526 |
|
|
|
| 9527 |
|
|
rtx loc[8];
|
| 9528 |
|
|
int i, offset = 0, ub = arg_size;
|
| 9529 |
|
|
|
| 9530 |
|
|
/* Align the base register. */
|
| 9531 |
|
|
gpr_reg_base -= alignment;
|
| 9532 |
|
|
|
| 9533 |
|
|
ub = MIN (ub, max_arg_words - cum->words - alignment);
|
| 9534 |
|
|
for (i = 0; i < ub; i++)
|
| 9535 |
|
|
{
|
| 9536 |
|
|
loc[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
|
| 9537 |
|
|
gen_rtx_REG (DImode, gpr_reg_base),
|
| 9538 |
|
|
GEN_INT (offset));
|
| 9539 |
|
|
gpr_reg_base -= 1;
|
| 9540 |
|
|
offset += 8;
|
| 9541 |
|
|
}
|
| 9542 |
|
|
|
| 9543 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (mode, gen_rtvec_v (ub, loc));
|
| 9544 |
|
|
}
|
| 9545 |
|
|
}
|
| 9546 |
|
|
else
|
| 9547 |
|
|
{
|
| 9548 |
|
|
/* If the argument is larger than a word, then we know precisely
|
| 9549 |
|
|
which registers we must use. */
|
| 9550 |
|
|
if (arg_size > 1)
|
| 9551 |
|
|
{
|
| 9552 |
|
|
if (cum->words)
|
| 9553 |
|
|
{
|
| 9554 |
|
|
gpr_reg_base = 23;
|
| 9555 |
|
|
fpr_reg_base = 38;
|
| 9556 |
|
|
}
|
| 9557 |
|
|
else
|
| 9558 |
|
|
{
|
| 9559 |
|
|
gpr_reg_base = 25;
|
| 9560 |
|
|
fpr_reg_base = 34;
|
| 9561 |
|
|
}
|
| 9562 |
|
|
|
| 9563 |
|
|
/* Structures 5 to 8 bytes in size are passed in the general
|
| 9564 |
|
|
registers in the same manner as other non floating-point
|
| 9565 |
|
|
objects. The data is right-justified and zero-extended
|
| 9566 |
|
|
to 64 bits. This is opposite to the normal justification
|
| 9567 |
|
|
used on big endian targets and requires special treatment.
|
| 9568 |
|
|
We now define BLOCK_REG_PADDING to pad these objects.
|
| 9569 |
|
|
Aggregates, complex and vector types are passed in the same
|
| 9570 |
|
|
manner as structures. */
|
| 9571 |
|
|
if (mode == BLKmode
|
| 9572 |
|
|
|| (type && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
|
| 9573 |
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE
|
| 9574 |
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)))
|
| 9575 |
|
|
{
|
| 9576 |
|
|
rtx loc = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
|
| 9577 |
|
|
gen_rtx_REG (DImode, gpr_reg_base),
|
| 9578 |
|
|
const0_rtx);
|
| 9579 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (BLKmode, gen_rtvec (1, loc));
|
| 9580 |
|
|
}
|
| 9581 |
|
|
}
|
| 9582 |
|
|
else
|
| 9583 |
|
|
{
|
| 9584 |
|
|
/* We have a single word (32 bits). A simple computation
|
| 9585 |
|
|
will get us the register #s we need. */
|
| 9586 |
|
|
gpr_reg_base = 26 - cum->words;
|
| 9587 |
|
|
fpr_reg_base = 32 + 2 * cum->words;
|
| 9588 |
|
|
}
|
| 9589 |
|
|
}
|
| 9590 |
|
|
|
| 9591 |
|
|
/* Determine if the argument needs to be passed in both general and
|
| 9592 |
|
|
floating point registers. */
|
| 9593 |
|
|
if (((TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME || TARGET_64BIT || TARGET_ELF32)
|
| 9594 |
|
|
/* If we are doing soft-float with portable runtime, then there
|
| 9595 |
|
|
is no need to worry about FP regs. */
|
| 9596 |
|
|
&& !TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT
|
| 9597 |
|
|
/* The parameter must be some kind of scalar float, else we just
|
| 9598 |
|
|
pass it in integer registers. */
|
| 9599 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
|
| 9600 |
|
|
/* The target function must not have a prototype. */
|
| 9601 |
|
|
&& cum->nargs_prototype <= 0
|
| 9602 |
|
|
/* libcalls do not need to pass items in both FP and general
|
| 9603 |
|
|
registers. */
|
| 9604 |
|
|
&& type != NULL_TREE
|
| 9605 |
|
|
/* All this hair applies to "outgoing" args only. This includes
|
| 9606 |
|
|
sibcall arguments setup with FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG. */
|
| 9607 |
|
|
&& !cum->incoming)
|
| 9608 |
|
|
/* Also pass outgoing floating arguments in both registers in indirect
|
| 9609 |
|
|
calls with the 32 bit ABI and the HP assembler since there is no
|
| 9610 |
|
|
way to the specify argument locations in static functions. */
|
| 9611 |
|
|
|| (!TARGET_64BIT
|
| 9612 |
|
|
&& !TARGET_GAS
|
| 9613 |
|
|
&& !cum->incoming
|
| 9614 |
|
|
&& cum->indirect
|
| 9615 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT))
|
| 9616 |
|
|
{
|
| 9617 |
|
|
retval
|
| 9618 |
|
|
= gen_rtx_PARALLEL
|
| 9619 |
|
|
(mode,
|
| 9620 |
|
|
gen_rtvec (2,
|
| 9621 |
|
|
gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
|
| 9622 |
|
|
gen_rtx_REG (mode, fpr_reg_base),
|
| 9623 |
|
|
const0_rtx),
|
| 9624 |
|
|
gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
|
| 9625 |
|
|
gen_rtx_REG (mode, gpr_reg_base),
|
| 9626 |
|
|
const0_rtx)));
|
| 9627 |
|
|
}
|
| 9628 |
|
|
else
|
| 9629 |
|
|
{
|
| 9630 |
|
|
/* See if we should pass this parameter in a general register. */
|
| 9631 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT
|
| 9632 |
|
|
/* Indirect calls in the normal 32bit ABI require all arguments
|
| 9633 |
|
|
to be passed in general registers. */
|
| 9634 |
|
|
|| (!TARGET_PORTABLE_RUNTIME
|
| 9635 |
|
|
&& !TARGET_64BIT
|
| 9636 |
|
|
&& !TARGET_ELF32
|
| 9637 |
|
|
&& cum->indirect)
|
| 9638 |
|
|
/* If the parameter is not a scalar floating-point parameter,
|
| 9639 |
|
|
then it belongs in GPRs. */
|
| 9640 |
|
|
|| GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_FLOAT
|
| 9641 |
|
|
/* Structure with single SFmode field belongs in GPR. */
|
| 9642 |
|
|
|| (type && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)))
|
| 9643 |
|
|
retval = gen_rtx_REG (mode, gpr_reg_base);
|
| 9644 |
|
|
else
|
| 9645 |
|
|
retval = gen_rtx_REG (mode, fpr_reg_base);
|
| 9646 |
|
|
}
|
| 9647 |
|
|
return retval;
|
| 9648 |
|
|
}
|
| 9649 |
|
|
|
| 9650 |
|
|
/* Arguments larger than one word are double word aligned. */
|
| 9651 |
|
|
|
| 9652 |
|
|
static unsigned int
|
| 9653 |
|
|
pa_function_arg_boundary (enum machine_mode mode, const_tree type)
|
| 9654 |
|
|
{
|
| 9655 |
|
|
bool singleword = (type
|
| 9656 |
|
|
? (integer_zerop (TYPE_SIZE (type))
|
| 9657 |
|
|
|| !TREE_CONSTANT (TYPE_SIZE (type))
|
| 9658 |
|
|
|| int_size_in_bytes (type) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
| 9659 |
|
|
: GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_WORD);
|
| 9660 |
|
|
|
| 9661 |
|
|
return singleword ? PARM_BOUNDARY : MAX_PARM_BOUNDARY;
|
| 9662 |
|
|
}
|
| 9663 |
|
|
|
| 9664 |
|
|
/* If this arg would be passed totally in registers or totally on the stack,
|
| 9665 |
|
|
then this routine should return zero. */
|
| 9666 |
|
|
|
| 9667 |
|
|
static int
|
| 9668 |
|
|
pa_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t cum_v, enum machine_mode mode,
|
| 9669 |
|
|
tree type, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 9670 |
|
|
{
|
| 9671 |
|
|
CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
|
| 9672 |
|
|
unsigned int max_arg_words = 8;
|
| 9673 |
|
|
unsigned int offset = 0;
|
| 9674 |
|
|
|
| 9675 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 9676 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 9677 |
|
|
|
| 9678 |
|
|
if (FUNCTION_ARG_SIZE (mode, type) > 1 && (cum->words & 1))
|
| 9679 |
|
|
offset = 1;
|
| 9680 |
|
|
|
| 9681 |
|
|
if (cum->words + offset + FUNCTION_ARG_SIZE (mode, type) <= max_arg_words)
|
| 9682 |
|
|
/* Arg fits fully into registers. */
|
| 9683 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 9684 |
|
|
else if (cum->words + offset >= max_arg_words)
|
| 9685 |
|
|
/* Arg fully on the stack. */
|
| 9686 |
|
|
return 0;
|
| 9687 |
|
|
else
|
| 9688 |
|
|
/* Arg is split. */
|
| 9689 |
|
|
return (max_arg_words - cum->words - offset) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
| 9690 |
|
|
}
|
| 9691 |
|
|
|
| 9692 |
|
|
|
| 9693 |
|
|
/* A get_unnamed_section callback for switching to the text section.
|
| 9694 |
|
|
|
| 9695 |
|
|
This function is only used with SOM. Because we don't support
|
| 9696 |
|
|
named subspaces, we can only create a new subspace or switch back
|
| 9697 |
|
|
to the default text subspace. */
|
| 9698 |
|
|
|
| 9699 |
|
|
static void
|
| 9700 |
|
|
som_output_text_section_asm_op (const void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 9701 |
|
|
{
|
| 9702 |
|
|
gcc_assert (TARGET_SOM);
|
| 9703 |
|
|
if (TARGET_GAS)
|
| 9704 |
|
|
{
|
| 9705 |
|
|
if (cfun && cfun->machine && !cfun->machine->in_nsubspa)
|
| 9706 |
|
|
{
|
| 9707 |
|
|
/* We only want to emit a .nsubspa directive once at the
|
| 9708 |
|
|
start of the function. */
|
| 9709 |
|
|
cfun->machine->in_nsubspa = 1;
|
| 9710 |
|
|
|
| 9711 |
|
|
/* Create a new subspace for the text. This provides
|
| 9712 |
|
|
better stub placement and one-only functions. */
|
| 9713 |
|
|
if (cfun->decl
|
| 9714 |
|
|
&& DECL_ONE_ONLY (cfun->decl)
|
| 9715 |
|
|
&& !DECL_WEAK (cfun->decl))
|
| 9716 |
|
|
{
|
| 9717 |
|
|
output_section_asm_op ("\t.SPACE $TEXT$\n"
|
| 9718 |
|
|
"\t.NSUBSPA $CODE$,QUAD=0,ALIGN=8,"
|
| 9719 |
|
|
"ACCESS=44,SORT=24,COMDAT");
|
| 9720 |
|
|
return;
|
| 9721 |
|
|
}
|
| 9722 |
|
|
}
|
| 9723 |
|
|
else
|
| 9724 |
|
|
{
|
| 9725 |
|
|
/* There isn't a current function or the body of the current
|
| 9726 |
|
|
function has been completed. So, we are changing to the
|
| 9727 |
|
|
text section to output debugging information. Thus, we
|
| 9728 |
|
|
need to forget that we are in the text section so that
|
| 9729 |
|
|
varasm.c will call us when text_section is selected again. */
|
| 9730 |
|
|
gcc_assert (!cfun || !cfun->machine
|
| 9731 |
|
|
|| cfun->machine->in_nsubspa == 2);
|
| 9732 |
|
|
in_section = NULL;
|
| 9733 |
|
|
}
|
| 9734 |
|
|
output_section_asm_op ("\t.SPACE $TEXT$\n\t.NSUBSPA $CODE$");
|
| 9735 |
|
|
return;
|
| 9736 |
|
|
}
|
| 9737 |
|
|
output_section_asm_op ("\t.SPACE $TEXT$\n\t.SUBSPA $CODE$");
|
| 9738 |
|
|
}
|
| 9739 |
|
|
|
| 9740 |
|
|
/* A get_unnamed_section callback for switching to comdat data
|
| 9741 |
|
|
sections. This function is only used with SOM. */
|
| 9742 |
|
|
|
| 9743 |
|
|
static void
|
| 9744 |
|
|
som_output_comdat_data_section_asm_op (const void *data)
|
| 9745 |
|
|
{
|
| 9746 |
|
|
in_section = NULL;
|
| 9747 |
|
|
output_section_asm_op (data);
|
| 9748 |
|
|
}
|
| 9749 |
|
|
|
| 9750 |
|
|
/* Implement TARGET_ASM_INITIALIZE_SECTIONS */
|
| 9751 |
|
|
|
| 9752 |
|
|
static void
|
| 9753 |
|
|
pa_som_asm_init_sections (void)
|
| 9754 |
|
|
{
|
| 9755 |
|
|
text_section
|
| 9756 |
|
|
= get_unnamed_section (0, som_output_text_section_asm_op, NULL);
|
| 9757 |
|
|
|
| 9758 |
|
|
/* SOM puts readonly data in the default $LIT$ subspace when PIC code
|
| 9759 |
|
|
is not being generated. */
|
| 9760 |
|
|
som_readonly_data_section
|
| 9761 |
|
|
= get_unnamed_section (0, output_section_asm_op,
|
| 9762 |
|
|
"\t.SPACE $TEXT$\n\t.SUBSPA $LIT$");
|
| 9763 |
|
|
|
| 9764 |
|
|
/* When secondary definitions are not supported, SOM makes readonly
|
| 9765 |
|
|
data one-only by creating a new $LIT$ subspace in $TEXT$ with
|
| 9766 |
|
|
the comdat flag. */
|
| 9767 |
|
|
som_one_only_readonly_data_section
|
| 9768 |
|
|
= get_unnamed_section (0, som_output_comdat_data_section_asm_op,
|
| 9769 |
|
|
"\t.SPACE $TEXT$\n"
|
| 9770 |
|
|
"\t.NSUBSPA $LIT$,QUAD=0,ALIGN=8,"
|
| 9771 |
|
|
"ACCESS=0x2c,SORT=16,COMDAT");
|
| 9772 |
|
|
|
| 9773 |
|
|
|
| 9774 |
|
|
/* When secondary definitions are not supported, SOM makes data one-only
|
| 9775 |
|
|
by creating a new $DATA$ subspace in $PRIVATE$ with the comdat flag. */
|
| 9776 |
|
|
som_one_only_data_section
|
| 9777 |
|
|
= get_unnamed_section (SECTION_WRITE,
|
| 9778 |
|
|
som_output_comdat_data_section_asm_op,
|
| 9779 |
|
|
"\t.SPACE $PRIVATE$\n"
|
| 9780 |
|
|
"\t.NSUBSPA $DATA$,QUAD=1,ALIGN=8,"
|
| 9781 |
|
|
"ACCESS=31,SORT=24,COMDAT");
|
| 9782 |
|
|
|
| 9783 |
|
|
if (flag_tm)
|
| 9784 |
|
|
som_tm_clone_table_section
|
| 9785 |
|
|
= get_unnamed_section (0, output_section_asm_op,
|
| 9786 |
|
|
"\t.SPACE $PRIVATE$\n\t.SUBSPA $TM_CLONE_TABLE$");
|
| 9787 |
|
|
|
| 9788 |
|
|
/* FIXME: HPUX ld generates incorrect GOT entries for "T" fixups
|
| 9789 |
|
|
which reference data within the $TEXT$ space (for example constant
|
| 9790 |
|
|
strings in the $LIT$ subspace).
|
| 9791 |
|
|
|
| 9792 |
|
|
The assemblers (GAS and HP as) both have problems with handling
|
| 9793 |
|
|
the difference of two symbols which is the other correct way to
|
| 9794 |
|
|
reference constant data during PIC code generation.
|
| 9795 |
|
|
|
| 9796 |
|
|
So, there's no way to reference constant data which is in the
|
| 9797 |
|
|
$TEXT$ space during PIC generation. Instead place all constant
|
| 9798 |
|
|
data into the $PRIVATE$ subspace (this reduces sharing, but it
|
| 9799 |
|
|
works correctly). */
|
| 9800 |
|
|
readonly_data_section = flag_pic ? data_section : som_readonly_data_section;
|
| 9801 |
|
|
|
| 9802 |
|
|
/* We must not have a reference to an external symbol defined in a
|
| 9803 |
|
|
shared library in a readonly section, else the SOM linker will
|
| 9804 |
|
|
complain.
|
| 9805 |
|
|
|
| 9806 |
|
|
So, we force exception information into the data section. */
|
| 9807 |
|
|
exception_section = data_section;
|
| 9808 |
|
|
}
|
| 9809 |
|
|
|
| 9810 |
|
|
/* Implement TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION. */
|
| 9811 |
|
|
|
| 9812 |
|
|
static section *
|
| 9813 |
|
|
pa_som_tm_clone_table_section (void)
|
| 9814 |
|
|
{
|
| 9815 |
|
|
return som_tm_clone_table_section;
|
| 9816 |
|
|
}
|
| 9817 |
|
|
|
| 9818 |
|
|
/* On hpux10, the linker will give an error if we have a reference
|
| 9819 |
|
|
in the read-only data section to a symbol defined in a shared
|
| 9820 |
|
|
library. Therefore, expressions that might require a reloc can
|
| 9821 |
|
|
not be placed in the read-only data section. */
|
| 9822 |
|
|
|
| 9823 |
|
|
static section *
|
| 9824 |
|
|
pa_select_section (tree exp, int reloc,
|
| 9825 |
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 9826 |
|
|
{
|
| 9827 |
|
|
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == VAR_DECL
|
| 9828 |
|
|
&& TREE_READONLY (exp)
|
| 9829 |
|
|
&& !TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
|
| 9830 |
|
|
&& DECL_INITIAL (exp)
|
| 9831 |
|
|
&& (DECL_INITIAL (exp) == error_mark_node
|
| 9832 |
|
|
|| TREE_CONSTANT (DECL_INITIAL (exp)))
|
| 9833 |
|
|
&& !reloc)
|
| 9834 |
|
|
{
|
| 9835 |
|
|
if (TARGET_SOM
|
| 9836 |
|
|
&& DECL_ONE_ONLY (exp)
|
| 9837 |
|
|
&& !DECL_WEAK (exp))
|
| 9838 |
|
|
return som_one_only_readonly_data_section;
|
| 9839 |
|
|
else
|
| 9840 |
|
|
return readonly_data_section;
|
| 9841 |
|
|
}
|
| 9842 |
|
|
else if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (exp) && !reloc)
|
| 9843 |
|
|
return readonly_data_section;
|
| 9844 |
|
|
else if (TARGET_SOM
|
| 9845 |
|
|
&& TREE_CODE (exp) == VAR_DECL
|
| 9846 |
|
|
&& DECL_ONE_ONLY (exp)
|
| 9847 |
|
|
&& !DECL_WEAK (exp))
|
| 9848 |
|
|
return som_one_only_data_section;
|
| 9849 |
|
|
else
|
| 9850 |
|
|
return data_section;
|
| 9851 |
|
|
}
|
| 9852 |
|
|
|
| 9853 |
|
|
static void
|
| 9854 |
|
|
pa_globalize_label (FILE *stream, const char *name)
|
| 9855 |
|
|
{
|
| 9856 |
|
|
/* We only handle DATA objects here, functions are globalized in
|
| 9857 |
|
|
ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME. */
|
| 9858 |
|
|
if (! FUNCTION_NAME_P (name))
|
| 9859 |
|
|
{
|
| 9860 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.EXPORT ", stream);
|
| 9861 |
|
|
assemble_name (stream, name);
|
| 9862 |
|
|
fputs (",DATA\n", stream);
|
| 9863 |
|
|
}
|
| 9864 |
|
|
}
|
| 9865 |
|
|
|
| 9866 |
|
|
/* Worker function for TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX. */
|
| 9867 |
|
|
|
| 9868 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 9869 |
|
|
pa_struct_value_rtx (tree fntype ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
| 9870 |
|
|
int incoming ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 9871 |
|
|
{
|
| 9872 |
|
|
return gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, PA_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM);
|
| 9873 |
|
|
}
|
| 9874 |
|
|
|
| 9875 |
|
|
/* Worker function for TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY. */
|
| 9876 |
|
|
|
| 9877 |
|
|
bool
|
| 9878 |
|
|
pa_return_in_memory (const_tree type, const_tree fntype ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
| 9879 |
|
|
{
|
| 9880 |
|
|
/* SOM ABI says that objects larger than 64 bits are returned in memory.
|
| 9881 |
|
|
PA64 ABI says that objects larger than 128 bits are returned in memory.
|
| 9882 |
|
|
Note, int_size_in_bytes can return -1 if the size of the object is
|
| 9883 |
|
|
variable or larger than the maximum value that can be expressed as
|
| 9884 |
|
|
a HOST_WIDE_INT. It can also return zero for an empty type. The
|
| 9885 |
|
|
simplest way to handle variable and empty types is to pass them in
|
| 9886 |
|
|
memory. This avoids problems in defining the boundaries of argument
|
| 9887 |
|
|
slots, allocating registers, etc. */
|
| 9888 |
|
|
return (int_size_in_bytes (type) > (TARGET_64BIT ? 16 : 8)
|
| 9889 |
|
|
|| int_size_in_bytes (type) <= 0);
|
| 9890 |
|
|
}
|
| 9891 |
|
|
|
| 9892 |
|
|
/* Structure to hold declaration and name of external symbols that are
|
| 9893 |
|
|
emitted by GCC. We generate a vector of these symbols and output them
|
| 9894 |
|
|
at the end of the file if and only if SYMBOL_REF_REFERENCED_P is true.
|
| 9895 |
|
|
This avoids putting out names that are never really used. */
|
| 9896 |
|
|
|
| 9897 |
|
|
typedef struct GTY(()) extern_symbol
|
| 9898 |
|
|
{
|
| 9899 |
|
|
tree decl;
|
| 9900 |
|
|
const char *name;
|
| 9901 |
|
|
} extern_symbol;
|
| 9902 |
|
|
|
| 9903 |
|
|
/* Define gc'd vector type for extern_symbol. */
|
| 9904 |
|
|
DEF_VEC_O(extern_symbol);
|
| 9905 |
|
|
DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(extern_symbol,gc);
|
| 9906 |
|
|
|
| 9907 |
|
|
/* Vector of extern_symbol pointers. */
|
| 9908 |
|
|
static GTY(()) VEC(extern_symbol,gc) *extern_symbols;
|
| 9909 |
|
|
|
| 9910 |
|
|
#ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_REAL
|
| 9911 |
|
|
/* Mark DECL (name NAME) as an external reference (assembler output
|
| 9912 |
|
|
file FILE). This saves the names to output at the end of the file
|
| 9913 |
|
|
if actually referenced. */
|
| 9914 |
|
|
|
| 9915 |
|
|
void
|
| 9916 |
|
|
pa_hpux_asm_output_external (FILE *file, tree decl, const char *name)
|
| 9917 |
|
|
{
|
| 9918 |
|
|
extern_symbol * p = VEC_safe_push (extern_symbol, gc, extern_symbols, NULL);
|
| 9919 |
|
|
|
| 9920 |
|
|
gcc_assert (file == asm_out_file);
|
| 9921 |
|
|
p->decl = decl;
|
| 9922 |
|
|
p->name = name;
|
| 9923 |
|
|
}
|
| 9924 |
|
|
|
| 9925 |
|
|
/* Output text required at the end of an assembler file.
|
| 9926 |
|
|
This includes deferred plabels and .import directives for
|
| 9927 |
|
|
all external symbols that were actually referenced. */
|
| 9928 |
|
|
|
| 9929 |
|
|
static void
|
| 9930 |
|
|
pa_hpux_file_end (void)
|
| 9931 |
|
|
{
|
| 9932 |
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
| 9933 |
|
|
extern_symbol *p;
|
| 9934 |
|
|
|
| 9935 |
|
|
if (!NO_DEFERRED_PROFILE_COUNTERS)
|
| 9936 |
|
|
output_deferred_profile_counters ();
|
| 9937 |
|
|
|
| 9938 |
|
|
output_deferred_plabels ();
|
| 9939 |
|
|
|
| 9940 |
|
|
for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (extern_symbol, extern_symbols, i, p); i++)
|
| 9941 |
|
|
{
|
| 9942 |
|
|
tree decl = p->decl;
|
| 9943 |
|
|
|
| 9944 |
|
|
if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl)
|
| 9945 |
|
|
&& SYMBOL_REF_REFERENCED_P (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0)))
|
| 9946 |
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_REAL (asm_out_file, decl, p->name);
|
| 9947 |
|
|
}
|
| 9948 |
|
|
|
| 9949 |
|
|
VEC_free (extern_symbol, gc, extern_symbols);
|
| 9950 |
|
|
}
|
| 9951 |
|
|
#endif
|
| 9952 |
|
|
|
| 9953 |
|
|
/* Return true if a change from mode FROM to mode TO for a register
|
| 9954 |
|
|
in register class RCLASS is invalid. */
|
| 9955 |
|
|
|
| 9956 |
|
|
bool
|
| 9957 |
|
|
pa_cannot_change_mode_class (enum machine_mode from, enum machine_mode to,
|
| 9958 |
|
|
enum reg_class rclass)
|
| 9959 |
|
|
{
|
| 9960 |
|
|
if (from == to)
|
| 9961 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 9962 |
|
|
|
| 9963 |
|
|
/* Reject changes to/from complex and vector modes. */
|
| 9964 |
|
|
if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (from) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from)
|
| 9965 |
|
|
|| COMPLEX_MODE_P (to) || VECTOR_MODE_P (to))
|
| 9966 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 9967 |
|
|
|
| 9968 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (from) == GET_MODE_SIZE (to))
|
| 9969 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 9970 |
|
|
|
| 9971 |
|
|
/* There is no way to load QImode or HImode values directly from
|
| 9972 |
|
|
memory. SImode loads to the FP registers are not zero extended.
|
| 9973 |
|
|
On the 64-bit target, this conflicts with the definition of
|
| 9974 |
|
|
LOAD_EXTEND_OP. Thus, we can't allow changing between modes
|
| 9975 |
|
|
with different sizes in the floating-point registers. */
|
| 9976 |
|
|
if (MAYBE_FP_REG_CLASS_P (rclass))
|
| 9977 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 9978 |
|
|
|
| 9979 |
|
|
/* HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK places modes with sizes larger than a word
|
| 9980 |
|
|
in specific sets of registers. Thus, we cannot allow changing
|
| 9981 |
|
|
to a larger mode when it's larger than a word. */
|
| 9982 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (to) > UNITS_PER_WORD
|
| 9983 |
|
|
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (to) > GET_MODE_SIZE (from))
|
| 9984 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 9985 |
|
|
|
| 9986 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 9987 |
|
|
}
|
| 9988 |
|
|
|
| 9989 |
|
|
/* Returns TRUE if it is a good idea to tie two pseudo registers
|
| 9990 |
|
|
when one has mode MODE1 and one has mode MODE2.
|
| 9991 |
|
|
If HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK could produce different values for MODE1 and MODE2,
|
| 9992 |
|
|
for any hard reg, then this must be FALSE for correct output.
|
| 9993 |
|
|
|
| 9994 |
|
|
We should return FALSE for QImode and HImode because these modes
|
| 9995 |
|
|
are not ok in the floating-point registers. However, this prevents
|
| 9996 |
|
|
tieing these modes to SImode and DImode in the general registers.
|
| 9997 |
|
|
So, this isn't a good idea. We rely on HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK and
|
| 9998 |
|
|
CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS to prevent these modes from being used
|
| 9999 |
|
|
in the floating-point registers. */
|
| 10000 |
|
|
|
| 10001 |
|
|
bool
|
| 10002 |
|
|
pa_modes_tieable_p (enum machine_mode mode1, enum machine_mode mode2)
|
| 10003 |
|
|
{
|
| 10004 |
|
|
/* Don't tie modes in different classes. */
|
| 10005 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode1) != GET_MODE_CLASS (mode2))
|
| 10006 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 10007 |
|
|
|
| 10008 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 10009 |
|
|
}
|
| 10010 |
|
|
|
| 10011 |
|
|
|
| 10012 |
|
|
/* Length in units of the trampoline instruction code. */
|
| 10013 |
|
|
|
| 10014 |
|
|
#define TRAMPOLINE_CODE_SIZE (TARGET_64BIT ? 24 : (TARGET_PA_20 ? 32 : 40))
|
| 10015 |
|
|
|
| 10016 |
|
|
|
| 10017 |
|
|
/* Output assembler code for a block containing the constant parts
|
| 10018 |
|
|
of a trampoline, leaving space for the variable parts.\
|
| 10019 |
|
|
|
| 10020 |
|
|
The trampoline sets the static chain pointer to STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
|
| 10021 |
|
|
and then branches to the specified routine.
|
| 10022 |
|
|
|
| 10023 |
|
|
This code template is copied from text segment to stack location
|
| 10024 |
|
|
and then patched with pa_trampoline_init to contain valid values,
|
| 10025 |
|
|
and then entered as a subroutine.
|
| 10026 |
|
|
|
| 10027 |
|
|
It is best to keep this as small as possible to avoid having to
|
| 10028 |
|
|
flush multiple lines in the cache. */
|
| 10029 |
|
|
|
| 10030 |
|
|
static void
|
| 10031 |
|
|
pa_asm_trampoline_template (FILE *f)
|
| 10032 |
|
|
{
|
| 10033 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 10034 |
|
|
{
|
| 10035 |
|
|
fputs ("\tldw 36(%r22),%r21\n", f);
|
| 10036 |
|
|
fputs ("\tbb,>=,n %r21,30,.+16\n", f);
|
| 10037 |
|
|
if (ASSEMBLER_DIALECT == 0)
|
| 10038 |
|
|
fputs ("\tdepi 0,31,2,%r21\n", f);
|
| 10039 |
|
|
else
|
| 10040 |
|
|
fputs ("\tdepwi 0,31,2,%r21\n", f);
|
| 10041 |
|
|
fputs ("\tldw 4(%r21),%r19\n", f);
|
| 10042 |
|
|
fputs ("\tldw 0(%r21),%r21\n", f);
|
| 10043 |
|
|
if (TARGET_PA_20)
|
| 10044 |
|
|
{
|
| 10045 |
|
|
fputs ("\tbve (%r21)\n", f);
|
| 10046 |
|
|
fputs ("\tldw 40(%r22),%r29\n", f);
|
| 10047 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.word 0\n", f);
|
| 10048 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.word 0\n", f);
|
| 10049 |
|
|
}
|
| 10050 |
|
|
else
|
| 10051 |
|
|
{
|
| 10052 |
|
|
fputs ("\tldsid (%r21),%r1\n", f);
|
| 10053 |
|
|
fputs ("\tmtsp %r1,%sr0\n", f);
|
| 10054 |
|
|
fputs ("\tbe 0(%sr0,%r21)\n", f);
|
| 10055 |
|
|
fputs ("\tldw 40(%r22),%r29\n", f);
|
| 10056 |
|
|
}
|
| 10057 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.word 0\n", f);
|
| 10058 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.word 0\n", f);
|
| 10059 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.word 0\n", f);
|
| 10060 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.word 0\n", f);
|
| 10061 |
|
|
}
|
| 10062 |
|
|
else
|
| 10063 |
|
|
{
|
| 10064 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.dword 0\n", f);
|
| 10065 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.dword 0\n", f);
|
| 10066 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.dword 0\n", f);
|
| 10067 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.dword 0\n", f);
|
| 10068 |
|
|
fputs ("\tmfia %r31\n", f);
|
| 10069 |
|
|
fputs ("\tldd 24(%r31),%r1\n", f);
|
| 10070 |
|
|
fputs ("\tldd 24(%r1),%r27\n", f);
|
| 10071 |
|
|
fputs ("\tldd 16(%r1),%r1\n", f);
|
| 10072 |
|
|
fputs ("\tbve (%r1)\n", f);
|
| 10073 |
|
|
fputs ("\tldd 32(%r31),%r31\n", f);
|
| 10074 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.dword 0 ; fptr\n", f);
|
| 10075 |
|
|
fputs ("\t.dword 0 ; static link\n", f);
|
| 10076 |
|
|
}
|
| 10077 |
|
|
}
|
| 10078 |
|
|
|
| 10079 |
|
|
/* Emit RTL insns to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
|
| 10080 |
|
|
FNADDR is an RTX for the address of the function's pure code.
|
| 10081 |
|
|
CXT is an RTX for the static chain value for the function.
|
| 10082 |
|
|
|
| 10083 |
|
|
Move the function address to the trampoline template at offset 36.
|
| 10084 |
|
|
Move the static chain value to trampoline template at offset 40.
|
| 10085 |
|
|
Move the trampoline address to trampoline template at offset 44.
|
| 10086 |
|
|
Move r19 to trampoline template at offset 48. The latter two
|
| 10087 |
|
|
words create a plabel for the indirect call to the trampoline.
|
| 10088 |
|
|
|
| 10089 |
|
|
A similar sequence is used for the 64-bit port but the plabel is
|
| 10090 |
|
|
at the beginning of the trampoline.
|
| 10091 |
|
|
|
| 10092 |
|
|
Finally, the cache entries for the trampoline code are flushed.
|
| 10093 |
|
|
This is necessary to ensure that the trampoline instruction sequence
|
| 10094 |
|
|
is written to memory prior to any attempts at prefetching the code
|
| 10095 |
|
|
sequence. */
|
| 10096 |
|
|
|
| 10097 |
|
|
static void
|
| 10098 |
|
|
pa_trampoline_init (rtx m_tramp, tree fndecl, rtx chain_value)
|
| 10099 |
|
|
{
|
| 10100 |
|
|
rtx fnaddr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (fndecl), 0);
|
| 10101 |
|
|
rtx start_addr = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 10102 |
|
|
rtx end_addr = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 10103 |
|
|
rtx line_length = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
| 10104 |
|
|
rtx r_tramp, tmp;
|
| 10105 |
|
|
|
| 10106 |
|
|
emit_block_move (m_tramp, assemble_trampoline_template (),
|
| 10107 |
|
|
GEN_INT (TRAMPOLINE_SIZE), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
|
| 10108 |
|
|
r_tramp = force_reg (Pmode, XEXP (m_tramp, 0));
|
| 10109 |
|
|
|
| 10110 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 10111 |
|
|
{
|
| 10112 |
|
|
tmp = adjust_address (m_tramp, Pmode, 36);
|
| 10113 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmp, fnaddr);
|
| 10114 |
|
|
tmp = adjust_address (m_tramp, Pmode, 40);
|
| 10115 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmp, chain_value);
|
| 10116 |
|
|
|
| 10117 |
|
|
/* Create a fat pointer for the trampoline. */
|
| 10118 |
|
|
tmp = adjust_address (m_tramp, Pmode, 44);
|
| 10119 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmp, r_tramp);
|
| 10120 |
|
|
tmp = adjust_address (m_tramp, Pmode, 48);
|
| 10121 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmp, gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 19));
|
| 10122 |
|
|
|
| 10123 |
|
|
/* fdc and fic only use registers for the address to flush,
|
| 10124 |
|
|
they do not accept integer displacements. We align the
|
| 10125 |
|
|
start and end addresses to the beginning of their respective
|
| 10126 |
|
|
cache lines to minimize the number of lines flushed. */
|
| 10127 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_andsi3 (start_addr, r_tramp,
|
| 10128 |
|
|
GEN_INT (-MIN_CACHELINE_SIZE)));
|
| 10129 |
|
|
tmp = force_reg (Pmode, plus_constant (r_tramp, TRAMPOLINE_CODE_SIZE-1));
|
| 10130 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_andsi3 (end_addr, tmp,
|
| 10131 |
|
|
GEN_INT (-MIN_CACHELINE_SIZE)));
|
| 10132 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (line_length, GEN_INT (MIN_CACHELINE_SIZE));
|
| 10133 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_dcacheflushsi (start_addr, end_addr, line_length));
|
| 10134 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_icacheflushsi (start_addr, end_addr, line_length,
|
| 10135 |
|
|
gen_reg_rtx (Pmode),
|
| 10136 |
|
|
gen_reg_rtx (Pmode)));
|
| 10137 |
|
|
}
|
| 10138 |
|
|
else
|
| 10139 |
|
|
{
|
| 10140 |
|
|
tmp = adjust_address (m_tramp, Pmode, 56);
|
| 10141 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmp, fnaddr);
|
| 10142 |
|
|
tmp = adjust_address (m_tramp, Pmode, 64);
|
| 10143 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmp, chain_value);
|
| 10144 |
|
|
|
| 10145 |
|
|
/* Create a fat pointer for the trampoline. */
|
| 10146 |
|
|
tmp = adjust_address (m_tramp, Pmode, 16);
|
| 10147 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmp, force_reg (Pmode, plus_constant (r_tramp, 32)));
|
| 10148 |
|
|
tmp = adjust_address (m_tramp, Pmode, 24);
|
| 10149 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (tmp, gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 27));
|
| 10150 |
|
|
|
| 10151 |
|
|
/* fdc and fic only use registers for the address to flush,
|
| 10152 |
|
|
they do not accept integer displacements. We align the
|
| 10153 |
|
|
start and end addresses to the beginning of their respective
|
| 10154 |
|
|
cache lines to minimize the number of lines flushed. */
|
| 10155 |
|
|
tmp = force_reg (Pmode, plus_constant (r_tramp, 32));
|
| 10156 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_anddi3 (start_addr, tmp,
|
| 10157 |
|
|
GEN_INT (-MIN_CACHELINE_SIZE)));
|
| 10158 |
|
|
tmp = force_reg (Pmode, plus_constant (tmp, TRAMPOLINE_CODE_SIZE - 1));
|
| 10159 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_anddi3 (end_addr, tmp,
|
| 10160 |
|
|
GEN_INT (-MIN_CACHELINE_SIZE)));
|
| 10161 |
|
|
emit_move_insn (line_length, GEN_INT (MIN_CACHELINE_SIZE));
|
| 10162 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_dcacheflushdi (start_addr, end_addr, line_length));
|
| 10163 |
|
|
emit_insn (gen_icacheflushdi (start_addr, end_addr, line_length,
|
| 10164 |
|
|
gen_reg_rtx (Pmode),
|
| 10165 |
|
|
gen_reg_rtx (Pmode)));
|
| 10166 |
|
|
}
|
| 10167 |
|
|
}
|
| 10168 |
|
|
|
| 10169 |
|
|
/* Perform any machine-specific adjustment in the address of the trampoline.
|
| 10170 |
|
|
ADDR contains the address that was passed to pa_trampoline_init.
|
| 10171 |
|
|
Adjust the trampoline address to point to the plabel at offset 44. */
|
| 10172 |
|
|
|
| 10173 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 10174 |
|
|
pa_trampoline_adjust_address (rtx addr)
|
| 10175 |
|
|
{
|
| 10176 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 10177 |
|
|
addr = memory_address (Pmode, plus_constant (addr, 46));
|
| 10178 |
|
|
return addr;
|
| 10179 |
|
|
}
|
| 10180 |
|
|
|
| 10181 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 10182 |
|
|
pa_delegitimize_address (rtx orig_x)
|
| 10183 |
|
|
{
|
| 10184 |
|
|
rtx x = delegitimize_mem_from_attrs (orig_x);
|
| 10185 |
|
|
|
| 10186 |
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == LO_SUM
|
| 10187 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == UNSPEC
|
| 10188 |
|
|
&& XINT (XEXP (x, 1), 1) == UNSPEC_DLTIND14R)
|
| 10189 |
|
|
return gen_const_mem (Pmode, XVECEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0, 0));
|
| 10190 |
|
|
return x;
|
| 10191 |
|
|
}
|
| 10192 |
|
|
|
| 10193 |
|
|
static rtx
|
| 10194 |
|
|
pa_internal_arg_pointer (void)
|
| 10195 |
|
|
{
|
| 10196 |
|
|
/* The argument pointer and the hard frame pointer are the same in
|
| 10197 |
|
|
the 32-bit runtime, so we don't need a copy. */
|
| 10198 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT)
|
| 10199 |
|
|
return copy_to_reg (virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
|
| 10200 |
|
|
else
|
| 10201 |
|
|
return virtual_incoming_args_rtx;
|
| 10202 |
|
|
}
|
| 10203 |
|
|
|
| 10204 |
|
|
/* Given FROM and TO register numbers, say whether this elimination is allowed.
|
| 10205 |
|
|
Frame pointer elimination is automatically handled. */
|
| 10206 |
|
|
|
| 10207 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 10208 |
|
|
pa_can_eliminate (const int from, const int to)
|
| 10209 |
|
|
{
|
| 10210 |
|
|
/* The argument cannot be eliminated in the 64-bit runtime. */
|
| 10211 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT && from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
| 10212 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 10213 |
|
|
|
| 10214 |
|
|
return (from == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
| 10215 |
|
|
? ! frame_pointer_needed
|
| 10216 |
|
|
: true);
|
| 10217 |
|
|
}
|
| 10218 |
|
|
|
| 10219 |
|
|
/* Define the offset between two registers, FROM to be eliminated and its
|
| 10220 |
|
|
replacement TO, at the start of a routine. */
|
| 10221 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT
|
| 10222 |
|
|
pa_initial_elimination_offset (int from, int to)
|
| 10223 |
|
|
{
|
| 10224 |
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
|
| 10225 |
|
|
|
| 10226 |
|
|
if ((from == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM || from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
| 10227 |
|
|
&& to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
| 10228 |
|
|
offset = -pa_compute_frame_size (get_frame_size (), 0);
|
| 10229 |
|
|
else if (from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
| 10230 |
|
|
offset = 0;
|
| 10231 |
|
|
else
|
| 10232 |
|
|
gcc_unreachable ();
|
| 10233 |
|
|
|
| 10234 |
|
|
return offset;
|
| 10235 |
|
|
}
|
| 10236 |
|
|
|
| 10237 |
|
|
static void
|
| 10238 |
|
|
pa_conditional_register_usage (void)
|
| 10239 |
|
|
{
|
| 10240 |
|
|
int i;
|
| 10241 |
|
|
|
| 10242 |
|
|
if (!TARGET_64BIT && !TARGET_PA_11)
|
| 10243 |
|
|
{
|
| 10244 |
|
|
for (i = 56; i <= FP_REG_LAST; i++)
|
| 10245 |
|
|
fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
|
| 10246 |
|
|
for (i = 33; i < 56; i += 2)
|
| 10247 |
|
|
fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
|
| 10248 |
|
|
}
|
| 10249 |
|
|
if (TARGET_DISABLE_FPREGS || TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT)
|
| 10250 |
|
|
{
|
| 10251 |
|
|
for (i = FP_REG_FIRST; i <= FP_REG_LAST; i++)
|
| 10252 |
|
|
fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
|
| 10253 |
|
|
}
|
| 10254 |
|
|
if (flag_pic)
|
| 10255 |
|
|
fixed_regs[PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM] = 1;
|
| 10256 |
|
|
}
|
| 10257 |
|
|
|
| 10258 |
|
|
/* Target hook for c_mode_for_suffix. */
|
| 10259 |
|
|
|
| 10260 |
|
|
static enum machine_mode
|
| 10261 |
|
|
pa_c_mode_for_suffix (char suffix)
|
| 10262 |
|
|
{
|
| 10263 |
|
|
if (HPUX_LONG_DOUBLE_LIBRARY)
|
| 10264 |
|
|
{
|
| 10265 |
|
|
if (suffix == 'q')
|
| 10266 |
|
|
return TFmode;
|
| 10267 |
|
|
}
|
| 10268 |
|
|
|
| 10269 |
|
|
return VOIDmode;
|
| 10270 |
|
|
}
|
| 10271 |
|
|
|
| 10272 |
|
|
/* Target hook for function_section. */
|
| 10273 |
|
|
|
| 10274 |
|
|
static section *
|
| 10275 |
|
|
pa_function_section (tree decl, enum node_frequency freq,
|
| 10276 |
|
|
bool startup, bool exit)
|
| 10277 |
|
|
{
|
| 10278 |
|
|
/* Put functions in text section if target doesn't have named sections. */
|
| 10279 |
|
|
if (!targetm_common.have_named_sections)
|
| 10280 |
|
|
return text_section;
|
| 10281 |
|
|
|
| 10282 |
|
|
/* Force nested functions into the same section as the containing
|
| 10283 |
|
|
function. */
|
| 10284 |
|
|
if (decl
|
| 10285 |
|
|
&& DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE
|
| 10286 |
|
|
&& DECL_CONTEXT (decl) != NULL_TREE
|
| 10287 |
|
|
&& TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL
|
| 10288 |
|
|
&& DECL_SECTION_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NULL_TREE)
|
| 10289 |
|
|
return function_section (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
|
| 10290 |
|
|
|
| 10291 |
|
|
/* Otherwise, use the default function section. */
|
| 10292 |
|
|
return default_function_section (decl, freq, startup, exit);
|
| 10293 |
|
|
}
|
| 10294 |
|
|
|
| 10295 |
|
|
/* Implement TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P.
|
| 10296 |
|
|
|
| 10297 |
|
|
In 64-bit mode, we reject CONST_DOUBLES. We also reject CONST_INTS
|
| 10298 |
|
|
that need more than three instructions to load prior to reload. This
|
| 10299 |
|
|
limit is somewhat arbitrary. It takes three instructions to load a
|
| 10300 |
|
|
CONST_INT from memory but two are memory accesses. It may be better
|
| 10301 |
|
|
to increase the allowed range for CONST_INTS. We may also be able
|
| 10302 |
|
|
to handle CONST_DOUBLES. */
|
| 10303 |
|
|
|
| 10304 |
|
|
static bool
|
| 10305 |
|
|
pa_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
|
| 10306 |
|
|
{
|
| 10307 |
|
|
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT && x != CONST0_RTX (mode))
|
| 10308 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 10309 |
|
|
|
| 10310 |
|
|
if (!NEW_HP_ASSEMBLER && !TARGET_GAS && GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF)
|
| 10311 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 10312 |
|
|
|
| 10313 |
|
|
/* TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC and TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC are not
|
| 10314 |
|
|
legitimate constants. */
|
| 10315 |
|
|
if (PA_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P (x))
|
| 10316 |
|
|
{
|
| 10317 |
|
|
enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x);
|
| 10318 |
|
|
|
| 10319 |
|
|
if (model == TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC || model == TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC)
|
| 10320 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 10321 |
|
|
}
|
| 10322 |
|
|
|
| 10323 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT && GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
|
| 10324 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 10325 |
|
|
|
| 10326 |
|
|
if (TARGET_64BIT
|
| 10327 |
|
|
&& HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > 32
|
| 10328 |
|
|
&& GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
|
| 10329 |
|
|
&& !reload_in_progress
|
| 10330 |
|
|
&& !reload_completed
|
| 10331 |
|
|
&& !LEGITIMATE_64BIT_CONST_INT_P (INTVAL (x))
|
| 10332 |
|
|
&& !pa_cint_ok_for_move (INTVAL (x)))
|
| 10333 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 10334 |
|
|
|
| 10335 |
|
|
if (function_label_operand (x, mode))
|
| 10336 |
|
|
return false;
|
| 10337 |
|
|
|
| 10338 |
|
|
return true;
|
| 10339 |
|
|
}
|
| 10340 |
|
|
|
| 10341 |
|
|
#include "gt-pa.h"
|